This is a modern-English version of Howard Pyle's Book of pirates : fiction, fact & fancy concerning the buccaneers & marooners of the Spanish Main, originally written by Pyle, Howard. It has been thoroughly updated, including changes to sentence structure, words, spelling, and grammar—to ensure clarity for contemporary readers, while preserving the original spirit and nuance. If you click on a paragraph, you will see the original text that we modified, and you can toggle between the two versions.

Scroll to the bottom of this page and you will find a free ePUB download link for this book.


 

The Challenge The Challenge
Studio April 7, 1903.
H. Pyle. del.

 

Howard Pyle's Book of Pirates Howard Pyle's
Book of Pirates

The Bold Pirate, as envisioned by
a Quaker gentleman in the—
farmlands of Pennsylvania—

Howard Pyle—Chadds Ford
September 13th 1903—

 

 

AN ATTACK ON A GALLEON an attack on a ship

 

 

 

 

Howard Pyle's
Book of Pirates

 

Fiction, Fact & Fancy concerning
the Buccaneers & Marooners of
the Spanish Main: From the
writing & Pictures of Howard
Pyle: Compiled by Merle Johnson

 

 

Harper & Brothers Publishers
New York & London


CONTENTS

PAGE
  Foreword by Merle Johnson xi
  Preface xiii
I.   Buccaneers and Marooners of the Spanish Main 3
II.   The Ghost of Captain Brand 39
III.   With the Buccaneers 75
IV.   Tom Chist and the Treasure Box 99
V.   Jack Ballister's Fortunes 129
VI.   Blueskin, the Pirate 150
VII.   Captain Scarfield 187
VIII.   The Ruby of Kishmoor 210

ILLUSTRATIONS

An Attack on a Galleon  Frontispiece
On the Dry Tortugas Facing p.6
Capture of the Galleon "10
Henry Morgan Recruiting for the Attack "14
Morgan at Porto Bello "16
The Sacking of Panama "20
Marooned "26
Blackbeard Buries His Treasure "32
Walking the Plank "36
"Captain Malyoe shot Captain Brand in the head." "40
"She would sit completely still, allowing Barnaby to stare." "68
Buried Treasure "76
Kidd on the Deck of the "Adventure Ship" "85
Burning the Ship "92
Who Shall Be Captain? "104
Kidd at Gardiner's Island "108
Extorting Tribute from the Citizens "116
"Pirates used to do that to their captains every now and then." "124
"Jack followed the captain and the young lady up the winding path to the house." "132
"He brought Jack to a man who was sitting on a barrel." " 136
"The bullets were buzzing and singing, zipping along the surface of the water." "142
"The fighters sliced and hacked with wild rage." "146
So the Treasure Was Divided "154
Colonel Rhett and the Pirate "162
The Pirate's Christmas "174
"He lay quiet and motionless, with his face partially buried in the sand." "182
"There goes Cap'n Goldsack, sneaking, sneaking, sneaking, searching for his treasure down below!" "186
"He found the captain friendly and easy to get along with." "190
The Buccaneer Was a Picturesque Fellow "196
Then the Real Fight Began "200
"He hit the bald, narrow forehead below him again and again." "206
Captain Keitt "212
How the Buccaneers Kept Christmas "224
The Burning Ship "236
Dead Men Tell No Tales "240
"I Am the Daughter of That Unlucky Captain Keitt" "244

FOREWORD

Pirates, Buccaneers, Marooners, those cruel but picturesque sea wolves who once infested the Spanish Main, all live in present-day conceptions in great degree as drawn by the pen and pencil of Howard Pyle.

Pirates, Buccaneers, Marooners—those ruthless yet iconic sea wolves who once roamed the Spanish Main—are still very much alive in today's imagination, largely shaped by the art and writings of Howard Pyle.

Pyle, artist-author, living in the latter half of the nineteenth century and the first decade of the twentieth, had the fine faculty of transposing himself into any chosen period of history and making its people flesh and blood again—not just historical puppets. His characters were sketched with both words and picture; with both words and picture he ranks as a master, with a rich personality which makes his work individual and attractive in either medium.

Pyle, an artist and author who lived in the late 1800s and early 1900s, had a remarkable ability to immerse himself in any historical period and bring its people to life—not just as mere historical figures. His characters were brought to life through both words and images; he is a master in both mediums, with a vibrant personality that makes his work unique and appealing in either form.

He was one of the founders of present-day American illustration, and his pupils and grand-pupils pervade that field to-day. While he bore no such important part in the world of letters, his stories are modern in treatment, and yet widely read. His range included historical treatises concerning his favorite Pirates (Quaker though he was); fiction, with the same Pirates as principals; Americanized version of Old World fairy tales; boy stories of the Middle Ages, still best sellers to growing lads; stories of the occult, such as In Tenebras and To the Soil of the Earth, which, if newly published, would be hailed as contributions to our latest cult.

He was one of the founders of modern American illustration, and his students and their students dominate that field today. Although he didn't play a major role in literature, his stories are contemporary in style and still widely read. His work included historical accounts about his favorite pirates (even though he was a Quaker), fiction featuring those same pirates as characters, Americanized versions of classic fairy tales, medieval boy stories that remain bestsellers for young readers, and occult stories like In Tenebras and To the Soil of the Earth, which would be celebrated as contributions to our latest trends if they were newly published.

In all these fields Pyle's work may be equaled, surpassed, save in one. It is improbable that anyone else will ever bring his combination of interest and talent to the depiction of these old-time Pirates, any more than there could be a second Remington to paint the now extinct Indians and gun-fighters of the Great West.

In all these areas, Pyle's work can be matched or even surpassed, except for one. It's unlikely that anyone else will ever combine his interest and talent in portraying these historical pirates, just like there will never be another Remington to capture the now-extinct Indians and gunfighters of the Wild West.

Important and interesting to the student of history, the[xii] adventure-lover, and the artist, as they are, these Pirate stories and pictures have been scattered through many magazines and books. Here, in this volume, they are gathered together for the first time, perhaps not just as Mr. Pyle would have done, but with a completeness and appreciation of the real value of the material which the author's modesty might not have permitted.

Important and interesting to students of history, adventure lovers, and artists, these pirate stories and illustrations have been spread across various magazines and books. In this volume, they are compiled together for the first time, maybe not exactly as Mr. Pyle would have done, but with a thoroughness and recognition of the true worth of the material that the author's humility might not have allowed.

Merle Johnson.

Merle Johnson


PREFACE

Why is it that a little spice of deviltry lends not an unpleasantly titillating twang to the great mass of respectable flour that goes to make up the pudding of our modern civilization? And pertinent to this question another—Why is it that the pirate has, and always has had, a certain lurid glamour of the heroical enveloping him round about? Is there, deep under the accumulated debris of culture, a hidden groundwork of the old-time savage? Is there even in these well-regulated times an unsubdued nature in the respectable mental household of every one of us that still kicks against the pricks of law and order? To make my meaning more clear, would not every boy, for instance—that is, every boy of any account—rather be a pirate captain than a Member of Parliament? And we ourselves—would we not rather read such a story as that of Captain Avery's capture of the East Indian treasure ship, with its beautiful princess and load of jewels (which gems he sold by the handful, history sayeth, to a Bristol merchant), than, say, one of Bishop Atterbury's sermons, or the goodly Master Robert Boyle's religious romance of "Theodora and Didymus"? It is to be apprehended that to the unregenerate nature of most of us there can be but one answer to such a query.

Why is it that a little bit of mischief adds a surprisingly exciting twist to the solid foundation of respectable society that shapes our modern civilization? And related to this question is another—Why does the pirate always have a compelling, heroic allure surrounding him? Is there, beneath all the layers of culture, a deep-rooted essence of the ancient savage? Even in our organized times, is there an untamed spirit within each of us that still rebels against the rules of law and order? To clarify my point, wouldn’t every boy, at least those of any substance, prefer to be a pirate captain rather than a Member of Parliament? And wouldn't we ourselves rather read a story like that of Captain Avery's capture of the East Indian treasure ship, with its beautiful princess and cargo of jewels (which he supposedly sold by the handful to a Bristol merchant), than, say, one of Bishop Atterbury's sermons or the esteemed Master Robert Boyle's religious tale "Theodora and Didymus"? It seems that for the unrefined nature of most of us, there can only be one answer to such a question.

In the pleasurable warmth the heart feels in answer to tales of derring-do Nelson's battles are all mightily interesting, but,[xiv] even in spite of their romance of splendid courage, I fancy that the majority of us would rather turn back over the leaves of history to read how Drake captured the Spanish treasure ship in the South Sea, and of how he divided such a quantity of booty in the Island of Plate (so named because of the tremendous dividend there declared) that it had to be measured in quart bowls, being too considerable to be counted.

In the enjoyable warmth that fills the heart while listening to tales of daring deeds, Nelson's battles are all really fascinating; however, [xiv] I think most of us would prefer to flip back through history to read about how Drake captured the Spanish treasure ship in the South Sea and how he divided so much treasure on the Island of Plate (named for the huge dividend declared there) that it had to be measured in quart bowls, since there was too much to count.

Courage and daring, no matter how mad and ungodly, have always a redundancy of vim and life to recommend them to the nether man that lies within us, and no doubt his desperate courage, his battle against the tremendous odds of all the civilized world of law and order, have had much to do in making a popular hero of our friend of the black flag. But it is not altogether courage and daring that endear him to our hearts. There is another and perhaps a greater kinship in that lust for wealth that makes one's fancy revel more pleasantly in the story of the division of treasure in the pirate's island retreat, the hiding of his godless gains somewhere in the sandy stretch of tropic beach, there to remain hidden until the time should come to rake the doubloons up again and to spend them like a lord in polite society, than in the most thrilling tales of his wonderful escapes from commissioned cruisers through tortuous channels between the coral reefs.

Courage and boldness, no matter how reckless and sinful, always have an abundance of energy and life that appeals to the darker side within us. Without a doubt, his fierce bravery and his fight against the overwhelming forces of the civilized world of law and order have contributed significantly to making our friend with the black flag a popular hero. But it isn't just his courage and boldness that make him beloved. There's another, perhaps even greater connection in the desire for wealth that makes us enjoy the story of treasure division in the pirate's island hideaway, the concealment of his ill-gotten gains somewhere along the sandy stretches of a tropical beach, where they will remain hidden until the time comes to dig up the gold coins and spend them like a gentleman in high society, more than in the most exciting tales of his incredible narrow escapes from government ships through winding passages between the coral reefs.

And what a life of adventure is his, to be sure! A life of constant alertness, constant danger, constant escape! An ocean Ishmaelite, he wanders forever aimlessly, homelessly; now unheard of for months, now careening his boat on some lonely uninhabited shore, now appearing suddenly to swoop down on some merchant vessel with rattle of musketry, shouting, yells, and a hell of unbridled passions let loose to rend and tear. What a Carlislean hero! What a setting of blood and lust and flame and rapine for such a hero!

And what an adventurous life he leads, for sure! A life of constant vigilance, constant danger, and constant escapes! Like a wandering outcast on the ocean, he drifts aimlessly and without a home; sometimes unheard of for months, other times racing his boat onto some lonely, deserted shore, and then suddenly showing up to attack a merchant ship with gunfire, shouts, and a wild chaos of unleashed passions. What a heroic figure! What a backdrop of blood, desire, fire, and plunder for such a hero!

Piracy, such as was practiced in the flower of its days—that is, during the early eighteenth century—was no sudden growth. It[xv] was an evolution, from the semilawful buccaneering of the sixteenth century, just as buccaneering was upon its part, in a certain sense, an evolution from the unorganized, unauthorized warfare of the Tudor period.

Piracy, like that of its heyday in the early eighteenth century, didn’t just appear out of nowhere. It[xv] was a development, stemming from the semi-legal buccaneering of the sixteenth century, just as buccaneering itself was, in a way, a progression from the unstructured, unofficial warfare of the Tudor era.

For there was a deal of piratical smack in the anti-Spanish ventures of Elizabethan days. Many of the adventurers—of the Sir Francis Drake school, for instance—actually overstepped again and again the bounds of international law, entering into the realms of de facto piracy. Nevertheless, while their doings were not recognized officially by the government, the perpetrators were neither punished nor reprimanded for their excursions against Spanish commerce at home or in the West Indies; rather were they commended, and it was considered not altogether a discreditable thing for men to get rich upon the spoils taken from Spanish galleons in times of nominal peace. Many of the most reputable citizens and merchants of London, when they felt that the queen failed in her duty of pushing the fight against the great Catholic Power, fitted out fleets upon their own account and sent them to levy good Protestant war of a private nature upon the Pope's anointed.

There was definitely a lot of pirate influence in the anti-Spanish efforts during Elizabethan times. Many adventurers—like those from the Sir Francis Drake crowd—repeatedly crossed the lines of international law, diving into real piracy. However, even though the government didn't officially acknowledge what they were doing, the perpetrators were neither punished nor reprimanded for their attacks on Spanish trade at home or in the West Indies. Instead, they were praised, and it was viewed as somewhat respectable for men to get rich off the spoils taken from Spanish galleons during periods of nominal peace. Many of the most respected citizens and merchants of London, feeling that the queen wasn't doing enough to combat the powerful Catholic force, outfitted their own fleets and sent them out to wage their own Protestant war against the Pope's chosen ones.

Some of the treasures captured in such ventures were immense, stupendous, unbelievable. For an example, one can hardly credit the truth of the "purchase" gained by Drake in the famous capture of the plate ship in the South Sea.

Some of the treasures acquired in these ventures were enormous, incredible, and hard to believe. For example, it's almost unbelievable to accept the reality of the "purchase" made by Drake during the famous capture of the plate ship in the South Sea.

One of the old buccaneer writers of a century later says: "The Spaniards affirm to this day that he took at that time twelvescore tons of plate and sixteen bowls of coined money a man (his number being then forty-five men in all), insomuch that they were forced to heave much of it overboard, because his ship could not carry it all."

One of the old pirate writers from a century later says: "The Spaniards still claim that he took at that time 240 tons of silver and 16 bowls of coined money per man (with a total of 45 men), to the point that they had to throw a lot of it overboard because his ship couldn't carry it all."

Maybe this was a very greatly exaggerated statement put by the author and his Spanish authorities, nevertheless there was enough truth in it to prove very conclusively to the bold minds of[xvi] the age that tremendous profits—"purchases" they called them—were to be made from piracy. The Western World is filled with the names of daring mariners of those old days, who came flitting across the great trackless ocean in their little tublike boats of a few hundred tons burden, partly to explore unknown seas, partly—largely, perhaps—in pursuit of Spanish treasure: Frobisher, Davis, Drake, and a score of others.

Maybe this was a highly exaggerated claim made by the author and his Spanish sources, but there was enough truth in it to clearly show the adventurous minds of[xvi] that huge profits—what they called "purchases"—could be made from piracy. The Western World is filled with the names of bold sailors from those times, who sailed across the vast, uncharted ocean in their small tub-like ships of a few hundred tons, partly to explore unknown waters, but mostly—perhaps largely—in search of Spanish treasure: Frobisher, Davis, Drake, and many others.

In this left-handed war against Catholic Spain many of the adventurers were, no doubt, stirred and incited by a grim, Calvinistic, puritanical zeal for Protestantism. But equally beyond doubt the gold and silver and plate of the "Scarlet Woman" had much to do with the persistent energy with which these hardy mariners braved the mysterious, unknown terrors of the great unknown ocean that stretched away to the sunset, there in far-away waters to attack the huge, unwieldy, treasure-laden galleons that sailed up and down the Caribbean Sea and through the Bahama Channel.

During this indirect war against Catholic Spain, many of the adventurers were certainly motivated by a harsh, Calvinistic, puritanical passion for Protestantism. But it's also clear that the gold, silver, and treasures of the "Scarlet Woman" played a significant role in the relentless determination these brave sailors had as they faced the mysterious, unknown dangers of the vast ocean that extended towards the sunset, venturing into distant waters to raid the massive, unwieldy, treasure-filled galleons that navigated the Caribbean Sea and through the Bahama Channel.

Of all ghastly and terrible things old-time religious war was the most ghastly and terrible. One can hardly credit nowadays the cold, callous cruelty of those times. Generally death was the least penalty that capture entailed. When the Spaniards made prisoners of the English, the Inquisition took them in hand, and what that meant all the world knows. When the English captured a Spanish vessel the prisoners were tortured, either for the sake of revenge or to compel them to disclose where treasure lay hidden. Cruelty begat cruelty, and it would be hard to say whether the Anglo-Saxon or the Latin showed himself to be most proficient in torturing his victim.

Of all the horrific and dreadful things, religious wars from the past were the most horrific and dreadful. It's hard to believe today the cold, heartless brutality of those times. Generally, death was the least punishment that capture could bring. When the Spaniards took English prisoners, the Inquisition dealt with them, and everyone knows what that meant. When the English captured a Spanish ship, the prisoners were tortured, either for revenge or to force them to reveal where treasure was hidden. Cruelty led to more cruelty, and it’s difficult to say whether the Anglo-Saxon or the Latin was more skilled at torturing their victims.

When Cobham, for instance, captured the Spanish ship in the Bay of Biscay, after all resistance was over and the heat of the battle had cooled, he ordered his crew to bind the captain and all of the crew and every Spaniard aboard—whether in arms or not—to sew them up in the mainsail and to fling them overboard. There[xvii] were some twenty dead bodies in the sail when a few days later it was washed up on the shore.

When Cobham, for example, captured the Spanish ship in the Bay of Biscay, after all resistance had ended and the intensity of the battle had faded, he commanded his crew to tie up the captain and all the crew members, along with every Spaniard on board—armed or not—and to wrap them in the mainsail and throw them overboard. There[xvii] were about twenty dead bodies in the sail when it washed up on the shore a few days later.

Of course such acts were not likely to go unavenged, and many an innocent life was sacrificed to pay the debt of Cobham's cruelty.

Of course, such actions were unlikely to go unpunished, and many innocent lives were lost to settle the score for Cobham's cruelty.

Nothing could be more piratical than all this. Nevertheless, as was said, it was winked at, condoned, if not sanctioned, by the law; and it was not beneath people of family and respectability to take part in it. But by and by Protestantism and Catholicism began to be at somewhat less deadly enmity with each other; religious wars were still far enough from being ended, but the scabbard of the sword was no longer flung away when the blade was drawn. And so followed a time of nominal peace, and a generation arose with whom it was no longer respectable and worthy—one might say a matter of duty—to fight a country with which one's own land was not at war. Nevertheless, the seed had been sown; it had been demonstrated that it was feasible to practice piracy against Spain and not to suffer therefor. Blood had been shed and cruelty practiced, and, once indulged, no lust seems stronger than that of shedding blood and practicing cruelty.

Nothing could be more pirate-like than all this. Still, as mentioned, it was overlooked, ignored, if not approved, by the law; and it wasn't beneath respectable families to get involved in it. Over time, Protestantism and Catholicism started to have a bit less hatred for each other; religious wars were still a long way from being over, but the sword's scabbard was no longer discarded when the blade was drawn. This led to a period of nominal peace, and a generation emerged that found it no longer respectable or necessary—one could even say a duty—to fight against a country that wasn't at war with one's own. However, the groundwork had been laid; it had been shown that piracy against Spain was feasible without facing consequences. Blood had been spilled and cruelty displayed, and once unleashed, there seems to be no stronger desire than that for bloodshed and cruelty.

Though Spain might be ever so well grounded in peace at home, in the West Indies she was always at war with the whole world—English, French, Dutch. It was almost a matter of life or death with her to keep her hold upon the New World. At home she was bankrupt and, upon the earthquake of the Reformation, her power was already beginning to totter and to crumble to pieces. America was her treasure house, and from it alone could she hope to keep her leaking purse full of gold and silver. So it was that she strove strenuously, desperately, to keep out the world from her American possessions—a bootless task, for the old order upon which her power rested was broken and crumbled forever. But still she strove, fighting against fate, and so it was that in the tropical America it was one continual war between her and all[xviii] the world. Thus it came that, long after piracy ceased to be allowed at home, it continued in those far-away seas with unabated vigor, recruiting to its service all that lawless malign element which gathers together in every newly opened country where the only law is lawlessness, where might is right and where a living is to be gained with no more trouble than cutting a throat.

Though Spain might be at peace at home, in the West Indies she was always at war with everyone—English, French, Dutch. It was almost a matter of survival for her to maintain her control over the New World. Back home, she was bankrupt, and with the upheaval of the Reformation, her power was already starting to weaken and fall apart. America was her treasure trove, and from it alone could she hope to fill her empty coffers with gold and silver. So, she worked tirelessly, even desperately, to keep the world out of her American territories—a hopeless task, because the old order that supported her power was shattered and gone for good. But still she fought against fate, and thus, in tropical America, it was a constant battle between her and the rest of the world. Consequently, long after piracy was no longer condoned at home, it thrived in those distant seas with unrelenting vigor, attracting all the lawless elements that come together in any new land where the only rule is lawlessness, where might makes right, and where making a living requires nothing more than taking a life.

 

Howard Pyle,  His mark Howard Pyle,
His signature

 

Howard Pyle's
Book of Pirates

Howard Pyle's Pirate Book

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ye Pirate Bold.

Yay Pirate Bold.

t is not because of his life of adventure and daring that I admire this one of my favorite heroes; nor is it because of blowing winds nor blue ocean nor balmy islands which he knew so well; nor is it because of gold he spent nor treasure he hid. He was a man who knew his own mind and what he wanted.

It’s not just his adventurous and bold life that I admire about this favorite hero of mine; it’s not because of the strong winds, the deep blue ocean, or the tropical islands he explored so well; and it’s not because of the gold he spent or the treasures he buried. He was a man who understood his own thoughts and what he truly wanted.

Howard Pyle

Howard Pyle


Chapter I

BUCCANEERS AND MAROONERS OF THE SPANISH MAIN

J

ust above the northwestern shore of the old island of Hispaniola—the Santo Domingo of our day—and separated from it only by a narrow channel of some five or six miles in width, lies a queer little hunch of an island, known, because of a distant resemblance to that animal, as the Tortuga de Mar, or sea turtle. It is not more than twenty miles in length by perhaps seven or eight in breadth; it is only a little spot of land, and as you look at it upon the map a pin's head would almost cover it; yet from that spot, as from a center of inflammation, a burning fire of human wickedness and ruthlessness and lust overran the world, and spread terror and[4] death throughout the Spanish West Indies, from St. Augustine to the island of Trinidad, and from Panama to the coasts of Peru.

Just off the northwestern shore of the old island of Hispaniola—the Santo Domingo of today—and separated from it by a narrow channel about five or six miles wide, lies a peculiar little island, known because it resembles the creature, as the Tortuga de Mar, or sea turtle. It measures no more than twenty miles long and maybe seven or eight miles wide; it’s just a tiny patch of land, and when you look at it on a map, a pinhead could almost cover it. Yet from that spot, like a center of infection, a blazing fire of human wickedness, ruthlessness, and lust spread across the world, unleashing terror and[4] death throughout the Spanish West Indies, from St. Augustine to Trinidad, and from Panama to the coasts of Peru.

About the middle of the seventeenth century certain French adventurers set out from the fortified island of St. Christopher in longboats and hoys, directing their course to the westward, there to discover new islands. Sighting Hispaniola "with abundance of joy," they landed, and went into the country, where they found great quantities of wild cattle, horses, and swine.

About the middle of the seventeenth century, some French adventurers left the fortified island of St. Christopher in longboats and small ships, heading west to discover new islands. When they spotted Hispaniola "with great joy," they landed and ventured into the land, where they found many wild cattle, horses, and pigs.

Now vessels on the return voyage to Europe from the West Indies needed revictualing, and food, especially flesh, was at a premium in the islands of the Spanish Main; wherefore a great profit was to be turned in preserving beef and pork, and selling the flesh to homeward-bound vessels.

Now ships heading back to Europe from the West Indies needed resupplying, and food, especially meat, was scarce in the islands of the Spanish Main. This created a significant profit opportunity in preserving beef and pork, and selling the meat to vessels returning home.

The northwestern shore of Hispaniola, lying as it does at the eastern outlet of the old Bahama Channel, running between the island of Cuba and the great Bahama Banks, lay almost in the very main stream of travel. The pioneer Frenchmen were not slow to discover the double advantage to be reaped from the wild cattle that cost them nothing to procure, and a market for the flesh ready found for them. So down upon Hispaniola they came by boatloads and shiploads, gathering like a swarm of mosquitoes, and overrunning the whole western end of the island. There they established themselves, spending the time alternately in hunting the wild cattle and buccanning[1] the meat, and squandering their hardly earned gains in wild debauchery, the opportunities for which were never lacking in the Spanish West Indies.

The northwestern shore of Hispaniola, located at the eastern entrance of the old Bahama Channel, which runs between Cuba and the great Bahama Banks, was right in the main flow of travel. The early French explorers quickly realized the dual benefit of the wild cattle they could obtain for free and the ready market for the meat. So they arrived in Hispaniola by boatloads and shiploads, gathering like a swarm of mosquitoes and taking over the entire western part of the island. There, they settled in, alternating between hunting the wild cattle and processing the meat, while wasting their hard-earned profits on wild partying, which was always easy to find in the Spanish West Indies.

[1] Buccanning, by which the "buccaneers" gained their name, was a process of curing thin strips of meat by salting, smoking, and drying in the sun.

[1] Buccanning, which is how the "buccaneers" got their name, was the method of preserving thin strips of meat by salting, smoking, and drying them in the sun.

At first the Spaniards thought nothing of the few travel-worn Frenchmen who dragged their longboats and hoys up on the beach, and shot a wild bullock or two to keep body and soul together; but when the few grew to dozens, and the dozens to scores, and the scores to hundreds, it was a very different matter, and wrathful [5]grumblings and mutterings began to be heard among the original settlers.

At first, the Spaniards didn't think much of the few tired Frenchmen who dragged their boats onto the beach and shot a wild bull or two to survive; but when the few turned into dozens, then scores, and then hundreds, it became a serious issue, and angry grumbling and muttering started to be heard among the original settlers.

But of this the careless buccaneers thought never a whit, the only thing that troubled them being the lack of a more convenient shipping point than the main island afforded them.

But the careless pirates didn’t think about this at all; the only thing that bothered them was the lack of a more convenient shipping point than what the main island offered them.

This lack was at last filled by a party of hunters who ventured across the narrow channel that separated the main island from Tortuga. Here they found exactly what they needed—a good harbor, just at the junction of the Windward Channel with the old Bahama Channel—a spot where four-fifths of the Spanish-Indian trade would pass by their very wharves.

This gap was finally filled by a group of hunters who crossed the narrow channel separating the main island from Tortuga. There, they found exactly what they needed—a good harbor right at the junction of the Windward Channel and the old Bahama Channel—a place where four-fifths of the Spanish-Indian trade would pass by their wharves.

There were a few Spaniards upon the island, but they were a quiet folk, and well disposed to make friends with the strangers; but when more Frenchmen and still more Frenchmen crossed the narrow channel, until they overran the Tortuga and turned it into one great curing house for the beef which they shot upon the neighboring island, the Spaniards grew restive over the matter, just as they had done upon the larger island.

There were a few Spaniards on the island, but they were a quiet group, friendly towards the newcomers. However, when more and more Frenchmen came across the narrow channel and took over Tortuga, turning it into a massive processing site for the beef they hunted on the nearby island, the Spaniards became uneasy about the situation, just as they had on the larger island.

Accordingly, one fine day there came half a dozen great boatloads of armed Spaniards, who landed upon the Turtle's Back and sent the Frenchmen flying to the woods and fastnesses of rocks as the chaff flies before the thunder gust. That night the Spaniards drank themselves mad and shouted themselves hoarse over their victory, while the beaten Frenchmen sullenly paddled their canoes back to the main island again, and the Sea Turtle was Spanish once more.

One day, half a dozen large boats filled with armed Spaniards arrived, landing on Turtle's Back and forcing the Frenchmen to scatter into the woods and rocky hideouts like chaff before a storm. That night, the Spaniards celebrated wildly, drinking excessively and shouting hoarsely about their victory, while the defeated Frenchmen quietly paddled their canoes back to the main island, and the Sea Turtle was Spanish once again.

But the Spaniards were not contented with such a petty triumph as that of sweeping the island of Tortuga free from the obnoxious strangers; down upon Hispaniola they came, flushed with their easy victory, and determined to root out every Frenchman, until not one single buccaneer remained. For a time they had an easy thing of it, for each French hunter roamed the woods by himself, with no better company than his half-wild dogs, so[6] that when two or three Spaniards would meet such a one, he seldom if ever came out of the woods again, for even his resting place was lost.

But the Spaniards weren't satisfied with such a small win as clearing the island of Tortuga of the unwanted outsiders; they set their sights on Hispaniola, filled with confidence from their easy victory, and aimed to eliminate every Frenchman, leaving not a single buccaneer behind. For a while, it was simple for them since each French hunter wandered the woods alone, with nothing but his half-wild dogs for company, so[6] when two or three Spaniards encountered one, he rarely if ever came out of the woods again, as even his resting place was forgotten.

On the Tortugas On the Tortugas

Illustration from
BUCCANEERS AND MAROONERS OF THE SPANISH MAIN

by Howard Pyle

Originally published in
Harper's Magazine, August and September, 1887

But the very success of the Spaniards brought their ruin along with it, for the buccaneers began to combine together for self-protection, and out of that combination arose a strange union of lawless man with lawless man, so near, so close, that it can scarce be compared to any other than that of husband and wife. When two entered upon this comradeship, articles were drawn up and signed by both parties, a common stock was made of all their possessions, and out into the woods they went to seek their fortunes; thenceforth they were as one man; they lived together by day, they slept together by night; what one suffered, the other suffered; what one gained, the other gained. The only separation that came betwixt them was death, and then the survivor inherited all that the other left. And now it was another thing with Spanish buccaneer hunting, for two buccaneers, reckless of life, quick of eye, and true of aim, were worth any half dozen of Spanish islanders.

But the very success of the Spaniards led to their downfall, as the buccaneers started to band together for protection. This bond created a unique partnership between lawless individuals, so close that it could only be compared to a marriage. When two people entered this partnership, they drafted and signed articles, pooled all their belongings, and ventured into the wilderness to seek their fortunes; from that point on, they were like one person. They lived together during the day and slept together at night. If one experienced pain, the other felt it too; if one earned something, the other shared in it. The only thing that could separate them was death, and then the survivor would inherit everything the other left behind. Now it was a different story when it came to hunting Spanish buccaneers, as two fearless, sharp-eyed, and accurate buccaneers were worth more than any six Spanish islanders.

By and by, as the French became more strongly organized for mutual self-protection, they assumed the offensive. Then down they came upon Tortuga, and now it was the turn of the Spanish to be hunted off the island like vermin, and the turn of the French to shout their victory.

Gradually, as the French organized better for mutual protection, they took the offensive. They descended upon Tortuga, and it was now the Spanish who were driven off the island like pests, while the French celebrated their victory.

Having firmly established themselves, a governor was sent to the French of Tortuga, one M. le Passeur, from the island of St. Christopher; the Sea Turtle was fortified, and colonists, consisting of men of doubtful character and women of whose character there could be no doubt whatever, began pouring in upon the island, for it was said that the buccaneers thought no more of a doubloon than of a Lima bean, so that this was the place for the brothel and the brandy shop to reap their golden harvest, and the island remained French.

Once they had firmly set up their base, a governor named M. le Passeur was sent to the French at Tortuga from the island of St. Christopher. The Sea Turtle was fortified, and colonists—some shady men and women of unimpeachable character—started arriving on the island. It was rumored that the buccaneers valued a doubloon as little as a lima bean, making this the perfect spot for brothels and bars to cash in, and the island stayed under French control.

Hitherto the Tortugans had been content to gain as much [7]as possible from the homeward-bound vessels through the orderly channels of legitimate trade. It was reserved for Pierre le Grand to introduce piracy as a quicker and more easy road to wealth than the semihonest exchange they had been used to practice.

Up until now, the people of Tortuga had been satisfied with getting as much [7] as they could from ships returning home through the normal routes of legitimate trade. It was Pierre le Grand who introduced piracy as a faster and easier way to make money than the somewhat honest trading they had been doing.

Gathering together eight-and-twenty other spirits as hardy and reckless as himself, he put boldly out to sea in a boat hardly large enough to hold his crew, and running down the Windward Channel and out into the Caribbean Sea, he lay in wait for such a prize as might be worth the risks of winning.

Gathering together twenty-eight other daring and fearless spirits like himself, he boldly set out to sea in a boat barely big enough to hold his crew. Navigating down the Windward Channel and out into the Caribbean Sea, he waited for a prize that would be worth the risks involved in capturing it.

For a while their luck was steadily against them; their provisions and water began to fail, and they saw nothing before them but starvation or a humiliating return. In this extremity they sighted a Spanish ship belonging to a "flota" which had become separated from her consorts.

For a while, they had really bad luck; their food and water started to run low, and all they could see ahead of them was starvation or a shameful retreat. In this desperate situation, they spotted a Spanish ship from a "flota" that had gotten separated from the others.

The boat in which the buccaneers sailed might, perhaps, have served for the great ship's longboat; the Spaniards outnumbered them three to one, and Pierre and his men were armed only with pistols and cutlasses; nevertheless this was their one and their only chance, and they determined to take the Spanish ship or to die in the attempt. Down upon the Spaniard they bore through the dusk of the night, and giving orders to the "chirurgeon" to scuttle their craft under them as they were leaving it, they swarmed up the side of the unsuspecting ship and upon its decks in a torrent—pistol in one hand and cutlass in the other. A part of them ran to the gun room and secured the arms and ammunition, pistoling or cutting down all such as stood in their way or offered opposition; the other party burst into the great cabin at the heels of Pierre le Grand, found the captain and a party of his friends at cards, set a pistol to his breast, and demanded him to deliver up the ship. Nothing remained for the Spaniard but to yield, for there was no alternative between surrender and death. And so the great prize was won.

The boat the buccaneers sailed in could have probably served as the longboat for a large ship; the Spaniards had them outnumbered three to one, and Pierre and his crew were only armed with pistols and cutlasses. Still, this was their only chance, and they decided to take the Spanish ship or die trying. They charged at the Spaniard through the night, instructing the "chirurgeon" to scuttle their own ship as they abandoned it, and they swarmed up the side of the unsuspecting vessel, pistols in one hand and cutlasses in the other. Some of them rushed to the gun room to secure arms and ammunition, shooting or cutting down anyone who stood in their way or resisted; the rest rushed into the captain's cabin right behind Pierre le Grand, found the captain and a group of his friends playing cards, pointed a pistol at his chest, and demanded he surrender the ship. The Spaniard had no choice but to give in, as there was no option between surrender and death. And so, the great prize was won.

It was not long before the news of this great exploit and of[8] the vast treasure gained reached the ears of the buccaneers of Tortuga and Hispaniola. Then what a hubbub and an uproar and a tumult there was! Hunting wild cattle and buccanning the meat was at a discount, and the one and only thing to do was to go a-pirating; for where one such prize had been won, others were to be had.

It didn’t take long for the news of this amazing feat and the huge treasure acquired to reach the buccaneers of Tortuga and Hispaniola. Then there was a huge commotion and a lot of noise! Hunting wild cattle and curing the meat was no longer appealing, and the only thing to do was to go pirating; because if one big prize had been won, there were sure to be more out there.

In a short time freebooting assumed all of the routine of a regular business. Articles were drawn up betwixt captain and crew, compacts were sealed, and agreements entered into by the one party and the other.

In a short time, piracy took on all the regular routines of a business. Contracts were created between the captain and the crew, agreements were signed, and deals were made by both parties.

In all professions there are those who make their mark, those who succeed only moderately well, and those who fail more or less entirely. Nor did pirating differ from this general rule, for in it were men who rose to distinction, men whose names, something tarnished and rusted by the lapse of years, have come down even to us of the present day.

In every profession, there are people who stand out, those who do okay, and those who pretty much fail. Pirating was no different; it had its share of individuals who became famous, men whose names, a bit faded and rusty from the passage of time, have reached us in the present day.

Pierre François, who, with his boatload of six-and-twenty desperadoes, ran boldly into the midst of the pearl fleet off the coast of South America, attacked the vice admiral under the very guns of two men-of-war, captured his ship, though she was armed with eight guns and manned with threescore men, and would have got her safely away, only that having to put on sail, their main-mast went by the board, whereupon the men-of-war came up with them, and the prize was lost.

Pierre François, who, with his crew of twenty-six outlaws, boldly charged into the heart of the pearl fleet off the coast of South America, attacked the vice admiral right under the guns of two warships. He captured the ship, which was armed with eight cannons and crewed by sixty men, and would have successfully escaped if it weren't for the fact that when they tried to set sail, their main mast fell overboard. This allowed the warships to catch up with them, and they lost the prize.

But even though there were two men-of-war against all that remained of six-and-twenty buccaneers, the Spaniards were glad enough to make terms with them for the surrender of the vessel, whereby Pierre François and his men came off scot-free.

But even though there were two warships against what was left of twenty-six buccaneers, the Spaniards were more than happy to negotiate terms for the surrender of the ship, which allowed Pierre François and his crew to get away without any consequences.

Bartholomew Portuguese was a worthy of even more note. In a boat manned with thirty fellow adventurers he fell upon a great ship off Cape Corrientes, manned with threescore and ten men, all told.

Bartholomew Portuguese was truly someone to be remembered. In a boat crewed by thirty fellow adventurers, he encountered a large ship off Cape Corrientes, which had a total of seventy men on board.

Her he assaulted again and again, beaten off with the very pressure of numbers only to renew the assault, until the Spaniards[9] who survived, some fifty in all, surrendered to twenty living pirates, who poured upon their decks like a score of blood-stained, powder-grimed devils.

Her he attacked repeatedly, pushed back only by sheer numbers, only to launch another attack, until the Spaniards[9] who survived, around fifty in total, surrendered to twenty living pirates, who descended on their decks like a horde of blood-soaked, powder-covered demons.

They lost their vessel by recapture, and Bartholomew Portuguese barely escaped with his life through a series of almost unbelievable adventures. But no sooner had he fairly escaped from the clutches of the Spaniards than, gathering together another band of adventurers, he fell upon the very same vessel in the gloom of the night, recaptured her when she rode at anchor in the harbor of Campeche under the guns of the fort, slipped the cable, and was away without the loss of a single man. He lost her in a hurricane soon afterward, just off the Isle of Pines; but the deed was none the less daring for all that.

They lost their ship when it was recaptured, and Bartholomew Portuguese barely escaped with his life through a series of almost unbelievable adventures. But as soon as he managed to escape from the grasp of the Spaniards, he gathered another group of adventurers and attacked the same ship in the dark of night. They recaptured her while she was anchored in the harbor of Campeche, right under the fort's guns, cut the cable, and left without losing a single man. He ended up losing her in a hurricane soon after, just off the Isle of Pines, but the act was still incredibly bold despite that.

Another notable no less famous than these two worthies was Roch Braziliano, the truculent Dutchman who came up from the coast of Brazil to the Spanish Main with a name ready-made for him. Upon the very first adventure which he undertook he captured a plate ship of fabulous value, and brought her safely into Jamaica; and when at last captured by the Spaniards, he fairly frightened them into letting him go by truculent threats of vengeance from his followers.

Another notable figure, just as famous as these two, was Roch Braziliano, the fierce Dutchman who came up from the coast of Brazil to the Spanish Main with a name that suited him perfectly. In his very first adventure, he captured a treasure ship worth a fortune and brought it safely to Jamaica. When he was eventually captured by the Spaniards, he scared them into releasing him with menacing threats of retaliation from his crew.

Such were three of the pirate buccaneers who infested the Spanish Main. There were hundreds no less desperate, no less reckless, no less insatiate in their lust for plunder, than they.

Such were three of the pirate buccaneers who roamed the Spanish Main. There were hundreds just as desperate, just as reckless, and just as greedy for loot as they were.

The effects of this freebooting soon became apparent. The risks to be assumed by the owners of vessels and the shippers of merchandise became so enormous that Spanish commerce was practically swept away from these waters. No vessel dared to venture out of port excepting under escort of powerful men-of-war, and even then they were not always secure from molestation. Exports from Central and South America were sent to Europe by way of the Strait of Magellan, and little or none went through the passes between the Bahamas and the Caribbees.[10]

The impact of this piracy quickly became clear. The risks faced by ship owners and merchandise shippers grew so high that Spanish trade was almost wiped out from these waters. No ship was willing to leave port without the protection of strong warships, and even then, they weren’t always safe from attacks. Exports from Central and South America were routed to Europe via the Strait of Magellan, and hardly any went through the channels between the Bahamas and the Caribbean.[10]

Capture of the Galleon Capture of the Galleon

Illustration from
BUCCANEERS AND MAROONERS OF THE SPANISH MAIN

by Howard Pyle

Originally published in
Harper's Magazine, August and September, 1887

So at last "buccaneering," as it had come to be generically called, ceased to pay the vast dividends that it had done at first. The cream was skimmed off, and only very thin milk was left in the dish. Fabulous fortunes were no longer earned in a ten days' cruise, but what money was won hardly paid for the risks of the winning. There must be a new departure, or buccaneering would cease to exist.

So finally, "buccaneering," as it had come to be generally called, stopped yielding the huge profits it once did. The best opportunities were taken, leaving only a little bit behind. Incredible fortunes were no longer made on a ten-day cruise, and the money earned barely covered the risks involved. There had to be a new approach, or buccaneering would disappear.

Then arose one who showed the buccaneers a new way to squeeze money out of the Spaniards. This man was an Englishman—Lewis Scot.

Then someone appeared who showed the pirates a new way to take money from the Spaniards. This man was an Englishman—Lewis Scot.

The stoppage of commerce on the Spanish Main had naturally tended to accumulate all the wealth gathered and produced into the chief fortified cities and towns of the West Indies. As there no longer existed prizes upon the sea, they must be gained upon the land, if they were to be gained at all. Lewis Scot was the first to appreciate this fact.

The halt of trade on the Spanish Main had naturally caused all the wealth that had been gathered and produced to concentrate in the main fortified cities and towns of the West Indies. Since there were no longer prizes to be found at sea, they had to be sought after on land, if they were to be obtained at all. Lewis Scot was the first to recognize this reality.

Gathering together a large and powerful body of men as hungry for plunder and as desperate as himself, he descended upon the town of Campeche, which he captured and sacked, stripping it of everything that could possibly be carried away.

Gathering a large, powerful group of men who were just as eager for loot and desperate as he was, he attacked the town of Campeche, which he took and looted, taking everything that could be carried off.

When the town was cleared to the bare walls Scot threatened to set the torch to every house in the place if it was not ransomed by a large sum of money which he demanded. With this booty he set sail for Tortuga, where he arrived safely—and the problem was solved.

When the town was stripped down to its bare walls, Scot threatened to set fire to every house unless he was given a hefty ransom. With this loot, he set sail for Tortuga, where he arrived safely—and the problem was resolved.

After him came one Mansvelt, a buccaneer of lesser note, who first made a descent upon the isle of Saint Catharine, now Old Providence, which he took, and, with this as a base, made an unsuccessful descent upon Neuva Granada and Cartagena. His name might not have been handed down to us along with others of greater fame had he not been the master of that most apt of pupils, the great Captain Henry Morgan, most famous of all the buccaneers, one time governor of Jamaica, and knighted by King Charles II.

After him came a guy named Mansvelt, a lesser-known buccaneer, who first attacked the island of Saint Catharine, now known as Old Providence. He took it over and, using it as a base, tried to launch an unsuccessful attack on New Granada and Cartagena. His name might not have been remembered alongside those with greater fame if he hadn't been the mentor of the very skilled Captain Henry Morgan, the most famous of all the buccaneers, who was once the governor of Jamaica and was knighted by King Charles II.

After Mansvelt followed the bold John Davis, native of Jamaica, where he sucked in the lust of piracy with his mother's milk. With only fourscore men, he swooped down upon the great city of Nicaragua in the darkness of the night, silenced the sentry with the thrust of a knife, and then fell to pillaging the churches and houses "without any respect or veneration."

After Mansvelt followed the daring John Davis, a native of Jamaica, where he was raised on the thrill of piracy. With just eighty men, he descended upon the great city of Nicaragua under the cover of night, silenced the guard with a knife, and then began looting the churches and homes "without any respect or veneration."

Of course it was but a short time until the whole town was in an uproar of alarm, and there was nothing left for the little handful of men to do but to make the best of their way to their boats. They were in the town but a short time, but in that time they were able to gather together and to carry away money and jewels to the value of fifty thousand pieces of eight, besides dragging off with them a dozen or more notable prisoners, whom they held for ransom.

Of course, it wasn't long before the whole town was in a panic, and the small group of men had no choice but to make their way to their boats. They were in the town for a short time, but during that period, they managed to collect and take away money and jewels worth fifty thousand pieces of eight, along with a dozen or so notable prisoners whom they held for ransom.

And now one appeared upon the scene who reached a far greater height than any had arisen to before. This was François l'Olonoise, who sacked the great city of Maracaibo and the town of Gibraltar. Cold, unimpassioned, pitiless, his sluggish blood was never moved by one single pulse of human warmth, his icy heart was never touched by one ray of mercy or one spark of pity for the hapless wretches who chanced to fall into his bloody hands.

And now someone came onto the scene who reached a much greater height than anyone before him. This was François l'Olonoise, who raided the great city of Maracaibo and the town of Gibraltar. Cold, unemotional, and ruthless, his sluggish blood was never stirred by a single pulse of human warmth, his icy heart was never affected by a moment of mercy or even a hint of pity for the unfortunate souls who happened to fall into his bloody grasp.

Against him the governor of Havana sent out a great war vessel, and with it a negro executioner, so that there might be no inconvenient delays of law after the pirates had been captured. But l'Olonoise did not wait for the coming of the war vessel; he went out to meet it, and he found it where it lay riding at anchor in the mouth of the river Estra. At the dawn of the morning he made his attack—sharp, unexpected, decisive. In a little while the Spaniards were forced below the hatches, and the vessel was taken. Then came the end. One by one the poor shrieking wretches were dragged up from below, and one by one they were butchered in cold blood, while l'Olonoise stood upon the poop deck and looked coldly down upon what was being done. Among[12] the rest the negro was dragged upon the deck. He begged and implored that his life might be spared, promising to tell all that might be asked of him. L'Olonoise questioned him, and when he had squeezed him dry, waved his hand coldly, and the poor black went with the rest. Only one man was spared; him he sent to the governor of Havana with a message that henceforth he would give no quarter to any Spaniard whom he might meet in arms—a message which was not an empty threat.

The governor of Havana sent out a large warship, along with a black executioner, to avoid any delays in justice once the pirates were captured. However, l'Olonoise didn't wait for the warship to arrive; he went out to confront it and found it anchored at the mouth of the Estra River. At dawn, he launched a sudden, decisive attack. Before long, the Spaniards were forced below deck, and the ship was taken. Then came the end. One by one, the terrified prisoners were dragged up from below and brutally killed, while l'Olonoise stood on the poop deck, coldly watching the slaughter. Among the others, the black executioner was brought up to the deck. He begged for his life, promising to share anything they wanted to know. L'Olonoise interrogated him, and after extracting all the information he could, he waved his hand dismissively, and the poor man met the same fate as the rest. Only one person was spared; he was sent to the governor of Havana with a message that from now on, l'Olonoise would show no mercy to any Spaniard he encountered in battle—a message that was far from an empty threat.

The rise of l'Olonoise was by no means rapid. He worked his way up by dint of hard labor and through much ill fortune. But by and by, after many reverses, the tide turned, and carried him with it from one success to another, without let or stay, to the bitter end.

The rise of l'Olonoise wasn't quick at all. He climbed the ranks through hard work and a lot of bad luck. But eventually, after facing many setbacks, things changed for him, leading him success after success, without stopping, until the very end.

Cruising off Maracaibo, he captured a rich prize laden with a vast amount of plate and ready money, and there conceived the design of descending upon the powerful town of Maracaibo itself. Without loss of time he gathered together five hundred picked scoundrels from Tortuga, and taking with him one Michael de Basco as land captain, and two hundred more buccaneers whom he commanded, down he came into the Gulf of Venezuela and upon the doomed city like a blast of the plague. Leaving their vessels, the buccaneers made a land attack upon the fort that stood at the mouth of the inlet that led into Lake Maracaibo and guarded the city.

Cruising off Maracaibo, he seized a valuable prize filled with a large amount of silver and cash, and there came up with the plan to attack the stronghold of Maracaibo itself. Without wasting any time, he gathered five hundred elite outlaws from Tortuga, taking along Michael de Basco as his land captain, along with two hundred more buccaneers under his command. He then charged into the Gulf of Venezuela and headed for the doomed city like a plague. Leaving their ships behind, the buccaneers launched a land assault on the fort at the entrance of the inlet leading to Lake Maracaibo, which defended the city.

The Spaniards held out well, and fought with all the might that Spaniards possess; but after a fight of three hours all was given up and the garrison fled, spreading terror and confusion before them. As many of the inhabitants of the city as could do so escaped in boats to Gibraltar, which lies to the southward, on the shores of Lake Maracaibo, at the distance of some forty leagues or more.

The Spaniards held their ground well and fought with all the strength that Spaniards have; however, after three hours of fighting, they surrendered and the garrison fled, creating panic and chaos in their wake. Many of the city's residents who were able to escape took to boats heading to Gibraltar, which is located to the south along the shores of Lake Maracaibo, about forty leagues away or more.

Then the pirates marched into the town, and what followed may be conceived. It was a holocaust of lust, of passion, and of[13] blood such as even the Spanish West Indies had never seen before. Houses and churches were sacked until nothing was left but the bare walls; men and women were tortured to compel them to disclose where more treasure lay hidden.

Then the pirates marched into the town, and what followed can be imagined. It was a devastating mix of desire, violence, and bloodshed like nothing even the Spanish West Indies had seen before. Houses and churches were ransacked until all that remained were the bare walls; men and women were tortured to make them reveal where more treasure was hidden.

Then, having wrenched all that they could from Maracaibo, they entered the lake and descended upon Gibraltar, where the rest of the panic-stricken inhabitants were huddled together in a blind terror.

Then, after taking everything they could from Maracaibo, they entered the lake and descended on Gibraltar, where the remaining terrified residents were huddled together in blind fear.

The governor of Merida, a brave soldier who had served his king in Flanders, had gathered together a troop of eight hundred men, had fortified the town, and now lay in wait for the coming of the pirates. The pirates came all in good time, and then, in spite of the brave defense, Gibraltar also fell. Then followed a repetition of the scenes that had been enacted in Maracaibo for the past fifteen days, only here they remained for four horrible weeks, extorting money—money! ever money!—from the poor poverty-stricken, pest-ridden souls crowded into that fever hole of a town.

The governor of Merida, a brave soldier who had served his king in Flanders, had gathered a group of eight hundred men, fortified the town, and was now waiting for the pirates to arrive. The pirates showed up right on time, and despite the strong defense, Gibraltar also fell. What followed was a repeat of the events that had taken place in Maracaibo over the last fifteen days, but this time they stayed for four terrible weeks, extorting money—money! always money!—from the impoverished, disease-ridden people packed into that fever-stricken town.

Then they left, but before they went they demanded still more money—ten thousand pieces of eight—as a ransom for the town, which otherwise should be given to the flames. There was some hesitation on the part of the Spaniards, some disposition to haggle, but there was no hesitation on the part of l'Olonoise. The torch was set to the town as he had promised, whereupon the money was promptly paid, and the pirates were piteously begged to help quench the spreading flames. This they were pleased to do, but in spite of all their efforts nearly half of the town was consumed.

Then they left, but before they went, they demanded even more money—ten thousand pieces of eight—as a ransom for the town, which would otherwise be set on fire. The Spaniards hesitated a bit and tried to bargain, but l'Olonoise showed no hesitation. He set fire to the town just as he promised, and then the money was quickly paid. The pirates were desperately asked to help put out the growing flames. They agreed to help, but despite all their efforts, nearly half of the town was burned down.

After that they returned to Maracaibo again, where they demanded a ransom of thirty thousand pieces of eight for the city. There was no haggling here, thanks to the fate of Gibraltar; only it was utterly impossible to raise that much money in all of the poverty-stricken region. But at last the matter was compromised, and the town was redeemed for twenty thousand pieces of eight[14] and five hundred head of cattle, and tortured Maracaibo was quit of them.

After that, they went back to Maracaibo, where they demanded a ransom of thirty thousand pieces of eight for the city. There was no negotiating this time, thanks to what had happened in Gibraltar; it was just totally impossible to raise that much money in such a poor area. But finally, they reached a compromise, and the town was freed for twenty thousand pieces of eight[14] and five hundred head of cattle, allowing the tormented Maracaibo to be rid of them.

Henry Morgan Recruiting for the Attack Henry Morgan Recruiting for the Attack

Illustration from
BUCCANEERS AND MAROONERS OF THE SPANISH MAIN

by Howard Pyle

Originally published in
Harper's Magazine, August and September, 1887

In the Ile de la Vache the buccaneers shared among themselves two hundred and sixty thousand pieces of eight, besides jewels and bales of silk and linen and miscellaneous plunder to a vast amount.

In the Isle of the Cow, the pirates divided up two hundred sixty thousand coins, along with jewels, bales of silk and linen, and a huge amount of various loot.

Such was the one great deed of l'Olonoise; from that time his star steadily declined—for even nature seemed fighting against such a monster—until at last he died a miserable, nameless death at the hands of an unknown tribe of Indians upon the Isthmus of Darien.

Such was the one significant action of l'Olonoise; from that moment on, his fortune steadily declined—for even nature appeared to be battling against such a monster—until ultimately he died a pitiful, forgotten death at the hands of an unknown tribe of Indians on the Isthmus of Darien.


And now we come to the greatest of all the buccaneers, he who stands pre-eminent among them, and whose name even to this day is a charm to call up his deeds of daring, his dauntless courage, his truculent cruelty, and his insatiate and unappeasable lust for gold—Capt. Henry Morgan, the bold Welshman, who brought buccaneering to the height and flower of its glory.

And now we reach the greatest of all the pirates, the one who stands out among them, and whose name even today evokes his daring acts, fearless courage, ruthless cruelty, and his unquenchable thirst for gold—Captain Henry Morgan, the brave Welshman, who took piracy to its peak and fullest glory.

Having sold himself, after the manner of the times, for his passage across the seas, he worked out his time of servitude at the Barbados. As soon as he had regained his liberty he entered upon the trade of piracy, wherein he soon reached a position of considerable prominence. He was associated with Mansvelt at the time of the latter's descent upon Saint Catharine's Isle, the importance of which spot, as a center of operations against the neighboring coasts, Morgan never lost sight of.

Having sold himself, like many others at the time, for a ticket across the ocean, he completed his term of servitude in Barbados. Once he regained his freedom, he got into piracy, where he quickly became quite prominent. He was involved with Mansvelt during the latter's attack on Saint Catharine's Isle, which Morgan always recognized as a crucial base for operations against the nearby coastlines.

The first attempt that Capt. Henry Morgan ever made against any town in the Spanish Indies was the bold descent upon the city of Puerto del Principe in the island of Cuba, with a mere handful of men. It was a deed the boldness of which has never been outdone by any of a like nature—not even the famous attack upon Panama itself. Thence they returned to their boats in the very face of the whole island of Cuba, aroused and determined upon their extermination. Not only did they make good their [15]escape, but they brought away with them a vast amount of plunder, computed at three hundred thousand pieces of eight, besides five hundred head of cattle and many prisoners held for ransom.

The first attempt that Capt. Henry Morgan ever made against any town in the Spanish Indies was the daring raid on the city of Puerto del Principe in Cuba, with just a small group of men. It was an act of bravery that has never been surpassed by anything similar—not even the famous attack on Panama itself. They then made their way back to their boats while the entire island of Cuba was stirred up and intent on wiping them out. Not only did they successfully escape, but they also took with them a huge amount of loot, estimated at three hundred thousand pieces of eight, along with five hundred head of cattle and many prisoners taken for ransom.

But when the division of all this wealth came to be made, lo! there were only fifty thousand pieces of eight to be found. What had become of the rest no man could tell but Capt. Henry Morgan himself. Honesty among thieves was never an axiom with him.

But when it came time to divide all this wealth, guess what? There were only fifty thousand pieces of eight to be found. No one knew what happened to the rest, except Capt. Henry Morgan himself. Honesty among thieves was never something he believed in.

Rude, truculent, and dishonest as Captain Morgan was, he seems to have had a wonderful power of persuading the wild buccaneers under him to submit everything to his judgment, and to rely entirely upon his word. In spite of the vast sum of money that he had very evidently made away with, recruits poured in upon him, until his band was larger and better equipped than ever.

Rude, aggressive, and dishonest as Captain Morgan was, he seems to have had a remarkable ability to persuade the wild buccaneers under him to trust his judgment completely and rely solely on his word. Despite the enormous amount of money he had obviously taken, recruits kept coming to him, and his crew became larger and better equipped than ever.

And now it was determined that the plunder harvest was ripe at Porto Bello, and that city's doom was sealed. The town was defended by two strong castles thoroughly manned, and officered by as gallant a soldier as ever carried Toledo steel at his side. But strong castles and gallant soldiers weighed not a barleycorn with the buccaneers when their blood was stirred by the lust of gold.

And now it was decided that the loot was ready to be taken at Porto Bello, and the city's fate was sealed. The town was protected by two strong castles, well-staffed, and led by a brave soldier who was as skilled as any who ever carried Toledo steel at his side. But strong castles and brave soldiers meant nothing to the buccaneers when their blood was driven by the desire for gold.

Landing at Puerto Naso, a town some ten leagues westward of Porto Bello, they marched to the latter town, and coming before the castle, boldly demanded its surrender. It was refused, whereupon Morgan threatened that no quarter should be given. Still surrender was refused; and then the castle was attacked, and after a bitter struggle was captured. Morgan was as good as his word: every man in the castle was shut in the guard room, the match was set to the powder magazine, and soldiers, castle, and all were blown into the air, while through all the smoke and the dust the buccaneers poured into the town. Still the governor held out in the other castle, and might have made good his defense, but that he was betrayed by the soldiers under him. Into the castle poured the howling buccaneers. But still the governor fought on, with his wife and daughter clinging to his knees and beseeching[16] him to surrender, and the blood from his wounded forehead trickling down over his white collar, until a merciful bullet put an end to the vain struggle.

Landing at Puerto Naso, a town about ten leagues west of Porto Bello, they marched to the latter town and boldly demanded the castle's surrender. It was refused, prompting Morgan to threaten that no mercy would be shown. Still, they refused to surrender, so the castle was attacked and, after a fierce fight, was captured. Morgan kept his word: every man in the castle was locked in the guard room, the fuse was lit on the gunpowder magazine, and soldiers, castle, and everything were blown into the air, while the buccaneers rushed into the town through the smoke and dust. The governor held out in the other castle and could have defended it well, but he was betrayed by his own soldiers. The howling buccaneers surged into the castle. Yet, the governor continued to fight, with his wife and daughter holding onto his knees, pleading with him to surrender, while blood from his wounded forehead trickled down over his white collar until a merciful bullet ended the futile struggle.

Morgan at Porto Bello Morgan at Porto Bello

Illustration from
MORGAN

by E. C. Stedman

Originally published in
Harper's Magazine, December 1888

Here were enacted the old scenes. Everything plundered that could be taken, and then a ransom set upon the town itself.

Here were played out the old scenes. Everything that could be taken was looted, and then a ransom was placed on the town itself.

This time an honest, or an apparently honest, division was made of the spoils, which amounted to two hundred and fifty thousand pieces of eight, besides merchandise and jewels.

This time, a fair, or at least a seemingly fair, division was made of the loot, which totaled two hundred and fifty thousand pieces of eight, along with some merchandise and jewels.

The next towns to suffer were poor Maracaibo and Gibraltar, now just beginning to recover from the desolation wrought by l'Olonoise. Once more both towns were plundered of every bale of merchandise and of every piaster, and once more both were ransomed until everything was squeezed from the wretched inhabitants.

The next towns to suffer were poor Maracaibo and Gibraltar, now just starting to recover from the destruction caused by l'Olonoise. Once again, both towns were stripped of every bale of goods and every piaster, and once more, both were held for ransom until everything was drained from the unfortunate residents.

Here affairs were like to have taken a turn, for when Captain Morgan came up from Gibraltar he found three great men-of-war lying in the entrance to the lake awaiting his coming. Seeing that he was hemmed in in the narrow sheet of water, Captain Morgan was inclined to compromise matters, even offering to relinquish all the plunder he had gained if he were allowed to depart in peace. But no; the Spanish admiral would hear nothing of this. Having the pirates, as he thought, securely in his grasp, he would relinquish nothing, but would sweep them from the face of the sea once and forever.

Here, things were about to change, because when Captain Morgan arrived from Gibraltar, he found three powerful warships waiting at the entrance to the lake for his appearance. Realizing he was trapped in the narrow body of water, Captain Morgan was willing to make a deal, even offering to give up all the loot he had taken if he could leave in peace. But the Spanish admiral wouldn’t hear of it. Believing he had the pirates firmly in his grip, he refused to give anything up and planned to wipe them off the face of the sea for good.

That was an unlucky determination for the Spaniards to reach, for instead of paralyzing the pirates with fear, as he expected it would do, it simply turned their mad courage into as mad desperation.

That was an unfortunate conclusion for the Spaniards to come to, because instead of scaring the pirates into submission, as he thought it would, it only fueled their reckless courage into reckless desperation.

A great vessel that they had taken with the town of Maracaibo was converted into a fire ship, manned with logs of wood in montera caps and sailor jackets, and filled with brimstone, pitch, and palm leaves soaked in oil. Then out of the lake the pirates sailed to meet the Spaniards, the fire ship leading the way, and bearing down [17]directly upon the admiral's vessel. At the helm stood volunteers, the most desperate and the bravest of all the pirate gang, and at the ports stood the logs of wood in montera caps. So they came up with the admiral, and grappled with his ship in spite of the thunder of all his great guns, and then the Spaniard saw, all too late, what his opponent really was.

A huge ship they had taken from the town of Maracaibo was turned into a fire ship, crewed by logs of wood wearing montera caps and sailor jackets, and packed with brimstone, pitch, and palm leaves soaked in oil. Then, the pirates sailed out of the lake to confront the Spaniards, with the fire ship in the lead, heading straight for the admiral's ship. At the helm stood volunteers, the most reckless and courageous of all the pirates, and at the sides were the logs of wood in montera caps. They approached the admiral and boarded his ship despite the booming of all his cannons, and then the Spaniard realized, far too late, what his enemy really was.

He tried to swing loose, but clouds of smoke and almost instantly a mass of roaring flames enveloped both vessels, and the admiral was lost. The second vessel, not wishing to wait for the coming of the pirates, bore down upon the fort, under the guns of which the cowardly crew sank her, and made the best of their way to the shore. The third vessel, not having an opportunity to escape, was taken by the pirates without the slightest resistance, and the passage from the lake was cleared. So the buccaneers sailed away, leaving Maracaibo and Gibraltar prostrate a second time.

He tried to break free, but clouds of smoke quickly turned into a huge wave of roaring flames that engulfed both ships, and the admiral was lost. The second ship, eager to avoid the approaching pirates, charged at the fort, and under its guns, the cowardly crew sank it and hurried to the shore. The third ship, having no chance to escape, was captured by the pirates with barely any resistance, and the way from the lake was cleared. So the buccaneers sailed off, leaving Maracaibo and Gibraltar once again brought to their knees.

And now Captain Morgan determined to undertake another venture, the like of which had never been equaled in all of the annals of buccaneering. This was nothing less than the descent upon and the capture of Panama, which was, next to Cartagena, perhaps, the most powerful and the most strongly fortified city in the West Indies.

And now Captain Morgan decided to embark on another adventure, one that had never been matched in all the history of piracy. This was nothing less than the attack and seizure of Panama, which was, next to Cartagena, probably the most powerful and heavily fortified city in the West Indies.

In preparation for this venture he obtained letters of marque from the governor of Jamaica, by virtue of which elastic commission he began immediately to gather around him all material necessary for the undertaking.

In preparation for this venture, he obtained letters of marque from the governor of Jamaica, which allowed him to start gathering all the necessary materials for the undertaking right away.

When it became known abroad that the great Captain Morgan was about undertaking an adventure that was to eclipse all that was ever done before, great numbers came flocking to his standard, until he had gathered together an army of two thousand or more desperadoes and pirates wherewith to prosecute his adventure, albeit the venture itself was kept a total secret from everyone. Port Couillon, in the island of Hispaniola, over against the Ile de la[18] Vache, was the place of muster, and thither the motley band gathered from all quarters. Provisions had been plundered from the mainland wherever they could be obtained, and by the 24th of October, 1670 (O. S.), everything was in readiness.

When word spread overseas that the great Captain Morgan was about to embark on an adventure that would surpass anything ever done before, a massive crowd flocked to join him, and he managed to assemble an army of over two thousand outlaws and pirates for his expedition, even though the details of the venture were kept completely secret from everyone. Port Couillon, on the island of Hispaniola, opposite the Ile de la[18] Vache, was the gathering point, and there the diverse group convened from all directions. Supplies were stolen from the mainland wherever they could be found, and by October 24, 1670 (O. S.), everything was ready.

The island of Saint Catharine, as it may be remembered, was at one time captured by Mansvelt, Morgan's master in his trade of piracy. It had been retaken by the Spaniards, and was now thoroughly fortified by them. Almost the first attempt that Morgan had made as a master pirate was the retaking of Saint Catharine's Isle. In that undertaking he had failed; but now, as there was an absolute need of some such place as a base of operations, he determined that the place must be taken. And it was taken.

The island of Saint Catharine, as you might remember, was once captured by Mansvelt, Morgan's mentor in piracy. It had been reclaimed by the Spaniards and was now heavily fortified. One of Morgan's first attempts as a master pirate was to retake Saint Catharine's Isle. He had failed in that effort, but now, since he absolutely needed a location to use as a base of operations, he decided that the place had to be taken. And it was taken.

The Spaniards, during the time of their possession, had fortified it most thoroughly and completely, and had the governor thereof been as brave as he who met his death in the castle of Porto Bello, there might have been a different tale to tell. As it was, he surrendered it in a most cowardly fashion, merely stipulating that there should be a sham attack by the buccaneers, whereby his credit might be saved. And so Saint Catharine was won.

The Spaniards, while they held it, had fortified it very well, and if the governor had been as courageous as the one who died in the castle of Porto Bello, the story might have been different. Instead, he surrendered it in a very cowardly way, only asking for a fake attack by the buccaneers to save face. And that's how Saint Catharine was taken.

The next step to be taken was the capture of the castle of Chagres, which guarded the mouth of the river of that name, up which river the buccaneers would be compelled to transport their troops and provisions for the attack upon the city of Panama. This adventure was undertaken by four hundred picked men under command of Captain Morgan himself.

The next step was to capture the castle of Chagres, which protected the mouth of the river of the same name. The buccaneers would need to take their troops and supplies up this river to launch their attack on the city of Panama. This mission was carried out by four hundred elite men, led by Captain Morgan himself.

The castle of Chagres, known as San Lorenzo by the Spaniards, stood upon the top of an abrupt rock at the mouth of the river, and was one of the strongest fortresses for its size in all of the West Indies. This stronghold Morgan must have if he ever hoped to win Panama.

The castle of Chagres, called San Lorenzo by the Spaniards, was perched on top of a steep rock at the river's mouth and was one of the strongest fortresses of its size in the entire West Indies. Morgan needed this stronghold if he ever wanted to take Panama.

The attack of the castle and the defense of it were equally fierce, bloody, and desperate. Again and again the buccaneers[19] assaulted, and again and again they were beaten back. So the morning came, and it seemed as though the pirates had been baffled this time. But just at this juncture the thatch of palm leaves on the roofs of some of the buildings inside the fortifications took fire, a conflagration followed, which caused the explosion of one of the magazines, and in the paralysis of terror that followed, the pirates forced their way into the fortifications, and the castle was won. Most of the Spaniards flung themselves from the castle walls into the river or upon the rocks beneath, preferring death to capture and possible torture; many who were left were put to the sword, and some few were spared and held as prisoners.

The attack on the castle and its defense were both intense, bloody, and desperate. Time and time again, the pirates[19] charged, and time and time again, they were pushed back. By morning, it seemed like the pirates had been thwarted this time. But just then, the palm thatch on some of the buildings inside the fort caught fire, leading to a blaze that caused one of the powder magazines to explode. In the chaos and panic that followed, the pirates broke through the fortifications, and the castle was captured. Most of the Spaniards jumped from the castle walls into the river or onto the rocks below, choosing death over capture and possible torture; many of those who remained were killed, while a few were spared and taken prisoner.

So fell the castle of Chagres, and nothing now lay between the buccaneers and the city of Panama but the intervening and trackless forests.

So fell the castle of Chagres, and now there was nothing between the buccaneers and the city of Panama but the dense and uncharted forests.

And now the name of the town whose doom was sealed was no secret.

And now the name of the town whose fate was sealed was no secret.

Up the river of Chagres went Capt. Henry Morgan and twelve hundred men, packed closely in their canoes; they never stopped, saving now and then to rest their stiffened legs, until they had come to a place known as Cruz de San Juan Gallego, where they were compelled to leave their boats on account of the shallowness of the water.

Up the Chagres River went Capt. Henry Morgan and twelve hundred men, crammed closely in their canoes; they didn't stop, except now and then to stretch their stiff legs, until they reached a spot called Cruz de San Juan Gallego, where they had to leave their boats because the water was too shallow.

Leaving a guard of one hundred and sixty men to protect their boats as a place of refuge in case they should be worsted before Panama, they turned and plunged into the wilderness before them.

Leaving a guard of one hundred and sixty men to protect their boats as a safe haven in case they were defeated before Panama, they turned and plunged into the wilderness ahead of them.

There a more powerful foe awaited them than a host of Spaniards with match, powder, and lead—starvation. They met but little or no opposition in their progress; but wherever they turned they found every fiber of meat, every grain of maize, every ounce of bread or meal, swept away or destroyed utterly before them. Even when the buccaneers had successfully overcome an ambuscade or an attack, and had sent the Spaniards flying, the fugitives took[20] the time to strip their dead comrades of every grain of food in their leathern sacks, leaving nothing but the empty bags.

There was a more powerful enemy waiting for them than a group of Spaniards with matches, gunpowder, and lead—starvation. They faced little to no resistance as they moved forward; however, wherever they went, they found every piece of meat, every grain of corn, and every bit of bread or meal completely gone or destroyed. Even when the buccaneers successfully dealt with an ambush or an attack and sent the Spaniards running, the fleeing soldiers took[20] the time to strip their dead comrades of any food in their leather sacks, leaving only the empty bags.

The Sacking of Panama The Sacking of Panama

Illustration from
BUCCANEERS AND MAROONERS OF THE SPANISH MAIN

by Howard Pyle

Originally published in
Harper's Magazine, August and September, 1887

Says the narrator of these events, himself one of the expedition, "They afterward fell to eating those leathern bags, as affording something to the ferment of their stomachs."

Says the narrator of these events, who is part of the expedition, "They later started eating those leather bags, as they provided something for their upset stomachs."

Ten days they struggled through this bitter privation, doggedly forcing their way onward, faint with hunger and haggard with weakness and fever. Then, from the high hill and over the tops of the forest trees, they saw the steeples of Panama, and nothing remained between them and their goal but the fighting of four Spaniards to every one of them—a simple thing which they had done over and over again.

For ten days, they fought through this harsh deprivation, stubbornly making their way forward, weak with hunger and worn out from fatigue and fever. Then, from the high hill and over the tree tops, they saw the steeples of Panama, and all that stood between them and their goal was the battle against four Spaniards for each one of them—a straightforward task they had accomplished time and time again.

Down they poured upon Panama, and out came the Spaniards to meet them; four hundred horse, two thousand five hundred foot, and two thousand wild bulls which had been herded together to be driven over the buccaneers so that their ranks might be disordered and broken. The buccaneers were only eight hundred strong; the others had either fallen in battle or had dropped along the dreary pathway through the wilderness; but in the space of two hours the Spaniards were flying madly over the plain, minus six hundred who lay dead or dying behind them.

Down they charged into Panama, and the Spaniards came out to confront them; four hundred cavalry, two thousand five hundred infantry, and two thousand wild bulls that had been rounded up to stampede over the buccaneers to disrupt their ranks. The buccaneers were only eight hundred strong; the rest had either been killed in battle or had fallen along the bleak path through the wilderness; but in just two hours, the Spaniards were fleeing wildly across the plain, leaving behind six hundred who were dead or dying.

As for the bulls, as many of them as were shot served as food there and then for the half-famished pirates, for the buccaneers were never more at home than in the slaughter of cattle.

As for the bulls, as many as were shot were used as food right there for the starving pirates, because the buccaneers were never more at ease than when killing cattle.

Then they marched toward the city. Three hours' more fighting and they were in the streets, howling, yelling, plundering, gorging, dram-drinking, and giving full vent to all the vile and nameless lusts that burned in their hearts like a hell of fire. And now followed the usual sequence of events—rapine, cruelty, and extortion; only this time there was no town to ransom, for Morgan had given orders that it should be destroyed. The torch was set to it, and Panama, one of the greatest cities in the New World, was swept from the face of the earth. Why the deed was done, [21]no man but Morgan could tell. Perhaps it was that all the secret hiding places for treasure might be brought to light; but whatever the reason was, it lay hidden in the breast of the great buccaneer himself. For three weeks Morgan and his men abode in this dreadful place; and they marched away with one hundred and seventy-five beasts of burden loaded with treasures of gold and silver and jewels, besides great quantities of merchandise, and six hundred prisoners held for ransom.

Then they marched toward the city. After three more hours of fighting, they were in the streets, howling, yelling, looting, gorging, drinking, and letting out all the vile and shameful desires that burned in their hearts like a raging fire. And then came the usual sequence of events—rape, cruelty, and extortion; but this time there was no town to ransom, as Morgan had ordered it to be destroyed. Fire was set to it, and Panama, one of the greatest cities in the New World, was erased from existence. Why this was done, [21]no one but Morgan could say. Maybe it was to uncover all the hidden treasure, but whatever the reason, it remained a secret with the great buccaneer himself. For three weeks, Morgan and his men stayed in this terrible place; and they left with one hundred and seventy-five pack animals loaded with treasures of gold, silver, and jewels, along with a large amount of merchandise, and six hundred prisoners taken for ransom.

Whatever became of all that vast wealth, and what it amounted to, no man but Morgan ever knew, for when a division was made it was found that there was only two hundred pieces of eight to each man.

Whatever happened to all that wealth, and how much it really was, no one but Morgan ever knew. When they divided it up, it turned out that each man only got two hundred pieces of eight.

When this dividend was declared, a howl of execration went up, under which even Capt. Henry Morgan quailed. At night he and four other commanders slipped their cables and ran out to sea, and it was said that these divided the greater part of the booty among themselves. But the wealth plundered at Panama could hardly have fallen short of a million and a half of dollars. Computing it at this reasonable figure, the various prizes won by Henry Morgan in the West Indies would stand as follows: Panama, $1,500,000; Porto Bello, $800,000; Puerto del Principe, $700,000; Maracaibo and Gibraltar, $400,000; various piracies, $250,000—making a grand total of $3,650,000 as the vast harvest of plunder. With this fabulous wealth, wrenched from the Spaniards by means of the rack and the cord, and pilfered from his companions by the meanest of thieving, Capt. Henry Morgan retired from business, honored of all, rendered famous by his deeds, knighted by the good King Charles II, and finally appointed governor of the rich island of Jamaica.

When this dividend was announced, there was an uproar of outrage, causing even Capt. Henry Morgan to tremble. That night, he and four other commanders quietly set sail and headed out to sea, and it was rumored that they shared the majority of the loot among themselves. The wealth taken from Panama was certainly around one and a half million dollars. With that figure in mind, the various treasures captured by Henry Morgan in the West Indies would be tallied as follows: Panama, $1,500,000; Porto Bello, $800,000; Puerto del Principe, $700,000; Maracaibo and Gibraltar, $400,000; various piracy acts, $250,000—adding up to an impressive total of $3,650,000 from their tremendous plunder. With this incredible wealth, taken from the Spaniards through torture and stolen from his comrades through deceit, Capt. Henry Morgan retired from piracy, celebrated by all, renowned for his exploits, knighted by the honorable King Charles II, and ultimately appointed governor of the wealthy island of Jamaica.

Other buccaneers followed him. Campeche was taken and sacked, and even Cartagena itself fell; but with Henry Morgan culminated the glory of the buccaneers, and from that time they declined in power and wealth and wickedness until they were finally swept away.[22]

Other pirates followed him. Campeche was captured and looted, and even Cartagena itself fell; but with Henry Morgan, the height of the pirates' glory was reached, and from that point on, they lost power, wealth, and wickedness until they were eventually wiped out.[22]

The buccaneers became bolder and bolder. In fact, so daring were their crimes that the home governments, stirred at last by these outrageous barbarities, seriously undertook the suppression of the freebooters, lopping and trimming the main trunk until its members were scattered hither and thither, and it was thought that the organization was exterminated. But, so far from being exterminated, the individual members were merely scattered north, south, east, and west, each forming a nucleus around which gathered and clustered the very worst of the offscouring of humanity.

The buccaneers grew increasingly bold. In fact, their crimes became so outrageous that the home governments, finally roused by these shocking acts, seriously took action to eliminate the pirates, cutting back the main group until its members were scattered everywhere, and it was believed that the organization had been wiped out. But rather than being eliminated, the individual members were only dispersed to the north, south, east, and west, each creating a base around which the very worst elements of society gathered.

The result was that when the seventeenth century was fairly packed away with its lavender in the store chest of the past, a score or more bands of freebooters were cruising along the Atlantic seaboard in armed vessels, each with a black flag with its skull and crossbones at the fore, and with a nondescript crew made up of the tags and remnants of civilized and semicivilized humanity (white, black, red, and yellow), known generally as marooners, swarming upon the decks below.

The result was that when the seventeenth century was pretty much put away with its lavender in the storage chest of the past, a number of pirate crews were sailing along the Atlantic coast in armed ships, each flying a black flag with a skull and crossbones at the front, and crewed by a mix of the scraps and remnants of civilized and semi-civilized humanity (white, black, red, and yellow), commonly referred to as marooners, swarming on the decks below.

Nor did these offshoots from the old buccaneer stem confine their depredations to the American seas alone; the East Indies and the African coast also witnessed their doings, and suffered from them, and even the Bay of Biscay had good cause to remember more than one visit from them.

Nor did these offshoots of the old pirates limit their raids to the American seas; the East Indies and the African coast also experienced their actions and suffered because of them, and even the Bay of Biscay had good reason to remember more than one encounter with them.

Worthy sprigs from so worthy a stem improved variously upon the parent methods; for while the buccaneers were content to prey upon the Spaniards alone, the marooners reaped the harvest from the commerce of all nations.

Worthy branches from such a noble stem enhanced the original methods in different ways; while the buccaneers were satisfied to target the Spaniards alone, the marooners benefitted from the trade of all nations.

So up and down the Atlantic seaboard they cruised, and for the fifty years that marooning was in the flower of its glory it was a sorrowful time for the coasters of New England, the middle provinces, and the Virginias, sailing to the West Indies with their cargoes of salt fish, grain, and tobacco. Trading became almost as dangerous as privateering, and sea captains were chosen as[23] much for their knowledge of the flintlock and the cutlass as for their seamanship.

So they cruised up and down the Atlantic coast, and for fifty years, when marooning was at its peak, it was a tough time for the coastal traders of New England, the middle colonies, and Virginia, who sailed to the West Indies with their loads of salt fish, grain, and tobacco. Trading became nearly as risky as privateering, and sea captains were selected as[23] much for their skills with a flintlock and a cutlass as for their seafaring ability.

As by far the largest part of the trading in American waters was conducted by these Yankee coasters, so by far the heaviest blows, and those most keenly felt, fell upon them. Bulletin after bulletin came to port with its doleful tale of this vessel burned or that vessel scuttled, this one held by the pirates for their own use or that one stripped of its goods and sent into port as empty as an eggshell from which the yolk had been sucked. Boston, New York, Philadelphia, and Charleston suffered alike, and worthy ship owners had to leave off counting their losses upon their fingers and take to the slate to keep the dismal record.

Since the majority of trade in American waters was handled by these Yankee coasters, they felt the heaviest hits, which affected them the most. Bulletin after bulletin arrived at port with its sad news about this vessel being burned or that vessel being sunk, this one captured by pirates for their own use or that one stripped of its goods and sent back to port as empty as an eggshell. Boston, New York, Philadelphia, and Charleston all faced the same struggles, and respected ship owners had to stop counting their losses on their fingers and start using a chalkboard to keep track of the grim tally.

"Maroon—to put ashore on a desert isle, as a sailor, under pretense of having committed some great crime." Thus our good Noah Webster gives us the dry bones, the anatomy, upon which the imagination may construct a specimen to suit itself.

"Maroon—to land someone on a deserted island, like a sailor, pretending they’ve committed some serious crime." This is how our good Noah Webster lays out the basics, the framework, on which the imagination can build a version of its own.

It is thence that the marooners took their name, for marooning was one of their most effective instruments of punishment or revenge. If a pirate broke one of the many rules which governed the particular band to which he belonged, he was marooned; did a captain defend his ship to such a degree as to be unpleasant to the pirates attacking it, he was marooned; even the pirate captain himself, if he displeased his followers by the severity of his rule, was in danger of having the same punishment visited upon him which he had perhaps more than once visited upon another.

That's where the marooners got their name, because marooning was one of their most effective ways to punish or get revenge. If a pirate broke one of the many rules set by the group he was part of, he would be marooned; if a captain defended his ship strongly enough to annoy the attacking pirates, he would be marooned; even the pirate captain himself was at risk of facing the same punishment he might have previously given to someone else if he upset his crew with harsh leadership.

The process of marooning was as simple as terrible. A suitable place was chosen (generally some desert isle as far removed as possible from the pathway of commerce), and the condemned man was rowed from the ship to the beach. Out he was bundled upon the sand spit; a gun, a half dozen bullets, a few pinches of powder, and a bottle of water were chucked ashore after him, and away rowed the boat's crew back to the ship, leaving the poor wretch alone to rave away his life in madness, or to sit sunken in his gloomy[24] despair till death mercifully released him from torment. It rarely if ever happened that anything was known of him after having been marooned. A boat's crew from some vessel, sailing by chance that way, might perhaps find a few chalky bones bleaching upon the white sand in the garish glare of the sunlight, but that was all. And such were marooners.

The process of marooning was as straightforward as it was horrific. A suitable location was selected (usually some remote island far from trade routes), and the condemned man was taken from the ship to the shore. He was tossed onto the sandy strip; a gun, half a dozen bullets, a few pinches of gunpowder, and a bottle of water were thrown ashore after him, and the boat's crew rowed back to the ship, leaving the unfortunate man alone to either lose his mind in despair or sit in his deep sorrow until death finally set him free from his suffering. It was rare, if it ever happened, that anything was known of him after being marooned. A crew from another ship passing nearby might stumble upon a few bleached bones scattered on the white sand under the harsh sunlight, but that was the extent of it. And such were marooners.

By far the largest number of pirate captains were Englishmen, for, from the days of good Queen Bess, English sea captains seemed to have a natural turn for any species of venture that had a smack of piracy in it, and from the great Admiral Drake of the old, old days, to the truculent Morgan of buccaneering times, the Englishman did the boldest and wickedest deeds, and wrought the most damage.

The largest number of pirate captains were English, because, since the days of Queen Elizabeth I, English sea captains had a natural knack for any venture that had a hint of piracy. From the great Admiral Drake of the distant past to the fierce Morgan of the buccaneering era, the English were responsible for the boldest and most notorious acts, causing the most destruction.

First of all upon the list of pirates stands the bold Captain Avary, one of the institutors of marooning. Him we see but dimly, half hidden by the glamouring mists of legends and tradition. Others who came afterward outstripped him far enough in their doings, but he stands pre-eminent as the first of marooners of whom actual history has been handed down to us of the present day.

First of all, at the top of the list of pirates is the daring Captain Avary, one of the pioneers of marooning. We see him only vaguely, partially obscured by the enchanting mists of legends and tradition. Others who came after him surpassed him significantly in their actions, but he remains the most prominent of the marooners of whom actual history has been passed down to us today.

When the English, Dutch, and Spanish entered into an alliance to suppress buccaneering in the West Indies, certain worthies of Bristol, in old England, fitted out two vessels to assist in this laudable project; for doubtless Bristol trade suffered smartly from the Morgans and the l'Olonoises of that old time. One of these vessels was named the Duke, of which a certain Captain Gibson was the commander and Avary the mate.

When the English, Dutch, and Spanish formed an alliance to stop piracy in the West Indies, some notable individuals from Bristol, England, outfitted two ships to support this noble effort; after all, Bristol's trade had certainly been hurt by the likes of Morgans and l'Olonoises back in the day. One of these ships was called the Duke, and it was commanded by Captain Gibson, with Avary as the first mate.

Away they sailed to the West Indies, and there Avary became impressed by the advantages offered by piracy, and by the amount of good things that were to be gained by very little striving.

Away they sailed to the West Indies, and there Avary became captivated by the benefits of piracy and the abundance of rewards that could be attained with minimal effort.

One night the captain (who was one of those fellows mightily addicted to punch), instead of going ashore to saturate himself with rum at the ordinary, had his drink in his cabin in private. While he lay snoring away the effects of his rum in the cabin, Avary and a few other conspirators heaved the anchor very leisurely,[25] and sailed out of the harbor of Corunna, and through the midst of the allied fleet riding at anchor in the darkness.

One night, the captain (who was really into punch) decided to skip going ashore to soak up some rum at the bar and chose to have his drink in his cabin instead. While he lay there snoring off the effects of his rum, Avary and a few other conspirators quietly lifted the anchor and sailed out of the harbor of Corunna, navigating through the allied fleet anchored in the dark. [25]

By and by, when the morning came, the captain was awakened by the pitching and tossing of the vessel, the rattle and clatter of the tackle overhead, and the noise of footsteps passing and repassing hither and thither across the deck. Perhaps he lay for a while turning the matter over and over in his muddled head, but he presently rang the bell, and Avary and another fellow answered the call.

Eventually, when morning came, the captain was jolted awake by the swaying of the ship, the rattling of the gear above, and the sound of footsteps going back and forth across the deck. He might have spent some time thinking it through in his confused mind, but soon he rang the bell, and Avary along with another crew member responded to the call.

"What's the matter?" bawls the captain from his berth.

"What's wrong?" shouts the captain from his bunk.

"Nothing," says Avary, coolly.

"Nothing," Avary says coolly.

"Something's the matter with the ship," says the captain. "Does she drive? What weather is it?"

"There's something wrong with the ship," says the captain. "Is she moving? What’s the weather like?"

"Oh no," says Avary; "we are at sea."

"Oh no," says Avary, "we're at sea."

"At sea?"

"Out at sea?"

"Come, come!" says Avary: "I'll tell you; you must know that I'm the captain of the ship now, and you must be packing from this here cabin. We are bound to Madagascar, to make all of our fortunes, and if you're a mind to ship for the cruise, why, we'll be glad to have you, if you will be sober and mind your own business; if not, there is a boat alongside, and I'll have you set ashore."

"Come on!" says Avary. "Let me fill you in; you need to know that I'm the captain of the ship now, and you need to start packing up from this cabin. We're headed to Madagascar to make our fortunes, and if you want to join us for the journey, we'd be happy to have you, as long as you stay sober and take care of your own business. If not, there's a boat right next to us, and I'll have you taken ashore."

The poor half-tipsy captain had no relish to go a-pirating under the command of his backsliding mate, so out of the ship he bundled, and away he rowed with four or five of the crew, who, like him, refused to join with their jolly shipmates.

The tipsy captain didn’t want to go pirating under his unreliable mate, so he hurried off the ship and rowed away with four or five crew members who, like him, didn’t want to join their cheerful shipmates.

The rest of them sailed away to the East Indies, to try their fortunes in those waters, for our Captain Avary was of a high spirit, and had no mind to fritter away his time in the West Indies, squeezed dry by buccaneer Morgan and others of lesser note. No, he would make a bold stroke for it at once, and make or lose at a single cast.

The others set sail for the East Indies to seek their fortunes in those waters, because our Captain Avary was very ambitious and didn't want to waste his time in the West Indies, which had been drained by buccaneer Morgan and others of lesser fame. No, he aimed to take a bold chance right away and either win big or lose it all in one go.

On his way he picked up a couple of like kind with himself—two[26] sloops off Madagascar. With these he sailed away to the coast of India, and for a time his name was lost in the obscurity of uncertain history. But only for a time, for suddenly it flamed out in a blaze of glory. It was reported that a vessel belonging to the Great Mogul, laden with treasure and bearing the monarch's own daughter upon a holy pilgrimage to Mecca (they being Mohammedans), had fallen in with the pirates, and after a short resistance had been surrendered, with the damsel, her court, and all the diamonds, pearls, silk, silver, and gold aboard. It was rumored that the Great Mogul, raging at the insult offered to him through his own flesh and blood, had threatened to wipe out of existence the few English settlements scattered along the coast; whereat the honorable East India Company was in a pretty state of fuss and feathers. Rumor, growing with the telling, has it that Avary is going to marry the Indian princess, willy-nilly, and will turn rajah, and eschew piracy as indecent. As for the treasure itself, there was no end to the extent to which it grew as it passed from mouth to mouth.

On his way, he picked up a couple of guys like himself—two[26] sloops off Madagascar. With them, he sailed to the coast of India, and for a while, his name was lost in the shadows of unclear history. But only for a while, as it suddenly shone bright in a blaze of glory. It was reported that a ship belonging to the Great Mogul, loaded with treasure and carrying the monarch's own daughter on a holy pilgrimage to Mecca (since they were Muslims), had encountered the pirates. After a brief resistance, it was surrendered, along with the princess, her entourage, and all the diamonds, pearls, silk, silver, and gold on board. It was rumored that the Great Mogul, furious at the insult to his own flesh and blood, threatened to wipe out the few English settlements scattered along the coast; this had the honorable East India Company in quite a panic. As rumors grew with each telling, it was said that Avary was going to marry the Indian princess whether he liked it or not and would become a rajah, leaving piracy behind as improper. As for the treasure itself, there seemed to be no limit to how much it grew as it spread from person to person.

Marooned Marooned

Illustration from
BUCCANEERS AND MAROONERS OF THE SPANISH MAIN

by Howard Pyle

Originally published in
Harper's Magazine, August and September, 1887

Cracking the nut of romance and exaggeration, we come to the kernel of the story—that Avary did fall in with an Indian vessel laden with great treasure (and possibly with the Mogul's daughter), which he captured, and thereby gained a vast prize.

Cracking the shell of romance and exaggeration, we reach the core of the story—that Avary did come across an Indian ship filled with immense treasure (and maybe the Mogul's daughter), which he seized, thus securing a huge prize.

Having concluded that he had earned enough money by the trade he had undertaken, he determined to retire and live decently for the rest of his life upon what he already had. As a step toward this object, he set about cheating his Madagascar partners out of their share of what had been gained. He persuaded them to store all the treasure in his vessel, it being the largest of the three; and so, having it safely in hand, he altered the course of his ship one fine night, and when the morning came the Madagascar sloops found themselves floating upon a wide ocean without a farthing of the treasure for which they had fought so hard, and for which they might whistle for all the good it would do them.

Having decided he had made enough money from his trade, he planned to retire and live comfortably for the rest of his life on what he already had. To achieve this, he schemed to cheat his Madagascar partners out of their share of the profits. He convinced them to store all the treasure in his ship, as it was the largest of the three. Then, one night, he changed his ship's course, and when morning came, the Madagascar sloops found themselves drifting in a vast ocean without a single penny of the treasure they had fought so hard for, leaving them with no hope of ever seeing it again.

At first Avary had a great part of a mind to settle at Boston, in Massachusetts, and had that little town been one whit less bleak and forbidding, it might have had the honor of being the home of this famous man. As it was, he did not like the looks of it, so he sailed away to the eastward, to Ireland, where he settled himself at Biddeford, in hopes of an easy life of it for the rest of his days.

At first, Avary planned to settle in Boston, Massachusetts, and if that little town had been just a bit less dreary and unwelcoming, it might have been the home of this famous person. However, he wasn't fond of its appearance, so he sailed east to Ireland, where he settled in Biddeford, hoping for an easy life for the rest of his days.

Here he found himself the possessor of a plentiful stock of jewels, such as pearls, diamonds, rubies, etc., but with hardly a score of honest farthings to jingle in his breeches pocket. He consulted with a certain merchant of Bristol concerning the disposal of the stones—a fellow not much more cleanly in his habits of honesty than Avary himself. This worthy undertook to act as Avary's broker. Off he marched with the jewels, and that was the last that the pirate saw of his Indian treasure.

Here he found himself with a large stash of jewels, like pearls, diamonds, rubies, and more, but hardly a few coins to jingle in his pocket. He talked to a merchant from Bristol about selling the stones—a guy not much more trustworthy than Avary himself. This guy agreed to be Avary's broker. He marched off with the jewels, and that was the last time the pirate saw his Indian treasure.

Perhaps the most famous of all the piratical names to American ears are those of Capt. Robert Kidd and Capt. Edward Teach, or "Blackbeard."

Perhaps the most famous pirate names that Americans recognize are Capt. Robert Kidd and Capt. Edward Teach, or "Blackbeard."

Nothing will be ventured in regard to Kidd at this time, nor in regard to the pros and cons as to whether he really was or was not a pirate, after all. For many years he was the very hero of heroes of piratical fame; there was hardly a creek or stream or point of land along our coast, hardly a convenient bit of good sandy beach, or hump of rock, or water-washed cave, where fabulous treasures were not said to have been hidden by this worthy marooner. Now we are assured that he never was a pirate, and never did bury any treasure, excepting a certain chest, which he was compelled to hide upon Gardiner's Island—and perhaps even it was mythical.

Nothing will be said about Kidd at this time, nor about the debate over whether he truly was a pirate or not. For many years, he was the ultimate hero of pirate legends; there was hardly a creek, stream, or landmark along our coast, hardly a nice sandy beach, rocky outcrop, or water-carved cave, where fantastic treasures weren’t said to have been hidden by this infamous marooner. Now we’re told that he was never a pirate and never buried any treasure, except for a certain chest that he had to hide on Gardiner's Island—and maybe even that was just a myth.

So poor Kidd must be relegated to the dull ranks of simply respectable people, or semirespectable people at best.

So poor Kidd has to be stuck among the boring crowd of just decent people, or at best, semi-decent people.

But with "Blackbeard" it is different, for in him we have a real, ranting, raging, roaring pirate per se—one who really did bury treasure, who made more than one captain walk the plank, and who committed more private murders than he could number[28] on the fingers of both hands; one who fills, and will continue to fill, the place to which he has been assigned for generations, and who may be depended upon to hold his place in the confidence of others for generations to come.

But with "Blackbeard," it's different because he is a true, loud, wild pirate who really did bury treasure, made more than one captain walk the plank, and committed more murders than he could count on both hands. He occupies, and will continue to occupy, the role he's held for generations, and he can be counted on to maintain his status in people's minds for years to come.[28]

Captain Teach was a Bristol man born, and learned his trade on board of sundry privateers in the East Indies during the old French war—that of 1702—and a better apprenticeship could no man serve. At last, somewhere about the latter part of the year 1716, a privateering captain, one Benjamin Hornigold, raised him from the ranks and put him in command of a sloop—a lately captured prize—and Blackbeard's fortune was made. It was a very slight step, and but the change of a few letters, to convert "privateer" into "pirate," and it was a very short time before Teach made that change. Not only did he make it himself, but he persuaded his old captain to join with him.

Captain Teach was born in Bristol and learned his trade on various privateers in the East Indies during the old French war of 1702—which was a great apprenticeship. By the end of 1716, a privateering captain named Benjamin Hornigold elevated him from the crew and put him in charge of a recently captured sloop—this was the moment Blackbeard's fortune began. The change from "privateer" to "pirate" was just a slight adjustment in letters, and it didn't take long for Teach to make that switch. Not only did he make the change himself, but he also convinced his former captain to join him.

And now fairly began that series of bold and lawless depredations which have made his name so justly famous, and which placed him among the very greatest of marooning freebooters.

And now truly began that series of daring and lawless acts that have made his name so well-known, placing him among the very greatest of pirate freebooters.

"Our hero," says the old historian who sings of the arms and bravery of this great man—"our hero assumed the cognomen of Blackbeard from that large quantity of hair which, like a frightful meteor, covered his whole face, and frightened America more than any comet that appeared there in a long time. He was accustomed to twist it with ribbons into small tails, after the manner of our Ramillies wig, and turn them about his ears. In time of action he wore a sling over his shoulders, with three brace of pistols, hanging in holsters like bandoleers; he stuck lighted matches under his hat, which, appearing on each side of his face, and his eyes naturally looking fierce and wild, made him altogether such a figure that imagination cannot form an idea of a Fury from hell to look more frightful."

"Our hero," says the old historian who tells the tale of this great man's exploits and courage—"our hero took on the nickname Blackbeard because of the thick hair that covered his entire face, resembling a terrifying meteor, which scared America more than any comet that had shown up in a while. He would twist it with ribbons into small ponytails, like the style of our Ramillies wig, and wrap them around his ears. During battle, he wore a sling over his shoulders with three pairs of pistols hanging in holsters like bandoleers; he placed lighted fuses under his hat, which, sticking out on either side of his face, combined with his naturally fierce and wild expression, made him such a sight that the imagination couldn't conceive of a more terrifying creature from hell."

The night before the day of the action in which he was killed he sat up drinking with some congenial company until broad[29] daylight. One of them asked him if his poor young wife knew where his treasure was hidden. "No," says Blackbeard; "nobody but the devil and I knows where it is, and the longest liver shall have all."

The night before he was killed, he stayed up drinking with some friends until just before dawn. One of them asked if his young wife knew where his treasure was hidden. "No," Blackbeard replied, "only the devil and I know where it is, and whoever lives the longest will get it all."

As for that poor young wife of his, the life that he and his rum-crazy shipmates led her was too terrible to be told.

As for his poor young wife, the life he and his rum-crazed shipmates put her through was too awful to describe.

For a time Blackbeard worked at his trade down on the Spanish Main, gathering, in the few years he was there, a very neat little fortune in the booty captured from sundry vessels; but by and by he took it into his head to try his luck along the coast of the Carolinas; so off he sailed to the northward, with quite a respectable little fleet, consisting of his own vessel and two captured sloops. From that time he was actively engaged in the making of American history in his small way.

For a while, Blackbeard worked at his trade along the Spanish Main, collecting, in just a few years, a tidy little fortune from the loot taken from various ships. Eventually, he decided to try his luck along the coast of the Carolinas, so he set sail northward with a pretty decent little fleet, which included his own ship and two captured sloops. From that point on, he was actively involved in shaping American history, in his own small way.

He first appeared off the bar of Charleston Harbor, to the no small excitement of the worthy town of that ilk, and there he lay for five or six days, blockading the port, and stopping incoming and outgoing vessels at his pleasure, so that, for the time, the commerce of the province was entirely paralyzed. All the vessels so stopped he held as prizes, and all the crews and passengers (among the latter of whom was more than one provincial worthy of the day) he retained as though they were prisoners of war.

He first showed up off the coast of Charleston Harbor, which got the town all worked up, and he stayed there for five or six days, blockading the port and halting ships coming in and out whenever he wanted. As a result, the province's commerce was completely frozen. All the ships he stopped became his prizes, and he kept all the crews and passengers (including more than a few notable locals) as if they were prisoners of war.

And it was a mightily awkward thing for the good folk of Charleston to behold day after day a black flag with its white skull and crossbones fluttering at the fore of the pirate captain's craft, over across the level stretch of green salt marshes; and it was mightily unpleasant, too, to know that this or that prominent citizen was crowded down with the other prisoners under the hatches.

And it was really awkward for the good people of Charleston to see day after day a black flag with its white skull and crossbones flying at the front of the pirate captain's ship, out over the flat expanse of green salt marshes; and it was really unpleasant, too, to know that this or that well-known citizen was crammed down with the other prisoners below deck.

One morning Captain Blackbeard finds that his stock of medicine is low. "Tut!" says he, "we'll turn no hair gray for that." So up he calls the bold Captain Richards, the commander of his consort the Revenge sloop, and bids him take Mr. Marks[30] (one of his prisoners), and go up to Charleston and get the medicine. There was no task that suited our Captain Richards better than that. Up to the town he rowed, as bold as brass. "Look ye," says he to the governor, rolling his quid of tobacco from one cheek to another—"look ye, we're after this and that, and if we don't get it, why, I'll tell you plain, we'll burn them bloody crafts of yours that we've took over yonder, and cut the weasand of every clodpoll aboard of 'em."

One morning, Captain Blackbeard realizes that he’s running low on medicine. “No worries!” he declares, “We won’t let that stress us out.” So he calls in the daring Captain Richards, the leader of his companion sloop, the Revenge, and instructs him to take Mr. Marks[30] (one of his prisoners) and head to Charleston to get the medicine. There was no task better suited for Captain Richards than that. He rowed up to the town, completely fearless. “Listen,” he said to the governor, shifting his chew of tobacco from one side of his mouth to the other—“we’re here for this and that, and if we don’t get it, well, I’ll be straightforward with you, we’ll burn those bloody ships of yours that we’ve taken over there and cut the throats of every simpleton on board.”

There was no answering an argument of such force as this, and the worshipful governor and the good folk of Charleston knew very well that Blackbeard and his crew were the men to do as they promised. So Blackbeard got his medicine, and though it cost the colony two thousand dollars, it was worth that much to the town to be quit of him.

There was no way to counter an argument this strong, and the respected governor and the good people of Charleston knew that Blackbeard and his crew would follow through on their word. So Blackbeard got what he needed, and even though it cost the colony two thousand dollars, it was worth that much to the town to be rid of him.

They say that while Captain Richards was conducting his negotiations with the governor his boat's crew were stumping around the streets of the town, having a glorious time of it, while the good folk glowered wrathfully at them, but dared venture nothing in speech or act.

They say that while Captain Richards was negotiating with the governor, his boat crew was wandering around the town, having a great time, while the townspeople glared at them angrily but didn’t say or do anything.

Having gained a booty of between seven and eight thousand dollars from the prizes captured, the pirates sailed away from Charleston Harbor to the coast of North Carolina.

Having collected between seven and eight thousand dollars from the prizes they took, the pirates sailed away from Charleston Harbor to the coast of North Carolina.

And now Blackbeard, following the plan adopted by so many others of his kind, began to cudgel his brains for means to cheat his fellows out of their share of the booty.

And now Blackbeard, following the strategy used by many others like him, started to rack his brain for ways to trick his crew out of their share of the loot.

At Topsail Inlet he ran his own vessel aground, as though by accident. Hands, the captain of one of the consorts, pretending to come to his assistance, also grounded his sloop. Nothing now remained but for those who were able to get away in the other craft, which was all that was now left of the little fleet. This did Blackbeard with some forty of his favorites. The rest of the pirates were left on the sand spit to await the return of their companions—which never happened.[31]

At Topsail Inlet, he intentionally ran his own ship aground, as if it were an accident. Hands, the captain of one of the other ships, pretended to help and also ran his sloop aground. Now, all that was left was for those who could escape in the other boats, which was all that remained of the small fleet. This is what Blackbeard did with about forty of his crew. The other pirates were left on the sandbar waiting for their friends to return—which never happened.[31]

As for Blackbeard and those who were with him, they were that much richer, for there were so many the fewer pockets to fill. But even yet there were too many to share the booty, in Blackbeard's opinion, and so he marooned a parcel more of them—some eighteen or twenty—upon a naked sand bank, from which they were afterward mercifully rescued by another freebooter who chanced that way—a certain Major Stede Bonnet, of whom more will presently be said. About that time a royal proclamation had been issued offering pardon to all pirates in arms who would surrender to the king's authority before a given date. So up goes Master Blackbeard to the Governor of North Carolina and makes his neck safe by surrendering to the proclamation—albeit he kept tight clutch upon what he had already gained.

As for Blackbeard and his crew, they were much wealthier since there were fewer pockets to fill. However, in Blackbeard's view, there were still too many people to split the loot among, so he marooned a few more of them—about eighteen or twenty—on a bare sandbank, from which they were eventually rescued by another pirate who happened to pass by—a certain Major Stede Bonnet, who will be discussed further soon. Around that time, a royal proclamation was issued offering pardon to all pirates in arms who would surrender to the king's authority by a certain date. So, Master Blackbeard went to the Governor of North Carolina and secured his safety by surrendering to the proclamation—even though he tightly held onto what he had already acquired.

And now we find our bold Captain Blackbeard established in the good province of North Carolina, where he and His Worship the Governor struck up a vast deal of intimacy, as profitable as it was pleasant. There is something very pretty in the thought of the bold sea rover giving up his adventurous life (excepting now and then an excursion against a trader or two in the neighboring sound, when the need of money was pressing); settling quietly down into the routine of old colonial life, with a young wife of sixteen at his side, who made the fourteenth that he had in various ports here and there in the world.

And now we find our fearless Captain Blackbeard settled in the charming province of North Carolina, where he and the Governor became close friends, as beneficial as it was enjoyable. There’s something quite lovely about the idea of the daring pirate leaving behind his adventurous lifestyle (except for the occasional raid on a trader or two in the nearby sound when he was short on cash); settling into the everyday life of the old colonies with a young wife of sixteen by his side, who was the fourteenth he had taken in different ports around the world.

Becoming tired of an inactive life, Blackbeard afterward resumed his piratical career. He cruised around in the rivers and inlets and sounds of North Carolina for a while, ruling the roost and with never a one to say him nay, until there was no bearing with such a pest any longer. So they sent a deputation up to the Governor of Virginia asking if he would be pleased to help them in their trouble.

Tired of an inactive life, Blackbeard decided to get back into piracy. He sailed the rivers, inlets, and sounds of North Carolina for a while, taking charge and facing no opposition, until no one could stand him any longer. So, they sent a group to the Governor of Virginia, asking if he could help them with their problem.

There were two men-of-war lying at Kicquetan, in the James River, at the time. To them the Governor of Virginia applies, and plucky Lieutenant Maynard, of the Pearl, was sent to Ocracoke[32] Inlet to fight this pirate who ruled it down there so like the cock of a walk. There he found Blackbeard waiting for him, and as ready for a fight as ever the lieutenant himself could be. Fight they did, and while it lasted it was as pretty a piece of business of its kind as one could wish to see. Blackbeard drained a glass of grog, wishing the lieutenant luck in getting aboard of him, fired a broadside, blew some twenty of the lieutenant's men out of existence, and totally crippled one of his little sloops for the balance of the fight. After that, and under cover of the smoke, the pirate and his men boarded the other sloop, and then followed a fine old-fashioned hand-to-hand conflict betwixt him and the lieutenant. First they fired their pistols, and then they took to it with cutlasses—right, left, up and down, cut and slash—until the lieutenant's cutlass broke short off at the hilt. Then Blackbeard would have finished him off handsomely, only up steps one of the lieutenant's men and fetches him a great slash over the neck, so that the lieutenant came off with no more hurt than a cut across the knuckles.

Two warships were anchored at Kicquetan in the James River during that time. The Governor of Virginia reached out to them, and brave Lieutenant Maynard from the Pearl was dispatched to Ocracoke[32] Inlet to confront the pirate who had become like a king down there. When he arrived, Blackbeard was waiting, just as eager for a fight as the lieutenant was. They engaged in battle, and while it lasted, it was an impressive exchange to witness. Blackbeard raised a glass of grog, wishing the lieutenant luck in boarding him, then fired a broadside that wiped out about twenty of the lieutenant's men and severely damaged one of his small ships for the rest of the fight. After that, using the cover of smoke, the pirate and his crew boarded the other sloop, leading to a classic hand-to-hand combat between him and the lieutenant. They first fired their pistols, then switched to cutlasses—swinging left and right, cutting and slashing—until the lieutenant's cutlass snapped off at the hilt. Just when Blackbeard was about to finish him off, one of the lieutenant's men stepped up and delivered a deep slash across Blackbeard's neck, leaving the lieutenant with nothing more than a cut on his knuckles.

Blackbeard Buries His Treasure Blackbeard Buries His Treasure

Illustration from
BUCCANEERS AND MAROONERS OF THE SPANISH MAIN

by Howard Pyle

Originally published in
Harper's Magazine, August and September, 1887

At the very first discharge of their pistols Blackbeard had been shot through the body, but he was not for giving up for that—not he. As said before, he was of the true roaring, raging breed of pirates, and stood up to it until he received twenty more cutlass cuts and five additional shots, and then fell dead while trying to fire off an empty pistol. After that the lieutenant cut off the pirate's head, and sailed away in triumph, with the bloody trophy nailed to the bow of his battered sloop.

At the very first shot from their pistols, Blackbeard was hit in the body, but he wasn’t about to give up—not him. As mentioned before, he was the real deal when it came to wild and fierce pirates, and he fought on until he had received twenty more cuts from cutlasses and five more shots, then he fell dead while trying to fire an empty pistol. After that, the lieutenant chopped off the pirate's head and sailed away in triumph, with the bloody trophy nailed to the front of his beaten-up sloop.

Those of Blackbeard's men who were not killed were carried off to Virginia, and all of them tried and hanged but one or two, their names, no doubt, still standing in a row in the provincial records.

Those of Blackbeard's crew who weren't killed were taken to Virginia, and almost all of them were tried and hanged except for one or two, their names likely still listed in the provincial records.

But did Blackbeard really bury treasures, as tradition says, along the sandy shores he haunted?

But did Blackbeard actually bury treasure, as the legend goes, along the sandy shores he frequented?

Master Clement Downing, midshipman aboard the Salisbury, wrote a book after his return from the cruise to Madagascar, [33]whither the Salisbury had been ordered, to put an end to the piracy with which those waters were infested. He says:

Master Clement Downing, midshipman on the Salisbury, wrote a book after he got back from the trip to Madagascar, [33]where the Salisbury was sent to stop the piracy that was troubling those waters. He says:

"At Guzarat I met with a Portuguese named Anthony de Sylvestre; he came with two other Portuguese and two Dutchmen to take on in the Moor's service, as many Europeans do. This Anthony told me he had been among the pirates, and that he belonged to one of the sloops in Virginia when Blackbeard was taken. He informed me that if it should be my lot ever to go to York River or Maryland, near an island called Mulberry Island, provided we went on shore at the watering place, where the shipping used most commonly to ride, that there the pirates had buried considerable sums of money in great chests well clamped with iron plates. As to my part, I never was that way, nor much acquainted with any that ever used those parts; but I have made inquiry, and am informed that there is such a place as Mulberry Island. If any person who uses those parts should think it worth while to dig a little way at the upper end of a small cove, where it is convenient to land, he would soon find whether the information I had was well grounded. Fronting the landing place are five trees, among which, he said, the money was hid. I cannot warrant the truth of this account; but if I was ever to go there, I should find some means or other to satisfy myself, as it could not be a great deal out of my way. If anybody should obtain the benefit of this account, if it please God that they ever come to England, 'tis hoped they will remember whence they had this information."

"At Guzarat, I met a Portuguese man named Anthony de Sylvestre; he came with two other Portuguese and two Dutchmen to work for the Moors, just like many Europeans do. Anthony told me he had been among the pirates and that he was on one of the sloops in Virginia when Blackbeard was captured. He mentioned that if I ever happened to go to York River or Maryland, near an island called Mulberry Island, and if we landed at the watering place where ships usually anchored, that’s where the pirates buried significant amounts of money in large chests secured with iron plates. Personally, I’ve never traveled that way nor do I know anyone who has, but I’ve done some research and confirmed that there is indeed a place called Mulberry Island. If anyone familiar with that area thinks it’s worth digging a little at the upper end of a small cove where it’s easy to land, they would quickly find out if the information I received was accurate. In front of the landing spot are five trees where he said the money was hidden. I can't guarantee the truth of this story, but if I ever went there, I would find some way to check it out since it wouldn't be too much out of my way. If anyone benefits from this information, I hope they will remember where they got it if they ever come to England."

Another worthy was Capt. Edward Low, who learned his trade of sail-making at good old Boston town, and piracy at Honduras. No one stood higher in the trade than he, and no one mounted to more lofty altitudes of bloodthirsty and unscrupulous wickedness. 'Tis strange that so little has been written and sung of this man of might, for he was as worthy of story and of song as was Blackbeard.

Another notable figure was Capt. Edward Low, who learned the craft of sail-making in good old Boston and picked up piracy in Honduras. No one was more respected in the trade than he was, and no one reached greater heights of ruthlessness and unscrupulous villainy. It's odd that so little has been written or sung about this powerful man, as he was just as deserving of story and song as Blackbeard.

It was under a Yankee captain that he made his first cruise—down[34] to Honduras, for a cargo of logwood, which in those times was no better than stolen from the Spanish folk.

It was under a Yankee captain that he took his first cruise—down[34] to Honduras, to pick up a load of logwood, which back then was hardly more than stolen from the Spanish.

One day, lying off the shore, in the Gulf of Honduras, comes Master Low and the crew of the whaleboat rowing across from the beach, where they had been all morning chopping logwood.

One day, while lying off the shore in the Gulf of Honduras, Master Low and the crew of the whaleboat were rowing over from the beach, where they had spent all morning chopping logwood.

"What are you after?" says the captain, for they were coming back with nothing but themselves in the boat.

"What are you looking for?" says the captain, as they returned with nothing but themselves in the boat.

"We're after our dinner," says Low, as spokesman of the party.

"We're looking for our dinner," says Low, speaking for the group.

"You'll have no dinner," says the captain, "until you fetch off another load."

"You won't have any dinner," says the captain, "until you bring back another load."

"Dinner or no dinner, we'll pay for it," says Low, wherewith he up with a musket, squinted along the barrel, and pulled the trigger.

"Dinner or no dinner, we're going to pay for it," says Low, as he raises a musket, aims along the barrel, and pulls the trigger.

Luckily the gun hung fire, and the Yankee captain was spared to steal logwood a while longer.

Luckily, the gun misfired, and the Yankee captain was given a bit more time to steal logwood.

All the same, that was no place for Ned Low to make a longer stay, so off he and his messmates rowed in a whaleboat, captured a brig out at sea, and turned pirates.

All the same, that was not a place for Ned Low to stick around for long, so he and his crew rowed off in a whaleboat, captured a brig out at sea, and became pirates.

He presently fell in with the notorious Captain Lowther, a fellow after his own kidney, who put the finishing touches to his education and taught him what wickedness he did not already know.

He soon teamed up with the infamous Captain Lowther, a guy just like him, who added the final touches to his education and showed him the wickedness he hadn’t learned yet.

And so he became a master pirate, and a famous hand at his craft, and thereafter forever bore an inveterate hatred of all Yankees because of the dinner he had lost, and never failed to smite whatever one of them luck put within his reach. Once he fell in with a ship off South Carolina—the Amsterdam Merchant, Captain Williamson, commander—a Yankee craft and a Yankee master. He slit the nose and cropped the ears of the captain, and then sailed merrily away, feeling the better for having marred a Yankee.

And so he became a master pirate and well-known for his skills, and from then on, he held a deep hatred for all Yankees because of the dinner he had lost, never missing a chance to attack any of them that fate put in his way. One time, he encountered a ship off South Carolina—the Amsterdam Merchant, commanded by Captain Williamson—another Yankee ship with a Yankee captain. He cut the captain’s nose and cropped his ears, and then happily sailed away, feeling better for having harmed a Yankee.

New York and New England had more than one visit from the doughty captain, each of which visits they had good cause to remember, for he made them smart for it.[35]

New York and New England welcomed the brave captain more than once, and each visit was memorable because he made them pay for it.[35]

Along in the year 1722 thirteen vessels were riding at anchor in front of the good town of Marblehead. Into the harbor sailed a strange craft. "Who is she?" say the townsfolk, for the coming of a new vessel was no small matter in those days.

In the year 1722, thirteen ships were anchored in front of the town of Marblehead. A strange boat sailed into the harbor. "Who is she?" asked the townspeople, as the arrival of a new vessel was a big deal back then.

Who the strangers were was not long a matter of doubt. Up goes the black flag, and the skull and crossbones to the fore.

Who the strangers were soon became clear. Up went the black flag, and the skull and crossbones stood out in front.

"'Tis the bloody Low," say one and all; and straightway all was flutter and commotion, as in a duck pond when a hawk pitches and strikes in the midst.

"'Tis the bloody Low," say everyone; and immediately there was a flurry and chaos, like in a duck pond when a hawk swoops down and strikes in the middle.

It was a glorious thing for our captain, for here were thirteen Yankee crafts at one and the same time. So he took what he wanted, and then sailed away, and it was many a day before Marblehead forgot that visit.

It was a fantastic moment for our captain because there were thirteen Yankee ships all at once. So he took what he wanted and then sailed away, and it was a long time before Marblehead forgot that visit.

Some time after this he and his consort fell foul of an English sloop of war, the Greyhound, whereby they were so roughly handled that Low was glad enough to slip away, leaving his consort and her crew behind him, as a sop to the powers of law and order. And lucky for them if no worse fate awaited them than to walk the dreadful plank with a bandage around the blinded eyes and a rope around the elbows. So the consort was taken, and the crew tried and hanged in chains, and Low sailed off in as pretty a bit of rage as ever a pirate fell into.

Some time later, he and his partner ran into trouble with an English warship, the Greyhound, and they got dealt with so harshly that Low was just happy to escape, leaving his partner and her crew behind as a way to appease the authorities. They were lucky if the worst that happened to them was walking the deadly plank with their eyes blindfolded and their elbows tied. So the partner was captured, and the crew was tried and hanged in chains, while Low sailed away in one of the angriest moods a pirate could have.

The end of this worthy is lost in the fogs of the past: some say that he died of a yellow fever down in New Orleans; it was not at the end of a hempen cord, more's the pity.

The fate of this worthy individual is shrouded in the mists of history: some say he died from yellow fever in New Orleans; unfortunately, it wasn’t at the end of a noose.

Here fittingly with our strictly American pirates should stand Major Stede Bonnet along with the rest. But in truth he was only a poor half-and-half fellow of his kind, and even after his hand was fairly turned to the business he had undertaken, a qualm of conscience would now and then come across him, and he would make vast promises to forswear his evil courses.

Here, right alongside our purely American pirates, should stand Major Stede Bonnet with the others. But in reality, he was just a somewhat indecisive guy of his kind, and even after he got into the business he had taken on, a pang of conscience would occasionally hit him, and he would make big promises to turn away from his wrongdoings.

However, he jogged along in his course of piracy snugly enough until he fell foul of the gallant Colonel Rhett, off Charleston Harbor,[36] whereupon his luck and his courage both were suddenly snuffed out with a puff of powder smoke and a good rattling broadside. Down came the "Black Roger" with its skull and crossbones from the fore, and Colonel Rhett had the glory of fetching back as pretty a cargo of scoundrels and cutthroats as the town ever saw.

However, he sailed along smoothly in his pirate life until he ran into the brave Colonel Rhett, off Charleston Harbor,[36] which caused his luck and bravery to be abruptly extinguished with a blast of gunpowder and a loud broadside. Down came the "Black Roger" with its skull and crossbones flying from the mast, and Colonel Rhett earned the honor of returning with as fine a group of criminals and ruthless men as the town had ever seen.

Walking the Plank Walking the Plank

Illustration from
BUCCANEERS AND MAROONERS OF THE SPANISH MAIN

by Howard Pyle

Originally published in
Harper's Magazine, August and September, 1887

After the next assizes they were strung up, all in a row—evil apples ready for the roasting.

After the next court session, they were hanged, all in a row—bad apples ready for roasting.

"Ned" England was a fellow of different blood—only he snapped his whip across the back of society over in the East Indies and along the hot shores of Hindustan.

"Ned" England was a man of a different kind—he just cracked his whip across the back of society over in the East Indies and along the warm shores of Hindustan.

The name of Capt. Howel Davis stands high among his fellows. He was the Ulysses of pirates, the beloved not only of Mercury, but of Minerva.

The name of Capt. Howel Davis is highly regarded among his peers. He was the Ulysses of pirates, favored not only by Mercury, but also by Minerva.

He it was who hoodwinked the captain of a French ship of double the size and strength of his own, and fairly cheated him into the surrender of his craft without the firing of a single pistol or the striking of a single blow; he it was who sailed boldly into the port of Gambia, on the coast of Guinea, and under the guns of the castle, proclaiming himself as a merchant trading for slaves.

He was the one who tricked the captain of a French ship that was twice the size and strength of his own, completely deceiving him into surrendering without firing a single shot or throwing a single punch; he was the one who confidently sailed into the port of Gambia, on the coast of Guinea, right under the guns of the castle, declaring himself a merchant trading for slaves.

The cheat was kept up until the fruit of mischief was ripe for the picking; then, when the governor and the guards of the castle were lulled into entire security, and when Davis's band was scattered about wherever each man could do the most good, it was out pistol, up cutlass, and death if a finger moved. They tied the soldiers back to back, and the governor to his own armchair, and then rifled wherever it pleased them. After that they sailed away, and though they had not made the fortune they had hoped to glean, it was a good snug round sum that they shared among them.

The scam was maintained until the opportunity for chaos was just right; then, when the governor and the castle guards were completely at ease, and when Davis's crew was spread out where each could be most effective, it was time to draw their guns, wield their cutlasses, and threaten death at the slightest movement. They tied the soldiers back to back and the governor to his own armchair, then looted wherever they wanted. After that, they sailed away, and although they hadn’t struck the jackpot they had hoped for, it was still a decent amount of money that they split among themselves.

Their courage growing high with success, they determined to attempt the island of Del Principe—a prosperous Portuguese settlement on the coast. The plan for taking the place was cleverly laid, and would have succeeded, only that a Portuguese negro among the pirate crew turned traitor and carried the news ashore [37]to the governor of the fort. Accordingly, the next day, when Captain Davis came ashore, he found there a good strong guard drawn up as though to honor his coming. But after he and those with him were fairly out of their boat, and well away from the water side, there was a sudden rattle of musketry, a cloud of smoke, and a dull groan or two. Only one man ran out from under that pungent cloud, jumped into the boat, and rowed away; and when it lifted, there lay Captain Davis and his companions all of a heap, like a pile of old clothes.

Their confidence rising with each victory, they decided to try to take the island of Del Principe—a thriving Portuguese settlement on the coast. The plan to capture the place was cleverly devised and would have worked, if not for a Portuguese slave among the pirates who betrayed them and reported their scheme to the governor of the fort [37]. So, the next day, when Captain Davis came ashore, he was greeted by a strong guard, as if to celebrate his arrival. But just as he and his crew stepped out of their boat and moved away from the water, a sudden volley of gunfire erupted, followed by a cloud of smoke and some muffled groans. Only one person managed to escape from that thick cloud; he jumped into the boat and rowed away, while Captain Davis and his men lay scattered on the ground like a pile of old clothes.

Capt. Bartholomew Roberts was the particular and especial pupil of Davis, and when that worthy met his death so suddenly and so unexpectedly in the unfortunate manner above narrated, he was chosen unanimously as the captain of the fleet, and he was a worthy pupil of a worthy master. Many were the poor fluttering merchant ducks that this sea hawk swooped upon and struck; and cleanly and cleverly were they plucked before his savage clutch loosened its hold upon them.

Capt. Bartholomew Roberts was a standout student of Davis, and when that notable man died so suddenly and unexpectedly in the unfortunate way mentioned earlier, Roberts was unanimously chosen as the captain of the fleet, proving to be a worthy student of a great mentor. Many hapless merchant ships fell prey to this sea hawk, and he skillfully and efficiently took control before his fierce grip let go of them.

"He made a gallant figure," says the old narrator, "being dressed in a rich crimson waistcoat and breeches and red feather in his hat, a gold chain around his neck, with a diamond cross hanging to it, a sword in his hand, and two pair of pistols hanging at the end of a silk sling flung over his shoulders according to the fashion of the pyrates." Thus he appeared in the last engagement which he fought—that with the Swallow—a royal sloop of war. A gallant fight they made of it, those bulldog pirates, for, finding themselves caught in a trap betwixt the man-of-war and the shore, they determined to bear down upon the king's vessel, fire a slapping broadside into her, and then try to get away, trusting to luck in the doing, and hoping that their enemy might be crippled by their fire.

"He looked impressive," the old narrator says, "dressed in a rich crimson waistcoat and breeches, a red feather in his hat, a gold chain around his neck with a diamond cross hanging from it, a sword in his hand, and two pairs of pistols hanging at the end of a silk sling draped over his shoulders, just like the pirates." This is how he appeared in the last battle he fought—against the Swallow—a royal warship. Those tough pirates put up a brave fight because they found themselves trapped between the man-of-war and the shore. They decided to charge at the king's ship, fire a powerful broadside into her, and then try to escape, relying on luck and hoping their enemy would be damaged by their attack.

Captain Roberts himself was the first to fall at the return fire of the Swallow; a grapeshot struck him in the neck, and he fell forward across the gun near to which he was standing at the time. A certain fellow named Stevenson, who was at the helm, saw him[38] fall, and thought he was wounded. At the lifting of the arm the body rolled over upon the deck, and the man saw that the captain was dead. "Whereupon," says the old history, "he" [Stevenson] "gushed into tears, and wished that the next shot might be his portion." After their captain's death the pirate crew had no stomach for more fighting; the "Black Roger" was struck, and one and all surrendered to justice and the gallows.

Captain Roberts was the first to go down when the Swallow returned fire; a grapeshot hit him in the neck, and he collapsed forward onto the gun he had been standing near. A guy named Stevenson, who was at the helm, saw him fall and thought he was injured. When he lifted Roberts's arm, the body rolled over onto the deck, and Stevenson realized the captain was dead. "Then," according to the old history, "he" [Stevenson] "broke down in tears and wished that the next shot would hit him instead." After their captain's death, the pirate crew lost their will to fight; the "Black Roger" was lowered, and they all surrendered to justice and the gallows.


Such is a brief and bald account of the most famous of these pirates. But they are only a few of a long list of notables, such as Captain Martel, Capt. Charles Vane (who led the gallant Colonel Rhett, of South Carolina, such a wild-goose chase in and out among the sluggish creeks and inlets along the coast), Capt. John Rackam, and Captain Anstis, Captain Worley, and Evans, and Philips, and others—a score or more of wild fellows whose very names made ship captains tremble in their shoes in those good old times.

Here’s a quick overview of the most famous pirates. However, they’re just a few names among a long list of notable figures, like Captain Martel, Captain Charles Vane (who took the brave Colonel Rhett of South Carolina on a wild goose chase through the slow-moving creeks and inlets along the coast), Captain John Rackam, Captain Anstis, Captain Worley, Evans, Philips, and many others—a whole bunch of wild characters whose names alone made ship captains shake in their boots back in those days.

And such is that black chapter of history of the past—an evil chapter, lurid with cruelty and suffering, stained with blood and smoke. Yet it is a written chapter, and it must be read. He who chooses may read betwixt the lines of history this great truth: Evil itself is an instrument toward the shaping of good. Therefore the history of evil as well as the history of good should be read, considered, and digested.

And that’s a dark chapter in our history—an awful time filled with cruelty and suffering, marked by blood and smoke. But it’s a written chapter, and it has to be read. Anyone can understand this important truth from the lines of history: Evil itself can be a tool for creating good. So, both the history of evil and the history of good should be read, reflected on, and understood.


Chapter II

THE GHOST OF CAPTAIN BRAND

I

t is not so easy to tell why discredit should be cast upon a man because of something that his grandfather may have done amiss, but the world, which is never overnice in its discrimination as to where to lay the blame, is often pleased to make the innocent suffer in the place of the guilty.

It's not simple to understand why a man should be judged for something his grandfather might have done wrong, but the world, which doesn't always discriminate carefully about where to place the blame, often chooses to make the innocent pay for the guilty.

Barnaby True was a good, honest, biddable lad, as boys go, but yet he was not ever allowed altogether to forget that his grandfather had been that very famous pirate, Capt. William Brand, who, after so many marvelous adventures (if one may believe the catchpenny stories and ballads that were written about him), was murdered in Jamaica by Capt. John Malyoe, the commander of his own consort, the Adventure galley.

Barnaby True was a good, honest, obedient kid, like most boys, but he was never really allowed to forget that his grandfather was the infamous pirate, Capt. William Brand, who, after so many incredible adventures (if you believe the sensational stories and ballads written about him), was killed in Jamaica by Capt. John Malyoe, the captain of his own ship, the Adventure galley.

It has never been denied, that ever I heard, that up to the time of Captain Brand's being commissioned against the South Sea pirates he had always been esteemed as honest, reputable a sea captain as could be.

It has never been denied, as far as I know, that until Captain Brand was given the mission against the South Sea pirates, he had always been regarded as an honest and reputable sea captain.

When he started out upon that adventure it was with a ship,[40] the Royal Sovereign, fitted out by some of the most decent merchants of New York. The governor himself had subscribed to the adventure, and had himself signed Captain Brand's commission. So, if the unfortunate man went astray, he must have had great temptation to do so, many others behaving no better when the opportunity offered in those far-away seas where so many rich purchases might very easily be taken and no one the wiser.

When he set out on that adventure, he was aboard a ship, [40], the Royal Sovereign, provided by some of the most respectable merchants in New York. The governor had even invested in the venture and signed Captain Brand's commission himself. So, if the unfortunate man strayed off course, he must have faced a strong temptation to do so, as many others acted just as poorly when given the chance in those distant waters where numerous valuable goods could be easily seized without anyone knowing.

"Captain Malyoe Shot Captain Brand Through the Head" "Captain Malyoe Shot Captain Brand in the Head"

Illustration from
THE GHOST OF CAPTAIN BRAND

by Howard Pyle

Originally published in
Harper's Weekly, December 19, 1896

To be sure, those stories and ballads made our captain to be a most wicked, profane wretch; and if he were, why, God knows he suffered and paid for it, for he laid his bones in Jamaica, and never saw his home or his wife and daughter again after he had sailed away on the Royal Sovereign on that long misfortunate voyage, leaving them in New York to the care of strangers.

To be sure, those stories and ballads painted our captain as a truly wicked and profane person; and if that was the case, well, God knows he suffered and paid for it, because he died in Jamaica and never saw his home or his wife and daughter again after he set sail on the Royal Sovereign on that long, unfortunate voyage, leaving them in New York in the care of strangers.

At the time when he met his fate in Port Royal Harbor he had obtained two vessels under his command—the Royal Sovereign, which was the boat fitted out for him in New York, and the Adventure galley, which he was said to have taken somewhere in the South Seas. With these he lay in those waters of Jamaica for over a month after his return from the coasts of Africa, waiting for news from home, which, when it came, was of the very blackest; for the colonial authorities were at that time stirred up very hot against him to take him and hang him for a pirate, so as to clear their own skirts for having to do with such a fellow. So maybe it seemed better to our captain to hide his ill-gotten treasure there in those far-away parts, and afterward to try and bargain with it for his life when he should reach New York, rather than to sail straight for the Americas with what he had earned by his piracies, and so risk losing life and money both.

At the time he met his fate in Port Royal Harbor, he was in command of two ships—the Royal Sovereign, which had been outfitted for him in New York, and the Adventure galley, which he was said to have captured somewhere in the South Seas. He had been anchored in those Jamaican waters for over a month after returning from Africa, waiting for news from home. When it finally arrived, it was extremely grim; the colonial authorities were very worked up against him, wanting to capture and hang him as a pirate to wash their hands of any association with him. So it probably seemed smarter to our captain to stash his ill-gotten treasure in those far-off places and later try to use it to buy his life when he got to New York, instead of sailing directly to the Americas with the spoils of his piracy and risking losing both his life and his fortune.

However that might be, the story was that Captain Brand and his gunner, and Captain Malyoe of the Adventure and the sailing master of the Adventure all went ashore together with a chest of money (no one of them choosing to trust the other three in so nice an affair), and buried the treasure somewhere on the beach of [41]Port Royal Harbor. The story then has it that they fell a-quarreling about a future division of the money, and that, as a wind-up to the affair, Captain Malyoe shot Captain Brand through the head, while the sailing master of the Adventure served the gunner of the Royal Sovereign after the same fashion through the body, and that the murderers then went away, leaving the two stretched out in their own blood on the sand in the staring sun, with no one to know where the money was hid but they two who had served their comrades so.

However that may be, the story goes that Captain Brand, his gunner, Captain Malyoe of the Adventure, and the sailing master of the Adventure all went ashore together with a chest of money (none of them trusting the other three in such a delicate matter) and buried the treasure somewhere on the beach of [41] Port Royal Harbor. Then the tale continues that they started quarreling about how to divide the money, and to wrap things up, Captain Malyoe shot Captain Brand in the head, while the sailing master of the Adventure similarly shot the gunner of the Royal Sovereign in the body, and then the murderers left, leaving the two lying in their own blood on the sand under the glaring sun, with no one knowing where the money was hidden except for the two who had betrayed their comrades.

It is a mighty great pity that anyone should have a grandfather who ended his days in such a sort as this, but it was no fault of Barnaby True's, nor could he have done anything to prevent it, seeing that he was not even born into the world at the time that his grandfather turned pirate, and was only one year old when he so met his tragical end. Nevertheless, the boys with whom he went to school never tired of calling him "Pirate," and would sometimes sing for his benefit that famous catchpenny song beginning thus:

It's really unfortunate that anyone should have a grandfather who ended his life in such a way, but it wasn't Barnaby True's fault, nor could he have done anything to stop it, since he wasn't even born when his grandfather became a pirate, and was only one year old when he met his tragic end. Still, the boys at his school never stopped calling him "Pirate," and would sometimes sing that famous catchy song that starts like this:

Oh, my name is Captain Brand,
Sailing, And sailing; Oh, my name was Captain Brand,
Sailing freely.
Oh, my name was Captain Brand,
And I sinned on land and at sea,
For I broke God's fair command,
Sailing free.

'Twas a vile thing to sing at the grandson of so misfortunate a man, and oftentimes little Barnaby True would double up his fists and would fight his tormentors at great odds, and would sometimes go back home with a bloody nose to have his poor mother cry over him and grieve for him.

It was a terrible thing to mock the grandson of such an unfortunate man, and frequently little Barnaby True would clench his fists and fight his bullies even when the odds were against him, sometimes returning home with a bloody nose, leaving his poor mother to weep and worry for him.

Not that his days were all of teasing and torment, neither; for if his comrades did treat him so, why, then, there were other[42] times when he and they were as great friends as could be, and would go in swimming together where there was a bit of sandy strand along the East River above Fort George, and that in the most amicable fashion. Or, maybe the very next day after he had fought so with his fellows, he would go a-rambling with them up the Bowerie Road, perhaps to help them steal cherries from some old Dutch farmer, forgetting in such adventure what a thief his own grandfather had been.

Not that his days were all about teasing and torment, either; because when his friends treated him like that, there were other times when he and they were the best of friends and would go swimming together at a sandy spot along the East River above Fort George, and it was all in good spirits. Or, maybe the very next day after he had fought with his buddies, he would go wandering with them up Bowerie Road, possibly to help them steal cherries from some old Dutch farmer, forgetting in that adventure what a thief his own grandfather had been.

Well, when Barnaby True was between sixteen and seventeen years old he was taken into employment in the countinghouse of Mr. Roger Hartright, the well-known West India merchant, and Barnaby's own stepfather.

Well, when Barnaby True was between sixteen and seventeen years old, he started working in the office of Mr. Roger Hartright, the famous West India merchant, who was also Barnaby's stepfather.

It was the kindness of this good man that not only found a place for Barnaby in the countinghouse, but advanced him so fast that against our hero was twenty-one years old he had made four voyages as supercargo to the West Indies in Mr. Hartright's ship, the Belle Helen, and soon after he was twenty-one undertook a fifth. Nor was it in any such subordinate position as mere supercargo that he acted, but rather as the confidential agent of Mr. Hartright, who, having no children of his own, was very jealous to advance our hero into a position of trust and responsibility in the countinghouse, as though he were indeed a son, so that even the captain of the ship had scarcely more consideration aboard than he, young as he was in years.

It was the kindness of this good man that not only gave Barnaby a job in the countinghouse but also helped him move up so quickly that by the time our hero turned twenty-one, he had completed four voyages as a supercargo to the West Indies on Mr. Hartright's ship, the Belle Helen, and soon after his twenty-first birthday, he took on a fifth voyage. He didn't just work in a junior position as a supercargo; instead, he acted as Mr. Hartright's trusted agent. Mr. Hartright, who had no children of his own, was keen to elevate our hero to a role of trust and responsibility in the countinghouse, treating him almost like a son. As a result, even the captain of the ship regarded him with barely less respect than himself, despite Barnaby's youth.

As for the agents and correspondents of Mr. Hartright throughout these parts, they also, knowing how the good man had adopted his interests, were very polite and obliging to Master Barnaby—especially, be it mentioned, Mr. Ambrose Greenfield, of Kingston, Jamaica, who, upon the occasions of his visits to those parts, did all that he could to make Barnaby's stay in that town agreeable and pleasant to him.

As for Mr. Hartright's agents and correspondents in the area, they were very polite and helpful to Master Barnaby, knowing how much the good man cared about him. In particular, Mr. Ambrose Greenfield from Kingston, Jamaica, made an effort during his visits to ensure that Barnaby's time in the town was enjoyable and comfortable.

So much for the history of our hero to the time of the beginning of this story, without which you shall hardly be able to[43] understand the purport of those most extraordinary adventures that befell him shortly after he came of age, nor the logic of their consequence after they had occurred.

That's enough about our hero's background leading up to the start of this story, which you’ll definitely need to[43] understand the meaning of the incredible adventures that happened to him soon after he turned twenty-one, as well as the reasoning behind what happened afterwards.

For it was during his fifth voyage to the West Indies that the first of those extraordinary adventures happened of which I shall have presently to tell.

For it was during his fifth trip to the West Indies that the first of those incredible adventures took place, which I will soon recount.

At that time he had been in Kingston for the best part of four weeks, lodging at the house of a very decent, respectable widow, by name Mrs. Anne Bolles, who, with three pleasant and agreeable daughters, kept a very clean and well-served lodging house in the outskirts of the town.

At that time, he had been in Kingston for almost four weeks, staying at the home of a respectable widow named Mrs. Anne Bolles, who, along with her three pleasant and friendly daughters, ran a clean and well-managed boarding house on the outskirts of town.

One morning, as our hero sat sipping his coffee, clad only in loose cotton drawers, a shirt, and a jacket, and with slippers upon his feet, as is the custom in that country, where everyone endeavors to keep as cool as may be—while he sat thus sipping his coffee Miss Eliza, the youngest of the three daughters, came and gave him a note, which, she said, a stranger had just handed in at the door, going away again without waiting for a reply. You may judge of Barnaby's surprise when he opened the note and read as follows:

One morning, as our hero sat sipping his coffee, wearing just loose cotton shorts, a shirt, and a jacket, with slippers on his feet, as is the custom in that country where everyone tries to stay as cool as possible—while he sat there sipping his coffee, Miss Eliza, the youngest of the three daughters, came and handed him a note. She said a stranger had just dropped it off at the door and left without waiting for a response. You can imagine Barnaby's surprise when he opened the note and read the following:

Mr. Barnaby True.

Mr. Barnaby True.

Sir,—Though you don't know me, I know you, and I tell you this: if you will be at Pratt's Ordinary on Harbor Street on Friday next at eight o'clock of the evening, and will accompany the man who shall say to you, "The Royal Sovereign is come in," you shall learn something the most to your advantage that ever befell you. Sir, keep this note, and show it to him who shall address these words to you, so to certify that you are the man he seeks.

Dude,—Even though you don't know me, I know you, and I want to tell you this: if you can be at Pratt's Ordinary on Harbor Street next Friday at eight o'clock in the evening, and go with the man who tells you, "The Royal Sovereign has arrived," you will discover something very beneficial that has ever happened to you. Sir, hold onto this note, and show it to the person who says these words to you, so he can confirm that you are the one he is looking for.

Such was the wording of the note, which was without address, and without any superscription whatever.

Such was the wording of the note, which had no address and no heading at all.

The first emotion that stirred Barnaby was one of extreme and profound amazement. Then the thought came into his mind that some witty fellow, of whom he knew a good many in that town—and wild, waggish pranks they were—was attempting to play[44] off some smart jest upon him. But all that Miss Eliza could tell him when he questioned her concerning the messenger was that the bearer of the note was a tall, stout man, with a red neckerchief around his neck and copper buckles to his shoes, and that he had the appearance of a sailorman, having a great big queue hanging down his back. But, Lord! what was such a description as that in a busy seaport town, full of scores of men to fit such a likeness? Accordingly, our hero put away the note into his wallet, determining to show it to his good friend Mr. Greenfield that evening, and to ask his advice upon it. So he did show it, and that gentleman's opinion was the same as his—that some wag was minded to play off a hoax upon him, and that the matter of the letter was all nothing but smoke.

The first feeling Barnaby experienced was pure and deep amazement. Then it hit him that some clever prankster, of which there were quite a few in that town—and they were known for their wild and playful antics—was trying to pull a fast one on him. But all Miss Eliza could tell him when he asked about the messenger was that the person who delivered the note was a tall, stocky man wearing a red neckerchief and copper buckles on his shoes, and that he looked like a sailor with a long queue hanging down his back. But honestly! What good was such a description in a busy seaport town filled with dozens of men who could match that look? So, our hero tucked the note into his wallet, planning to show it to his good friend Mr. Greenfield that evening for advice. And he did show it, and Mr. Greenfield’s opinion was the same as Barnaby’s—that some jokester was trying to pull off a trick on him, and that the contents of the letter were just smoke and mirrors.

Nevertheless, though Barnaby was thus confirmed in his opinion as to the nature of the communication he had received, he yet determined in his own mind that he would see the business through to the end, and would be at Pratt's Ordinary, as the note demanded, upon the day and at the time specified therein.

Nevertheless, even though Barnaby was sure about the nature of the message he had received, he decided that he would see the situation through to the end and would be at Pratt's Ordinary, as the note instructed, on the date and time mentioned.

Pratt's Ordinary was at that time a very fine and well-known place of its sort, with good tobacco and the best rum that ever I tasted, and had a garden behind it that, sloping down to the harbor front, was planted pretty thick with palms and ferns grouped into clusters with flowers and plants. Here were a number of little tables, some in little grottoes, like our Vauxhall in New York, and with red and blue and white paper lanterns hung among the foliage, whither gentlemen and ladies used sometimes to go of an evening to sit and drink lime juice and sugar and water (and sometimes a taste of something stronger), and to look out across the water at the shipping in the cool of the night.

Pratt's Ordinary was then a really popular and nice spot, with great tobacco and the best rum I’ve ever had. It had a garden out back that sloped down to the harbor, thick with palms and ferns arranged in clusters, along with various flowers and plants. There were several small tables, some in cozy grotto-like areas, similar to our Vauxhall in New York, adorned with red, blue, and white paper lanterns hanging among the greenery. It was a place where ladies and gentlemen would sometimes go in the evening to relax and enjoy drinks made of lime juice, sugar, and water (and occasionally something a bit stronger), while taking in the view of the ships against the backdrop of the cool night.

Thither, accordingly, our hero went, a little before the time appointed in the note, and passing directly through the Ordinary and the garden beyond, chose a table at the lower end of the garden and close to the water's edge, where he would not be easily seen[45] by anyone coming into the place. Then, ordering some rum and water and a pipe of tobacco, he composed himself to watch for the appearance of those witty fellows whom he suspected would presently come thither to see the end of their prank and to enjoy his confusion.

So, our hero headed there a bit before the time mentioned in the note, and walked straight through the Ordinary and the garden beyond. He picked a table at the far end of the garden, right by the water's edge, where he wouldn’t be easily spotted[45] by anyone coming in. Then, after ordering some rum and water and a pipe of tobacco, he settled in to wait for the witty guys he thought would soon show up to see how their prank played out and to enjoy his embarrassment.

The spot was pleasant enough; for the land breeze, blowing strong and full, set the leaves of the palm tree above his head to rattling and clattering continually against the sky, where, the moon then being about full, they shone every now and then like blades of steel. The waves also were splashing up against the little landing place at the foot of the garden, sounding very cool in the night, and sparkling all over the harbor where the moon caught the edges of the water. A great many vessels were lying at anchor in their ridings, with the dark, prodigious form of a man-of-war looming up above them in the moonlight.

The spot was quite nice; the land breeze was blowing strong and full, making the leaves of the palm tree above him rattle and clatter against the sky. The moon was nearly full, causing the leaves to occasionally shine like blades of steel. The waves splashed against the small landing area at the bottom of the garden, sounding very refreshing in the night and sparkling across the harbor where the moonlight caught the edges of the water. Many vessels were anchored in their places, with the dark, massive shape of a warship rising above them in the moonlight.

There our hero sat for the best part of an hour, smoking his pipe of tobacco and sipping his grog, and seeing not so much as a single thing that might concern the note he had received.

There our hero sat for most of an hour, smoking his pipe and sipping his drink, seeing not a single thing that might relate to the note he had received.

It was not far from half an hour after the time appointed in the note, when a rowboat came suddenly out of the night and pulled up to the landing place at the foot of the garden above mentioned, and three or four men came ashore in the darkness. Without saying a word among themselves they chose a near-by table and, sitting down, ordered rum and water, and began drinking their grog in silence. They might have sat there about five minutes, when, by and by, Barnaby True became aware that they were observing him very curiously; and then almost immediately one, who was plainly the leader of the party, called out to him:

It was just under half an hour after the time mentioned in the note when a rowboat suddenly appeared out of the night and docked at the landing spot at the bottom of the garden mentioned earlier, and three or four men came ashore in the darkness. Without saying a word to each other, they chose a nearby table, sat down, ordered rum and water, and started sipping their drinks in silence. They had been there for about five minutes when Barnaby True noticed they were watching him very curiously; then almost immediately, one who was clearly the leader of the group called out to him:

"How now, messmate! Won't you come and drink a dram of rum with us?"

"Hey there, buddy! Want to come and have a shot of rum with us?"

"Why, no," says Barnaby, answering very civilly; "I have drunk enough already, and more would only heat my blood."

"Why, no," Barnaby replies politely; "I've had enough to drink already, and any more would just make me hot-headed."

"All the same," quoth the stranger, "I think you will come[46] and drink with us; for, unless I am mistook, you are Mr. Barnaby True, and I am come here to tell you that the Royal Sovereign is come in."

"Still," said the stranger, "I believe you’ll come[46] and drink with us; because, unless I’m mistaken, you are Mr. Barnaby True, and I’m here to tell you that the Royal Sovereign has arrived."

Now I may honestly say that Barnaby True was never more struck aback in all his life than he was at hearing these words uttered in so unexpected a manner. He had been looking to hear them under such different circumstances that, now that his ears heard them addressed to him, and that so seriously, by a perfect stranger, who, with others, had thus mysteriously come ashore out of the darkness, he could scarce believe that his ears heard aright. His heart suddenly began beating at a tremendous rate, and had he been an older and wiser man, I do believe he would have declined the adventure, instead of leaping blindly, as he did, into that of which he could see neither the beginning nor the ending. But being barely one-and-twenty years of age, and having an adventurous disposition that would have carried him into almost anything that possessed a smack of uncertainty or danger about it, he contrived to say, in a pretty easy tone (though God knows how it was put on for the occasion):

Now I can honestly say that Barnaby True was never more taken aback in his life than when he heard these words spoken in such an unexpected way. He had been expecting to hear them under completely different circumstances, so now that they were addressed to him so seriously by a complete stranger who, along with others, had mysteriously come ashore from the darkness, he could hardly believe his ears. His heart suddenly started racing, and if he had been older and wiser, I think he would have turned down the adventure instead of jumping blindly into something he couldn’t see the beginning or the end of. But at just twenty-one years old and having an adventurous spirit that would drive him toward anything that sounded uncertain or dangerous, he managed to speak in a pretty casual tone (though God knows how he pulled it off for the occasion):

"Well, then, if that be so, and if the Royal Sovereign is indeed come in, why, I'll join you, since you are so kind as to ask me." And therewith he went across to the other table, carrying his pipe with him, and sat down and began smoking, with all the appearance of ease he could assume upon the occasion.

"Alright then, if that's the case, and if the Royal Sovereign has really arrived, I'll join you since you’re nice enough to invite me." With that, he walked over to the other table, brought his pipe along, sat down, and started smoking, trying to look as relaxed as possible.

"Well, Mr. Barnaby True," said the man who had before addressed him, so soon as Barnaby had settled himself, speaking in a low tone of voice, so there would be no danger of any others hearing the words—"Well, Mr. Barnaby True—for I shall call you by your name, to show you that though I know you, you don't know me—I am glad to see that you are man enough to enter thus into an affair, though you can't see to the bottom of it. For it shows me that you are a man of mettle, and are deserving of the fortune that is to befall you to-night. Nevertheless, first of all,[47] I am bid to say that you must show me a piece of paper that you have about you before we go a step farther."

"Well, Mr. Barnaby True," said the man who had spoken to him before, as soon as Barnaby got settled, lowering his voice so that no one else could hear—"Well, Mr. Barnaby True—I’ll call you by your name to show you that even though I know you, you don’t know me. I’m glad to see that you’re brave enough to get involved in this situation, even though you can't understand everything about it. It shows me that you have guts and that you deserve the fortune that’s coming to you tonight. However, first of all, [47] I have to say that you need to show me a piece of paper you have on you before we go any further."

"Very well," said Barnaby; "I have it here safe and sound, and see it you shall." And thereupon and without more ado he fetched out his wallet, opened it, and handed his interlocutor the mysterious note he had received the day or two before. Whereupon the other, drawing to him the candle, burning there for the convenience of those who would smoke tobacco, began immediately reading it.

"Alright," said Barnaby; "I've got it here safe and sound, and you'll see it." With that, he quickly pulled out his wallet, opened it, and handed over the mysterious note he had received a day or two earlier. The other person then leaned in closer to the candle, which was lit for those who wanted to smoke, and started reading it right away.

This gave Barnaby True a moment or two to look at him. He was a tall, stout man, with a red handkerchief tied around his neck, and with copper buckles on his shoes, so that Barnaby True could not but wonder whether he was not the very same man who had given the note to Miss Eliza Bolles at the door of his lodging house.

This gave Barnaby True a minute to take a look at him. He was a tall, heavy-set man, wearing a red handkerchief around his neck, and copper buckles on his shoes, so Barnaby True couldn't help but wonder if he was the same man who had handed the note to Miss Eliza Bolles at the entrance of his lodging house.

"'Tis all right and straight as it should be," the other said, after he had so glanced his eyes over the note. "And now that the paper is read" (suiting his action to his words), "I'll just burn it, for safety's sake."

"Everything is fine and just as it should be," the other said after he briefly looked over the note. "And now that I've read the paper" (doing what he said), "I'll just burn it for safety."

And so he did, twisting it up and setting it to the flame of the candle.

And so he did, twisting it up and holding it to the flame of the candle.

"And now," he said, continuing his address, "I'll tell you what I am here for. I was sent to ask you if you're man enough to take your life in your own hands and to go with me in that boat down there? Say 'Yes,' and we'll start away without wasting more time, for the devil is ashore here at Jamaica—though you don't know what that means—and if he gets ahead of us, why, then we may whistle for what we are after. Say 'No,' and I go away again, and I promise you you shall never be troubled again in this sort. So now speak up plain, young gentleman, and tell us what is your mind in this business, and whether you will adventure any farther or not."

"And now," he said, continuing his speech, "I'll tell you why I'm here. I was sent to ask if you're brave enough to take control of your life and join me in that boat down there. Say 'Yes,' and we'll leave right away without wasting any more time, because danger is waiting for us here in Jamaica—though you might not fully understand what that means—and if it gets ahead of us, we may as well forget about our goal. Say 'No,' and I'll walk away, and I promise you won't be bothered by this kind of thing again. So now be clear, young gentleman, and let us know what you want to do in this situation, and whether you're willing to take a chance or not."

If our hero hesitated it was not for long. I cannot say that[48] his courage did not waver for a moment; but if it did, it was, I say, not for long, and when he spoke up it was with a voice as steady as could be.

If our hero hesitated, it wasn’t for long. I can’t say his courage didn’t waver for a moment; but if it did, as I said, it wasn’t for long, and when he spoke, it was with a voice as steady as possible.

"To be sure I'm man enough to go with you," he said; "and if you mean me any harm I can look out for myself; and if I can't, why, here is something can look out for me," and therewith he lifted up the flap of his coat pocket and showed the butt of a pistol he had fetched with him when he had set out from his lodging house that evening.

"To make sure I'm tough enough to join you," he said; "and if you intend to hurt me, I can take care of myself; and if I can't, well, here's something that can protect me," and with that, he lifted the flap of his coat pocket and revealed the handle of a pistol he had brought with him when he left his place that evening.

At this the other burst out a-laughing. "Come," says he, "you are indeed of right mettle, and I like your spirit. All the same, no one in all the world means you less ill than I, and so, if you have to use that barker, 'twill not be upon us who are your friends, but only upon one who is more wicked than the devil himself. So come, and let us get away."

At this, the other one started laughing. "Come on," he said, "you really have the right attitude, and I like your spirit. Still, no one in the world wishes you harm less than I do, so if you have to use that weapon, it won't be against us, your friends, but only against someone more wicked than the devil himself. So come on, let’s get out of here."

Thereupon he and the others, who had not spoken a single word for all this time, rose from the table, and he having paid the scores of all, they all went down together to the boat that still lay at the landing place at the bottom of the garden.

Thereupon he and the others, who had not said a single word the entire time, got up from the table, and after he paid for everyone, they all headed down together to the boat that was still at the dock at the bottom of the garden.

Thus coming to it, our hero could see that it was a large yawl boat manned with half a score of black men for rowers, and there were two lanterns in the stern sheets, and three or four iron shovels.

Thus coming to it, our hero could see that it was a large yawl boat manned by about a dozen black men as rowers, and there were two lanterns in the back seat, along with three or four iron shovels.

The man who had conducted the conversation with Barnaby True for all this time, and who was, as has been said, plainly the captain of the party, stepped immediately down into the boat; our hero followed, and the others followed after him; and instantly they were seated the boat was shoved off and the black men began pulling straight out into the harbor, and so, at some distance away, around under the stern of the man-of-war.

The man who had been talking with Barnaby True all this time, and was clearly the captain of the group, immediately stepped down into the boat. Our hero followed him, and the others followed suit; as soon as they were seated, the boat was pushed off, and the Black crew members started rowing directly out into the harbor, and then, at some distance away, around the back of the warship.

Not a word was spoken after they had thus left the shore, and presently they might all have been ghosts, for the silence of the party. Barnaby True was too full of his own thoughts to talk—and serious enough thoughts they were by this time, with crimps[49] to trepan a man at every turn, and press gangs to carry a man off so that he might never be heard of again. As for the others, they did not seem to choose to say anything now that they had him fairly embarked upon their enterprise.

Not a word was said after they left the shore, and soon they could have all been ghosts because of how silent they were. Barnaby True was too lost in his own thoughts to speak—and they were serious thoughts at this point, with dangers lurking at every corner, ready to trap a man, and press gangs around to take someone away so they might never be seen again. As for the others, they didn’t seem inclined to say anything now that they had him fully committed to their mission.

And so the crew pulled on in perfect silence for the best part of an hour, the leader of the expedition directing the course of the boat straight across the harbor, as though toward the mouth of the Rio Cobra River. Indeed, this was their destination, as Barnaby could after a while see, by the low point of land with a great long row of coconut palms upon it (the appearance of which he knew very well), which by and by began to loom up out of the milky dimness of the moonlight. As they approached the river they found the tide was running strong out of it, so that some distance away from the stream it gurgled and rippled alongside the boat as the crew of black men pulled strongly against it. Thus they came up under what was either a point of land or an islet covered with a thick growth of mangrove trees. But still no one spoke a single word as to their destination, or what was the business they had in hand.

The crew paddled quietly for the better part of an hour, the leader steering the boat straight across the harbor, aiming for the mouth of the Rio Cobra River. Barnaby eventually recognized their destination by a low point of land lined with a long row of coconut palms, which started to emerge from the soft moonlight. As they neared the river, they noticed the tide was flowing strongly out of it, creating a gurgling and rippling sound alongside the boat as the team of men pulled hard against the current. They approached what seemed to be either a point of land or a small island thick with mangrove trees. Yet, no one said a word about where they were headed or what their mission was.

The night, now that they were close to the shore, was loud with the noise of running tide-water, and the air was heavy with the smell of mud and marsh, and over all the whiteness of the moonlight, with a few stars pricking out here and there in the sky; and all so strange and silent and mysterious that Barnaby could not divest himself of the feeling that it was all a dream.

The night, now that they were near the shore, was filled with the sound of rushing tidewater, and the air was thick with the smell of mud and marsh, under the bright moonlight, with a few stars twinkling here and there in the sky; and everything felt so strange, quiet, and mysterious that Barnaby couldn't shake the feeling that it was all a dream.

So, the rowers bending to the oars, the boat came slowly around from under the clump of mangrove bushes and out into the open water again.

So, the rowers leaned into the oars as the boat gradually turned away from the cluster of mangrove bushes and back into the open water.

Instantly it did so the leader of the expedition called out in a sharp voice, and the black men instantly lay on their oars.

Immediately, the leader of the expedition shouted in a sharp voice, and the Black men quickly stopped rowing.

Almost at the same instant Barnaby True became aware that there was another boat coming down the river toward where they lay, now drifting with the strong tide out into the harbor again,[50] and he knew that it was because of the approach of that boat that the other had called upon his men to cease rowing.

Almost at the same time, Barnaby True realized that another boat was coming down the river toward where they were, now drifting with the strong tide back out into the harbor again,[50] and he understood that it was because of the approaching boat that the other had instructed his crew to stop rowing.

The other boat, as well as he could see in the distance, was full of men, some of whom appeared to be armed, for even in the dusk of the darkness the shine of the moonlight glimmered sharply now and then on the barrels of muskets or pistols, and in the silence that followed after their own rowing had ceased Barnaby True could hear the chug! chug! of the oars sounding louder and louder through the watery stillness of the night as the boat drew nearer and nearer. But he knew nothing of what it all meant, nor whether these others were friends or enemies, or what was to happen next.

The other boat, as far as he could see in the distance, was filled with men, some of whom seemed to be armed, because even in the dimness of the night, the moonlight occasionally sparkled off the barrels of muskets or pistols. In the silence that followed their own rowing, Barnaby True could hear the chug! chug! of the oars getting louder and louder through the stillness of the night as the boat approached. But he had no idea what it all meant, whether these others were friends or foes, or what would happen next.

The oarsmen of the approaching boat did not for a moment cease their rowing, not till they had come pretty close to Barnaby and his companions. Then a man who sat in the stern ordered them to cease rowing, and as they lay on their oars he stood up. As they passed by, Barnaby True could see him very plain, the moonlight shining full upon him—a large, stout gentleman with a round red face, and clad in a fine laced coat of red cloth. Amidship of the boat was a box or chest about the bigness of a middle-sized traveling trunk, but covered all over with cakes of sand and dirt. In the act of passing, the gentleman, still standing, pointed at it with an elegant gold-headed cane which he held in his hand. "Are you come after this, Abraham Dawling?" says he, and thereat his countenance broke into as evil, malignant a grin as ever Barnaby True saw in all of his life.

The rowers of the approaching boat didn’t stop rowing for a moment, not until they got pretty close to Barnaby and his friends. Then a man in the stern told them to stop, and as they rested on their oars, he stood up. As they passed by, Barnaby True could see him clearly in the moonlight—a big, hefty guy with a round red face, dressed in a fancy laced red coat. In the middle of the boat was a box or chest about the size of a medium travel trunk, but it was completely covered in sand and dirt. As they went by, the gentleman stood and pointed at it with a fancy gold-headed cane he was holding. "Are you here for this, Abraham Dawling?" he said, and his face broke into an evil, nasty grin unlike anything Barnaby True had ever seen in his life.

The other did not immediately reply so much as a single word, but sat as still as any stone. Then, at last, the other boat having gone by, he suddenly appeared to regain his wits, for he bawled out after it, "Very well, Jack Malyoe! Very well, Jack Malyoe! you've got ahead of us this time again, but next time is the third, and then it shall be our turn, even if William Brand must come back from hell to settle with you."

The other person didn’t respond at all, just sat there as still as a stone. Then, once the other boat had passed, he finally seemed to snap back to reality and shouted after it, “Alright, Jack Malyoe! Alright, Jack Malyoe! You’ve won this time, but next time will be the third, and then it’ll be our turn, even if William Brand has to come back from the dead to deal with you.”

This he shouted out as the other boat passed farther and[51] farther away, but to it my fine gentleman made no reply except to burst out into a great roaring fit of laughter.

This he shouted as the other boat drifted farther and[51] farther away, but my fine gentleman just laughed loudly in response.

There was another man among the armed men in the stern of the passing boat—a villainous, lean man with lantern jaws, and the top of his head as bald as the palm of my hand. As the boat went away into the night with the tide and the headway the oars had given it, he grinned so that the moonlight shone white on his big teeth. Then, flourishing a great big pistol, he said, and Barnaby could hear every word he spoke, "Do but give me the word, Your Honor, and I'll put another bullet through the son of a sea cook."

There was another guy among the armed men in the back of the passing boat—a shady, thin dude with a long jaw, and the top of his head was as bald as my palm. As the boat drifted away into the night with the tide and the momentum from the oars, he grinned so wide that the moonlight glinted off his big teeth. Then, waving a huge pistol, he said, and Barnaby could hear every word he said, "Just give me the word, Your Honor, and I'll put another bullet through that son of a sea cook."

But the gentleman said some words to forbid him, and therewith the boat was gone away into the night, and presently Barnaby could hear that the men at the oars had begun rowing again, leaving them lying there, without a single word being said for a long time.

But the man told him to stop, and just like that, the boat disappeared into the night. Soon, Barnaby could hear the oarsmen starting to row again, leaving them there in silence for a long time.

By and by one of those in Barnaby's boat spoke up. "Where shall you go now?" he said.

By and by, one of the people in Barnaby's boat spoke up. "Where will you go now?" he asked.

At this the leader of the expedition appeared suddenly to come back to himself, and to find his voice again. "Go?" he roared out. "Go to the devil! Go? Go where you choose! Go? Go back again—that's where we'll go!" and therewith he fell a-cursing and swearing until he foamed at the lips, as though he had gone clean crazy, while the black men began rowing back again across the harbor as fast as ever they could lay oars into the water.

At this, the leader of the expedition suddenly seemed to come back to himself and find his voice again. "Go?" he shouted. "Go to hell! Go? Go wherever you want! Go? We're going back—that's where we're going!" With that, he started cursing and swearing until he was practically foaming at the mouth, as if he had completely lost it, while the Black men began rowing back across the harbor as fast as they could.

They put Barnaby True ashore below the old custom house; but so bewildered and shaken was he by all that had happened, and by what he had seen, and by the names that he heard spoken, that he was scarcely conscious of any of the familiar things among which he found himself thus standing. And so he walked up the moonlit street toward his lodging like one drunk or bewildered; for "John Malyoe" was the name of the captain of the Adventure galley—he who had shot Barnaby's own grandfather—and "Abraham Dawling" was the name of the gunner of the Royal Sovereign[52] who had been shot at the same time with the pirate captain, and who, with him, had been left stretched out in the staring sun by the murderers.

They dropped Barnaby True off by the old customs house; but he was so confused and shaken by everything that had happened, what he had seen, and the names he heard that he could barely recognize any of the familiar things around him. So, he walked up the moonlit street towards his lodging like someone who was drunk or dazed; for "John Malyoe" was the name of the captain of the Adventure galley—he who had shot Barnaby's own grandfather—and "Abraham Dawling" was the name of the gunner of the Royal Sovereign[52] who had been shot at the same time as the pirate captain and who, along with him, had been left lying in the glaring sun by the murderers.

The whole business had occupied hardly two hours, but it was as though that time was no part of Barnaby's life, but all a part of some other life, so dark and strange and mysterious that it in no wise belonged to him.

The whole thing had taken barely two hours, but it felt as if that time was not part of Barnaby's life at all; instead, it was a part of some other life—dark, strange, and mysterious—that did not belong to him in any way.

As for that box covered all over with mud, he could only guess at that time what it contained and what the finding of it signified.

As for that box covered in mud, he could only guess at what it held and what finding it meant.

But of this our hero said nothing to anyone, nor did he tell a single living soul what he had seen that night, but nursed it in his own mind, where it lay so big for a while that he could think of little or nothing else for days after.

But our hero didn’t say anything to anyone about it, nor did he share what he had seen that night with a single soul. He kept it to himself, and it loomed so large in his mind for a while that he could think of little else for days afterward.

Mr. Greenfield, Mr. Hartright's correspondent and agent in these parts, lived in a fine brick house just out of the town, on the Mona Road, his family consisting of a wife and two daughters—brisk, lively young ladies with black hair and eyes, and very fine bright teeth that shone whenever they laughed, and with a plenty to say for themselves. Thither Barnaby True was often asked to a family dinner; and, indeed, it was a pleasant home to visit, and to sit upon the veranda and smoke a cigarro with the good old gentleman and look out toward the mountains, while the young ladies laughed and talked, or played upon the guitar and sang. And oftentimes so it was strongly upon Barnaby's mind to speak to the good gentleman and tell him what he had beheld that night out in the harbor; but always he would think better of it and hold his peace, falling to thinking, and smoking away upon his cigarro at a great rate.

Mr. Greenfield, Mr. Hartright's contact and agent in the area, lived in a nice brick house just outside of town on Mona Road. His family included a wife and two daughters—energetic, lively young ladies with black hair and eyes, and very bright teeth that sparkled whenever they laughed, and who always had plenty to say. Barnaby True was often invited to family dinners there; it was truly a delightful place to visit. He would sit on the porch, smoke a cigar with the kind old gentleman, and gaze toward the mountains while the young ladies laughed, chatted, or played guitar and sang. Many times, Barnaby felt compelled to speak to the good gentleman about what he had seen that night out in the harbor, but he would always reconsider and keep quiet, lost in thought, smoking away on his cigar at a rapid pace.

A day or two before the Belle Helen sailed from Kingston Mr. Greenfield stopped Barnaby True as he was going through the office to bid him to come to dinner that night (for there within the tropics they breakfast at eleven o'clock and take dinner in the cool[53] of the evening, because of the heat, and not at midday, as we do in more temperate latitudes). "I would have you meet," says Mr. Greenfield, "your chief passenger for New York, and his granddaughter, for whom the state cabin and the two staterooms are to be fitted as here ordered [showing a letter]—Sir John Malyoe and Miss Marjorie Malyoe. Did you ever hear tell of Capt. Jack Malyoe, Master Barnaby?"

A day or two before the Belle Helen left Kingston, Mr. Greenfield stopped Barnaby True as he was passing through the office to invite him to dinner that night (because in the tropics they have breakfast at eleven o'clock and dinner in the cool[53] of the evening, due to the heat, instead of at midday like we do in cooler regions). "I want you to meet," says Mr. Greenfield, "your main passenger for New York and his granddaughter, for whom the state cabin and the two staterooms are to be prepared as requested [showing a letter]—Sir John Malyoe and Miss Marjorie Malyoe. Have you ever heard of Capt. Jack Malyoe, Master Barnaby?"

Now I do believe that Mr. Greenfield had no notion at all that old Captain Brand was Barnaby True's own grandfather and Capt. John Malyoe his murderer, but when he so thrust at him the name of that man, what with that in itself and the late adventure through which he himself had just passed, and with his brooding upon it until it was so prodigiously big in his mind, it was like hitting him a blow to so fling the questions at him. Nevertheless, he was able to reply, with a pretty straight face, that he had heard of Captain Malyoe and who he was.

Now I really think that Mr. Greenfield had no idea that old Captain Brand was Barnaby True's grandfather and that Capt. John Malyoe was his murderer. But when Mr. Greenfield brought up that name, along with the recent events he had just experienced and his deep thoughts about it, it felt like he was delivering a punch by throwing those questions at him. Still, he managed to respond, keeping a pretty straight face, that he had heard of Captain Malyoe and who he was.

"Well," says Mr. Greenfield, "if Jack Malyoe was a desperate pirate and a wild, reckless blade twenty years ago, why, he is Sir John Malyoe now and the owner of a fine estate in Devonshire. Well, Master Barnaby, when one is a baronet and come into the inheritance of a fine estate (though I do hear it is vastly cumbered with debts), the world will wink its eye to much that he may have done twenty years ago. I do hear say, though, that his own kin still turn the cold shoulder to him."

"Well," says Mr. Greenfield, "if Jack Malyoe was a desperate pirate and a wild, reckless guy twenty years ago, he's Sir John Malyoe now and owns a great estate in Devonshire. Well, Master Barnaby, when someone becomes a baronet and inherits a fine estate (though I hear it has a lot of debts), the world will overlook a lot of what he might have done twenty years ago. I've heard, though, that his own family still shuns him."

To this address Barnaby answered nothing, but sat smoking away at his cigarro at a great rate.

To this address, Barnaby didn’t respond at all but continued to smoke his cigar vigorously.

And so that night Barnaby True came face to face for the first time with the man who murdered his own grandfather—the greatest beast of a man that ever he met in all of his life.

And so that night, Barnaby True confronted for the first time the man who killed his own grandfather—the most brutal man he had ever encountered in his entire life.

That time in the harbor he had seen Sir John Malyoe at a distance and in the darkness; now that he beheld him near by it seemed to him that he had never looked at a more evil face in all his life. Not that the man was altogether ugly, for he had a[54] good nose and a fine double chin; but his eyes stood out like balls and were red and watery, and he winked them continually, as though they were always smarting; and his lips were thick and purple-red, and his fat, red cheeks were mottled here and there with little clots of purple veins; and when he spoke his voice rattled so in his throat that it made one wish to clear one's own throat to listen to him. So, what with a pair of fat, white hands, and that hoarse voice, and his swollen face, and his thick lips sticking out, it seemed to Barnaby True he had never seen a countenance so distasteful to him as that one into which he then looked.

That time in the harbor, he had seen Sir John Malyoe from a distance and in the dark; now that he was looking at him up close, it seemed like he had never seen a more sinister face in his life. Not that the man was completely unattractive, as he had a good nose and a nice double chin; but his eyes bulged out like marbles and were red and watery, constantly squinting as if they were always stinging; his lips were thick and a deep purple-red, and his chubby, red cheeks had splotches of purple veins here and there. When he spoke, his voice rattled in his throat, making one want to clear their own throat just to hear him. So, with his pair of chubby, pale hands, that gruff voice, his swollen face, and his thick lips protruding, Barnaby True felt he had never seen a face so unpleasant as the one he was currently looking at.

But if Sir John Malyoe was so displeasing to our hero's taste, why, the granddaughter, even this first time he beheld her, seemed to him to be the most beautiful, lovely young lady that ever he saw. She had a thin, fair skin, red lips, and yellow hair—though it was then powdered pretty white for the occasion—and the bluest eyes that Barnaby beheld in all of his life. A sweet, timid creature, who seemed not to dare so much as to speak a word for herself without looking to Sir John for leave to do so, and would shrink and shudder whenever he would speak of a sudden to her or direct a sudden glance upon her. When she did speak, it was in so low a voice that one had to bend his head to hear her, and even if she smiled would catch herself and look up as though to see if she had leave to be cheerful.

But if Sir John Malyoe was so unappealing to our hero, the granddaughter, even the first time he saw her, seemed to him to be the most beautiful, lovely young woman he had ever seen. She had a smooth, fair complexion, red lips, and blonde hair—though it was powdered white for the occasion—and the bluest eyes that Barnaby had ever seen in his life. A sweet, shy girl, who seemed too afraid to speak for herself without looking to Sir John for permission, and would flinch and tremble whenever he suddenly spoke to her or directed a glance her way. When she did speak, it was in such a soft voice that one had to lean in to hear her, and even when she smiled, she would catch herself and look up as if checking to see if she had permission to be happy.

As for Sir John, he sat at dinner like a pig, and gobbled and ate and drank, smacking his lips all the while, but with hardly a word to either her or Mrs. Greenfield or to Barnaby True; but with a sour, sullen air, as though he would say, "Your damned victuals and drink are no better than they should be, but I must eat 'em or nothing." A great bloated beast of a man!

As for Sir John, he sat at dinner like a pig, gobbling down food and drink, smacking his lips the whole time, hardly speaking to her, Mrs. Greenfield, or Barnaby True; instead, he had a sour, grumpy look, as if to say, "This terrible food and drink aren’t worth much, but I guess I have to eat it anyway." A big, bloated man!

Only after dinner was over and the young lady and the two misses sat off in a corner together did Barnaby hear her talk with any ease. Then, to be sure, her tongue became loose, and she prattled away at a great rate, though hardly above her breath,[55] until of a sudden her grandfather called out, in his hoarse, rattling voice, that it was time to go. Whereupon she stopped short in what she was saying and jumped up from her chair, looking as frightened as though she had been caught in something amiss, and was to be punished for it.

Only after dinner was over and the young lady and the two younger women were sitting together in a corner did Barnaby hear her speak comfortably. Then, for sure, she opened up and chattered away at a fast pace, though barely above a whisper,[55] until suddenly her grandfather called out in his hoarse, raspy voice that it was time to leave. At that, she abruptly stopped speaking and jumped up from her chair, looking as scared as if she had been caught doing something wrong and was about to be punished for it.

Barnaby True and Mr. Greenfield both went out to see the two into their coach, where Sir John's man stood holding the lantern. And who should he be, to be sure, but that same lean villain with bald head who had offered to shoot the leader of our hero's expedition out on the harbor that night! For, one of the circles of light from the lantern shining up into his face, Barnaby True knew him the moment he clapped eyes upon him. Though he could not have recognized our hero, he grinned at him in the most impudent, familiar fashion, and never so much as touched his hat either to him or to Mr. Greenfield; but as soon as his master and his young mistress had entered the coach, banged to the door and scrambled up on the seat alongside the driver, and so away without a word, but with another impudent grin, this time favoring both Barnaby and the old gentleman.

Barnaby True and Mr. Greenfield both went out to help the two into their coach, where Sir John's servant was holding the lantern. And who was he, of course, but that same lean villain with the bald head who had offered to shoot the leader of our hero's expedition out on the harbor that night! As one of the circles of light from the lantern shone up into his face, Barnaby True recognized him the moment he saw him. Although he wouldn't have known our hero, he grinned at him in the most cheeky, familiar way and didn’t even bother to tip his hat to either him or Mr. Greenfield. But as soon as his master and the young lady had gotten into the coach, he slammed the door, hopped up onto the seat next to the driver, and off they went without a word, giving one last cheeky grin to both Barnaby and the old gentleman.

Such were these two, master and man, and what Barnaby saw of them then was only confirmed by further observation—the most hateful couple he ever knew; though, God knows, what they afterward suffered should wipe out all complaint against them.

Such were these two, master and servant, and what Barnaby observed about them then was only confirmed by what he saw later—the most despicable pair he ever knew; though, God knows, what they went through afterward should erase any complaints against them.

The next day Sir John Malyoe's belongings began to come aboard the Belle Helen, and in the afternoon that same lean, villainous manservant comes skipping across the gangplank as nimble as a goat, with two black men behind him lugging a great sea chest. "What!" he cried out, "and so you is the supercargo, is you? Why, I thought you was more account when I saw you last night a-sitting talking with His Honor like his equal. Well, no matter; 'tis something to have a brisk, genteel young fellow for a supercargo. So come, my hearty, lend a hand, will you, and help me set His Honor's cabin to rights."[56]

The next day, Sir John Malyoe's belongings started arriving on the Belle Helen, and in the afternoon, that same lean, sneaky manservant came skipping across the gangplank as nimble as a goat, followed by two black men carrying a big sea chest. "What!" he shouted, "so you’re the supercargo, huh? I thought you were more important when I saw you chatting with His Honor like you were equals last night. Well, no worries; it’s nice to have a lively, respectable young guy for a supercargo. So come on, buddy, give me a hand and help me fix up His Honor's cabin." [56]

What a speech was this to endure from such a fellow, to be sure! and Barnaby so high in his own esteem, and holding himself a gentleman! Well, what with his distaste for the villain, and what with such odious familiarity, you can guess into what temper so impudent an address must have cast him. "You'll find the steward in yonder," he said, "and he'll show you the cabin," and therewith turned and walked away with prodigious dignity, leaving the other standing where he was.

What a speech this was to tolerate from someone like him, for sure! And Barnaby thought so highly of himself, considering himself a gentleman! Well, between his dislike for that guy and the obnoxious familiarity, you can imagine how furious such a disrespectful remark made him. "You'll find the steward over there," he said, "and he'll show you to your cabin," and with that, he turned and walked away with amazing dignity, leaving the other guy standing there.

As he entered his own cabin he could not but see, out of the tail of his eye, that the fellow was still standing where he had left him, regarding him with a most evil, malevolent countenance, so that he had the satisfaction of knowing that he had made one enemy during that voyage who was not very likely to forgive or forget what he must regard as a slight put upon him.

As he walked into his cabin, he couldn't help but notice out of the corner of his eye that the guy was still standing where he had left him, looking at him with a wicked, hostile expression. This gave him the satisfaction of knowing that he had made one enemy during the trip who was unlikely to forgive or forget what he probably saw as an insult.

The next day Sir John Malyoe himself came aboard, accompanied by his granddaughter, and followed by this man, and he followed again by four black men, who carried among them two trunks, not large in size, but prodigious heavy in weight, and toward which Sir John and his follower devoted the utmost solicitude and care to see that they were properly carried into the state cabin he was to occupy. Barnaby True was standing in the great cabin as they passed close by him; but though Sir John Malyoe looked hard at him and straight in the face, he never so much as spoke a single word, or showed by a look or a sign that he knew who our hero was. At this the serving man, who saw it all with eyes as quick as a cat's, fell to grinning and chuckling to see Barnaby in his turn so slighted.

The next day, Sir John Malyoe himself came on board, accompanied by his granddaughter and followed by a man, who was then followed by four Black men carrying two trunks. They weren’t very large, but they were incredibly heavy, and Sir John and his companion took great care to ensure they were properly brought into the state cabin he would occupy. Barnaby True was standing in the great cabin as they passed by; even though Sir John Malyoe looked directly at him, he didn’t say a word or show any sign that he recognized Barnaby. Seeing this, the servant, who had sharp eyes, started to grin and chuckle at how Barnaby was being overlooked.

The young lady, who also saw it all, flushed up red, then in the instant of passing looked straight at our hero, and bowed and smiled at him with a most sweet and gracious affability, then the next moment recovering herself, as though mightily frightened at what she had done.[57]

The young woman, who witnessed everything, turned bright red and, in a fleeting moment, looked directly at our hero, bowing and smiling at him with a charming and kind demeanor. Then, in the next instant, she regained her composure as if she were truly startled by her own actions.[57]

The same day the Belle Helen sailed, with as beautiful, sweet weather as ever a body could wish for.

The same day the Belle Helen set sail, the weather was as beautiful and pleasant as anyone could hope for.

There were only two other passengers aboard, the Rev. Simon Styles, the master of a flourishing academy in Spanish Town, and his wife, a good, worthy old couple, but very quiet, and would sit in the great cabin by the hour together reading, so that, what with Sir John Malyoe staying all the time in his own cabin with those two trunks he held so precious, it fell upon Barnaby True in great part to show attention to the young lady; and glad enough he was of the opportunity, as anyone may guess. For when you consider a brisk, lively young man of one-and-twenty and a sweet, beautiful miss of seventeen so thrown together day after day for two weeks, the weather being very fair, as I have said, and the ship tossing and bowling along before a fine humming breeze that sent white caps all over the sea, and with nothing to do but sit and look at that blue sea and the bright sky overhead, it is not hard to suppose what was to befall, and what pleasure it was to Barnaby True to show attention to her.

There were only two other passengers on board: Rev. Simon Styles, the head of a successful academy in Spanish Town, and his wife, a decent and respectable old couple. They were very quiet and would sit together in the large cabin for hours reading. With Sir John Malyoe always in his own cabin with those two trunks he valued so much, it was mostly up to Barnaby True to pay attention to the young lady, and he was more than happy to do so, as anyone could imagine. When you think about a lively, energetic twenty-one-year-old man and a beautiful seventeen-year-old girl spending day after day together for two weeks, especially with such nice weather, as I mentioned, and the ship cruising smoothly along with a pleasant breeze creating whitecaps on the sea, it’s easy to guess what would happen and how much Barnaby True enjoyed giving her his attention.

But, oh! those days when a man is young, and, whether wisely or no, fallen in love! How often during that voyage did our hero lie awake in his berth at night, tossing this way and that without sleep—not that he wanted to sleep if he could, but would rather lie so awake thinking about her and staring into the darkness!

But, oh! those days when a man is young and, whether wisely or not, has fallen in love! How often during that journey did our hero lie awake in his bunk at night, tossing and turning without sleep—not that he wanted to sleep if he could, but he preferred to lie awake thinking about her and staring into the darkness!

Poor fool! He might have known that the end must come to such a fool's paradise before very long. For who was he to look up to Sir John Malyoe's granddaughter, he, the supercargo of a merchant ship, and she the granddaughter of a baronet.

Poor fool! He should have known that the good times in such a fool's paradise can't last forever. After all, who was he to think he could stand beside Sir John Malyoe's granddaughter? He was just the cargo manager of a merchant ship, and she was the granddaughter of a baronet.

Nevertheless, things went along very smooth and pleasant, until one evening, when all came of a sudden to an end. At that time he and the young lady had been standing for a long while together, leaning over the rail and looking out across the water through the dusk toward the westward, where the sky was still[58] of a lingering brightness. She had been mightily quiet and dull all that evening, but now of a sudden she began, without any preface whatever, to tell Barnaby about herself and her affairs. She said that she and her grandfather were going to New York that they might take passage thence to Boston town, there to meet her cousin Captain Malyoe, who was stationed in garrison at that place. Then she went on to say that Captain Malyoe was the next heir to the Devonshire estate, and that she and he were to be married in the fall.

However, everything was going smoothly and pleasantly until one evening when it all suddenly came to an end. At that time, he and the young lady had been standing together for a long while, leaning over the rail and gazing out across the water in the fading light toward the west, where the sky still held onto a bit of brightness. She had been very quiet and unengaged all evening, but then, without any introduction, she started telling Barnaby about herself and her situation. She said that she and her grandfather were going to New York to catch a ship to Boston, where they were set to meet her cousin Captain Malyoe, who was stationed there. She then mentioned that Captain Malyoe was the next heir to the Devonshire estate, and that she and he were going to get married in the fall.

But, poor Barnaby! what a fool was he, to be sure! Methinks when she first began to speak about Captain Malyoe he knew what was coming. But now that she had told him, he could say nothing, but stood there staring across the ocean, his breath coming hot and dry as ashes in his throat. She, poor thing, went on to say, in a very low voice, that she had liked him from the very first moment she had seen him, and had been very happy for these days, and would always think of him as a dear friend who had been very kind to her, who had so little pleasure in life, and so would always remember him.

But poor Barnaby! What a fool he was, for sure! I think when she first started talking about Captain Malyoe, he knew what was coming. But now that she had told him, he couldn't say a word; he just stood there staring out at the ocean, his breath feeling hot and dry like ashes in his throat. She, poor thing, went on to say in a very soft voice that she had liked him from the very first moment she saw him, had been really happy these past few days, and would always remember him as a dear friend who had been so kind to her, since she had so little joy in her life, and so she would always keep him in her thoughts.

Then they were both silent, until at last Barnaby made shift to say, though in a hoarse and croaking voice, that Captain Malyoe must be a very happy man, and that if he were in Captain Malyoe's place he would be the happiest man in the world. Thus, having spoken, and so found his tongue, he went on to tell her, with his head all in a whirl, that he, too, loved her, and that what she had told him struck him to the heart, and made him the most miserable, unhappy wretch in the whole world.

Then they were both quiet until finally Barnaby managed to say, in a raspy and shaky voice, that Captain Malyoe must be a very happy man, and that if he were in Captain Malyoe's position, he would be the happiest man in the world. With that, having found his voice, he continued to tell her, his head spinning, that he loved her too, and that what she had shared with him hit him hard, making him the most miserable and unhappy person in the entire world.

She was not angry at what he said, nor did she turn to look at him, but only said, in a low voice, he should not talk so, for that it could only be a pain to them both to speak of such things, and that whether she would or no, she must do everything as her grandfather bade her, for that he was indeed a terrible man.

She wasn’t mad at what he said, nor did she look at him, but simply said in a low voice that he shouldn’t talk like that because it would only hurt them both to discuss such things. Whether she wanted to or not, she had to do everything her grandfather told her because he was truly a terrible man.

To this poor Barnaby could only repeat that he loved her with[59] all his heart, that he had hoped for nothing in his love, but that he was now the most miserable man in the world.

To this poor Barnaby could only repeat that he loved her with[59] all his heart, that he had hoped for nothing in his love, but that he was now the most miserable man in the world.

It was at this moment, so tragic for him, that some one who had been hiding nigh them all the while suddenly moved away, and Barnaby True could see in the gathering darkness that it was that villain manservant of Sir John Malyoe's and knew that he must have overheard all that had been said.

It was at this moment, so tragic for him, that someone who had been hiding nearby all along suddenly moved away, and Barnaby True could see in the fading light that it was that villainous servant of Sir John Malyoe's and realized that he must have overheard everything that had been said.

The man went straight to the great cabin, and poor Barnaby, his brain all atingle, stood looking after him, feeling that now indeed the last drop of bitterness had been added to his trouble to have such a wretch overhear what he had said.

The man headed straight for the big cabin, and poor Barnaby, his mind racing, stood watching him, realizing that now the final ounce of bitterness had been added to his troubles by having such a wretched person overhear what he had said.

The young lady could not have seen the fellow, for she continued leaning over the rail, and Barnaby True, standing at her side, not moving, but in such a tumult of many passions that he was like one bewildered, and his heart beating as though to smother him.

The young woman couldn't have seen the guy, because she kept leaning over the railing, and Barnaby True, standing next to her, was completely still, caught up in a whirlwind of emotions that left him feeling confused, with his heart racing as if it were trying to suffocate him.

So they stood for I know not how long when, of a sudden, Sir John Malyoe comes running out of the cabin, without his hat, but carrying his gold-headed cane, and so straight across the deck to where Barnaby and the young lady stood, that spying wretch close at his heels, grinning like an imp.

So they stood for I don't know how long when suddenly, Sir John Malyoe came running out of the cabin, without his hat but holding his gold-headed cane, and made his way straight across the deck to where Barnaby and the young lady were standing, that sneaky man right behind him, grinning like a devil.

"You hussy!" bawled out Sir John, so soon as he had come pretty near them, and in so loud a voice that all on deck might have heard the words; and as he spoke he waved his cane back and forth as though he would have struck the young lady, who, shrinking back almost upon the deck, crouched as though to escape such a blow. "You hussy!" he bawled out with vile oaths, too horrible here to be set down. "What do you do here with this Yankee supercargo, not fit for a gentlewoman to wipe her feet upon? Get to your cabin, you hussy" (only it was something worse he called her this time), "before I lay this cane across your shoulders!"

"You hussy!" shouted Sir John as he got close to them, his voice so loud that everyone on deck could have heard. He waved his cane back and forth as if he was going to hit the young lady, who recoiled almost onto the deck, crouching down as if to avoid a blow. "You hussy!" he yelled again, using terrible curses that I can't write down here. "What are you doing here with this Yankee supercargo, not even worthy for a lady to wipe her feet on? Get to your cabin, you hussy" (but this time he called her something worse), "before I hit you with this cane!"

What with the whirling of Barnaby's brains and the passion[60] into which he was already melted, what with his despair and his love, and his anger at this address, a man gone mad could scarcely be less accountable for his actions than was he at that moment. Hardly knowing what he did, he put his hand against Sir John Malyoe's breast and thrust him violently back, crying out upon him in a great, loud, hoarse voice for threatening a young lady, and saying that for a farthing he would wrench the stick out of his hand and throw it overboard.

With Barnaby's mind racing and the emotions he was already feeling, along with his despair, love, and anger over this situation, he was in a state where a person gone mad could hardly be less responsible for their actions than he was at that moment. Barely aware of what he was doing, he pushed his hand against Sir John Malyoe's chest and forcefully shoved him back, shouting loudly and harshly at him for threatening a young lady, and saying that for a penny he would rip the stick out of his hand and throw it overboard.

Sir John went staggering back with the push Barnaby gave him, and then caught himself up again. Then, with a great bellow, ran roaring at our hero, whirling his cane about, and I do believe would have struck him (and God knows then what might have happened) had not his manservant caught him and held him back.

Sir John stumbled back from the shove Barnaby gave him, then steadied himself. With a loud shout, he charged at our hero, swinging his cane wildly, and I honestly think he would have struck him (and who knows what could have happened then) if his servant hadn't grabbed him and held him back.

"Keep back!" cried out our hero, still mighty hoarse. "Keep back! If you strike me with that stick I'll fling you overboard!"

"Stay back!" shouted our hero, still really hoarse. "Stay back! If you hit me with that stick, I'll toss you overboard!"

By this time, what with the sound of loud voices and the stamping of feet, some of the crew and others aboard were hurrying up, and the next moment Captain Manly and the first mate, Mr. Freesden, came running out of the cabin. But Barnaby, who was by this fairly set agoing, could not now stop himself.

By this time, with the loud voices and stomping feet, some of the crew and other people on board were rushing up, and the next moment, Captain Manly and the first mate, Mr. Freesden, came running out of the cabin. But Barnaby, who was already fairly started, couldn’t stop himself now.

"And who are you, anyhow," he cried out, "to threaten to strike me and to insult me, who am as good as you? You dare not strike me! You may shoot a man from behind, as you shot poor Captain Brand on the Rio Cobra River, but you won't dare strike me face to face. I know who you are and what you are!"

"And who do you think you are," he shouted, "to threaten me and insult me, as if I'm not just as good as you? You wouldn’t dare hit me! You might shoot someone from behind, like you did to poor Captain Brand on the Rio Cobra River, but you won’t have the guts to hit me face to face. I know exactly who you are and what you’re about!"

By this time Sir John Malyoe had ceased to endeavor to strike him, but stood stock-still, his great bulging eyes staring as though they would pop out of his head.

By this point, Sir John Malyoe had stopped trying to hit him and stood completely still, his big bulging eyes wide open as if they might pop out of his head.

"What's all this?" cries Captain Manly, bustling up to them with Mr. Freesden. "What does all this mean?"

"What's going on here?" yells Captain Manly, rushing over to them with Mr. Freesden. "What does all this mean?"

But, as I have said, our hero was too far gone now to contain himself until all that he had to say was out.

But, as I mentioned, our hero was too overwhelmed now to hold back until everything he had to say was out.

"The damned villain insulted me and insulted the young lady,"[61] he cried out, panting in the extremity of his passion, "and then he threatened to strike me with his cane. But I know who he is and what he is. I know what he's got in his cabin in those two trunks, and where he found it, and whom it belongs to. He found it on the shores of the Rio Cobra River, and I have only to open my mouth and tell what I know about it."

"The damn villain insulted me and the young lady,"[61] he shouted, breathless with anger, "and then he threatened to hit me with his cane. But I know who he is and what he's up to. I know what's in those two trunks in his cabin, where he got them, and who they belong to. He found them on the banks of the Rio Cobra River, and all I have to do is speak up and reveal what I know."

At this Captain Manly clapped his hand upon our hero's shoulder and fell to shaking him so that he could scarcely stand, calling out to him the while to be silent. "What do you mean?" he cried. "An officer of this ship to quarrel with a passenger of mine! Go straight to your cabin, and stay there till I give you leave to come out again."

At this, Captain Manly placed his hand on our hero's shoulder and started shaking him so hard that he could barely stand, telling him in the meantime to be quiet. "What’s going on?" he shouted. "An officer on this ship arguing with one of my passengers! Go straight to your cabin and stay there until I say you can come out."

At this Master Barnaby came somewhat back to himself and into his wits again with a jump. "But he threatened to strike me with his cane, Captain," he cried out, "and that I won't stand from any man!"

At this, Master Barnaby suddenly regained his composure and came to his senses. "But he threatened to hit me with his cane, Captain," he shouted, "and I won't put up with that from anyone!"

"No matter what he did," said Captain Manly, very sternly. "Go to your cabin, as I bid you, and stay there till I tell you to come out again, and when we get to New York I'll take pains to tell your stepfather of how you have behaved. I'll have no such rioting as this aboard my ship."

"No matter what you do," Captain Manly said sharply. "Go to your cabin, as I instructed, and stay there until I say you can come out again. When we reach New York, I'll make sure to inform your stepfather about your behavior. I won't tolerate this kind of chaos on my ship."

Barnaby True looked around him, but the young lady was gone. Nor, in the blindness of his frenzy, had he seen when she had gone nor whither she went. As for Sir John Malyoe, he stood in the light of a lantern, his face gone as white as ashes, and I do believe if a look could kill, the dreadful malevolent stare he fixed upon Barnaby True would have slain him where he stood.

Barnaby True looked around, but the young woman was gone. In his frenzy, he hadn’t noticed when she left or where she went. As for Sir John Malyoe, he stood in the glow of a lantern, his face as pale as ashes, and I believe that if looks could kill, the terrifying glare he shot at Barnaby True would have taken him down right there.

After Captain Manly had so shaken some wits into poor Barnaby he, unhappy wretch, went to his cabin, as he was bidden to do, and there, shutting the door upon himself, and flinging himself down, all dressed as he was, upon his berth, yielded himself over to the profoundest passion of humiliation and despair.

After Captain Manly had shaken some sense into poor Barnaby, the unfortunate guy went to his cabin as instructed. Once there, he closed the door, threw himself onto his bed fully dressed, and surrendered to the deepest feelings of humiliation and despair.

There he lay for I know not how long, staring into the darkness,[62] until by and by, in spite of his suffering and his despair, he dozed off into a loose sleep, that was more like waking than sleep, being possessed continually by the most vivid and distasteful dreams, from which he would awaken only to doze off and to dream again.

There he lay for I don't know how long, staring into the darkness,[62] until eventually, despite his suffering and despair, he drifted into a light sleep that felt more like being awake than actually sleeping, constantly haunted by the most vivid and unpleasant dreams, from which he would wake only to doze off and dream again.

It was from the midst of one of these extravagant dreams that he was suddenly aroused by the noise of a pistol shot, and then the noise of another and another, and then a great bump and a grinding jar, and then the sound of many footsteps running across the deck and down into the great cabin. Then came a tremendous uproar of voices in the great cabin, the struggling as of men's bodies being tossed about, striking violently against the partitions and bulkheads. At the same instant arose a screaming of women's voices, and one voice, and that Sir John Malyoe's, crying out as in the greatest extremity: "You villains! You damned villains!" and with the sudden detonation of a pistol fired into the close space of the great cabin.

It was in the middle of one of these wild dreams that he was suddenly jolted awake by the sound of a gunshot, followed by another and another. Then there was a loud thud and a grinding noise, and soon after, he heard many footsteps running across the deck and heading down into the main cabin. Then there was a huge commotion of voices in the main cabin, the sound of men’s bodies being tossed around, crashing violently against the walls and bulkheads. At the same moment, there were screams from women, and one voice, Sir John Malyoe's, shouted out in utter desperation: "You bastards! You damned bastards!" followed by the sharp sound of a gunshot fired in the confined space of the main cabin.

Barnaby was out in the middle of his cabin in a moment, and taking only time enough to snatch down one of the pistols that hung at the head of his berth, flung out into the great cabin, to find it as black as night, the lantern slung there having been either blown out or dashed out into darkness. The prodigiously dark space was full of uproar, the hubbub and confusion pierced through and through by that keen sound of women's voices screaming, one in the cabin and the other in the stateroom beyond. Almost immediately Barnaby pitched headlong over two or three struggling men scuffling together upon the deck, falling with a great clatter and the loss of his pistol, which, however, he regained almost immediately.

Barnaby was outside his cabin in no time, quickly grabbing one of the pistols that hung above his bed before rushing into the main cabin, which was pitch black. The lantern hanging there had either been blown out or knocked away into the darkness. The incredibly dark space was filled with chaos, and the loud noise was pierced by women's voices screaming—one from the cabin and the other from the stateroom beyond. Almost immediately, Barnaby tripped over two or three men struggling on the deck, falling with a loud crash and dropping his pistol, which he managed to pick up again almost right away.

What all the uproar meant he could not tell, but he presently heard Captain Manly's voice from somewhere suddenly calling out, "You bloody pirate, would you choke me to death?" wherewith some notion of what had happened came to him like a flash, and that they had been attacked in the night by pirates.[63]

What all the commotion was about, he couldn't figure out, but he soon heard Captain Manly's voice suddenly shouting, "You damn pirate, are you trying to choke me to death?" With that, a flash of understanding hit him—realizing they had been attacked by pirates in the night.[63]

Looking toward the companionway, he saw, outlined against the darkness of the night without, the blacker form of a man's figure, standing still and motionless as a statue in the midst of all this hubbub, and so by some instinct he knew in a moment that that must be the master maker of all this devil's brew. Therewith, still kneeling upon the deck, he covered the bosom of that shadowy figure point-blank, as he thought, with his pistol, and instantly pulled the trigger.

Looking toward the companionway, he noticed the silhouette of a man outlined against the darkness of the night outside, standing still and motionless like a statue amid all the chaos. Instinctively, he realized that this must be the mastermind behind all this trouble. Still kneeling on the deck, he aimed his pistol directly at the shadowy figure and instantly pulled the trigger.

In the flash of red light, and in the instant stunning report of the pistol shot, Barnaby saw, as stamped upon the blackness, a broad, flat face with fishy eyes, a lean, bony forehead with what appeared to be a great blotch of blood upon the side, a cocked hat trimmed with gold lace, a red scarf across the breast, and the gleam of brass buttons. Then the darkness, very thick and black, swallowed everything again.

In the flash of red light and the sudden bang of the gunshot, Barnaby saw, imprinted against the darkness, a wide, flat face with watery eyes, a thin, bony forehead marked with what looked like a large splotch of blood on the side, a cocked hat decorated with gold lace, a red scarf across the chest, and the shine of brass buttons. Then the thick, deep darkness swallowed everything again.

But in the instant Sir John Malyoe called out, in a great loud voice: "My God! 'Tis William Brand!" Therewith came the sound of some one falling heavily down.

But in that moment, Sir John Malyoe shouted loudly, "My God! It's William Brand!" Then, there was the sound of someone falling down heavily.

The next moment, Barnaby's sight coming back to him again in the darkness, he beheld that dark and motionless figure still standing exactly where it had stood before, and so knew either that he had missed it or else that it was of so supernatural a sort that a leaden bullet might do it no harm. Though if it was indeed an apparition that Barnaby beheld in that moment, there is this to say, that he saw it as plain as ever he saw a living man in all of his life.

The next moment, as Barnaby's vision returned in the darkness, he saw that dark and still figure standing exactly where it had been before, which made him realize he had either missed it or that it was so supernatural that a lead bullet wouldn't affect it. Yet, if it was truly a ghost that Barnaby was witnessing at that moment, it’s worth noting that he saw it as clearly as he had ever seen a living person in his life.

This was the last our hero knew, for the next moment somebody—whether by accident or design he never knew—struck him such a terrible violent blow upon the side of the head that he saw forty thousand stars flash before his eyeballs, and then, with a great humming in his head, swooned dead away.

This was the last thing our hero remembered, because the next moment someone—he never figured out if it was by accident or on purpose—hit him with such a violent blow to the side of his head that he saw forty thousand stars flash before his eyes, and then, with a loud ringing in his head, he fainted.

When Barnaby True came back to his senses again it was to find himself being cared for with great skill and nicety, his head[64] bathed with cold water, and a bandage being bound about it as carefully as though a chirurgeon was attending to him.

When Barnaby True came to, he found himself being taken care of with remarkable skill and precision, his head[64] soaked with cold water and a bandage wrapped around it as carefully as if a surgeon was attending to him.

He could not immediately recall what had happened to him, nor until he had opened his eyes to find himself in a strange cabin, extremely well fitted and painted with white and gold, the light of a lantern shining in his eyes, together with the gray of the early daylight through the dead-eye. Two men were bending over him—one, a negro in a striped shirt, with a yellow handkerchief around his head and silver earrings in his ears; the other, a white man, clad in a strange outlandish dress of a foreign make, and with great mustachios hanging down, and with gold earrings in his ears.

He couldn't remember what had happened to him right away. It wasn't until he opened his eyes that he found himself in a strange cabin, very well decorated and painted in white and gold, with a lantern shining in his eyes along with the gray light of early dawn coming through the dead-eye. Two men were leaning over him—one was a Black man in a striped shirt, wearing a yellow scarf around his head and silver earrings; the other was a white man dressed in an unusual outfit of foreign style, with long mustaches and gold earrings.

It was the latter who was attending to Barnaby's hurt with such extreme care and gentleness.

It was the latter who was taking care of Barnaby's injury with such great attention and kindness.

All this Barnaby saw with his first clear consciousness after his swoon. Then remembering what had befallen him, and his head beating as though it would split asunder, he shut his eyes again, contriving with great effort to keep himself from groaning aloud, and wondering as to what sort of pirates these could be who would first knock a man in the head so terrible a blow as that which he had suffered, and then take such care to fetch him back to life again, and to make him easy and comfortable.

All of this was what Barnaby saw when he first became fully aware after his fainting spell. Then, remembering what had happened to him and feeling his head pounding as if it might split open, he closed his eyes again, trying hard not to groan out loud, and wondering what kind of pirates they could be who would first knock someone out with such a brutal blow and then go to the trouble of bringing him back to life and making him feel comfortable.

Nor did he open his eyes again, but lay there gathering his wits together and wondering thus until the bandage was properly tied about his head and sewed together. Then once more he opened his eyes, and looked up to ask where he was.

Nor did he open his eyes again, but lay there gathering his thoughts and wondering until the bandage was properly tied around his head and stitched together. Then he opened his eyes once more and looked up to ask where he was.

Either they who were attending to him did not choose to reply, or else they could not speak English, for they made no answer, excepting by signs; for the white man, seeing that he was now able to speak, and so was come back into his senses again, nodded his head three or four times, and smiled with a grin of his white teeth, and then pointed, as though toward a saloon beyond. At the same time the negro held up our hero's coat and beckoned for him to[65] put it on, so that Barnaby, seeing that it was required of him to meet some one without, arose, though with a good deal of effort, and permitted the negro to help him on with his coat, still feeling mightily dizzy and uncertain upon his legs, his head beating fit to split, and the vessel rolling and pitching at a great rate, as though upon a heavy ground swell.

Either the people around him didn't want to respond, or they couldn't speak English, because they didn't answer except with gestures. The white man, seeing that he could now talk and had regained his senses, nodded his head a few times, smiled widely, and then pointed as if toward a bar nearby. Meanwhile, the Black man held up our hero's coat and gestured for him to put it on. Realizing he needed to meet someone outside, Barnaby struggled to get up and allowed the Black man to help him with his coat, still feeling extremely dizzy and unsteady on his feet, his head pounding, while the boat rocked and swayed a lot, as if it were in heavy seas.

So, still sick and dizzy, he went out into what was indeed a fine saloon beyond, painted in white and gilt like the cabin he had just quitted, and fitted in the nicest fashion, a mahogany table, polished very bright, extending the length of the room, and a quantity of bottles, together with glasses of clear crystal, arranged in a hanging rack above.

So, still feeling sick and dizzy, he walked into what was actually a nice saloon, painted in white and gold like the cabin he had just left, and furnished to perfection, with a polished mahogany table running the length of the room, along with a bunch of bottles and clear crystal glasses neatly arranged in a hanging rack above.

Here at the table a man was sitting with his back to our hero, clad in a rough pea-jacket, and with a red handkerchief tied around his throat, his feet stretched out before him, and he smoking a pipe of tobacco with all the ease and comfort in the world.

Here at the table, a man was sitting with his back to our hero, wearing a rugged pea jacket and a red handkerchief tied around his neck, his feet stretched out in front of him, smoking a pipe of tobacco as if he were completely at ease and comfortable.

As Barnaby came in he turned round, and, to the profound astonishment of our hero, presented toward him in the light of the lantern, the dawn shining pretty strong through the skylight, the face of that very man who had conducted the mysterious expedition that night across Kingston Harbor to the Rio Cobra River.

As Barnaby entered, he turned around, and to our hero's utter shock, he revealed his face in the light of the lantern, with the dawn shining brightly through the skylight. It was the same man who had led the mysterious journey that night across Kingston Harbor to the Rio Cobra River.

This man looked steadily at Barnaby True for a moment or two, and then burst out laughing; and, indeed, Barnaby, standing there with the bandage about his head, must have looked a very droll picture of that astonishment he felt so profoundly at finding who was this pirate into whose hands he had fallen.

This guy stared at Barnaby True for a moment, then suddenly started laughing; and honestly, Barnaby, standing there with the bandage wrapped around his head, must have looked really funny, reflecting the shock he felt at discovering who this pirate was that he had ended up with.

"Well," says the other, "and so you be up at last, and no great harm done, I'll be bound. And how does your head feel by now, my young master?"

"Well," says the other, "so you’re finally up, and I bet no real harm was done. How’s your head feeling now, my young master?"

To this Barnaby made no reply, but, what with wonder and the dizziness of his head, seated himself at the table over against the speaker, who pushed a bottle of rum toward him, together with a glass from the swinging shelf above.[66]

To this, Barnaby didn’t say anything but, feeling both amazed and dizzy, sat down at the table across from the speaker, who slid a bottle of rum toward him along with a glass from the swinging shelf above.[66]

He watched Barnaby fill his glass, and so soon as he had done so began immediately by saying: "I do suppose you think you were treated mightily ill to be so handled last night. Well, so you were treated ill enough—though who hit you that crack upon the head I know no more than a child unborn. Well, I am sorry for the way you were handled, but there is this much to say, and of that you may believe me, that nothing was meant to you but kindness, and before you are through with us all you will believe that well enough."

He watched Barnaby fill his glass, and as soon as he finished, he immediately said: "I bet you think you were treated really badly last night. Well, you were treated poorly enough—though I have no idea who gave you that bump on the head. I genuinely regret how you were treated, but I have to say this much, and you can believe me on this: nothing was meant to you but kindness, and by the time you’re done with all of us, you’ll understand that well enough."

Here he helped himself to a taste of grog, and sucking in his lips, went on again with what he had to say. "Do you remember," said he, "that expedition of ours in Kingston Harbor, and how we were all of us balked that night?"

Here he took a sip of grog, and after sucking in his lips, continued what he wanted to say. "Do you remember," he said, "that trip we took in Kingston Harbor, and how we were all held up that night?"

"Why, yes," said Barnaby True, "nor am I likely to forget it."

"Of course," Barnaby True said, "and I probably won’t forget it."

"And do you remember what I said to that villain, Jack Malyoe, that night as his boat went by us?"

"And do you remember what I said to that jerk, Jack Malyoe, that night as his boat passed us?"

"As to that," said Barnaby True, "I do not know that I can say yes or no, but if you will tell me, I will maybe answer you in kind."

"As for that," said Barnaby True, "I'm not sure if I can say yes or no, but if you tell me, I might respond in kind."

"Why, I mean this," said the other. "I said that the villain had got the better of us once again, but that next time it would be our turn, even if William Brand himself had to come back from hell to put the business through."

"Listen, I really mean this," said the other. "I mentioned that the villain has outsmarted us again, but next time it will be our turn, even if William Brand himself has to come back from the grave to make it happen."

"I remember something of the sort," said Barnaby, "now that you speak of it, but still I am all in the dark as to what you are driving at."

"I remember something like that," said Barnaby, "now that you mention it, but I'm still completely in the dark about what you mean."

The other looked at him very cunningly for a little while, his head on one side, and his eyes half shut. Then, as if satisfied, he suddenly burst out laughing. "Look hither," said he, "and I'll show you something," and therewith, moving to one side, disclosed a couple of traveling cases or small trunks with brass studs, so exactly like those that Sir John Malyoe had fetched aboard at[67] Jamaica that Barnaby, putting this and that together, knew that they must be the same.

The other guy looked at him slyly for a moment, tilting his head and squinting his eyes. Then, seeming pleased, he suddenly burst into laughter. "Check this out," he said, and with that, he moved aside to reveal a couple of travel cases or small trunks with brass studs, exactly like the ones Sir John Malyoe had brought on board at[67] Jamaica. Barnaby, connecting the dots, realized they had to be the same ones.

Our hero had a strong enough suspicion as to what those two cases contained, and his suspicions had become a certainty when he saw Sir John Malyoe struck all white at being threatened about them, and his face lowering so malevolently as to look murder had he dared do it. But, Lord! what were suspicions or even certainty to what Barnaby True's two eyes beheld when that man lifted the lids of the two cases—the locks thereof having already been forced—and, flinging back first one lid and then the other, displayed to Barnaby's astonished sight a great treasure of gold and silver! Most of it tied up in leathern bags, to be sure, but many of the coins, big and little, yellow and white, lying loose and scattered about like so many beans, brimming the cases to the very top.

Our hero had a strong suspicion about what those two cases held, and his doubts turned into certainty when he saw Sir John Malyoe go pale at being threatened about them, his face looking so sinister that it seemed he could have killed if he had the nerve. But, good grief! What were suspicions or even certainty compared to what Barnaby True's eyes witnessed when that man lifted the lids of the two cases—the locks having already been forced—and, throwing back one lid and then the other, revealed to Barnaby's astonished gaze a huge treasure of gold and silver! Most of it was tied up in leather bags, but many of the coins, large and small, yellow and silver, were lying loose and scattered about like so many beans, filling the cases to the very top.

Barnaby sat dumb-struck at what he beheld; as to whether he breathed or no, I cannot tell; but this I know, that he sat staring at that marvelous treasure like a man in a trance, until, after a few seconds of this golden display, the other banged down the lids again and burst out laughing, whereupon he came back to himself with a jump.

Barnaby sat speechless at what he saw; I can’t say if he was breathing or not, but I know he stared at that incredible treasure like someone in a daze. After a few seconds of this dazzling sight, the other person slammed the lids shut and burst out laughing, which snapped him back to reality.

"Well, and what do you think of that?" said the other. "Is it not enough for a man to turn pirate for? But," he continued, "it is not for the sake of showing you this that I have been waiting for you here so long a while, but to tell you that you are not the only passenger aboard, but that there is another, whom I am to confide to your care and attention, according to orders I have received; so, if you are ready, Master Barnaby, I'll fetch her in directly." He waited for a moment, as though for Barnaby to speak, but our hero not replying, he arose and, putting away the bottle of rum and the glasses, crossed the saloon to a door like that from which Barnaby had come a little while before. This he opened, and after a moment's delay and a few words spoken[68] to some one within, ushered thence a young lady, who came out very slowly into the saloon where Barnaby still sat at the table.

"Well, what do you think about that?" said the other. "Isn't it enough to make a man turn pirate? But," he continued, "I'm not just here to show you this; I've been waiting for you to let you know that you're not the only passenger on board. There's another person I'm supposed to entrust to your care, as per my orders. So, if you're ready, Master Barnaby, I'll bring her in right away." He paused for a moment, as if waiting for Barnaby to respond, but since our hero didn't reply, he stood up, put away the bottle of rum and the glasses, and crossed the saloon to a door similar to the one Barnaby had come from a little while ago. He opened it, and after a brief moment and a few words exchanged[68] with someone inside, he brought out a young lady, who stepped slowly into the saloon where Barnaby was still sitting at the table.

"She Would Sit Quite Still, Permitting Barnaby to Gaze" "She Would Sit Quite Still, Allowing Barnaby to Stare"

Illustration from
THE GHOST OF CAPTAIN BRAND

by Howard Pyle

Originally published in
Harper's Weekly, December 19, 1896

It was Miss Marjorie Malyoe, very white, and looking as though stunned or bewildered by all that had befallen her.

It was Miss Marjorie Malyoe, very pale, looking as if she were stunned or confused by everything that had happened to her.

Barnaby True could never tell whether the amazing strange voyage that followed was of long or of short duration; whether it occupied three days or ten days. For conceive, if you choose, two people of flesh and blood moving and living continually in all the circumstances and surroundings as of a nightmare dream, yet they two so happy together that all the universe beside was of no moment to them! How was anyone to tell whether in such circumstances any time appeared to be long or short? Does a dream appear to be long or to be short?

Barnaby True could never figure out whether the incredible strange journey that followed lasted a long time or a short time; whether it took three days or ten days. Just imagine, if you will, two real people going through all the situations and surroundings of a nightmare, yet they were so happy together that nothing else in the universe mattered to them! How could anyone determine if, in such circumstances, any amount of time felt long or short? Does a dream feel long or short?

The vessel in which they sailed was a brigantine of good size and build, but manned by a considerable crew, the most strange and outlandish in their appearance that Barnaby had ever beheld—some white, some yellow, some black, and all tricked out with gay colors, and gold earrings in their ears, and some with great long mustachios, and others with handkerchiefs tied around their heads, and all talking a language together of which Barnaby True could understand not a single word, but which might have been Portuguese from one or two phrases he caught. Nor did this strange, mysterious crew, of God knows what sort of men, seem to pay any attention whatever to Barnaby or to the young lady. They might now and then have looked at him and her out of the corners of their yellow eyes, but that was all; otherwise they were indeed like the creatures of a nightmare dream. Only he who was the captain of this outlandish crew would maybe speak to Barnaby a few words as to the weather or what not when he would come down into the saloon to mix a glass of grog or to light a pipe of tobacco, and then to go on deck again about his business. Otherwise our hero and the young lady were left to themselves, to do as they pleased, with no one to interfere with them.

The ship they were on was a well-built brigantine, crewed by a diverse group of people that Barnaby had never seen before—some were white, some were yellow, some were black, all brightly dressed with colorful clothes and gold earrings, some had long mustaches, others had handkerchiefs tied around their heads, and they spoke a language that Barnaby True couldn't understand at all, though it might have been Portuguese based on a few phrases he caught. This odd, mysterious crew, made up of who knows what kind of men, seemed to completely ignore Barnaby and the young lady. They might have occasionally glanced at them from the corners of their eyes, but that was it; they truly seemed like creatures from a nightmare. The captain of this unusual crew would occasionally say a few words to Barnaby about the weather or something trivial when he came down to the saloon to mix a drink or light a pipe, then he would head back on deck to attend to his duties. Other than that, Barnaby and the young lady were left alone to do as they wished, without anyone bothering them.

As for her, she at no time showed any great sign of terror or of fear, only for a little while was singularly numb and quiet, as though dazed with what had happened to her. Indeed, methinks that wild beast, her grandfather, had so crushed her spirit by his tyranny and his violence that nothing that happened to her might seem sharp and keen, as it does to others of an ordinary sort.

As for her, she never really showed any strong signs of terror or fear. For a brief moment, she felt oddly numb and quiet, as if she were in shock from what had happened to her. In fact, I think that wild beast of a grandfather had so crushed her spirit with his tyranny and violence that nothing that happened to her seemed as intense or piercing as it does to ordinary people.

But this was only at first, for afterward her face began to grow singularly clear, as with a white light, and she would sit quite still, permitting Barnaby to gaze, I know not how long, into her eyes, her face so transfigured and her lips smiling, and they, as it were, neither of them breathing, but hearing, as in another far-distant place, the outlandish jargon of the crew talking together in the warm, bright sunlight, or the sound of creaking block and tackle as they hauled upon the sheets.

But this was only at first, because after that, her face began to look remarkably clear, almost illuminated, and she would sit completely still, allowing Barnaby to stare, I don’t know for how long, into her eyes. Her face was so transformed and her lips were smiling, and it seemed like neither of them was breathing, but instead, they were listening, as if from a faraway place, to the strange chatter of the crew talking together in the warm, bright sunlight, or the sound of creaking block and tackle as they pulled on the sheets.

Is it, then, any wonder that Barnaby True could never remember whether such a voyage as this was long or short?

Is it any surprise that Barnaby True could never remember whether a journey like this was long or short?

It was as though they might have sailed so upon that wonderful voyage forever. You may guess how amazed was Barnaby True when, coming upon deck one morning, he found the brigantine riding upon an even keel, at anchor off Staten Island, a small village on the shore, and the well-known roofs and chimneys of New York town in plain sight across the water.

It felt like they could have sailed on that incredible journey forever. You can imagine how surprised Barnaby True was when he came up on deck one morning and saw the brigantine perfectly balanced, anchored off Staten Island, with a small village on the shore and the familiar rooftops and chimneys of New York City clearly visible across the water.

'Twas the last place in the world he had expected to see.

It was the last place in the world he had expected to see.

And, indeed, it did seem strange to lie there alongside Staten Island all that day, with New York town so nigh at hand and yet so impossible to reach. For whether he desired to escape or no, Barnaby True could not but observe that both he and the young lady were so closely watched that they might as well have been prisoners, tied hand and foot and laid in the hold, so far as any hope of getting away was concerned.

And it truly felt odd to lie there next to Staten Island all day, with New York City so close yet totally out of reach. Whether he wanted to escape or not, Barnaby True couldn’t help but notice that both he and the young lady were being watched so closely that they might as well have been prisoners, tied up and locked away, as far as any hope of getting away was concerned.

All that day there was a deal of mysterious coming and going aboard the brigantine, and in the afternoon a sailboat went up to the town, carrying the captain, and a great load covered over with[70] a tarpaulin in the stern. What was so taken up to the town Barnaby did not then guess, but the boat did not return again till about sundown.

All day long, there was a lot of mysterious activity on the brigantine, and in the afternoon, a sailboat headed to the town with the captain and a big load covered with a tarpaulin in the back. Barnaby couldn't figure out what was taken to the town, but the boat didn't come back until around sunset.

For the sun was just dropping below the water when the captain came aboard once more and, finding Barnaby on deck, bade him come down into the saloon, where they found the young lady sitting, the broad light of the evening shining in through the skylight, and making it all pretty bright within.

For the sun was just setting when the captain came aboard again and, spotting Barnaby on deck, asked him to come down into the saloon, where they found the young lady sitting. The warm evening light was shining in through the skylight, making the inside pleasantly bright.

The captain commanded Barnaby to be seated, for he had something of moment to say to him; whereupon, as soon as Barnaby had taken his place alongside the young lady, he began very seriously, with a preface somewhat thus: "Though you may think me the captain of this brigantine, young gentleman, I am not really so, but am under orders, and so have only carried out those orders of a superior in all these things that I have done." Having so begun, he went on to say that there was one thing yet remaining for him to do, and that the greatest thing of all. He said that Barnaby and the young lady had not been fetched away from the Belle Helen as they were by any mere chance of accident, but that 'twas all a plan laid by a head wiser than his, and carried out by one whom he must obey in all things. He said that he hoped that both Barnaby and the young lady would perform willingly what they would be now called upon to do, but that whether they did it willingly or no, they must, for that those were the orders of one who was not to be disobeyed.

The captain told Barnaby to sit down because he had something important to discuss with him. As soon as Barnaby sat next to the young lady, the captain began seriously, starting with something like this: "Even though you might see me as the captain of this brigantine, young man, I'm actually not in charge; I'm following orders and just carrying out the instructions of someone above me in rank." After that, he went on to explain that there was one thing left for him to do, and it was the most important of all. He revealed that Barnaby and the young lady hadn’t been taken from the Belle Helen by mere accident, but that it was all part of a plan crafted by someone wiser than him, and executed by someone he had to obey in everything. He expressed hope that both Barnaby and the young lady would willingly do what they were now being asked to do, but he stated that whether they were willing or not, they had to comply, as those were the orders of someone not to be disobeyed.

You may guess how our hero held his breath at all this; but whatever might have been his expectations, the very wildest of them all did not reach to that which was demanded of him. "My orders are these," said the other, continuing: "I am to take you and the young lady ashore, and to see that you are married before I quit you; and to that end a very good, decent, honest minister who lives ashore yonder in the village was chosen and hath been spoken to and is now, no doubt, waiting for you to come. Such[71] are my orders, and this is the last thing I am set to do; so now I will leave you alone together for five minutes to talk it over, but be quick about it, for whether willing or not, this thing must be done."

You can imagine how our hero reacted to all of this; however, no matter what he expected, even his wildest ideas couldn't compare to what was being asked of him. "Here's the plan," the other said, continuing: "I need to take you and the young lady to shore and make sure you get married before I leave. A very good, decent, honest minister from the village has been contacted and is probably waiting for you right now. Such[71] are my orders, and this is the last task I'm assigned; so I'm going to leave you two alone for five minutes to discuss it, but hurry up, because whether you want to or not, this has to happen."

Thereupon he went away, as he had promised, leaving those two alone together, Barnaby like one turned into stone, and the young lady, her face turned away, flaming as red as fire in the fading light.

He then left, just as he had promised, leaving the two of them alone together, Barnaby standing still as if he were made of stone, and the young lady, her face turned away, blushing bright red in the fading light.

Nor can I tell what Barnaby said to her, nor what words he used, but only, all in a tumult, with neither beginning nor end he told her that God knew he loved her, and that with all his heart and soul, and that there was nothing in all the world for him but her; but, nevertheless, if she would not have it as had been ordered, and if she were not willing to marry him as she was bidden to do, he would rather die than lend himself to forcing her to do such a thing against her will. Nevertheless, he told her she must speak up and tell him yes or no, and that God knew he would give all the world if she would say "yes."

I can't say exactly what Barnaby said to her or the exact words he chose, but in a whirlwind of emotions, with no clear start or finish, he expressed that God knew he loved her with all his heart and soul, and that she was everything to him. However, he added that if she didn’t want to marry him as had been arranged, he would rather die than pressure her into doing something against her will. Still, he insisted that she needed to speak up and let him know her answer, and that God knew he would give anything if she would say "yes."

All this and more he said in such a tumult of words that there was no order in their speaking, and she sitting there, her bosom rising and falling as though her breath stifled her. Nor may I tell what she replied to him, only this, that she said she would marry him. At this he took her into his arms and set his lips to hers, his heart all melting away in his bosom.

All of this and more he said in such a rush of words that there was no clear order in what he was saying, and she sat there, her chest rising and falling like she was struggling to breathe. I can’t describe what she replied to him, only that she said she would marry him. At this, he pulled her into his arms and kissed her, his heart completely melting in his chest.

So presently came the captain back into the saloon again, to find Barnaby sitting there holding her hand, she with her face turned away, and his heart beating like a trip hammer, and so saw that all was settled as he would have it. Wherewith he wished them both joy, and gave Barnaby his hand.

So the captain came back into the lounge to find Barnaby sitting there holding her hand, her face turned away, his heart racing like crazy, and realized that everything was as he wanted it. With that, he wished them both happiness and shook Barnaby's hand.

The yawlboat belonging to the brigantine was ready and waiting alongside when they came upon deck, and immediately they descended to it and took their seats. So they landed, and in a little while were walking up the village street in the darkness,[72] she clinging to his arm as though she would swoon, and the captain of the brigantine and two other men from aboard following after them. And so to the minister's house, finding him waiting for them, smoking his pipe in the warm evening, and walking up and down in front of his own door. He immediately conducted them into the house, where, his wife having fetched a candle, and two others of the village folk being present, the good man having asked several questions as to their names and their age and where they were from, the ceremony was performed, and the certificate duly signed by those present—excepting the men who had come ashore from the brigantine, and who refused to set their hands to any paper.

The yawlboat belonging to the brigantine was ready and waiting alongside when they came on deck, and they quickly got in and took their seats. They landed, and soon found themselves walking up the village street in the darkness, [72] she clinging to his arm as if she might faint, while the captain of the brigantine and two other crew members followed behind them. They arrived at the minister's house, where he was waiting for them, smoking his pipe in the warm evening air and pacing in front of his door. He immediately led them inside, where his wife brought a candle, and two other villagers were present. The kind man asked them a few questions about their names, ages, and where they were from, then the ceremony was conducted, and the certificate was signed by those present—except for the men who had come ashore from the brigantine, who refused to sign any documents.

The same sailboat that had taken the captain up to the town in the afternoon was waiting for them at the landing place, whence, the captain, having wished them Godspeed, and having shaken Barnaby very heartily by the hand, they pushed off, and, coming about, ran away with the slant of the wind, dropping the shore and those strange beings alike behind them into the night.

The same sailboat that had taken the captain to town earlier was waiting for them at the dock. The captain wished them well and shook Barnaby's hand warmly before they set off. They turned the boat around and sailed away with the wind, leaving the shore and those strange people behind them in the darkness.

As they sped away through the darkness they could hear the creaking of the sails being hoisted aboard of the brigantine, and so knew that she was about to put to sea once more. Nor did Barnaby True ever set eyes upon those beings again, nor did anyone else that I ever heard tell of.

As they rushed away into the night, they could hear the sails being lifted on the brigantine, indicating that it was getting ready to sail again. Barnaby True never saw those people again, and neither did anyone else that I’ve ever heard of.

It was nigh midnight when they made Mr. Hartright's wharf at the foot of Wall Street, and so the streets were all dark and silent and deserted as they walked up to Barnaby's home.

It was almost midnight when they reached Mr. Hartright's wharf at the end of Wall Street, and the streets were dark, quiet, and empty as they walked up to Barnaby's home.

You may conceive of the wonder and amazement of Barnaby's dear stepfather when, clad in a dressing gown and carrying a lighted candle in his hand, he unlocked and unbarred the door, and so saw who it was had aroused him at such an hour of the night, and the young and beautiful lady whom Barnaby had fetched with him.

You can imagine the shock and surprise of Barnaby's beloved stepfather when, dressed in a bathrobe and holding a lit candle, he unlocked and opened the door. He was taken aback to see who had woken him at such an hour and the young, beautiful woman that Barnaby had brought with him.

The first thought of the good man was that the Belle Helen had come into port; nor did Barnaby undeceive him as he led the[73] way into the house, but waited until they were all safe and sound in privity together before he should unfold his strange and wonderful story.

The good man's first thought was that the Belle Helen had arrived in port; Barnaby didn't correct him as he guided the[73] way into the house, instead waiting until they were all safely together in private before sharing his strange and amazing story.

"This was left for you by two foreign sailors this afternoon, Barnaby," the good old man said, as he led the way through the hall, holding up the candle at the same time, so that Barnaby might see an object that stood against the wainscoting by the door of the dining room.

"This was left for you by two foreign sailors this afternoon, Barnaby," the kindly old man said, as he walked through the hall, holding up the candle so that Barnaby could see an object leaning against the wall by the dining room door.

Nor could Barnaby refrain from crying out with amazement when he saw that it was one of the two chests of treasure that Sir John Malyoe had fetched from Jamaica, and which the pirates had taken from the Belle Helen. As for Mr. Hartright, he guessed no more what was in it than the man in the moon.

Nor could Barnaby help but cry out in amazement when he saw that it was one of the two treasure chests that Sir John Malyoe had brought back from Jamaica, and which the pirates had taken from the Belle Helen. As for Mr. Hartright, he had no idea what was inside it, just like the man in the moon.

The next day but one brought the Belle Helen herself into port, with the terrible news not only of having been attacked at night by pirates, but also that Sir John Malyoe was dead. For whether it was the sudden shock of the sight of his old captain's face—whom he himself had murdered and thought dead and buried—flashing so out against the darkness, or whether it was the strain of passion that overset his brains, certain it is that when the pirates left the Belle Helen, carrying with them the young lady and Barnaby and the traveling trunks, those left aboard the Belle Helen found Sir John Malyoe lying in a fit upon the floor, frothing at the mouth and black in the face, as though he had been choked, and so took him away to his berth, where, the next morning about ten o'clock, he died, without once having opened his eyes or spoken a single word.

The day after next, the Belle Helen herself arrived in port, bringing the awful news that not only had they been attacked at night by pirates, but also that Sir John Malyoe was dead. Whether it was the shock of seeing the face of his old captain—whom he had killed and believed to be dead and buried—suddenly appearing out of the darkness, or whether it was the emotional strain that drove him mad, it’s clear that when the pirates left the Belle Helen, taking with them the young lady, Barnaby, and the travel trunks, those who remained on the Belle Helen found Sir John Malyoe lying on the floor in a fit, frothing at the mouth and turning black in the face as if he had been choked. They took him to his cabin, where, the next morning around ten o'clock, he died without ever having opened his eyes or said a single word.

As for the villain manservant, no one ever saw him afterward; though whether he jumped overboard, or whether the pirates who so attacked the ship had carried him away bodily, who shall say?

As for the villainous servant, no one ever saw him again; whether he jumped overboard or if the pirates who attacked the ship took him away, who can say?

Mr. Hartright, after he had heard Barnaby's story, had been very uncertain as to the ownership of the chest of treasure that had been left by those men for Barnaby, but the news of the death of Sir John Malyoe made the matter very easy for him to decide.[74] For surely if that treasure did not belong to Barnaby, there could be no doubt that it must belong to his wife, she being Sir John Malyoe's legal heir. And so it was that that great fortune (in actual computation amounting to upward of sixty-three thousand pounds) came to Barnaby True, the grandson of that famous pirate, William Brand; the English estate in Devonshire, in default of male issue of Sir John Malyoe, descended to Captain Malyoe, whom the young lady was to have married.

Mr. Hartright, after hearing Barnaby's story, was quite unsure about who owned the chest of treasure left for Barnaby by those men, but the news of Sir John Malyoe's death made things much clearer for him. For surely, if that treasure didn't belong to Barnaby, it had to belong to his wife, since she was Sir John Malyoe's legal heir. And so it was that the significant fortune (which totaled over sixty-three thousand pounds) came to Barnaby True, the grandson of the infamous pirate, William Brand; the English estate in Devonshire, in the absence of male heirs from Sir John Malyoe, went to Captain Malyoe, whom the young lady was supposed to marry.[74]

As for the other case of treasure, it was never heard of again, nor could Barnaby ever guess whether it was divided as booty among the pirates, or whether they had carried it away with them to some strange and foreign land, there to share it among themselves.

As for the other case of treasure, it was never heard of again, nor could Barnaby ever guess whether it was divided as loot among the pirates, or whether they took it with them to some distant and foreign land, there to share it among themselves.

And so the ending of the story, with only this to observe, that whether that strange appearance of Captain Brand's face by the light of the pistol was a ghostly and spiritual appearance, or whether he was present in flesh and blood, there is only to say that he was never heard of again; nor had he ever been heard of till that time since the day he was so shot from behind by Capt. John Malyoe on the banks of the Rio Cobra River in the year 1733.

And so, at the end of the story, all we can say is that whether the strange look on Captain Brand's face in the light of the pistol was ghostly or if he was there in person, he was never heard from again; nor had anyone heard from him since that day in 1733 when Capt. John Malyoe shot him from behind on the banks of the Rio Cobra River.


Chapter III

WITH THE BUCCANEERS

Being an Account of Certain Adventures that Befell Henry Mostyn Under Capt. H. Morgan in the Year 1665-66

I

J

lthough this narration has more particularly to do with the taking of the Spanish vice admiral in the harbor of Porto Bello, and of the rescue therefrom of Le Sieur Simon, his wife and daughter (the adventure of which was successfully achieved by Captain Morgan, the famous buccaneer), we shall, nevertheless, premise something of the earlier history of Master Harry Mostyn, whom you may, if you please, consider as the hero of the several circumstances recounted in these pages.

Although this story focuses mainly on the capture of the Spanish vice admiral in the harbor of Porto Bello and the rescue of Le Sieur Simon, his wife, and daughter (an adventure accomplished by Captain Morgan, the famous buccaneer), we will first provide some background on Master Harry Mostyn, who you can think of as the hero of the events described in these pages.

In the year 1664 our hero's father embarked from Portsmouth, in England, for the Barbados, where he owned a considerable sugar plantation. Thither to those parts of America he transported with himself his whole family, of whom our Master Harry was the fifth of eight children—a great lusty fellow as little fitted for the[76] Church (for which he was designed) as could be. At the time of this story, though not above sixteen years old, Master Harry Mostyn was as big and well-grown as many a man of twenty, and of such a reckless and dare-devil spirit that no adventure was too dangerous or too mischievous for him to embark upon.

In 1664, our hero's father left Portsmouth, England, for Barbados, where he owned a large sugar plantation. He took his entire family with him, and our Master Harry was the fifth of eight children—a big, robust guy who was completely unsuitable for the Church (which was his intended path). At the time of this story, even though he was just sixteen years old, Master Harry Mostyn was as big and well-built as many twenty-year-olds, with a wild and adventurous spirit that made no challenge too risky or too mischievous for him to take on.

BURIED TREASURE hidden treasure

At this time there was a deal of talk in those parts of the Americas concerning Captain Morgan, and the prodigious successes he was having pirating against the Spaniards.

At that time, there was a lot of chatter in those parts of the Americas about Captain Morgan and the amazing successes he was having in his piracy against the Spaniards.

This man had once been an indentured servant with Mr. Rolls, a sugar factor at the Barbados. Having served out his time, and being of lawless disposition, possessing also a prodigious appetite for adventure, he joined with others of his kidney, and, purchasing a caravel of three guns, embarked fairly upon that career of piracy the most successful that ever was heard of in the world.

This man had once been an indentured servant with Mr. Rolls, a sugar trader in Barbados. After completing his service, he was a bit of a rebel and had a huge thirst for adventure, so he teamed up with others like him. They bought a three-gun caravel and set off on a career in piracy that became the most successful anyone had ever heard of.

Master Harry had known this man very well while he was still with Mr. Rolls, serving as a clerk at that gentleman's sugar wharf, a tall, broad-shouldered, strapping fellow, with red cheeks, and thick red lips, and rolling blue eyes, and hair as red as any chestnut. Many knew him for a bold, gruff-spoken man, but no one at that time suspected that he had it in him to become so famous and renowned as he afterward grew to be.

Master Harry had known this man quite well when he was still with Mr. Rolls, working as a clerk at that gentleman's sugar wharf. He was a tall, broad-shouldered guy, with red cheeks, thick red lips, rolling blue eyes, and hair as red as a chestnut. Many people recognized him as a bold, gruff-spoken man, but back then, no one suspected that he would become so famous and renowned as he later did.

The fame of his exploits had been the talk of those parts for above a twelvemonth, when, in the latter part of the year 1665, Captain Morgan, having made a very successful expedition against the Spaniards into the Gulf of Campeche—where he took several important purchases from the plate fleet—came to the Barbados, there to fit out another such venture, and to enlist recruits.

The fame of his exploits had been the talk of the area for over a year when, in late 1665, Captain Morgan, after a very successful mission against the Spaniards in the Gulf of Campeche—where he captured several significant items from the treasure fleet—arrived in Barbados to prepare for another similar venture and to recruit new members.

He and certain other adventurers had purchased a vessel of some five hundred tons, which they proposed to convert into a pirate by cutting portholes for cannon, and running three or four carronades across her main deck. The name of this ship, be it mentioned, was the Good Samaritan, as ill-fitting a name as could be for such a craft, which, instead of being designed for the healing [77]of wounds, was intended to inflict such devastation as those wicked men proposed.

He and a few other adventurers had bought a ship of about five hundred tons, which they planned to turn into a pirate vessel by cutting portholes for cannons and fitting three or four carronades on the main deck. By the way, the name of this ship was the Good Samaritan, a completely inappropriate name for such a craft, which, instead of being meant for healing [77] wounds, was intended to cause the kind of destruction those wicked men had in mind.

Here was a piece of mischief exactly fitted to our hero's tastes; wherefore, having made up a bundle of clothes, and with not above a shilling in his pocket, he made an excursion into the town to seek for Captain Morgan. There he found the great pirate established at an ordinary, with a little court of ragamuffins and swashbucklers gathered about him, all talking very loud, and drinking healths in raw rum as though it were sugared water.

Here was a bit of trouble that suited our hero perfectly; so, after packing a bundle of clothes and having only a shilling to his name, he set off into town to look for Captain Morgan. He found the notorious pirate at a tavern, surrounded by a group of ragtag misfits and wannabe fighters, all talking loudly and toasting with straight rum as if it were soda.

And what a fine figure our buccaneer had grown, to be sure! How different from the poor, humble clerk upon the sugar wharf! What a deal of gold braid! What a fine, silver-hilted Spanish sword! What a gay velvet sling, hung with three silver-mounted pistols! If Master Harry's mind had not been made up before, to be sure such a spectacle of glory would have determined it.

And what a striking figure our buccaneer had become, for sure! How different from the poor, humble clerk at the sugar dock! So much gold braid! What a beautiful, silver-hilted Spanish sword! What a lively velvet sash, with three silver-mounted pistols! If Master Harry hadn't already made up his mind, such a glorious sight would have definitely made him decide.

This figure of war our hero asked to step aside with him, and when they had come into a corner, proposed to the other what he intended, and that he had a mind to enlist as a gentleman adventurer upon this expedition. Upon this our rogue of a buccaneer captain burst out a-laughing, and fetching Master Harry a great thump upon the back, swore roundly that he would make a man of him, and that it was a pity to make a parson out of so good a piece of stuff.

This warrior our hero asked to step aside with him, and when they reached a corner, he shared his intentions and said he wanted to join this expedition as a gentleman adventurer. The pirate captain then burst out laughing, gave Master Harry a hearty slap on the back, and exclaimed that he would turn him into a real man, saying it was a shame to make a priest out of someone so capable.

Nor was Captain Morgan less good than his word, for when the Good Samaritan set sail with a favoring wind for the island of Jamaica, Master Harry found himself established as one of the adventurers aboard.

Nor was Captain Morgan any less true to his word, for when the Good Samaritan set sail with a favorable wind for the island of Jamaica, Master Harry found himself welcomed as one of the adventurers on board.

II

Could you but have seen the town of Port Royal as it appeared in the year 1665 you would have beheld a sight very well worth while looking upon. There were no fine houses at that time, and no great counting houses built of brick, such as you may find nowadays,[78] but a crowd of board and wattled huts huddled along the streets, and all so gay with flags and bits of color that Vanity Fair itself could not have been gayer. To this place came all the pirates and buccaneers that infested those parts, and men shouted and swore and gambled, and poured out money like water, and then maybe wound up their merrymaking by dying of fever. For the sky in these torrid latitudes is all full of clouds overhead, and as hot as any blanket, and when the sun shone forth it streamed down upon the smoking sands so that the houses were ovens and the streets were furnaces; so it was little wonder that men died like rats in a hole. But little they appeared to care for that; so that everywhere you might behold a multitude of painted women and Jews and merchants and pirates, gaudy with red scarfs and gold braid and all sorts of odds and ends of foolish finery, all fighting and gambling and bartering for that ill-gotten treasure of the be-robbed Spaniard.

If you had seen the town of Port Royal in 1665, you would have witnessed a scene that was definitely worth a look. There weren't any fancy houses back then, nor grand counting houses made of brick like you see today,[78] but rather a jumble of wooden and thatched huts lined the streets, all decorated with flags and bursts of color that would make Vanity Fair look dull. This place attracted all the pirates and buccaneers in the area, and people shouted, swore, and gambled, throwing money around like it was nothing, often ending their festivities by succumbing to fever. In those sweltering climates, the sky was filled with clouds, and the heat was oppressive. When the sun came out, it beat down on the hot sands, turning the houses into ovens and the streets into furnaces; it was no surprise that people died like rats in a hole. But they seemed not to care; everywhere you looked, there were crowds of painted women, Jews, merchants, and pirates, decked out in red sashes, gold trim, and all kinds of ridiculous trinkets, all fighting, gambling, and trading for that stolen treasure of the robbed Spaniard.

Here, arriving, Captain Morgan found a hearty welcome, and a message from the governor awaiting him, the message bidding him attend His Excellency upon the earliest occasion that offered. Whereupon, taking our hero (of whom he had grown prodigiously fond) along with him, our pirate went, without any loss of time, to visit Sir Thomas Modiford, who was then the royal governor of all this devil's brew of wickedness.

Upon his arrival, Captain Morgan was warmly welcomed and found a message from the governor, asking him to meet with His Excellency at the earliest opportunity. So, without wasting any time, he took our hero (whom he had become very fond of) with him and went to visit Sir Thomas Modiford, who was the royal governor of that whole chaotic mess.

They found His Excellency seated in a great easy-chair, under the shadow of a slatted veranda, the floor whereof was paved with brick. He was clad, for the sake of coolness, only in his shirt, breeches, and stockings, and he wore slippers on his feet. He was smoking a great cigarro of tobacco, and a goblet of lime juice and water and rum stood at his elbow on a table. Here, out of the glare of the heat, it was all very cool and pleasant, with a sea breeze blowing violently in through the slats, setting them a-rattling now and then, and stirring Sir Thomas's long hair, which he had pushed back for the sake of coolness.[79]

They found His Excellency sitting in a large armchair, beneath the shade of a slatted porch, the floor made of brick. To stay cool, he was dressed only in his shirt, trousers, and socks, and he wore slippers on his feet. He was smoking a large cigar, and a glass of lime juice mixed with water and rum rested beside him on a table. Here, away from the heat, it was very cool and pleasant, with a sea breeze blowing strongly through the slats, causing them to rattle occasionally and tousling Sir Thomas's long hair, which he had pushed back to keep cool.[79]

The purport of this interview, I may tell you, concerned the rescue of one Le Sieur Simon, who, together with his wife and daughter, was held captive by the Spaniards.

The purpose of this interview, I should inform you, was about the rescue of one Le Sieur Simon, who, along with his wife and daughter, was being held captive by the Spaniards.

This gentleman adventurer (Le Sieur Simon) had, a few years before, been set up by the buccaneers as governor of the island of Santa Catharina. This place, though well fortified by the Spaniards, the buccaneers had seized upon, establishing themselves thereon, and so infesting the commerce of those seas that no Spanish fleet was safe from them. At last the Spaniards, no longer able to endure these assaults against their commerce, sent a great force against the freebooters to drive them out of their island stronghold. This they did, retaking Santa Catharina, together with its governor, his wife, and daughter, as well as the whole garrison of buccaneers.

This adventurous man (Le Sieur Simon) had, a few years earlier, been appointed by the buccaneers as the governor of the island of Santa Catharina. Although the Spaniards had heavily fortified this location, the buccaneers had taken control, settling there and disrupting trade in those waters to the point where no Spanish fleet was safe from them. Eventually, the Spaniards, unable to tolerate these attacks on their commerce any longer, sent a large force to drive the pirates out of their island stronghold. They succeeded in reclaiming Santa Catharina, along with its governor, his wife, and daughter, as well as the entire garrison of buccaneers.

This garrison was sent by their conquerors, some to the galleys, some to the mines, some to no man knows where. The[80] governor himself—Le Sieur Simon—was to be sent to Spain, there to stand his trial for piracy.

This garrison was sent by their conquerors, some to the galleys, some to the mines, and some to unknown places. The[80] governor himself—Le Sieur Simon—was to be sent to Spain to stand trial for piracy.

The news of all this, I may tell you, had only just been received in Jamaica, having been brought thither by a Spanish captain, one Don Roderiguez Sylvia, who was, besides, the bearer of dispatches to the Spanish authorities relating the whole affair.

The news about all this, I should let you know, had just arrived in Jamaica, brought there by a Spanish captain named Don Roderiguez Sylvia, who was also delivering messages to the Spanish authorities regarding the entire situation.

Such, in fine, was the purport of this interview, and as our hero and his captain walked back together from the governor's house to the ordinary where they had taken up their inn, the buccaneer assured his companion that he purposed to obtain those dispatches from the Spanish captain that very afternoon, even if he had to use force to seize them.

That was basically the main point of this meeting, and as our hero and his captain walked back together from the governor's house to the inn where they were staying, the buccaneer told his companion that he intended to get those messages from the Spanish captain that very afternoon, even if he had to use force to grab them.

All this, you are to understand, was undertaken only because of the friendship that the governor and Captain Morgan entertained for Le Sieur Simon. And, indeed, it was wonderful how honest and how faithful were these wicked men in their dealings with one another. For you must know that Governor Modiford and Le Sieur Simon and the buccaneers were all of one kidney—all taking a share in the piracies of those times, and all holding by one another as though they were the honestest men in the world. Hence it was they were all so determined to rescue Le Sieur Simon from the Spaniards.

All of this, you should understand, was done only because of the friendship that the governor and Captain Morgan had for Le Sieur Simon. And honestly, it was surprising how trustworthy and loyal these wicked men were in their dealings with each other. You need to know that Governor Modiford, Le Sieur Simon, and the buccaneers were all cut from the same cloth—all sharing in the piracy of that time, and all supporting each other as if they were the most honest men in the world. That's why they were so committed to rescuing Le Sieur Simon from the Spaniards.

III

Having reached his ordinary after his interview with the governor, Captain Morgan found there a number of his companions, such as usually gathered at that place to be in attendance upon him—some, those belonging to the Good Samaritan; others, those who hoped to obtain benefits from him; others, those ragamuffins who gathered around him because he was famous, and because it pleased them to be of his court and to be called his followers. For nearly always your successful pirate had such a little court surrounding him.[81]

After his meeting with the governor, Captain Morgan arrived at his usual spot, where a group of his companions had gathered to be around him—some were from the Good Samaritan; others sought favors from him; and there were those scruffy ones who surrounded him because he was famous and enjoyed being part of his entourage and calling themselves his followers. Almost always, a successful pirate had a small court of admirers around him.[81]

Finding a dozen or more of these rascals gathered there, Captain Morgan informed them of his present purpose—that he was going to find the Spanish captain to demand his papers of him, and calling upon them to accompany him.

Finding a dozen or more of these troublemakers gathered there, Captain Morgan told them about his current plan—that he was going to find the Spanish captain to ask for his papers, and he invited them to join him.

With this following at his heels, our buccaneer started off down the street, his lieutenant, a Cornishman named Bartholomew Davis, upon one hand and our hero upon the other. So they paraded the streets for the best part of an hour before they found the Spanish captain. For whether he had got wind that Captain Morgan was searching for him, or whether, finding himself in a place so full of his enemies, he had buried himself in some place of hiding, it is certain that the buccaneers had traversed pretty nearly the whole town before they discovered that he was lying at a certain auberge kept by a Portuguese Jew. Thither they went, and thither Captain Morgan entered with the utmost coolness and composure of demeanor, his followers crowding noisily in at his heels.

With a crowd following him, our pirate set off down the street, his lieutenant, a Cornishman named Bartholomew Davis, on one side and our hero on the other. They paraded through the streets for nearly an hour before they found the Spanish captain. Whether he had heard that Captain Morgan was looking for him, or if he had hidden himself away in a place packed with enemies, it's clear that the buccaneers had nearly covered the entire town before discovering he was at a certain inn run by a Portuguese Jew. They headed there, and Captain Morgan entered with complete calm and composure, his followers bustling noisily in behind him.

The space within was very dark, being lighted only by the doorway and by two large slatted windows or openings in the front.

The inside was really dark, lit only by the doorway and two big slatted windows or openings at the front.

In this dark, hot place—not over-roomy at the best—were gathered twelve or fifteen villainous-appearing men, sitting at tables and drinking together, waited upon by the Jew and his wife. Our hero had no trouble in discovering which of this lot of men was Captain Sylvia, for not only did Captain Morgan direct his glance full of war upon him, but the Spaniard was clad with more particularity and with more show of finery than any of the others who were there.

In this dark, stuffy place—not very spacious at all—were about twelve or fifteen shady-looking men, sitting at tables and drinking together, attended by the Jew and his wife. Our hero quickly figured out which of these men was Captain Sylvia, as not only did Captain Morgan stare at him with a fierce intensity, but the Spaniard was dressed more extravagantly and elegantly than anyone else there.

Him Captain Morgan approached and demanded his papers, whereunto the other replied with such a jabber of Spanish and English that no man could have understood what he said. To this Captain Morgan in turn replied that he must have those papers, no matter what it might cost him to obtain them, and thereupon drew a pistol from his sling and presented it at the other's head.[82]

Captain Morgan approached and demanded the other person's papers, to which the other responded with a jumble of Spanish and English that no one could understand. In response, Captain Morgan insisted that he needed those papers, no matter what it took to get them, and then pulled a pistol from his sling and aimed it at the other person's head.[82]

At this threatening action the innkeeper's wife fell a-screaming, and the Jew, as in a frenzy, besought them not to tear the house down about his ears.

At this alarming action, the innkeeper's wife started screaming, and the Jew, in a panic, begged them not to tear the house down around him.

Our hero could hardly tell what followed, only that all of a sudden there was a prodigious uproar of combat. Knives flashed everywhere, and then a pistol was fired so close to his head that he stood like one stunned, hearing some one crying out in a loud voice, but not knowing whether it was a friend or a foe who had been shot. Then another pistol shot so deafened what was left of Master Harry's hearing that his ears rang for above an hour afterward. By this time the whole place was full of gunpowder smoke, and there was the sound of blows and oaths and outcrying and the clashing of knives.

Our hero could barely make sense of what happened next, except that suddenly there was a huge uproar of fighting. Knives were flashing everywhere, and then a gun was fired so close to his head that he froze, hearing someone shout loudly, but not knowing if it was a friend or an enemy who had been hit. Then another gunshot was so loud that it left Master Harry's ears ringing for over an hour. By this point, the whole place was filled with gunpowder smoke, and there were sounds of blows, curses, shouting, and the clashing of knives.

As Master Harry, who had no great stomach for such a combat, and no very particular interest in the quarrel, was making for the door, a little Portuguese, as withered and as nimble as an ape, came ducking under the table and plunged at his stomach with a great long knife, which, had it effected its object, would surely have ended his adventures then and there. Finding himself in such danger, Master Harry snatched up a heavy chair, and, flinging it at his enemy, who was preparing for another attack, he fairly ran for it out of the door, expecting every instant to feel the thrust of the blade betwixt his ribs.

As Master Harry, who wasn’t really into fighting and didn’t care much about the argument, was heading for the door, a little Portuguese man, as scrappy and quick as a monkey, ducked under the table and lunged at him with a long knife, which, if it had hit, would have definitely ended his run right then and there. Realizing he was in serious danger, Master Harry grabbed a heavy chair and hurled it at his attacker, who was getting ready for another go, and he sprinted out the door, expecting to feel the blade stab him in the back any second.

A considerable crowd had gathered outside, and others, hearing the uproar, were coming running to join them. With these our hero stood, trembling like a leaf, and with cold chills running up and down his back like water at the narrow escape from the danger that had threatened him.

A large crowd had gathered outside, and others, hearing the noise, were rushing over to join them. With them, our hero stood, shaking like a leaf, with chills running up and down his back from the close call with the danger he had faced.

Nor shall you think him a coward, for you must remember he was hardly sixteen years old at the time, and that this was the first affair of the sort he had encountered. Afterward, as you shall learn, he showed that he could exhibit courage enough at a pinch.

Nor should you think of him as a coward, because you need to remember he was barely sixteen at the time, and this was the first situation of this kind he had faced. Later on, as you will see, he proved that he could show enough courage when it really mattered.

While he stood there, endeavoring to recover his composure,[83] the while the tumult continued within, suddenly two men came running almost together out of the door, a crowd of the combatants at their heels. The first of these men was Captain Sylvia; the other, who was pursuing him, was Captain Morgan.

While he stood there, trying to regain his composure,[83] the chaos continued inside, and suddenly two men burst out of the door, a group of fighters right behind them. The first man was Captain Sylvia; the other, chasing him, was Captain Morgan.

As the crowd about the door parted before the sudden appearing of these, the Spanish captain, perceiving, as he supposed, a way of escape opened to him, darted across the street with incredible swiftness toward an alleyway upon the other side. Upon this, seeing his prey like to get away from him, Captain Morgan snatched a pistol out of his sling, and resting it for an instant across his arm, fired at the flying Spaniard, and that with so true an aim that, though the street was now full of people, the other went tumbling over and over all of a heap in the kennel, where he lay, after a twitch or two, as still as a log.

As the crowd at the door moved aside when these appeared unexpectedly, the Spanish captain, thinking he had found a way to escape, dashed across the street with amazing speed toward an alley on the other side. Seeing his target about to get away, Captain Morgan quickly grabbed a pistol from his sling, rested it momentarily on his arm, and fired at the fleeing Spaniard. His aim was so precise that, despite the street being crowded, the man fell over and over into the gutter, where he lay still as a log after a few twitches.

At the sound of the shot and the fall of the man the crowd scattered upon all sides, yelling and screaming, and the street being thus pretty clear, Captain Morgan ran across the way to where his victim lay, his smoking pistol still in his hand, and our hero following close at his heels.

At the sound of the gunshot and the man's fall, the crowd panicked and ran in every direction, yelling and screaming. With the street now mostly clear, Captain Morgan rushed over to where his victim lay, his smoking gun still in his hand, while our hero followed closely behind him.

Our poor Harry had never before beheld a man killed thus in an instant who a moment before had been so full of life and activity, for when Captain Morgan turned the body over upon its back he could perceive at a glance, little as he knew of such matters, that the man was stone-dead. And, indeed, it was a dreadful sight for him who was hardly more than a child. He stood rooted for he knew not how long, staring down at the dead face with twitching fingers and shuddering limbs. Meantime a great crowd was gathering about them again.

Our poor Harry had never before seen a man killed like this in an instant, who just a moment ago had been so full of life and energy. When Captain Morgan turned the body over onto its back, he could tell right away, even with his little knowledge of such things, that the man was completely dead. And, in fact, it was a horrifying sight for someone who was hardly more than a child. He stood frozen for what felt like ages, staring at the lifeless face with trembling fingers and shaking limbs. Meanwhile, a large crowd was starting to gather around them again.

As for Captain Morgan, he went about his work with the utmost coolness and deliberation imaginable, unbuttoning the waistcoat and the[84] shirt of the man he had murdered with fingers that neither twitched nor shook. There were a gold cross and a bunch of silver medals hung by a whipcord about the neck of the dead man. This Captain Morgan broke away with a snap, reaching the jingling baubles to Harry, who took them in his nerveless hand and fingers that he could hardly close upon what they held.

As for Captain Morgan, he went about his task with absolute calm and focus, unbuttoning the waistcoat and the[84] shirt of the man he had killed with fingers that neither twitched nor shook. The dead man had a gold cross and a cluster of silver medals hanging by a whipcord around his neck. Captain Morgan snapped those off and handed the jingling trinkets to Harry, who took them in his limp hand, struggling to close his fingers around what he held.

The papers Captain Morgan found in a wallet in an inner breast pocket of the Spaniard's waistcoat. These he examined one by one, and finding them to his satisfaction, tied them up again, and slipped the wallet and its contents into his own pocket.

The papers Captain Morgan found in a wallet in the inner breast pocket of the Spaniard's waistcoat. He examined them one by one, and after finding them satisfactory, tied them up again and slipped the wallet and its contents into his own pocket.

Then for the first time he appeared to observe Master Harry, who, indeed, must have been standing, the perfect picture of horror and dismay. Whereupon, bursting out a-laughing, and slipping the pistol he had used back into its sling again, he fetched poor Harry a great slap upon the back, bidding him be a man, for that he would see many such sights as this.

Then for the first time, he seemed to truly notice Master Harry, who was clearly frozen in a moment of horror and shock. At that, he burst out laughing, tucked the pistol he had used back into its sling, and gave poor Harry a hearty slap on the back, telling him to toughen up, because he would encounter many more scenes like this one.

But indeed, it was no laughing matter for poor Master Harry, for it was many a day before his imagination could rid itself of the image of the dead Spaniard's face; and as he walked away down the street with his companions, leaving the crowd behind them, and the dead body where it lay for its friends to look after, his ears humming and ringing from the deafening noise of the pistol shots fired in the close room, and the sweat trickling down his face in drops, he knew not whether all that had passed had been real, or whether it was a dream from which he might presently awaken.

But honestly, it was no joke for poor Master Harry, because it took him a long time to shake off the image of the dead Spaniard's face. As he walked down the street with his friends, leaving the crowd behind and the dead body for its friends to take care of, his ears still ringing from the deafening gunshots fired in the small room, and sweat dripping down his face, he didn’t know if everything that happened was real or just a dream he might wake up from any moment.

IV

The papers Captain Morgan had thus seized upon as the fruit of the murder he had committed must have been as perfectly satisfactory to him as could be, for having paid a second visit that evening to Governor Modiford, the pirate lifted anchor the next morning and made sail toward the Gulf of Darien. There, after cruising about in those waters for about a fortnight without [85]falling in with a vessel of any sort, at the end of that time they overhauled a caravel bound from Porto Bello to Cartagena, which vessel they took, and finding her loaded with nothing better than raw hides, scuttled and sank her, being then about twenty leagues from the main of Cartagena. From the captain of this vessel they learned that the plate fleet was then lying in the harbor of Porto Bello, not yet having set sail thence, but waiting for the change of the winds before embarking for Spain. Besides this, which was a good deal more to their purpose, the Spaniards told the pirates that the Sieur Simon, his wife, and daughter were confined aboard the vice admiral of that fleet, and that the name of the vice admiral was the Santa Maria y Valladolid.

The papers Captain Morgan had seized as the result of his murder must have satisfied him completely. After visiting Governor Modiford again that evening, the pirate lifted anchor the next morning and set sail for the Gulf of Darien. There, after cruising those waters for about two weeks without coming across any vessels, they finally encountered a caravel heading from Porto Bello to Cartagena. They captured the ship and, finding it only carried raw hides, scuttled and sank it, being around twenty leagues from the Cartagena mainland. From the captain of that ship, they learned that the treasure fleet was still in the harbor of Porto Bello, waiting for favorable winds before heading to Spain. Additionally, which was much more relevant to their plans, the Spaniards revealed to the pirates that Sieur Simon, along with his wife and daughter, were being held aboard the vice admiral of that fleet, which was named the Santa Maria y Valladolid.

kidd on the deck of the Adventure Galley kid on the deck of the Adventure Galley

So soon as Captain Morgan had obtained the information he desired he directed his course straight for the Bay of Santo Blaso, where he might lie safely within the cape of that name without any danger of discovery (that part of the mainland being entirely uninhabited) and yet be within twenty or twenty-five leagues of Porto Bello.

As soon as Captain Morgan got the information he was looking for, he set his course directly for the Bay of Santo Blaso, where he could stay safely within the cape that bears that name without any risk of being discovered (that part of the mainland was completely uninhabited) and still be only twenty or twenty-five leagues away from Porto Bello.

Having come safely to this anchorage, he at once declared his intentions to his companions, which were as follows:

Having arrived safely at this anchorage, he immediately shared his plans with his companions, which were as follows:

That it was entirely impossible for them to hope to sail their vessel into the harbor of Porto Bello, and to attack the Spanish vice admiral where he lay in the midst of the armed flota; wherefore, if anything was to be accomplished, it must be undertaken by some subtle design rather than by open-handed boldness. Having so prefaced what he had to say, he now declared that it was his purpose to take one of the ship's boats and to go in that to Porto Bello, trusting for some opportunity to occur to aid him either in the accomplishment of his aims or in the gaining of some further information. Having thus delivered himself, he invited any who dared to do so to volunteer for the expedition, telling them plainly that he would constrain no man to go against his will, for that at best it was a desperate enterprise, possessing only the recommendation[86] that in its achievement the few who undertook it would gain great renown, and perhaps a very considerable booty.

It was completely unrealistic for them to think they could sail their ship into the port of Porto Bello and attack the Spanish vice admiral while he was surrounded by the armed flota. Therefore, if they wanted to achieve anything, it would have to be done through some clever plan rather than through bold direct action. After explaining his thoughts, he announced that he intended to take one of the ship's boats to Porto Bello, hoping for an opportunity to help him either succeed in his goals or gather more information. After sharing this, he invited anyone who was brave enough to volunteer for the mission, clearly stating that he wouldn’t force anyone to go against their will, since it was a risky venture that, at best, would bring great glory to those who attempted it, along with the possibility of a significant reward.

And such was the incredible influence of this bold man over his companions, and such was their confidence in his skill and cunning, that not above a dozen of all those aboard hung back from the undertaking, but nearly every man desired to be taken.

And the boldness of this man had such an incredible influence over his companions, and they had so much confidence in his skill and cleverness, that only about a dozen of those on board hesitated to join in, while nearly everyone else wanted to be included.

Of these volunteers Captain Morgan chose twenty—among others our Master Harry—and having arranged with his lieutenant that if nothing was heard from the expedition at the end of three days he should sail for Jamaica to await news, he embarked upon that enterprise, which, though never heretofore published, was perhaps the boldest and the most desperate of all those that have since made his name so famous. For what could be a more unparalleled undertaking than for a little open boat, containing but twenty men, to enter the harbor of the third strongest fortress of the Spanish mainland with the intention of cutting out the Spanish vice admiral from the midst of a whole fleet of powerfully armed vessels, and how many men in all the world do you suppose would venture such a thing?

Of these volunteers, Captain Morgan picked twenty—among them our Master Harry—and after arranging with his lieutenant that if they didn’t hear anything from the expedition within three days, he would sail to Jamaica to wait for news, he set off on this mission, which, although never published before, was probably the boldest and most desperate of all his adventures that later made him so famous. After all, what could be a more unique endeavor than for a small open boat with just twenty men to enter the harbor of the third strongest fortress on the Spanish mainland, with the goal of capturing the Spanish vice admiral right in the middle of a heavily armed fleet? How many people around the world do you think would dare to do that?

But there is this to be said of that great buccaneer: that if he undertook enterprises so desperate as this, he yet laid his plans so well that they never went altogether amiss. Moreover, the very desperation of his successes was of such a nature that no man could suspect that he would dare to undertake such things, and accordingly his enemies were never prepared to guard against his attacks. Aye, had he but worn the king's colors and served under the rules of honest war, he might have become as great and as renowned as Admiral Blake himself.

But there's something to be said about that great pirate: even though he took on such risky ventures, he always planned them so well that they rarely went wrong. Plus, the sheer audacity of his successes was so extreme that no one could have suspected he would be brave enough to attempt such things, which meant his enemies were never ready for his strikes. If he had just worn the king's colors and followed the rules of honorable warfare, he could have become as great and famous as Admiral Blake himself.

But all that is neither here nor there; what I have to tell you now is that Captain Morgan in this open boat with his twenty mates reached the Cape of Salmedina toward the fall of day. Arriving within view of the harbor they discovered the plate fleet at anchor, with two men-of-war and an armed galley riding as a guard at the[87] mouth of the harbor, scarce half a league distant from the other ships. Having spied the fleet in this posture, the pirates presently pulled down their sails and rowed along the coast, feigning to be a Spanish vessel from Nombre de Dios. So hugging the shore, they came boldly within the harbor, upon the opposite side of which you might see the fortress a considerable distance away.

But that’s neither here nor there; what I need to tell you now is that Captain Morgan, in this open boat with his twenty mates, reached the Cape of Salmedina just before sunset. When they got close enough to see the harbor, they discovered the treasure fleet anchored there, with two warships and an armed galley guarding the[87] entrance to the harbor, barely half a league away from the other ships. After spotting the fleet like this, the pirates quickly took down their sails and rowed along the coast, pretending to be a Spanish vessel from Nombre de Dios. Staying close to the shore, they boldly entered the harbor, on the opposite side of which you could see the fortress at a considerable distance.

Being now come so near to the consummation of their adventure, Captain Morgan required every man to make an oath to stand by him to the last, whereunto our hero swore as heartily as any man aboard, although his heart, I must needs confess, was beating at a great rate at the approach of what was to happen. Having thus received the oaths of all his followers, Captain Morgan commanded the surgeon of the expedition that, when the order was given, he, the medico, was to bore six holes in the boat, so that, it sinking under them, they might all be compelled to push forward, with no chance of retreat. And such was the ascendancy of this man over his followers, and such was their awe of him, that not one of them uttered even so much as a murmur, though what he had commanded the surgeon to do pledged them either to victory or to death, with no chance to choose between. Nor did the surgeon question the orders he had received, much less did he dream of disobeying them.

As they were getting closer to the end of their adventure, Captain Morgan asked every man to swear an oath to stick by him until the very end. Our hero swore just as earnestly as anyone else on board, though I have to admit, his heart was racing at the thought of what was about to happen. After receiving the oaths from all his followers, Captain Morgan instructed the ship’s surgeon that, when the time came, he was to drill six holes in the boat so that it would sink beneath them, forcing everyone to move forward with no chance of retreat. The influence this man had over his followers was so strong, and they were so in awe of him, that not a single one of them voiced even the slightest complaint, despite the fact that what he had ordered the surgeon to do bound them either to victory or to death, with no option in between. The surgeon didn’t question the orders he received, nor did he ever think about disobeying them.

By now it had fallen pretty dusk, whereupon, spying two fishermen in a canoe at a little distance, Captain Morgan demanded of them in Spanish which vessel of those at anchor in the harbor was the vice admiral, for that he had dispatches for the captain thereof. Whereupon the fishermen, suspecting nothing, pointed to them a galleon of great size riding at anchor not half a league distant.

By now it was getting pretty dark, and when Captain Morgan spotted two fishermen in a canoe nearby, he asked them in Spanish which ship anchored in the harbor was the vice admiral’s, as he had messages for that captain. The fishermen, not suspecting anything, pointed out a large galleon anchored less than half a league away.

Toward this vessel accordingly the pirates directed their course, and when they had come pretty nigh, Captain Morgan called upon the surgeon that now it was time for him to perform the duty that had been laid upon him. Whereupon[88] the other did as he was ordered, and that so thoroughly that the water presently came gushing into the boat in great streams, whereat all hands pulled for the galleon as though every next moment was to be their last.

The pirates steered their ship toward the vessel, and as they got closer, Captain Morgan called for the surgeon, saying it was time for him to do his job. The surgeon obeyed without hesitation, and water began pouring into the boat in huge waves, causing everyone to row toward the galleon as if each moment could be their last.

And what do you suppose were our hero's emotions at this time? Like all in the boat, his awe of Captain Morgan was so great that I do believe he would rather have gone to the bottom than have questioned his command, even when it was to scuttle the boat. Nevertheless, when he felt the cold water gushing about his feet (for he had taken off his shoes and stockings) he became possessed with such a fear of being drowned that even the Spanish galleon had no terrors for him if he could only feel the solid planks thereof beneath his feet.

And what do you think our hero was feeling at that moment? Like everyone in the boat, he was so in awe of Captain Morgan that I believe he would have preferred sinking to questioning his authority, even if it meant sinking the boat. However, when he felt the cold water rushing around his feet (since he had taken off his shoes and socks), he was suddenly overwhelmed with a fear of drowning that made even the Spanish galleon seem less scary, as long as he could feel the solid deck underneath him.

Indeed, all the crew appeared to be possessed of a like dismay, for they pulled at the oars with such an incredible force that they were under the quarter of the galleon before the boat was half filled with water.

Indeed, all the crew seemed to share the same shock, as they rowed with such incredible strength that they were at the back of the galleon before the boat was half full of water.

Here, as they approached, it then being pretty dark and the moon not yet having risen, the watch upon the deck hailed them, whereupon Captain Morgan called out in Spanish that he was Capt. Alvarez Mendazo, and that he brought dispatches for the vice admiral.

Here, as they got closer, it was getting pretty dark and the moon hadn't risen yet. The watch on the deck called out to them, and Captain Morgan replied in Spanish that he was Capt. Alvarez Mendazo and that he had dispatches for the vice admiral.

But at that moment, the boat being now so full of water as to be logged, it suddenly tilted upon one side as though to sink beneath them, whereupon all hands, without further orders, went scrambling up the side, as nimble as so many monkeys, each armed with a pistol in one hand and a cutlass in the other, and so were upon deck before the watch could collect his wits to utter any outcry or to give any other alarm than to cry out, "Jesu bless us! who are these?" at which words somebody knocked him down with the butt of a pistol, though who it was our hero could not tell in the darkness and the hurry.

But at that moment, the boat was so full of water that it started to sink, tipping over to one side as if it were going to go under. Without waiting for any orders, everyone scrambled up the side like a bunch of monkeys, each holding a pistol in one hand and a cutlass in the other. They got onto the deck before the lookout could gather his thoughts to shout out a warning. All he managed to say was, "Jesus, help us! Who are these?" At that moment, someone knocked him down with the butt of a pistol, but our hero couldn't tell who it was in the darkness and chaos.

Before any of those upon deck could recover from their alarm[89] or those from below come up upon deck, a part of the pirates, under the carpenter and the surgeon, had run to the gun room and had taken possession of the arms, while Captain Morgan, with Master Harry and a Portuguese called Murillo Braziliano, had flown with the speed of the wind into the great cabin.

Before anyone on deck could shake off their shock[89] or those below could come up, some of the pirates, led by the carpenter and the surgeon, raced to the gun room and grabbed the weapons, while Captain Morgan, along with Master Harry and a Portuguese man named Murillo Braziliano, dashed into the great cabin as fast as they could.

Here they found the captain of the vice admiral playing at cards with the Sieur Simon and a friend, Madam Simon and her daughter being present.

Here, they found the vice admiral's captain playing cards with Sieur Simon and a friend, while Madam Simon and her daughter were present.

Captain Morgan instantly set his pistol at the breast of the Spanish captain, swearing with a most horrible fierce countenance that if he spake a word or made any outcry he was a dead man. As for our hero, having now got his hand into the game, he performed the same service for the Spaniard's friend, declaring he would shoot him dead if he opened his lips or lifted so much as a single finger.

Captain Morgan quickly aimed his pistol at the chest of the Spanish captain, threatening with a fierce expression that if he said a word or made any noise, he would be a dead man. As for our hero, now involved in the situation, he did the same for the Spaniard's companion, stating he would shoot him dead if he said anything or moved even a single finger.

All this while the ladies, not comprehending what had occurred, had sat as mute as stones; but now having so far recovered themselves as to find a voice, the younger of the two fell to screaming, at which the Sieur Simon called out to her to be still, for these were friends who had come to help them, and not enemies who had come to harm them.

All this time, the ladies, not understanding what had happened, sat as silent as stones; but now, having gathered themselves enough to speak, the younger of the two started screaming. At this, Sieur Simon shouted to her to be quiet, assuring her that these were friends who had come to help them, not enemies who had come to harm them.

All this, you are to understand, occupied only a little while, for in less than a minute three or four of the pirates had come into the cabin, who, together with the Portuguese, proceeded at once to bind the two Spaniards hand and foot, and to gag them. This being done to our buccaneer's satisfaction, and the Spanish captain being stretched out in the corner of the cabin, he instantly cleared his countenance of its terrors, and bursting forth into a great loud laugh, clapped his hand to the Sieur Simon's, which he wrung with the best will in the world. Having done this, and being in a fine humor after this his first success, he turned to the two ladies. "And this, ladies," said he, taking our hero by the hand and presenting him, "is a young gentleman who has embarked with me to learn the trade of piracy. I recommend him to your politeness."[90]

All this, you should know, didn’t take long, because in less than a minute, three or four pirates came into the cabin. Along with the Portuguese, they immediately tied up the two Spaniards, binding their hands and feet, and gagging them. Once that was done to our buccaneer's satisfaction, and the Spanish captain was stretched out in the corner of the cabin, he quickly wiped the fear off his face, bursting into a loud laugh. He grabbed Sieur Simon's hand and shook it with great enthusiasm. After doing this and feeling cheerful from his first success, he turned to the two ladies. "And this, ladies," he said, taking our hero by the hand and introducing him, "is a young man who has joined me to learn the art of piracy. I trust you will be kind to him."[90]

Think what a confusion this threw our Master Harry into, to be sure, who at his best was never easy in the company of strange ladies! You may suppose what must have been his emotions to find himself thus introduced to the attention of Madam Simon and her daughter, being at the time in his bare feet, clad only in his shirt and breeches, and with no hat upon his head, a pistol in one hand and a cutlass in the other. However, he was not left for long to his embarrassments, for almost immediately after he had thus far relaxed, Captain Morgan fell of a sudden serious again, and bidding the Sieur Simon to get his ladies away into some place of safety, for the most hazardous part of this adventure was yet to occur, he quitted the cabin with Master Harry and the other pirates (for you may call him a pirate now) at his heels.

Think about the mess this threw our Master Harry into, for sure, who was never comfortable around unfamiliar ladies! You can imagine his feelings being suddenly introduced to Madam Simon and her daughter, especially since he was standing there in his bare feet, just wearing a shirt and breeches, without a hat on his head, a pistol in one hand and a cutlass in the other. However, he didn't have to deal with his embarrassment for long, because almost immediately after he relaxed a bit, Captain Morgan grew suddenly serious again. He instructed Sieur Simon to get his ladies somewhere safe, as the most dangerous part of this adventure was still to come, and he left the cabin with Master Harry and the other pirates (since you can now call him a pirate) following behind him.

Having come upon deck, our hero beheld that a part of the Spanish crew were huddled forward in a flock like so many sheep (the others being crowded below with the hatches fastened upon them), and such was the terror of the pirates, and so dreadful the name of Henry Morgan, that not one of those poor wretches dared to lift up his voice to give any alarm, nor even to attempt an escape by jumping overboard.

Having come up on deck, our hero saw that some of the Spanish crew were huddled together in a group like sheep (the others were crammed below with the hatches shut on them), and the pirates' fear, along with the terrifying name of Henry Morgan, was such that not one of those poor souls dared to raise their voice to give any warning, nor even to try to escape by jumping overboard.

At Captain Morgan's orders, these men, together with certain of his own company, ran nimbly aloft and began setting the sails, which, the night now having fallen pretty thick, was not for a good while observed by any of the vessels riding at anchor about them.

At Captain Morgan's orders, these men, along with some from his crew, quickly climbed up and started setting the sails. Since it had gotten quite dark by then, none of the ships anchored nearby noticed for quite a while.

Indeed, the pirates might have made good their escape, with at most only a shot or two from the men-of-war, had it not then been about the full of the moon, which, having arisen, presently discovered to those of the fleet that lay closest about them what was being done aboard the vice admiral.

Indeed, the pirates might have successfully escaped, with only a shot or two fired from the warships, if it hadn't been around the time of the full moon, which, once risen, quickly revealed to those in the fleet nearby what was happening on board the vice admiral's ship.

At this one of the vessels hailed them, and then after a while, having no reply, hailed them again. Even then the Spaniards might not immediately have suspected anything was amiss but[91] only that the vice admiral for some reason best known to himself was shifting his anchorage, had not one of the Spaniards aloft—but who it was Captain Morgan was never able to discover—answered the hail by crying out that the vice admiral had been seized by the pirates.

At this point, one of the ships called out to them, and after a while, receiving no response, called out again. Even then, the Spaniards might not have immediately suspected anything was wrong, but[91] only thought that the vice admiral, for reasons known only to him, was changing his anchor point. However, one of the Spaniards up in the rigging—but who it was, Captain Morgan was never able to find out—answered the call by shouting that the vice admiral had been captured by the pirates.

At this the alarm was instantly given and the mischief done, for presently there was a tremendous bustle through that part of the fleet lying nighest the vice admiral—a deal of shouting of orders, a beating of drums, and the running hither and thither of the crews.

At this, the alarm was quickly raised and the damage was done, because soon there was a huge commotion in that section of the fleet closest to the vice admiral—lots of shouting of orders, drumming, and the crews running back and forth.

But by this time the sails of the vice admiral had filled with a strong land breeze that was blowing up the harbor, whereupon the carpenter, at Captain Morgan's orders, having cut away both anchors, the galleon presently bore away up the harbor, gathering headway every moment with the wind nearly dead astern. The nearest vessel was the only one that for the moment was able to offer any hindrance. This ship, having by this time cleared away one of its guns, was able to fire a parting shot against the vice-admiral, striking her somewhere forward, as our hero could see by a great shower of splinters that flew up in the moonlight.

But by this time, the vice admiral's sails had caught a strong land breeze blowing up the harbor. Following Captain Morgan's orders, the carpenter cut away both anchors, and the galleon soon headed up the harbor, picking up speed with the wind almost directly behind it. The nearest ship was the only one at that moment capable of causing any trouble. This ship had cleared one of its guns by now and managed to fire a parting shot at the vice admiral, hitting her somewhere at the front, as our hero could see from the large spray of splinters that flew up in the moonlight.

At the sound of the shot all the vessels of the flota not yet disturbed by the alarm were aroused at once, so that the pirates had the satisfaction of knowing that they would have to run the gantlet of all the ships between them and the open sea before they could reckon themselves escaped.

At the sound of the shot, all the ships in the fleet that hadn’t been alerted yet were immediately awakened, which meant the pirates knew they would have to fight their way past all the vessels between them and the open sea before they could consider themselves safe.

And, indeed, to our hero's mind it seemed that the battle which followed must have been the most terrific cannonade that was ever heard in the world. It was not so ill at first, for it was some while before the Spaniards could get their guns clear for action, they being not the least in the world prepared for such an occasion as this. But by and by first one and then another ship opened fire upon the galleon, until it seemed to our hero that all the thunders of heaven let loose upon them could not have created[92] a more prodigious uproar, and that it was not possible that they could any of them escape destruction.

And, honestly, to our hero, it felt like the battle that followed was the most intense cannon fire ever heard in the world. At first, it wasn't so bad, because it took the Spaniards a while to get their guns ready for action—they weren’t at all prepared for something like this. But eventually, one ship after another started firing at the galleon, until our hero thought that no amount of thunder from heaven could have created a more massive uproar, and there was no way any of them could escape destruction.

BURNING THE SHIP burning the ships

By now the moon had risen full and round, so that the clouds of smoke that rose in the air appeared as white as snow. The air seemed full of the hiss and screaming of shot, each one of which, when it struck the galleon, was magnified by our hero's imagination into ten times its magnitude from the crash which it delivered and from the cloud of splinters it would cast up into the moonlight. At last he suddenly beheld one poor man knocked sprawling across the deck, who, as he raised his arm from behind the mast, disclosed that the hand was gone from it, and that the shirt sleeve was red with blood in the moonlight. At this sight all the strength fell away from poor Harry, and he felt sure that a like fate or even a worse must be in store for him.

By now, the moon was bright and full, and the clouds of smoke rising in the air looked as white as snow. The air was filled with the hissing and screaming of gunfire, each shot that hit the galleon magnified in our hero's imagination to ten times its size, thanks to the crash it made and the shower of splinters it sent flying into the moonlight. Suddenly, he spotted a poor man thrown across the deck, who, when he raised his arm from behind the mast, revealed that his hand was missing and his shirt sleeve was soaked in blood in the moonlight. Seeing this, all the strength left poor Harry, and he felt certain that he was destined for a similar fate, or perhaps even a worse one.

But, after all, this was nothing to what it might have been in broad daylight, for what with the darkness of night, and the little preparation the Spaniards could make for such a business, and the extreme haste with which they discharged their guns (many not understanding what was the occasion of all this uproar), nearly all the shot flew so wide of the mark that not above one in twenty struck that at which it was aimed.

But, really, this was nothing compared to what it could have been in broad daylight. With the darkness of night, the limited preparation the Spaniards could manage for this situation, and the frantic speed with which they fired their guns (many not knowing what all the fuss was about), almost all the shots missed their target, with only one in twenty hitting what it was aimed at.

Meantime Captain Morgan, with the Sieur Simon, who had followed him upon deck, stood just above where our hero lay behind the shelter of the bulwark. The captain had lit a pipe of tobacco, and he stood now in the bright moonlight close to the rail, with his hands behind him, looking out ahead with the utmost coolness imaginable, and paying no more attention to the din of battle than though it were twenty leagues away. Now and then he would take his pipe from his lips to utter an order to the man at the wheel. Excepting this he stood there hardly moving at all, the wind blowing his long red hair over his shoulders.

In the meantime, Captain Morgan, along with Sieur Simon, who had followed him onto the deck, stood just above where our hero lay behind the protection of the bulwark. The captain had lit a tobacco pipe and was now standing in the bright moonlight near the rail, with his hands behind him, looking out ahead with complete calmness, paying no more attention to the chaos of battle than if it were twenty leagues away. Occasionally, he would take his pipe out of his mouth to give an order to the man at the wheel. Other than that, he remained mostly still, with the wind blowing his long red hair over his shoulders.

Had it not been for the armed galley the pirates might have got the galleon away with no great harm done in spite of all this [93]cannonading, for the man-of-war which rode at anchor nighest to them at the mouth of the harbor was still so far away that they might have passed it by hugging pretty close to the shore, and that without any great harm being done to them in the darkness. But just at this moment, when the open water lay in sight, came this galley pulling out from behind the point of the shore in such a manner as either to head our pirates off entirely or else to compel them to approach so near to the man-of-war that that latter vessel could bring its guns to bear with more effect.

If it hadn't been for the armed galley, the pirates might have escaped with the galleon without much trouble despite all the cannon fire. The warship anchored closest to them at the harbor entrance was still far enough away that they could have slipped past by staying close to the shore, without much risk in the darkness. But just at that moment, as the open water came into view, the galley appeared, coming out from behind the shore in a way that would either block the pirates completely or force them to get so close to the warship that it could aim its guns more effectively.

This galley, I must tell you, was like others of its kind such as you may find in these waters, the hull being long and cut low to the water so as to allow the oars to dip freely. The bow was sharp and projected far out ahead, mounting a swivel upon it, while at the stern a number of galleries built one above another into a castle gave shelter to several companies of musketeers as well as the officers commanding them.

This galley was like other ones you’d find in these waters, with a long hull designed to sit low in the water, allowing the oars to move freely. The bow was sharp and extended out ahead, with a swivel mounted on it, while the stern featured multiple galleries stacked like a castle, providing cover for several groups of musketeers and their commanding officers.

Our hero could behold the approach of this galley from above the starboard bulwarks, and it appeared to him impossible for them to hope to escape either it or the man-of-war. But still Captain Morgan maintained the same composure that he had exhibited all the while, only now and then delivering an order to the man at the wheel, who, putting the helm over, threw the bows of the galleon around more to the larboard, as though to escape the bow of the galley and get into the open water beyond. This course brought the pirates ever closer and closer to the man-of-war, which now began to add its thunder to the din of the battle, and with so much more effect that at every discharge you might hear the crashing and crackling of splintered wood, and now and then the outcry or groaning of some man who was hurt. Indeed, had it been daylight, they must at this juncture all have perished, though, as was said, what with the night and the confusion and the hurry, they escaped entire destruction, though more by a miracle than through any policy upon their own part.[94]

Our hero could see the approaching galley from above the starboard side, and it seemed impossible for them to escape either it or the warship. But Captain Morgan remained as calm as he had been all along, occasionally giving orders to the helmsman, who adjusted the wheel to turn the galleon's bow more towards the port side, trying to evade the galley's front and reach the open water ahead. This maneuver brought the pirates closer to the warship, which began to add its booming fire to the chaos of battle, with such impact that each shot made the wood splinter and crack, and occasionally, you could hear the cries or groans of injured men. In fact, if it had been daylight, they would have surely perished at that moment. However, because of the night, the confusion, and the rush, they managed to escape complete destruction, more through luck than any strategy on their part.[94]

Meantime the galley, steering as though to come aboard of them, had now come so near that it, too, presently began to open its musketry fire upon them, so that the humming and rattling of bullets were presently added to the din of cannonading.

Meanwhile, the galley, heading straight for them, had gotten so close that it also started firing its guns at them, adding the sound of bullets buzzing and clattering to the noise of the cannon fire.

In two minutes more it would have been aboard of them, when in a moment Captain Morgan roared out of a sudden to the man at the helm to put it hard a starboard. In response the man ran the wheel over with the utmost quickness, and the galleon, obeying her helm very readily, came around upon a course which, if continued, would certainly bring them into collision with their enemy.

In two more minutes, it would have been on them, when suddenly Captain Morgan shouted to the man at the helm to turn it hard to starboard. The man quickly spun the wheel, and the galleon, responding to the commands, turned onto a course that would definitely lead to a collision with their enemy if they continued.

It is possible at first the Spaniards imagined the pirates intended to escape past their stern, for they instantly began backing oars to keep them from getting past, so that the water was all of a foam about them; at the same time they did this they poured in such a fire of musketry that it was a miracle that no more execution was accomplished than happened.

At first, the Spaniards might have thought the pirates were trying to slip past them, so they quickly started rowing backward to block their way, creating a lot of foam in the water around them. At the same time, they launched a barrage of gunfire, and it was surprising that more damage wasn't done than what actually occurred.

As for our hero, methinks for the moment he forgot all about everything else than as to whether or no his captain's maneuver would succeed, for in the very first moment he divined, as by some instinct, what Captain Morgan purposed doing.

As for our hero, I think for the moment he forgot everything else except whether his captain's maneuver would succeed, because in that very first moment he instinctively figured out what Captain Morgan was planning to do.

At this moment, so particular in the execution of this nice design, a bullet suddenly struck down the man at the wheel. Hearing the sharp outcry, our Harry turned to see him fall forward, and then to his hands and knees upon the deck, the blood running in a black pool beneath him, while the wheel, escaping from his hands, spun over until the spokes were all of a mist.

At that moment, crucial to carrying out this delicate plan, a bullet suddenly hit the man at the wheel. Hearing the sharp scream, Harry turned to see him collapse forward, then onto his hands and knees on the deck, blood pooling in a dark puddle beneath him, while the wheel slipped from his grip and spun until the spokes became a blur.

In a moment the ship would have fallen off before the wind had not our hero, leaping to the wheel (even as Captain Morgan shouted an order for some one to do so), seized the flying spokes, whirling them back again, and so bringing the bow of the galleon up to its former course.

In a moment, the ship would have been thrown off course by the wind if our hero hadn't jumped to the wheel (just as Captain Morgan yelled for someone to do it), grabbed the spinning spokes, turned them back, and brought the bow of the galleon back on track.

In the first moment of this effort he had reckoned of nothing[95] but of carrying out his captain's designs. He neither thought of cannon balls nor of bullets. But now that his task was accomplished, he came suddenly back to himself to find the galleries of the galley aflame with musket shots, and to become aware with a most horrible sinking of the spirits that all the shots therefrom were intended for him. He cast his eyes about him with despair, but no one came to ease him of his task, which, having undertaken, he had too much spirit to resign from carrying through to the end, though he was well aware that the very next instant might mean his sudden and violent death. His ears hummed and rang, and his brain swam as light as a feather. I know not whether he breathed, but he shut his eyes tight as though that might save him from the bullets that were raining about him.

In the first moment of this effort, he focused only on carrying out his captain's plans. He didn't think about cannonballs or bullets. But now that his task was done, he suddenly snapped back to reality and found the gallery of the ship ablaze with musket fire, becoming acutely aware with a terrifying feeling that all those shots were aimed at him. He looked around in despair, but no one came to relieve him of his duty, which he had committed to seeing through to the end, despite knowing that the next moment could bring his sudden and violent death. His ears buzzed, and his mind felt light and dizzy. I don’t know if he even breathed, but he shut his eyes tight, as if that might somehow protect him from the bullets that were falling around him.

At this moment the Spaniards must have discovered for the first time the pirates' design, for of a sudden they ceased firing, and[96] began to shout out a multitude of orders, while the oars lashed the water all about with a foam. But it was too late then for them to escape, for within a couple of seconds the galleon struck her enemy a blow so violent upon the larboard quarter as nearly to hurl our Harry upon the deck, and then with a dreadful, horrible crackling of wood, commingled with a yelling of men's voices, the galley was swung around upon her side, and the galleon, sailing into the open sea, left nothing of her immediate enemy but a sinking wreck, and the water dotted all over with bobbing heads and waving hands in the moonlight.

At that moment, the Spaniards must have realized the pirates' plan for the first time, because suddenly they stopped firing and[96] began shouting a flurry of orders, while the oars splashed the water around with foam. But it was too late for them to escape, because within seconds, the galleon struck its enemy with such force on the left side that it nearly knocked Harry onto the deck. Then, with a dreadful, horrible cracking of wood, mixed with the shouts of men, the galley tipped over onto its side, and the galleon sailed into the open sea, leaving nothing of its immediate enemy but a sinking wreck and the water filled with bobbing heads and waving hands in the moonlight.

And now, indeed, that all danger was past and gone, there were plenty to come running to help our hero at the wheel. As for Captain Morgan, having come down upon the main deck, he fetches the young helmsman a clap upon the back. "Well, Master Harry," says he, "and did I not tell you I would make a man of you?" Whereat our poor Harry fell a-laughing, but with a sad catch in his voice, for his hands trembled as with an ague, and were as cold as ice. As for his emotions, God knows he was nearer crying than laughing, if Captain Morgan had but known it.

And now that all the danger was over, there were plenty of people rushing to help our hero at the wheel. Captain Morgan, having come down to the main deck, gave the young helmsman a pat on the back. "Well, Master Harry," he said, "didn't I tell you I would make a man of you?" Poor Harry laughed, but there was a sad catch in his voice, as his hands trembled like he had chills, and they were as cold as ice. As for his feelings, God knows he was closer to crying than laughing if Captain Morgan had only known.

Nevertheless, though undertaken under the spur of the moment, I protest it was indeed a brave deed, and I cannot but wonder how many young gentlemen of sixteen there are to-day who, upon a like occasion, would act as well as our Harry.

Nevertheless, even though it was done on a whim, I insist it was truly a brave act, and I can't help but wonder how many sixteen-year-old young men today would act as commendably as our Harry.

V

The balance of our hero's adventures were of a lighter sort than those already recounted, for the next morning the Spanish captain (a very polite and well-bred gentleman) having fitted him out with a shift of his own clothes, Master Harry was presented in a proper form to the ladies. For Captain Morgan, if he had felt a liking for the young man before, could not now show sufficient regard for him. He ate in the great cabin and was petted by all. Madam Simon, who was a fat and red-faced lady, was forever praising him,[97] and the young miss, who was extremely well-looking, was as continually making eyes at him.

The remainder of our hero's adventures was lighter than the ones we've already discussed, because the next morning, the Spanish captain (a very polite and well-mannered gentleman) dressed him in a change of his own clothes, and Master Harry was properly introduced to the ladies. Captain Morgan, who had liked the young man before, now showed even more respect for him. He dined in the grand cabin and was adored by everyone. Madam Simon, a plump and red-faced lady, constantly praised him,[97] and the young lady, who was quite beautiful, kept making eyes at him.

She and Master Harry, I must tell you, would spend hours together, she making pretense of teaching him French, although he was so possessed with a passion of love that he was nigh suffocated with it. She, upon her part, perceiving his emotions, responded with extreme good nature and complacency, so that had our hero been older, and the voyage proved longer, he might have become entirely enmeshed in the toils of his fair siren. For all this while, you are to understand, the pirates were making sail straight for Jamaica, which they reached upon the third day in perfect safety.

She and Master Harry, I have to say, would spend hours together, with her pretending to teach him French, even though he was so overwhelmed with love that he could barely think. She, for her part, noticing his feelings, responded with kindness and ease, so that if our hero had been older and the journey had lasted longer, he might have gotten completely caught up in the charms of his lovely siren. Meanwhile, you should know that the pirates were sailing straight for Jamaica, which they reached safely on the third day.

In that time, however, the pirates had well-nigh gone crazy for joy; for when they came to examine their purchase they discovered her cargo to consist of plate to the prodigious sum of £130,000 in value. 'Twas a wonder they did not all make themselves drunk for joy. No doubt they would have done so had not Captain Morgan, knowing they were still in the exact track of the Spanish fleets, threatened them that the first man among them who touched a drop of rum without his permission he would shoot him dead upon the deck. This threat had such effect that they all remained entirely sober until they had reached Port Royal Harbor, which they did about nine o'clock in the morning.

At that moment, though, the pirates were almost out of their minds with joy; when they finally looked at their treasure, they found that the cargo was worth an astonishing £130,000 in silver. It was a miracle they didn’t all get drunk with happiness. No doubt they would have if Captain Morgan hadn’t warned them that since they were still in the direct path of the Spanish fleets, he would shoot the first one of them who touched a drop of rum without his permission. This threat had such an impact that they all stayed completely sober until they reached Port Royal Harbor, which they did around nine o'clock in the morning.

And now it was that our hero's romance came all tumbling down about his ears with a run. For they had hardly come to anchor in the harbor when a boat came from a man-of-war, and who should come stepping aboard but Lieutenant Grantley (a particular friend of our hero's father) and his own eldest brother Thomas, who, putting on a very stern face, informed Master Harry that he was a desperate and hardened villain who was sure to end at the gallows, and that he was to go immediately back to his home again. He told our embryo[98] pirate that his family had nigh gone distracted because of his wicked and ungrateful conduct. Nor could our hero move him from his inflexible purpose. "What," says our Harry, "and will you not then let me wait until our prize is divided and I get my share?"

And now our hero's romance was crashing down around him in an instant. They had barely docked in the harbor when a boat came from a warship, and stepping aboard was Lieutenant Grantley (a close friend of our hero's father) along with his older brother Thomas, who, wearing a very serious expression, told Master Harry that he was a desperate and hardened villain destined for the gallows, and that he had to return home immediately. He informed our budding pirate that his family was nearly driven to distraction because of his wicked and ungrateful behavior. Our hero couldn't convince him to change his mind. "What," said our Harry, "won't you at least let me wait until we divide the prize and I get my share?"

"Prize, indeed!" says his brother. "And do you then really think that your father would consent to your having a share in this terrible bloody and murthering business?"

"Prize, really!" says his brother. "Do you honestly believe that your father would agree to you being involved in this horrific, bloody, and murderous business?"

And so, after a good deal of argument, our hero was constrained to go; nor did he even have an opportunity to bid adieu to his inamorata. Nor did he see her any more, except from a distance, she standing on the poop deck as he was rowed away from her, her face all stained with crying. For himself, he felt that there was no more joy in life; nevertheless, standing up in the stern of the boat, he made shift, though with an aching heart, to deliver her a fine bow with the hat he had borrowed from the Spanish captain, before his brother bade him sit down again.

And so, after a lot of arguing, our hero had to leave; he didn’t even get a chance to say goodbye to his love. He only saw her again from a distance, standing on the upper deck as he was rowed away, her face all wet from crying. For him, it felt like there was no more joy in life; still, standing in the back of the boat, he managed, even with a heavy heart, to give her a nice bow with the hat he had borrowed from the Spanish captain, before his brother told him to sit down again.

And so to the ending of this story, with only this to relate, that our Master Harry, so far from going to the gallows, became in good time a respectable and wealthy sugar merchant with an English wife and a fine family of children, whereunto, when the mood was upon him, he has sometimes told these adventures (and sundry others not here recounted), as I have told them unto you.

And so we come to the end of this story, with just this to share: our Master Harry, far from facing the gallows, eventually became a respectable and wealthy sugar merchant with an English wife and a lovely family of children. When he felt like it, he would sometimes share these adventures (and various others not mentioned here), just as I have shared them with you.


Chapter IV

TOM CHIST AND THE TREASURE BOX

An Old-time Story of the Days of Captain Kidd

I

T

o tell about Tom Chist, and how he got his name, and how he came to be living at the little settlement of Henlopen, just inside the mouth of the Delaware Bay, the story must begin as far back as 1686, when a great storm swept the Atlantic coast from end to end. During the heaviest part of the hurricane a bark went ashore on the Hen-and-Chicken Shoals, just below Cape Henlopen and at the mouth of the Delaware Bay, and Tom Chist was the only soul of all those on board the ill-fated vessel who escaped alive.

To tell the story of Tom Chist, how he got his name, and how he ended up living in the small settlement of Henlopen, right at the entrance of Delaware Bay, we need to go back to 1686, when a massive storm hit the Atlantic coast from one end to the other. During the peak of the hurricane, a ship ran aground on the Hen-and-Chicken Shoals, just south of Cape Henlopen and at the mouth of Delaware Bay, and Tom Chist was the only person on that doomed vessel who survived.

This story must first be told, because it was on account of the strange and miraculous escape that happened to him at that time that he gained the name that was given to him.

This story needs to be told first, because it was due to the strange and miraculous escape he experienced at that time that he received the name that was given to him.

Even as late as that time of the American colonies, the little scattered settlement at Henlopen, made up of English, with a few Dutch and Swedish people, was still only a spot upon the face of the great American wilderness that spread away, with swamp[100] and forest, no man knew how far to the westward. That wilderness was not only full of wild beasts, but of Indian savages, who every fall would come in wandering tribes to spend the winter along the shores of the fresh-water lakes below Henlopen. There for four or five months they would live upon fish and clams and wild ducks and geese, chipping their arrowheads, and making their earthenware pots and pans under the lee of the sand hills and pine woods below the Capes.

Even during the time of the American colonies, the small, scattered settlement at Henlopen, made up of English people along with a few Dutch and Swedish individuals, was just a tiny spot in the vast American wilderness that stretched away, filled with swamps[100] and forests, the extent of which no one could determine to the west. This wilderness was not just home to wild animals, but also to Native American tribes, who would arrive every fall in wandering groups to spend the winter along the shores of the fresh-water lakes near Henlopen. There, for four or five months, they would survive on fish, clams, wild ducks, and geese, crafting their arrowheads and making their pottery under the protection of the sand hills and pine forests below the Capes.

Sometimes on Sundays, when the Rev. Hillary Jones would be preaching in the little log church back in the woods, these half-clad red savages would come in from the cold, and sit squatting in the back part of the church, listening stolidly to the words that had no meaning for them.

Sometimes on Sundays, when Rev. Hillary Jones was preaching in the small log church deep in the woods, these half-naked Native Americans would come in from the cold and squat in the back of the church, listening expressionlessly to words that held no meaning for them.

But about the wreck of the bark in 1686. Such a wreck as that which then went ashore on the Hen-and-Chicken Shoals was a godsend to the poor and needy settlers in the wilderness where so few good things ever came. For the vessel went to pieces during the night, and the next morning the beach was strewn with wreckage—boxes and barrels, chests and spars, timbers and planks, a plentiful and bountiful harvest to be gathered up by the settlers as they chose, with no one to forbid or prevent them.

But about the shipwreck in 1686. A wreck like the one that washed ashore on the Hen-and-Chicken Shoals was a blessing for the poor and needy settlers in the wilderness where so few good things ever came. The ship broke apart during the night, and by the next morning, the beach was covered with debris—boxes and barrels, chests and beams, timber and planks, a plentiful and generous bounty for the settlers to collect as they wished, with no one to stop or discourage them.

The name of the bark, as found painted on some of the water barrels and sea chests, was the Bristol Merchant, and she no doubt hailed from England.

The name of the ship, as seen painted on some of the water barrels and sea chests, was the Bristol Merchant, and she definitely came from England.

As was said, the only soul who escaped alive off the wreck was Tom Chist.

As mentioned, the only person who survived the wreck was Tom Chist.

A settler, a fisherman named Matt Abrahamson, and his daughter Molly, found Tom. He was washed up on the beach among the wreckage, in a great wooden box which had been securely tied around with a rope and lashed between two spars—apparently for better protection in beating through the surf. Matt Abrahamson thought he had found something of more than usual value when he came upon this chest; but when he cut the cords[101] and broke open the box with his broadax, he could not have been more astonished had he beheld a salamander instead of a baby of nine or ten months old lying half smothered in the blankets that covered the bottom of the chest.

A settler, a fisherman named Matt Abrahamson, and his daughter Molly found Tom. He was washed up on the beach among the wreckage, in a large wooden box that had been securely tied with a rope and strapped between two poles—apparently for better protection in the rough surf. Matt Abrahamson thought he had discovered something unusually valuable when he came across this chest; but when he cut the cords[101] and broke open the box with his broadax, he could not have been more shocked had he found a salamander instead of a baby about nine or ten months old lying half smothered in the blankets at the bottom of the chest.

Matt Abrahamson's daughter Molly had had a baby who had died a month or so before. So when she saw the little one lying there in the bottom of the chest, she cried out in a great loud voice that the Good Man had sent her another baby in place of her own.

Matt Abrahamson's daughter Molly had a baby who passed away about a month ago. So when she saw the little one lying at the bottom of the chest, she cried out loudly that the Good Man had sent her another baby in place of her own.

The rain was driving before the hurricane storm in dim, slanting sheets, and so she wrapped up the baby in the man's coat she wore and ran off home without waiting to gather up any more of the wreckage.

The rain was pouring down in dark, slanting sheets before the hurricane, so she wrapped the baby in the man’s coat she was wearing and hurried home without bothering to pick up any more of the mess.

It was Parson Jones who gave the foundling his name. When the news came to his ears of what Matt Abrahamson had found he went over to the fisherman's cabin to see the child. He examined the clothes in which the baby was dressed. They were of fine linen and handsomely stitched, and the reverend gentleman opined that the foundling's parents must have been of quality. A kerchief had been wrapped around the baby's neck and under its arms and tied behind, and in the corner, marked with very fine needlework, were the initials T. C.

It was Parson Jones who named the foundling. When he heard about what Matt Abrahamson had discovered, he went over to the fisherman’s cabin to see the child. He looked at the clothes the baby was wearing. They were made of fine linen and beautifully stitched, and the reverend believed that the foundling’s parents must have been well-off. A kerchief had been wrapped around the baby’s neck and under its arms, tied in the back, and in the corner, marked with very delicate needlework, were the initials T. C.

"What d'ye call him, Molly?" said Parson Jones. He was standing, as he spoke, with his back to the fire, warming his palms before the blaze. The pocket of the greatcoat he wore bulged out with a big case bottle of spirits which he had gathered up out of the wreck that afternoon. "What d'ye call him, Molly?"

"What do you call him, Molly?" said Parson Jones. He was standing, as he spoke, with his back to the fire, warming his palms before the flames. The pocket of the greatcoat he wore was bulging with a large bottle of alcohol that he had picked up from the wreck earlier that afternoon. "What do you call him, Molly?"

"I'll call him Tom, after my own baby."

"I'll call him Tom, after my own baby."

"That goes very well with the initial on the kerchief," said Parson Jones. "But what other name d'ye give him? Let it be something to go with the C."

"That works great with the initial on the handkerchief," said Parson Jones. "But what other name do you want to give him? It should be something that matches the C."

"I don't know," said Molly.

"I don't know," Molly said.

"Why not call him 'Chist,' since he was born in a chist out of the sea? 'Tom Chist'—the name goes off like a flash in the pan."[102] And so "Tom Chist" he was called and "Tom Chist" he was christened.

"Why not call him 'Chist,' since he was born in a chist from the sea? 'Tom Chist'—the name sounds like a flash in the pan."[102] And so he was called "Tom Chist" and that was the name he was baptized with.

So much for the beginning of the history of Tom Chist. The story of Captain Kidd's treasure box does not begin until the late spring of 1699.

So much for the start of Tom Chist's story. The tale of Captain Kidd's treasure box doesn't kick off until late spring of 1699.

That was the year that the famous pirate captain, coming up from the West Indies, sailed his sloop into the Delaware Bay, where he lay for over a month waiting for news from his friends in New York.

That was the year when the famous pirate captain, coming from the West Indies, sailed his sloop into Delaware Bay, where he stayed for more than a month waiting for news from his friends in New York.

For he had sent word to that town asking if the coast was clear for him to return home with the rich prize he had brought from the Indian seas and the coast of Africa, and meantime he lay there in the Delaware Bay waiting for a reply. Before he left he turned the whole of Tom Chist's life topsy-turvy with something that he brought ashore.

For he had sent a message to that town asking if it was safe for him to return home with the valuable treasure he had brought from the Indian seas and the coast of Africa, and in the meantime, he was lying there in Delaware Bay waiting for a response. Before he left, he turned Tom Chist's life completely upside down with something he had brought ashore.

By that time Tom Chist had grown into a strong-limbed, thick-jointed boy of fourteen or fifteen years of age. It was a miserable dog's life he lived with old Matt Abrahamson, for the old fisherman was in his cups more than half the time, and when he was so there was hardly a day passed that he did not give Tom a curse or a buffet or, as like as not, an actual beating. One would have thought that such treatment would have broken the spirit of the poor little foundling, but it had just the opposite effect upon Tom Chist, who was one of your stubborn, sturdy, stiff-willed fellows who only grow harder and more tough the more they are ill-treated. It had been a long time now since he had made any outcry or complaint at the hard usage he suffered from old Matt. At such times he would shut his teeth and bear whatever came to him, until sometimes the half-drunken old man would be driven almost mad by his stubborn silence. Maybe he would stop in the midst of the beating he was administering, and, grinding his teeth, would cry out: "Won't ye say naught? Won't ye say naught? Well, then, I'll see if I can't make ye say naught." When things had[103] reached such a pass as this Molly would generally interfere to protect her foster son, and then she and Tom would together fight the old man until they had wrenched the stick or the strap out of his hand. Then old Matt would chase them out of doors and around and around the house for maybe half an hour, until his anger was cool, when he would go back again, and for a time the storm would be over.

By that time, Tom Chist had grown into a strong, sturdy boy around fourteen or fifteen years old. He lived a rough life with old Matt Abrahamson, since the old fisherman was drunk more than half the time, and when he was, there was hardly a day when he didn't curse Tom, hit him, or, more often than not, actually beat him. You’d think such treatment would have broken the spirit of the poor kid, but it had the opposite effect on Tom Chist, who was one of those stubborn, tough-minded guys who just get harder and more resilient the more they’re mistreated. It had been a long time since he’d made any noise or complaint about the rough treatment he faced from old Matt. During those times, he'd grit his teeth and endure whatever came his way, until sometimes the half-drunk old man would be driven nearly mad by his stubborn silence. He might stop in the middle of a beating and, grinding his teeth, shout, “Aren’t you going to say anything? Aren’t you going to say anything? Well then, let’s see if I can make you say something.” When things had[103] gotten to that point, Molly would usually step in to protect her foster son, and then she and Tom would fight the old man together until they managed to wrest the stick or strap from his hands. After that, old Matt would chase them outside, running around the house for maybe half an hour until he calmed down, and then the storm would pass for a while.

Besides his foster mother, Tom Chist had a very good friend in Parson Jones, who used to come over every now and then to Abrahamson's hut upon the chance of getting a half dozen fish for breakfast. He always had a kind word or two for Tom, who during the winter evenings would go over to the good man's house to learn his letters, and to read and write and cipher a little, so that by now he was able to spell the words out of the Bible and the almanac, and knew enough to change tuppence into four ha'pennies.

Besides his foster mother, Tom Chist had a great friend in Parson Jones, who would drop by Abrahamson's hut now and then hoping to get a few fish for breakfast. He always had a kind word or two for Tom, who during the winter evenings would head over to the good man's house to learn his letters, and to read, write, and do a bit of math, so by now he could spell words from the Bible and the almanac and knew enough to change two pence into four halfpennies.

This is the sort of boy Tom Chist was, and this is the sort of life he led.

This is the kind of boy Tom Chist was, and this is the kind of life he lived.

In the late spring or early summer of 1699 Captain Kidd's sloop sailed into the mouth of the Delaware Bay and changed the whole fortune of his life.

In late spring or early summer of 1699, Captain Kidd's sloop sailed into the Delaware Bay and changed the entire course of his life.

And this is how you come to the story of Captain Kidd's treasure box.

And this is how you get to the story of Captain Kidd's treasure chest.

II

Old Matt Abrahamson kept the flat-bottomed boat in which he went fishing some distance down the shore, and in the neighborhood of the old wreck that had been sunk on the Shoals. This was the usual fishing ground of the settlers, and here old Matt's boat generally lay drawn up on the sand.

Old Matt Abrahamson kept the flat-bottomed boat he used for fishing a bit down the shore, near the old wreck that had sunk in the shallow waters. This was the regular fishing spot for the settlers, and it was where old Matt's boat usually rested on the sand.

There had been a thunderstorm that afternoon, and Tom had gone down the beach to bale out the boat in readiness for the morning's fishing.

There had been a thunderstorm that afternoon, and Tom had gone down to the beach to bail out the boat in preparation for the next morning's fishing.

It was full moonlight now, as he was returning, and the night sky was full of floating clouds. Now and then there was a dull[104] flash to the westward, and once a muttering growl of thunder, promising another storm to come.

It was a full moon night as he was coming back, and the night sky was filled with drifting clouds. Occasionally, there was a faint flash to the west, and once a low rumble of thunder, hinting at another storm on the way.

WHO SHALL BE CAPTAIN? who will be captain?

All that day the pirate sloop had been lying just off the shore back of the Capes, and now Tom Chist could see the sails glimmering pallidly in the moonlight, spread for drying after the storm. He was walking up the shore homeward when he became aware that at some distance ahead of him there was a ship's boat drawn up on the little narrow beach, and a group of men clustered about it. He hurried forward with a good deal of curiosity to see who had landed, but it was not until he had come close to them that he could distinguish who and what they were. Then he knew that it must be a party who had come off the pirate sloop. They had evidently just landed, and two men were lifting out a chest from the boat. One of them was a negro, naked to the waist, and the other was a white man in his shirt sleeves, wearing petticoat breeches, a Monterey cap upon his head, a red bandanna handkerchief around his neck, and gold earrings in his ears. He had a long, plaited queue hanging down his back, and a great sheath knife dangling from his side. Another man, evidently the captain of the party, stood at a little distance as they lifted the chest out of the boat. He had a cane in one hand and a lighted lantern in the other, although the moon was shining as bright as day. He wore jack boots and a handsome laced coat, and he had a long, drooping mustache that curled down below his chin. He wore a fine, feathered hat, and his long black hair hung down upon his shoulders.

All that day, the pirate sloop had been anchored just off the shore behind the Capes, and now Tom Chist could see the sails glowing faintly in the moonlight, spread out to dry after the storm. He was walking up the shore on his way home when he noticed a ship's boat pulled up on the narrow little beach, with a group of men gathered around it. He hurried forward, curious to see who had arrived, but it wasn't until he got closer that he could tell who they were. Then he realized it must be a group that had come off the pirate sloop. They had clearly just landed, and two men were unloading a chest from the boat. One of them was a Black man, bare-chested, and the other was a white man in his shirt sleeves, wearing petticoat breeches, a Monterey cap on his head, a red bandanna around his neck, and gold earrings in his ears. He had a long, braided queue hanging down his back and a large sheath knife hanging at his side. Another man, clearly the captain of the group, stood a little distance away as they lifted the chest out of the boat. He held a cane in one hand and a lit lantern in the other, even though the moon was shining as bright as day. He wore jack boots and a stylish laced coat, and had a long, drooping mustache that curled down below his chin. His fine, feathered hat perched on his head, and his long black hair cascaded down onto his shoulders.

All this Tom Chist could see in the moonlight that glinted and twinkled upon the gilt buttons of his coat.

All this Tom Chist could see in the moonlight that shone and sparkled on the gold buttons of his coat.

They were so busy lifting the chest from the boat that at first they did not observe that Tom Chist had come up and was standing there. It was the white man with the long, plaited queue and the gold earrings that spoke to him. "Boy, what do you want here, boy?" he said, in a rough, hoarse voice. "Where d'ye come from?" And then dropping his end of the chest, and [105]without giving Tom time to answer, he pointed off down the beach, and said, "You'd better be going about your own business, if you know what's good for you; and don't you come back, or you'll find what you don't want waiting for you."

They were so busy lifting the chest from the boat that at first they didn’t notice Tom Chist had come up and was standing there. It was the white guy with the long, braided hair and gold earrings who spoke to him. "Kid, what do you want here?" he said in a rough, raspy voice. "Where did you come from?" Then, without waiting for Tom to answer, he dropped his end of the chest, pointed down the beach, and said, "You’d better go take care of your own business if you know what's good for you; and don’t come back, or you’ll find what you don’t want waiting for you."

Tom saw in a glance that the pirates were all looking at him, and then, without saying a word, he turned and walked away. The man who had spoken to him followed him threateningly for some little distance, as though to see that he had gone away as he was bidden to do. But presently he stopped, and Tom hurried on alone, until the boat and the crew and all were dropped away behind and lost in the moonlight night. Then he himself stopped also, turned, and looked back whence he had come.

Tom noticed immediately that the pirates were all staring at him, and then, without saying anything, he turned and walked away. The man who had spoken to him followed him menacingly for a short distance, as if to make sure he left as instructed. But soon he stopped, and Tom hurried on by himself until the boat and the crew vanished behind him, swallowed by the moonlit night. Then he too stopped, turned, and looked back at where he had come from.

There had been something very strange in the appearance of the men he had just seen, something very mysterious in their actions, and he wondered what it all meant, and what they were going to do. He stood for a little while thus looking and listening. He could see nothing, and could hear only the sound of distant talking. What were they doing on the lonely shore thus at night? Then, following a sudden impulse, he turned and cut off across the sand hummocks, skirting around inland, but keeping pretty close to the shore, his object being to spy upon them, and to watch what they were about from the back of the low sand hills that fronted the beach.

There was something really odd about the men he had just seen, something mysterious in their behavior, and he wondered what it all meant and what they were planning to do. He stood there for a moment, looking and listening. He couldn’t see anything and could only hear the faint sound of distant voices. What were they doing on the empty shore at night? Then, on a sudden impulse, he turned and made his way across the sand dunes, staying close to the shore while moving inland, aiming to sneak up on them and see what they were up to from behind the low sand hills that lined the beach.

He had gone along some distance in his circuitous return when he became aware of the sound of voices that seemed to be drawing closer to him as he came toward the speakers. He stopped and stood listening, and instantly, as he stopped, the voices stopped also. He crouched there silently in the bright, glimmering moonlight, surrounded by the silent stretches of sand, and the stillness seemed to press upon him like a heavy hand. Then suddenly the sound of a man's voice began again, and as Tom listened he could hear some one slowly counting. "Ninety-one," the voice began, "ninety-two, ninety-three, ninety-four, ninety-five, ninety-six,[106] ninety-seven, ninety-eight, ninety-nine, one hundred, one hundred and one"—the slow, monotonous count coming nearer and nearer; "one hundred and two, one hundred and three, one hundred and four," and so on in its monotonous reckoning.

He had walked quite a way on his winding path back when he noticed voices that seemed to be getting closer as he moved toward the speakers. He stopped and listened, and right when he stopped, the voices ceased as well. He crouched silently in the bright, shimmering moonlight, surrounded by the quiet stretches of sand, and the stillness felt like a heavy weight on him. Then, suddenly, a man's voice started up again, and as Tom listened, he could hear someone slowly counting. "Ninety-one," the voice began, "ninety-two, ninety-three, ninety-four, ninety-five, ninety-six,[106] ninety-seven, ninety-eight, ninety-nine, one hundred, one hundred and one"—the slow, monotonous count coming closer and closer; "one hundred and two, one hundred and three, one hundred and four," and so on in its repetitive rhythm.

Suddenly he saw three heads appear above the sand hill, so close to him that he crouched down quickly with a keen thrill, close beside the hummock near which he stood. His first fear was that they might have seen him in the moonlight; but they had not, and his heart rose again as the counting voice went steadily on. "One hundred and twenty," it was saying—"and twenty-one, and twenty-two, and twenty-three, and twenty-four," and then he who was counting came out from behind the little sandy rise into the white and open level of shimmering brightness.

Suddenly, he saw three heads pop up above the sand dune, so close to him that he quickly crouched down beside the small mound where he stood, filled with a sharp thrill. His first worry was that they might have spotted him in the moonlight, but they hadn’t, and his heart lifted again as the counting voice continued steadily. "One hundred and twenty," it said—"and twenty-one, and twenty-two, and twenty-three, and twenty-four," and then the person counting moved out from behind the little sandy rise into the bright, open expanse of shimmering light.

It was the man with the cane whom Tom had seen some time before—the captain of the party who had landed. He carried his cane under his arm now, and was holding his lantern close to something that he held in his hand, and upon which he looked narrowly as he walked with a slow and measured tread in a perfectly straight line across the sand, counting each step as he took it. "And twenty-five, and twenty-six, and twenty-seven, and twenty-eight, and twenty-nine, and thirty."

It was the man with the cane whom Tom had seen a while ago—the captain of the group that had landed. He had his cane tucked under his arm now and was holding his lantern close to something in his hand, focusing on it as he walked slowly and methodically in a perfectly straight line across the sand, counting each step. "And twenty-five, and twenty-six, and twenty-seven, and twenty-eight, and twenty-nine, and thirty."

Behind him walked two other figures; one was the half-naked negro, the other the man with the plaited queue and the earrings, whom Tom had seen lifting the chest out of the boat. Now they were carrying the heavy box between them, laboring through the sand with shuffling tread as they bore it onward.

Behind him walked two other figures; one was the half-naked Black man, the other was the man with the braided ponytail and earrings, whom Tom had seen lifting the chest out of the boat. Now they were carrying the heavy box between them, struggling through the sand with a shuffling gait as they moved it forward.

As he who was counting pronounced the word "thirty," the two men set the chest down on the sand with a grunt, the white man panting and blowing and wiping his sleeve across his forehead. And immediately he who[107] counted took out a slip of paper and marked something down upon it. They stood there for a long time, during which Tom lay behind the sand hummock watching them, and for a while the silence was uninterrupted. In the perfect stillness Tom could hear the washing of the little waves beating upon the distant beach, and once the far-away sound of a laugh from one of those who stood by the ship's boat.

As the person counting said "thirty," the two men dropped the chest onto the sand with a grunt, the white man panting, blowing, and wiping his sleeve across his forehead. Right away, the one who counted pulled out a piece of paper and noted something down. They stood there for a long time, during which Tom lay behind the sand mound watching them, and for a while, the silence was uninterrupted. In the perfect stillness, Tom could hear the soft sound of the little waves crashing on the distant beach, and once, he heard a distant laugh from someone by the ship's boat.

One, two, three minutes passed, and then the men picked up the chest and started on again; and then again the other man began his counting. "Thirty and one, and thirty and two, and thirty and three, and thirty and four"—he walked straight across the level open, still looking intently at that which he held in his hand—"and thirty and five, and thirty and six, and thirty and seven," and so on, until the three figures disappeared in the little hollow between the two sand hills on the opposite side of the open, and still Tom could hear the sound of the counting voice in the distance.

One, two, three minutes went by, and then the men picked up the chest and moved on again; and again the other man started counting. "Thirty-one, thirty-two, thirty-three, thirty-four"—he walked straight across the flat open space, still focused on what he held in his hand—"thirty-five, thirty-six, thirty-seven," and so on, until the three figures vanished in the small dip between the two sand hills on the other side of the open area, and Tom could still hear the counting voice in the distance.

Just as they disappeared behind the hill there was a sudden faint flash of light; and by and by, as Tom lay still listening to the counting, he heard, after a long interval, a far-away muffled rumble of distant thunder. He waited for a while, and then arose and stepped to the top of the sand hummock behind which he had been lying. He looked all about him, but there was no one else to be seen. Then he stepped down from the hummock and followed in the direction which the pirate captain and the two men carrying the chest had gone. He crept along cautiously, stopping now and then to make sure that he still heard the counting voice, and when it ceased he lay down upon the sand and waited until it began again.

Just as they disappeared behind the hill, there was a sudden faint flash of light. After a while, as Tom lay still listening to the counting, he heard, after a long pause, the distant muffled rumble of thunder. He waited a bit, then got up and stepped to the top of the sand mound where he had been lying. He looked around, but no one else was in sight. Then he climbed down from the mound and followed the path the pirate captain and the two men carrying the chest had taken. He moved cautiously, stopping every now and then to make sure he could still hear the counting voice, and when it stopped, he lay down on the sand and waited for it to start again.

Presently, so following the pirates, he saw the three figures again in the distance, and, skirting around back of a hill of sand covered with coarse sedge grass, he came to where he overlooked a little open level space gleaming white in the moonlight.

Right now, while tracking the pirates, he spotted the three figures again in the distance. He went around the back of a sandy hill covered with coarse grass and arrived at a spot where he had a view of a small open area shining white in the moonlight.

The three had been crossing the level of sand, and were now[108] not more than twenty-five paces from him. They had again set down the chest, upon which the white man with the long queue and the gold earrings had seated to rest himself, the negro standing close beside him. The moon shone as bright as day and full upon his face. It was looking directly at Tom Chist, every line as keen cut with white lights and black shadows as though it had been carved in ivory and jet. He sat perfectly motionless, and Tom drew back with a start, almost thinking he had been discovered. He lay silent, his heart beating heavily in his throat; but there was no alarm, and presently he heard the counting begin again, and when he looked once more he saw they were going away straight across the little open. A soft, sliding hillock of sand lay directly in front of them. They did not turn aside, but went straight over it, the leader helping himself up the sandy slope with his cane, still counting and still keeping his eyes fixed upon that which he held in his hand. Then they disappeared again behind the white crest on the other side.

The three had been crossing the sandy ground and were now[108] only about twenty-five steps away from him. They had set the chest down again, and the white man with the long braid and gold earrings had sat on top of it to take a break, while the Black man stood right next to him. The moon shone as brightly as day, illuminating his face completely. It was looking straight at Tom Chist, every detail sharply defined by the bright lights and dark shadows, as if it had been carved from ivory and jet. He sat completely still, and Tom flinched, almost thinking he had been spotted. He stayed quiet, his heart pounding in his throat; but there was no panic, and soon he heard the counting start again. When he looked again, he saw they were moving away directly across the small clearing. A gentle, sloping mound of sand was right in front of them. They didn’t veer off but went straight over it, the leader using his cane to assist himself up the sandy slope, still counting and keeping his eyes focused on what he held in his hand. Then they vanished again behind the white peak on the other side.

Kidd at Gardiner's Island Kidd at Gardiner's Island

Illustration from
SEA ROBBERS OF NEW YORK

by Thomas A. Janvier

Originally published in
Harper's Magazine, November 1894

So Tom followed them cautiously until they had gone almost half a mile inland. When next he saw them clearly it was from a little sandy rise which looked down like the crest of a bowl upon the floor of sand below. Upon this smooth, white floor the moon beat with almost dazzling brightness.

So Tom followed them carefully until they had gone nearly half a mile inland. When he next saw them clearly, it was from a small sandy hill that overlooked the flat, sandy area below. The moon shone down on this smooth, white surface with almost blinding brightness.

The white man who had helped to carry the chest was now kneeling, busied at some work, though what it was Tom at first could not see. He was whittling the point of a stick into a long wooden peg, and when, by and by, he had finished what he was about, he arose and stepped to where he who seemed to be the captain had stuck his cane upright into the ground as though to mark some particular spot. He drew the cane out of the sand, thrusting the stick down in its stead. Then he drove the long peg down with a wooden mallet which the negro handed to him. The sharp rapping of the mallet upon the top of the peg sounded loud in the perfect stillness, and Tom lay watching and wondering what [109]it all meant. The man, with quick-repeated blows, drove the peg farther and farther down into the sand until it showed only two or three inches above the surface. As he finished his work there was another faint flash of light, and by and by another smothered rumble of thunder, and Tom, as he looked out toward the westward, saw the silver rim of the round and sharply outlined thundercloud rising slowly up into the sky and pushing the other and broken drifting clouds before it.

The white man who had helped carry the chest was now kneeling, focused on something, though Tom couldn’t see what it was at first. He was carving the end of a stick into a long wooden peg, and after he finished, he stood up and walked over to where the man who seemed to be the captain had planted his cane upright in the ground, as if to mark a specific spot. He took the cane out of the sand and replaced it with the stick. Then he hammered the long peg into the ground with a wooden mallet that the Black man handed to him. The sharp thud of the mallet against the peg echoed loudly in the perfect stillness, and Tom lay there, watching and wondering what it all meant. The man, with quick, repeated strikes, pushed the peg further down into the sand until only a couple of inches were visible above the surface. When he finished, there was another faint flash of light, followed by another muffled rumble of thunder. As Tom looked westward, he saw the silver edge of a round, sharply defined thundercloud slowly rising into the sky and pushing the other broken drifting clouds ahead of it.

The two white men were now stooping over the peg, the negro man watching them. Then presently the man with the cane started straight away from the peg, carrying the end of a measuring line with him, the other end of which the man with the plaited queue held against the top of the peg. When the pirate captain had reached the end of the measuring line he marked a cross upon the sand, and then again they measured out another stretch of space.

The two white men were now bent over the peg, while the Black man watched them. Soon, the man with the cane walked straight away from the peg, taking one end of a measuring line with him, while the other end was held against the top of the peg by the man with the braided hair. Once the pirate captain reached the end of the measuring line, he marked a cross in the sand, and then they measured out another section of space.

So they measured a distance five times over, and then, from where Tom lay, he could see the man with the queue drive another peg just at the foot of a sloping rise of sand that swept up beyond into a tall white dune marked sharp and clear against the night sky behind. As soon as the man with the plaited queue had driven the second peg into the ground they began measuring again, and so, still measuring, disappeared in another direction which took them in behind the sand dune where Tom no longer could see what they were doing.

So they measured a distance five times, and from where Tom was lying, he could see the guy with the long braid drive another stake right at the bottom of a sloping sand rise that went up into a tall white dune, sharply outlined against the night sky behind it. As soon as the guy with the braid drove the second stake into the ground, they started measuring again, and then, still measuring, they moved off in another direction that took them behind the sand dune, where Tom could no longer see what they were doing.

The negro still sat by the chest where the two had left him, and so bright was the moonlight that from where he lay Tom could see the glint of it twinkling in the whites of his eyeballs.

The man still sat by the chest where they had left him, and the moonlight was so bright that from where he lay, Tom could see the light reflecting in the whites of his eyes.

Presently from behind the hill there came, for the third time, the sharp rapping sound of the mallet driving still another peg, and then after a while the two pirates emerged from behind the sloping whiteness into the space of moonlight again.

Right now, from behind the hill, there was, for the third time, the sharp sound of a mallet driving in another peg, and after a while, the two pirates stepped out from behind the sloping whiteness into the moonlit area again.

They came direct to where the chest lay, and the white man and the black man lifting it once more, they walked away across[110] the level of open sand, and so on behind the edge of the hill and out of Tom's sight.

They went straight to where the chest was, and the white man and the black man lifted it again and walked away across[110] the flat sand, disappearing behind the hill and out of Tom's sight.

III

III

Tom Chist could no longer see what the pirates were doing, neither did he dare to cross over the open space of sand that now lay between them and him. He lay there speculating as to what they were about, and meantime the storm cloud was rising higher and higher above the horizon, with louder and louder mutterings of thunder following each dull flash from out the cloudy, cavernous depths. In the silence he could hear an occasional click as of some iron implement, and he opined that the pirates were burying the chest, though just where they were at work he could neither see nor tell.

Tom Chist could no longer see what the pirates were up to, and he didn't dare cross the open stretch of sand that lay between them and him. He lay there wondering what they were doing, while the storm cloud loomed higher and higher above the horizon, rumbling with louder and louder thunder after each dull flash from the dark, cavernous depths. In the silence, he could hear the occasional clinking sound of some metal tool, and he guessed that the pirates were burying the chest, although he couldn't see or tell exactly where they were working.

Still he lay there watching and listening, and by and by a puff of warm air blew across the sand, and a thumping tumble of louder thunder leaped from out the belly of the storm cloud, which every minute was coming nearer and nearer. Still Tom Chist lay watching.

Still he lay there watching and listening, and gradually a warm breeze swept across the sand, while a booming rumble of thunder erupted from the heart of the storm cloud, which was getting closer and closer. Still Tom Chist lay watching.

Suddenly, almost unexpectedly, the three figures reappeared from behind the sand hill, the pirate captain leading the way, and the negro and white man following close behind him. They had gone about halfway across the white, sandy level between the hill and the hummock behind which Tom Chist lay, when the white man stopped and bent over as though to tie his shoe.

Suddenly, almost out of nowhere, the three figures reemerged from behind the sand hill, with the pirate captain in the lead and the Black man and the white man closely following him. They had crossed about halfway over the white, sandy ground between the hill and the hummock where Tom Chist was lying when the white man paused and bent down as if to tie his shoe.

This brought the negro a few steps in front of his companion.

This brought the Black man a few steps ahead of his companion.

That which then followed happened so suddenly, so unexpectedly, so swiftly, that Tom Chist had hardly time to realize what it all meant before it was over. As the negro passed him the white man arose suddenly and silently erect, and Tom Chist saw the white moonlight glint upon the blade of a great dirk knife which he now held in his hand. He took one, two silent, catlike steps behind the unsuspecting negro. Then there was a sweeping flash of the blade in the pallid light, and a blow, the thump of which Tom could distinctly hear even from where he lay stretched[111] out upon the sand. There was an instant echoing yell from the black man, who ran stumbling forward, who stopped, who regained his footing, and then stood for an instant as though rooted to the spot.

What happened next occurred so suddenly, unexpectedly, and quickly that Tom Chist barely had time to understand what it all meant before it was over. As the Black man passed him, the white man suddenly stood up silently, and Tom Chist saw the moonlight glinting off the blade of a large dirk knife he now held. He took one, two silent, cat-like steps behind the unsuspecting Black man. Then there was a quick flash of the blade in the pale light, and a blow, the thud of which Tom could clearly hear even from where he lay stretched[111] out on the sand. There was an immediate echoing yell from the Black man, who stumbled forward, stopped, regained his footing, and then stood for a moment as if frozen in place.

Tom had distinctly seen the knife enter his back, and even thought that he had seen the glint of the point as it came out from the breast.

Tom had clearly seen the knife stab into his back, and he even thought he had seen the blade glimmer as it emerged from his chest.

Meantime the pirate captain had stopped, and now stood with his hand resting upon his cane looking impassively on.

Meanwhile, the pirate captain had stopped and was now standing with his hand resting on his cane, watching without any expression.

Then the black man started to run. The white man stood for a while glaring after him; then he, too, started after his victim upon the run. The black man was not very far from Tom when he staggered and fell. He tried to rise, then fell forward again, and lay at length. At that instant the first edge of the cloud cut across the moon, and there was a sudden darkness; but in the silence Tom heard the sound of another blow and a groan, and then presently a voice calling to the pirate captain that it was all over.

Then the Black man started to run. The white man stood for a moment, glaring at him; then he, too, took off after his target. The Black man wasn't very far from Tom when he stumbled and fell. He tried to get up, then collapsed forward again and lay sprawled out. At that moment, the first edge of the cloud swept across the moon, plunging everything into sudden darkness; but in the silence, Tom heard the sound of another punch and a groan, and then a voice called to the pirate captain that it was all over.

He saw the dim form of the captain crossing the level sand, and then, as the moon sailed out from behind the cloud, he saw the white man standing over a black figure that lay motionless upon the sand.

He saw the faint shape of the captain walking across the flat sand, and then, as the moon came out from behind the cloud, he saw the white man standing over a black figure that lay still on the sand.

Then Tom Chist scrambled up and ran away, plunging down into the hollow of sand that lay in the shadows below. Over the next rise he ran, and down again into the next black hollow, and so on over the sliding, shifting ground, panting and gasping. It seemed to him that he could hear footsteps following, and in the terror that possessed him he almost expected every instant to feel the cold knife blade slide between his own ribs in such a thrust from behind as he had seen given to the poor black man.[112]

Then Tom Chist scrambled up and ran away, diving into the sandy dip that was hidden in the shadows below. He raced over the next hill, then down into the next dark hollow, and kept going across the slippery, shifting ground, panting and gasping. He felt like he could hear footsteps behind him, and in his panic, he almost expected to feel a cold knife blade slide between his ribs at any moment, just like he had seen happen to the poor black man.[112]

So he ran on like one in a nightmare. His feet grew heavy like lead, he panted and gasped, his breath came hot and dry in his throat. But still he ran and ran until at last he found himself in front of old Matt Abrahamson's cabin, gasping, panting, and sobbing for breath, his knees relaxed and his thighs trembling with weakness.

So he kept running like someone in a nightmare. His feet felt heavy like lead, he was panting and gasping, his breath felt hot and dry in his throat. But he kept running until he finally ended up in front of old Matt Abrahamson's cabin, gasping, panting, and sobbing for breath, his knees giving way and his thighs shaking with weakness.

As he opened the door and dashed into the darkened cabin (for both Matt and Molly were long ago asleep in bed) there was a flash of light, and even as he slammed to the door behind him there was an instant peal of thunder, heavy as though a great weight had been dropped upon the roof of the sky, so that the doors and windows of the cabin rattled.

As he opened the door and rushed into the dark cabin (since both Matt and Molly had long been asleep in bed), there was a flash of light, and just as he slammed the door behind him, there was an immediate roar of thunder, so heavy it felt like a massive weight had crashed onto the roof of the sky, making the cabin's doors and windows shake.

IV

Then Tom Chist crept to bed, trembling, shuddering, bathed in sweat, his heart beating like a trip hammer, and his brain dizzy from that long, terror-inspired race through the soft sand in which he had striven to outstrip he knew not what pursuing horror.

Then Tom Chist crawled into bed, shaking, quaking, soaked in sweat, his heart pounding like a jackhammer, and his mind spinning from that long, fear-fueled sprint through the soft sand where he had tried to escape he didn't know what terrifying thing chasing him.

For a long, long time he lay awake, trembling and chattering with nervous chills, and when he did fall asleep it was only to drop[113] into monstrous dreams in which he once again saw ever enacted, with various grotesque variations, the tragic drama which his waking eyes had beheld the night before.

For a long time, he lay awake, shaking and chattering from nervous chills, and when he finally fell asleep, it was only to sink[113] into nightmarish dreams where he repeatedly experienced, with various bizarre twists, the tragic events that his waking eyes had witnessed the night before.

Then came the dawning of the broad, wet daylight, and before the rising of the sun Tom was up and out of doors to find the young day dripping with the rain of overnight.

Then the wide, wet daylight broke, and before the sun rose, Tom was up and outside to find the young day soaking from the overnight rain.

His first act was to climb the nearest sand hill and to gaze out toward the offing where the pirate ship had been the day before.

His first move was to climb the nearest sand dune and look out toward the horizon where the pirate ship had been the day before.

It was no longer there.

It wasn't there anymore.

Soon afterward Matt Abrahamson came out of the cabin and he called to Tom to go get a bite to eat, for it was time for them to be away fishing.

Soon after, Matt Abrahamson came out of the cabin and called to Tom to grab a bite to eat because it was time for them to head out fishing.

All that morning the recollection of the night before hung over Tom Chist like a great cloud of boding trouble. It filled the confined area of the little boat and spread over the entire wide spaces of sky and sea that surrounded them. Not for a moment was it lifted. Even when he was hauling in his wet and dripping line with a struggling fish at the end of it a recurrent memory of what he had seen would suddenly come upon him, and he would groan in spirit at the recollection. He looked at Matt Abrahamson's leathery face, at his lantern jaws cavernously and stolidly chewing at a tobacco leaf, and it seemed monstrous to him that the old man should be so unconscious of the black cloud that wrapped them all about.

All that morning, the memory of the night before hung over Tom Chist like a heavy cloud of impending trouble. It filled the cramped space of the small boat and stretched across the vast expanse of sky and sea surrounding them. It never lifted, not even when he was reeling in his wet, dripping line with a struggling fish on the end. A recurring memory of what he had seen would suddenly hit him, and he would groan inwardly at the thought. He looked at Matt Abrahamson's weathered face, watched him chew on a tobacco leaf with his heavy jaws, and it seemed outrageous that the old man was so unaware of the dark cloud that enveloped them all.

When the boat reached the shore again he leaped scrambling to the beach, and as soon as his dinner was eaten he hurried away to find the Dominie Jones.

When the boat got back to shore, he jumped out and scrambled onto the beach. As soon as he finished his dinner, he rushed off to find Dominie Jones.

He ran all the way from Abrahamson's hut to the parson's house, hardly stopping once, and when he knocked at the door he was panting and sobbing for breath.

He ran all the way from Abrahamson's hut to the parson's house, barely stopping, and when he knocked on the door, he was out of breath and sobbing.

The good man was sitting on the back-kitchen doorstep smoking his long pipe of tobacco out into the sunlight, while his wife[114] within was rattling about among the pans and dishes in preparation of their supper, of which a strong, porky smell already filled the air.

The good man was sitting on the back kitchen doorstep, smoking his long tobacco pipe in the sunlight, while his wife[114] inside was busy clanging around among the pans and dishes getting their dinner ready, and a strong, porky smell filled the air.

Then Tom Chist told his story, panting, hurrying, tumbling one word over another in his haste, and Parson Jones listened, breaking every now and then into an ejaculation of wonder. The light in his pipe went out and the bowl turned cold.

Then Tom Chist rushed through his story, out of breath, stumbling over his words in his excitement, while Parson Jones listened, occasionally interjecting with expressions of amazement. The flame in his pipe went out and the bowl became cold.

"And I don't see why they should have killed the poor black man," said Tom, as he finished his narrative.

"And I don't understand why they had to kill the poor Black man," Tom said as he wrapped up his story.

"Why, that is very easy enough to understand," said the good reverend man. "'Twas a treasure box they buried!"

"Well, that's really easy to understand," said the kind reverend. "They buried a treasure box!"

In his agitation Mr. Jones had risen from his seat and was now stumping up and down, puffing at his empty tobacco pipe as though it were still alight.

In his frustration, Mr. Jones had gotten up from his seat and was now pacing back and forth, puffing on his empty tobacco pipe as if it were still lit.

"A treasure box!" cried out Tom.

"A treasure chest!" Tom exclaimed.

"Aye, a treasure box! And that was why they killed the poor black man. He was the only one, d'ye see, besides they two who knew the place where 'twas hid, and now that they've killed him out of the way, there's nobody but themselves knows. The villains—Tut, tut, look at that now!" In his excitement the dominie had snapped the stem of his tobacco pipe in two.

"Yes, a treasure chest! And that’s why they killed the poor Black man. He was the only one, you see, besides those two, who knew where it was hidden, and now that they’ve killed him, there’s no one left who knows. The crooks—Oh, look at that!" In his excitement, the teacher had snapped the stem of his tobacco pipe in two.

"Why, then," said Tom, "if that is so, 'tis indeed a wicked, bloody treasure, and fit to bring a curse upon anybody who finds it!"

"Why, then," said Tom, "if that’s the case, it’s truly an evil, bloody treasure, and it’s bound to bring a curse on anyone who finds it!"

"'Tis more like to bring a curse upon the soul who buried it," said Parson Jones, "and it may be a blessing to him who finds it. But tell me, Tom, do you think you could find the place again where 'twas hid?"

"It's more likely to bring a curse upon the person who buried it," said Parson Jones, "and it might be a blessing for the one who finds it. But tell me, Tom, do you think you could locate the spot again where it was hidden?"

"I can't tell that," said Tom, "'twas all in among the sand humps, d'ye see, and it was at night into the bargain. Maybe we could find the marks of their feet in the sand," he added.

"I can't say," Tom said, "it was all around the sand hills, you see, and it was at night too. Maybe we could find their footprints in the sand," he added.

"'Tis not likely," said the reverend gentleman, "for the storm last night would have washed all that away."

"It's not likely," said the reverend gentleman, "because the storm last night would have washed all that away."

"I could find the place," said Tom, "where the boat was drawn up on the beach."[115]

"I could find the spot," said Tom, "where the boat was pulled up on the beach."[115]

"Why, then, that's something to start from, Tom," said his friend. "If we can find that, then maybe we can find whither they went from there."

"Well, that's a good starting point, Tom," his friend said. "If we can figure that out, then maybe we can discover where they went from there."

"If I was certain it was a treasure box," cried out Tom Chist, "I would rake over every foot of sand betwixt here and Henlopen to find it."

"If I was sure it was a treasure box," shouted Tom Chist, "I would search every inch of sand between here and Henlopen to find it."

"'Twould be like hunting for a pin in a haystack," said the Rev. Hilary Jones.

"It would be like looking for a needle in a haystack," said Rev. Hilary Jones.

As Tom walked away home, it seemed as though a ton's weight of gloom had been rolled away from his soul. The next day he and Parson Jones were to go treasure-hunting together; it seemed to Tom as though he could hardly wait for the time to come.

As Tom walked home, it felt like a huge weight of sadness had been lifted from his soul. The next day, he and Parson Jones were going treasure-hunting together; Tom could hardly wait for the time to arrive.

V

The next afternoon Parson Jones and Tom Chist started off together upon the expedition that made Tom's fortune forever. Tom carried a spade over his shoulder and the reverend gentleman walked along beside him with his cane.

The next afternoon, Parson Jones and Tom Chist set out together on the adventure that would change Tom's life forever. Tom carried a shovel over his shoulder while the reverend walked next to him with his cane.

As they jogged along up the beach they talked together about the only thing they could talk about—the treasure box. "And how big did you say 'twas?" quoth the good gentleman.

As they jogged along the beach, they talked about the only thing they could— the treasure box. "And how big did you say it was?" asked the good gentleman.

"About so long," said Tom Chist, measuring off upon the spade, "and about so wide, and this deep."

"About this long," said Tom Chist, measuring with the spade, "and about this wide, and as deep as this."

"And what if it should be full of money, Tom?" said the reverend gentleman, swinging his cane around and around in wide circles in the excitement of the thought, as he strode along briskly. "Suppose it should be full of money, what then?"

"And what if it were filled with money, Tom?" said the reverend gentleman, swinging his cane in wide circles, excited by the thought as he walked briskly. "What if it were filled with money, what then?"

"By Moses!" said Tom Chist, hurrying to keep up with his friend, "I'd buy a ship for myself, I would, and I'd trade to Injy and to Chiny to my own boot, I would. Suppose the chist was all full of money, sir, and suppose we should find it; would there be enough in it, d'ye suppose, to buy a ship?"[116]

"By Moses!" said Tom Chist, trying to catch up with his friend, "I'd buy a ship for myself, I really would, and I'd trade to India and China all on my own. Just imagine if the chest was full of money, sir, and what if we found it; do you think there would be enough in it to buy a ship?"[116]

EXTORTING TRIBUTE FROM THE CITIZENS extorting payments from the citizens

"To be sure there would be enough, Tom; enough and to spare, and a good big lump over."

"To make sure there was plenty, Tom; plenty and more than enough, and a big extra chunk left over."

"And if I find it 'tis mine to keep, is it, and no mistake?"

"And if I find it, it's mine to keep, right? No doubt about that?"

"Why, to be sure it would be yours!" cried out the parson, in a loud voice. "To be sure it would be yours!" He knew nothing of the law, but the doubt of the question began at once to ferment in his brain, and he strode along in silence for a while. "Whose else would it be but yours if you find it?" he burst out. "Can you tell me that?"

"Of course it would be yours!" the priest shouted loudly. "It would definitely be yours!" He didn't know much about the law, but the uncertainty of the question began to stir in his mind, and he walked in silence for a bit. "Whose else would it be but yours if you find it?" he exclaimed. "Can you answer that?"

"If ever I have a ship of my own," said Tom Chist, "and if ever I sail to Injy in her, I'll fetch ye back the best chist of tea, sir, that ever was fetched from Cochin Chiny."

"If I ever have my own ship," said Tom Chist, "and if I ever sail to India in it, I'll bring you back the best chest of tea, sir, that was ever brought from Cochin China."

Parson Jones burst out laughing. "Thankee, Tom," he said; "and I'll thankee again when I get my chist of tea. But tell me, Tom, didst thou ever hear of the farmer girl who counted her chickens before they were hatched?"

Parson Jones burst out laughing. "Thanks, Tom," he said, "and I'll thank you again when I get my chest of tea. But tell me, Tom, have you ever heard of the farmer girl who counted her chickens before they were hatched?"

It was thus they talked as they hurried along up the beach together, and so came to a place at last where Tom stopped short and stood looking about him. "'Twas just here," he said, "I saw the boat last night. I know 'twas here, for I mind me of that bit of wreck yonder, and that there was a tall stake drove in the sand just where yon stake stands."

They talked as they rushed along the beach together, and finally came to a spot where Tom suddenly stopped and looked around. "It was right here," he said, "I saw the boat last night. I know it was here because I remember that piece of wreck over there, and that there was a tall stake driven into the sand just where that stake is."

Parson Jones put on his spectacles and went over to the stake toward which Tom pointed. As soon as he had looked at it carefully he called out: "Why, Tom, this hath been just drove down into the sand. 'Tis a brand-new stake of wood, and the pirates must have set it here themselves as a mark, just as they drove the pegs you spoke about down into the sand."

Parson Jones put on his glasses and walked over to the stake Tom pointed at. After examining it closely, he called out, "Wow, Tom, this has just been driven into the sand. It's a brand-new wooden stake, and the pirates must have put it here themselves as a marker, just like they drove the pegs you mentioned into the sand."

Tom came over and looked at the stake. It was a stout piece of oak nearly two inches thick; it had been shaped with some care, and the top of it had been painted red. He shook the stake and tried to move it, but it had been driven or planted so deeply into the sand that he could not stir it. "Aye, sir," he said, "it must [117]have been set here for a mark, for I'm sure 'twas not here yesterday or the day before." He stood looking about him to see if there were other signs of the pirates' presence. At some little distance there was the corner of something white sticking up out of the sand. He could see that it was a scrap of paper, and he pointed to it, calling out: "Yonder is a piece of paper, sir. I wonder if they left that behind them?"

Tom came over and examined the stake. It was a sturdy piece of oak, nearly two inches thick; it had been shaped with care, and the top was painted red. He shook the stake and tried to move it, but it had been driven so deeply into the sand that he couldn't budge it. "Yeah, sir," he said, "it must [117] have been set here as a marker, because I'm sure it wasn't here yesterday or the day before." He looked around to see if there were any other signs of the pirates' presence. A short distance away, he noticed the corner of something white sticking up from the sand. He recognized it as a piece of paper and pointed it out, saying, "There's a piece of paper over there, sir. I wonder if they left that behind?"

It was a miraculous chance that placed that paper there. There was only an inch of it showing, and if it had not been for Tom's sharp eyes, it would certainly have been overlooked and passed by. The next windstorm would have covered it up, and all that afterward happened never would have occurred. "Look, sir," he said, as he struck the sand from it, "it hath writing on it."

It was a lucky chance that put that paper there. Only an inch of it was showing, and if it hadn't been for Tom's keen eyes, it definitely would have been missed. The next windstorm would have buried it, and everything that happened afterward would never have taken place. "Look, sir," he said, brushing the sand off, "it has writing on it."

"Let me see it," said Parson Jones. He adjusted the spectacles a little more firmly astride of his nose as he took the paper in his hand and began conning it. "What's all this?" he said; "a whole lot of figures and nothing else." And then he read aloud, "'Mark—S. S. W. S. by S.' What d'ye suppose that means, Tom?"

"Let me see that," said Parson Jones. He adjusted his glasses a bit more securely on his nose as he took the paper and started looking it over. "What's all this?" he asked; "just a bunch of numbers and nothing else." Then he read aloud, "'Mark—S. S. W. S. by S.' What do you think that means, Tom?"

"I don't know, sir," said Tom. "But maybe we can understand it better if you read on."

"I don't know, sir," Tom said. "But maybe we can understand it better if you keep reading."

"'Tis all a great lot of figures," said Parson Jones, "without a grain of meaning in them so far as I can see, unless they be sailing directions." And then he began reading again: "'Mark—S. S. W. by S. 40, 72, 91, 130, 151, 177, 202, 232, 256, 271'—d'ye see, it must be sailing directions—'299, 335, 362, 386, 415, 446, 469, 491, 522, 544, 571, 598'—what a lot of them there be—'626, 652, 676, 695, 724, 851, 876, 905, 940, 967. Peg. S. E. by E. 269 foot. Peg. S. S. W. by S. 427 foot. Peg. Dig to the west of this six foot.'"

"These are just a bunch of numbers," said Parson Jones, "that don’t seem to mean anything, unless they’re sailing directions." Then he started reading again: "‘Mark—S. S. W. by S. 40, 72, 91, 130, 151, 177, 202, 232, 256, 271’—do you see, it must be sailing directions—‘299, 335, 362, 386, 415, 446, 469, 491, 522, 544, 571, 598’—that’s a lot of them—‘626, 652, 676, 695, 724, 851, 876, 905, 940, 967. Peg. S. E. by E. 269 feet. Peg. S. S. W. by S. 427 feet. Peg. Dig to the west of this six feet.’"

"What's that about a peg?" exclaimed Tom. "What's that about a peg? And then there's something about digging, too!" It was as though a sudden light began shining into his brain. He[118] felt himself growing quickly very excited. "Read that over again, sir," he cried. "Why, sir, you remember I told you they drove a peg into the sand. And don't they say to dig close to it? Read it over again, sir—read it over again!"

"What's that about a peg?" Tom burst out. "What's that about a peg? And then there's something about digging too!" It was like a light bulb went off in his head. He[118] felt himself getting really excited. "Read that again, sir," he urged. "Remember I told you they drove a peg into the sand? And don't they say to dig close to it? Read it again, sir—read it again!"

"Peg?" said the good gentleman. "To be sure it was about a peg. Let's look again. Yes, here it is. 'Peg S. E. by E. 269 foot.'"

"Peg?" said the kind gentleman. "Of course, it was about a peg. Let's check again. Yes, here it is. 'Peg S. E. by E. 269 foot.'"

"Aye!" cried out Tom Chist again, in great excitement. "Don't you remember what I told you, sir, 269 foot? Sure that must be what I saw 'em measuring with the line."

"Aye!" shouted Tom Chist again, full of excitement. "Don't you remember what I told you, sir, 269 feet? That has to be what I saw them measuring with the line."

Parson Jones had now caught the flame of excitement that was blazing up so strongly in Tom's breast. He felt as though some wonderful thing was about to happen to them. "To be sure, to be sure!" he called out, in a great big voice. "And then they measured out 427 foot south-southwest by south, and they then drove another peg, and then they buried the box six foot to the west of it. Why, Tom—why, Tom Chist! if we've read this aright, thy fortune is made."

Parson Jones had now caught the spark of excitement that was blazing so brightly in Tom's chest. He felt like something amazing was about to happen to them. "Of course, of course!" he called out in a loud voice. "Then they measured out 427 feet south-southwest by south, drove another peg, and buried the box six feet to the west of it. Wow, Tom—wow, Tom Chist! If we’ve read this right, your fortune is made."

Tom Chist stood staring straight at the old gentleman's excited face, and seeing nothing but it in all the bright infinity of sunshine. Were they, indeed, about to find the treasure chest? He felt the sun very hot upon his shoulders, and he heard the harsh, insistent jarring of a tern that hovered and circled with forked tail and sharp white wings in the sunlight just above their heads; but all the time he stood staring into the good old gentleman's face.

Tom Chist stood staring straight at the old man's excited face, seeing nothing else in the bright sunlight. Were they really about to find the treasure chest? He felt the sun beating down on his shoulders, and he heard the harsh, persistent call of a tern hovering and circling above them, its forked tail and sharp white wings glinting in the light; but all he could do was focus on the kind old man's face.

It was Parson Jones who first spoke. "But what do all these figures mean?" And Tom observed how the paper shook and rustled in the tremor of excitement that shook his hand. He raised the paper to the focus of his spectacles and began to read again. "'Mark 40, 72, 91—'"

It was Parson Jones who spoke first. "But what do all these numbers mean?" Tom noticed how the paper shook and rustled in the excitement that tingled in his hand. He lifted the paper to his glasses and started reading again. "'Mark 40, 72, 91—'"

"Mark?" cried out Tom, almost screaming. "Why, that must mean the stake yonder; that must be the mark." And he[119] pointed to the oaken stick with its red tip blazing against the white shimmer of sand behind it.

"Mark?" Tom shouted, nearly screaming. "That has to be the stake over there; that must be the mark." And he[119] pointed to the wooden stick with its red tip shining against the white sand behind it.

"And the 40 and 72 and 91," cried the old gentleman, in a voice equally shrill—"why, that must mean the number of steps the pirate was counting when you heard him."

"And the 40, 72, and 91," shouted the old man, in a voice just as high-pitched—"that must be the number of steps the pirate was counting when you heard him."

"To be sure that's what they mean!" cried Tom Chist. "That is it, and it can be nothing else. Oh, come, sir—come, sir; let us make haste and find it!"

"That’s definitely what they mean!" shouted Tom Chist. "That’s it, and it can’t be anything else. Come on, sir—let’s hurry and find it!"

"Stay! stay!" said the good gentleman, holding up his hand; and again Tom Chist noticed how it trembled and shook. His voice was steady enough, though very hoarse, but his hand shook and trembled as though with a palsy. "Stay! stay! First of all, we must follow these measurements. And 'tis a marvelous thing," he croaked, after a little pause, "how this paper ever came to be here."

"Wait! wait!" said the kind man, raising his hand; and once again Tom Chist noticed how it trembled and shook. His voice was steady enough, though it was very raspy, but his hand shook as if he had a tremor. "Wait! wait! First, we need to follow these measurements. And it's truly amazing," he croaked after a brief pause, "how this paper ended up here."

"Maybe it was blown here by the storm," suggested Tom Chist.

"Maybe the storm blew it here," Tom Chist suggested.

"Like enough; like enough," said Parson Jones. "Like enough, after the wretches had buried the chest and killed the poor black man, they were so buffeted and bowsed about by the storm that it was shook out of the man's pocket, and thus blew away from him without his knowing aught of it."

"Yeah, probably," said Parson Jones. "It's likely that after those wretches buried the chest and killed the poor black man, they were tossed around so much by the storm that it fell out of the man's pocket and blew away without him even realizing it."

"But let us find the box!" cried out Tom Chist, flaming with his excitement.

"But let’s find the box!" shouted Tom Chist, filled with excitement.

"Aye, aye," said the good man; "only stay a little, my boy, until we make sure what we're about. I've got my pocket compass here, but we must have something to measure off the feet when we have found the peg. You run across to Tom Brooke's house and fetch that measuring rod he used to lay out his new byre. While you're gone I'll pace off the distance marked on the paper with my pocket compass here."

"Sure thing," said the good man; "just wait a moment, my boy, until we figure out what we're doing. I've got my pocket compass here, but we need something to measure the feet once we find the peg. Run over to Tom Brooke's house and grab that measuring rod he used to lay out his new barn. While you’re gone, I’ll walk off the distance marked on the paper with my pocket compass."

VI

Tom Chist was gone for almost an hour, though he ran nearly all the way and back, upborne as on the wings of the wind. When[120] he returned, panting, Parson Jones was nowhere to be seen, but Tom saw his footsteps leading away inland, and he followed the scuffling marks in the smooth surface across the sand humps and down into the hollows, and by and by found the good gentleman in a spot he at once knew as soon as he laid his eyes upon it.

Tom Chist was gone for almost an hour, but he ran nearly all the way there and back, as if he were flying on the wings of the wind. When[120] he got back, out of breath, Parson Jones was nowhere to be found, but Tom noticed his footprints leading away inland, so he followed the scuff marks across the smooth surface of the sand dunes and down into the dips, and eventually found the good gentleman in a place he recognized as soon as he saw it.

It was the open space where the pirates had driven their first peg, and where Tom Chist had afterward seen them kill the poor black man. Tom Chist gazed around as though expecting to see some sign of the tragedy, but the space was as smooth and as undisturbed as a floor, excepting where, midway across it, Parson Jones, who was now stooping over something on the ground, had trampled it all around about.

It was the open area where the pirates had driven their first peg, and where Tom Chist had later witnessed them kill the poor black man. Tom Chist looked around as if he expected to see some trace of the tragedy, but the spot was as smooth and undisturbed as a floor, except for where, halfway across it, Parson Jones, who was now bent over something on the ground, had trampled the area all around.

When Tom Chist saw him he was still bending over, scraping away from something he had found.

When Tom Chist saw him, he was still bent over, scraping something he had found.

It was the first peg!

It was the first peg!

Inside of half an hour they had found the second and third pegs, and Tom Chist stripped off his coat, and began digging like mad down into the sand, Parson Jones standing over him watching him. The sun was sloping well toward the west when the blade of Tom Chist's spade struck upon something hard.

Within half an hour, they had located the second and third pegs, and Tom Chist took off his coat and started digging furiously into the sand, while Parson Jones stood over him, watching. The sun was low in the west when the blade of Tom Chist's spade hit something hard.

If it had been his own heart that he had hit in the sand his breast could hardly have thrilled more sharply.

If it had been his own heart that he hit in the sand, his chest could hardly have felt more intense.

It was the treasure box!

It was the treasure chest!

Parson Jones himself leaped down into the hole, and began scraping away the sand with his hands as though he had gone crazy. At last, with some difficulty, they tugged and hauled the chest up out of the sand to the surface, where it lay covered all over with the grit that clung to it.

Parson Jones jumped into the hole and started digging at the sand with his hands like he had lost his mind. Finally, after some effort, they pulled the chest up from the sand to the surface, where it was completely covered in the grit that stuck to it.

It was securely locked and fastened with a padlock, and it took a good many blows with the blade of the spade to burst the bolt. Parson Jones himself lifted the lid.

It was firmly locked with a padlock, and it took quite a few strong hits with the spade’s blade to break the bolt. Parson Jones himself opened the lid.

Tom Chist leaned forward and gazed[121] down into the open box. He would not have been surprised to have seen it filled full of yellow gold and bright jewels. It was filled half full of books and papers, and half full of canvas bags tied safely and securely around and around with cords of string.

Tom Chist leaned forward and looked[121] down into the open box. He wouldn’t have been shocked to see it packed with yellow gold and shiny jewels. Instead, it was half filled with books and papers, and the other half with canvas bags tightly secured with string.

Parson Jones lifted out one of the bags, and it jingled as he did so. It was full of money.

Parson Jones pulled out one of the bags, and it made a jingling sound as he did. It was packed with cash.

He cut the string, and with trembling, shaking hands handed the bag to Tom, who, in an ecstasy of wonder and dizzy with delight, poured out with swimming sight upon the coat spread on the ground a cataract of shining silver money that rang and twinkled and jingled as it fell in a shining heap upon the coarse cloth.

He cut the string and, with trembling hands, handed the bag to Tom, who, overwhelmed with wonder and dizzy with joy, poured out a cascade of shiny silver coins onto the coat spread on the ground. The coins rang, sparkled, and jingled as they fell in a shiny pile onto the rough cloth.

Parson Jones held up both hands into the air, and Tom stared at what he saw, wondering whether it was all so, and whether he was really awake. It seemed to him as though he was in a dream.

Parson Jones raised both hands in the air, and Tom looked at what he saw, questioning whether it was all real and if he was truly awake. It felt to him like he was in a dream.

There were two-and-twenty bags in all in the chest: ten of them full of silver money, eight of them full of gold money, three of them full of gold dust, and one small bag with jewels wrapped up in wad cotton and paper.

There were twenty-two bags in total in the chest: ten filled with silver coins, eight filled with gold coins, three filled with gold dust, and one small bag containing jewels wrapped in cotton and paper.

"'Tis enough," cried out Parson Jones, "to make us both rich men as long as we live."

"It’s enough," shouted Parson Jones, "to make us both wealthy for the rest of our lives."

The burning summer sun, though sloping in the sky, beat down upon them as hot as fire; but neither of them noticed it. Neither did they notice hunger nor thirst nor fatigue, but sat there as though in a trance, with the bags of money scattered on the sand around them, a great pile of money heaped upon the coat, and the open chest beside them. It was an hour of sundown before Parson Jones had begun fairly to examine the books and papers in the chest.

The blazing summer sun, despite its lowering position in the sky, blared down on them like fire; yet neither of them seemed to care. They didn’t notice their hunger, thirst, or tiredness, but sat there as if in a daze, with bags of money strewn on the sand around them, a large pile of cash piled on the coat, and the open chest beside them. It was an hour before sunset when Parson Jones finally started to really look through the books and papers in the chest.

Of the three books, two were evidently log books of the pirates who had been lying off the mouth of the Delaware Bay all this time. The other book was written in Spanish, and was evidently the log book of some captured prize.[122]

Of the three books, two were clearly the logbooks of the pirates who had been hanging out at the mouth of Delaware Bay all this time. The other book was written in Spanish and was obviously the logbook of some captured prize.[122]

It was then, sitting there upon the sand, the good old gentleman reading in his high, cracking voice, that they first learned from the bloody records in those two books who it was who had been lying inside the Cape all this time, and that it was the famous Captain Kidd. Every now and then the reverend gentleman would stop to exclaim, "Oh, the bloody wretch!" or, "Oh, the desperate, cruel villains!" and then would go on reading again a scrap here and a scrap there.

It was then, sitting on the sand with the old gentleman reading in his high, crackly voice, that they first discovered from the bloody records in those two books who had been lying inside the Cape all this time, and it was the infamous Captain Kidd. Every now and then, the reverend gentleman would pause to exclaim, "Oh, the bloody wretch!" or, "Oh, the desperate, cruel villains!" before continuing to read bits and pieces here and there.

And all the while Tom Chist sat and listened, every now and then reaching out furtively and touching the heap of money still lying upon the coat.

And all the while, Tom Chist sat and listened, occasionally stretching out and secretly touching the pile of money still resting on the coat.

One might be inclined to wonder why Captain Kidd had kept those bloody records. He had probably laid them away because they so incriminated many of the great people of the colony of New York that, with the books in evidence, it would have been impossible to bring the pirate to justice without dragging a dozen or more fine gentlemen into the dock along with him. If he could have kept them in his own possession they would doubtless have been a great weapon of defense to protect him from the gallows. Indeed, when Captain Kidd was finally brought to conviction and hung, he was not accused of his piracies, but of striking a mutinous seaman upon the head with a bucket and accidentally killing him. The authorities did not dare try him for piracy. He was really hung because he was a pirate, and we know that it was the log books that Tom Chist brought to New York that did the business for him; he was accused and convicted of manslaughter for killing of his own ship carpenter with a bucket.

One might wonder why Captain Kidd kept those incriminating records. He probably tucked them away because they implicated many prominent people in the New York colony, and with those books as evidence, it would have been impossible to put the pirate on trial without dragging a dozen or more respected gentlemen down with him. If he could have kept them to himself, they would have been a powerful tool to defend him against the gallows. In fact, when Captain Kidd was finally convicted and hanged, he wasn’t charged with piracy but rather with hitting a mutinous crew member on the head with a bucket and accidentally killing him. The authorities didn’t dare prosecute him for piracy. He was really hanged because he was a pirate, and we know that it was the logbooks that Tom Chist brought to New York that sealed his fate; he was accused and convicted of manslaughter for the death of his own ship's carpenter with a bucket.

So Parson Jones, sitting there in the slanting light, read through these terrible records of piracy, and Tom, with the pile of gold and silver money beside him, sat and listened to him.

So Parson Jones, sitting there in the angled light, read through these awful accounts of piracy, while Tom, with the stack of gold and silver coins beside him, sat and listened.

What a spectacle, if anyone had come upon them! But they were alone, with the vast arch of sky empty above them and the wide white stretch of sand a desert around them. The sun sank[123] lower and lower, until there was only time to glance through the other papers in the chest.

What a sight it would have been if anyone had found them! But they were alone, with the huge expanse of sky empty above them and the broad white stretch of sand surrounding them like a desert. The sun kept sinking[123] lower and lower, leaving just enough time to quickly look through the other papers in the chest.

They were nearly all goldsmiths' bills of exchange drawn in favor of certain of the most prominent merchants of New York. Parson Jones, as he read over the names, knew of nearly all the gentlemen by hearsay. Aye, here was this gentleman; he thought that name would be among 'em. What? Here is Mr. So-and-so. Well, if all they say is true, the villain has robbed one of his own best friends. "I wonder," he said, "why the wretch should have hidden these papers so carefully away with the other treasures, for they could do him no good?" Then, answering his own question: "Like enough because these will give him a hold over the gentlemen to whom they are drawn so that he can make a good bargain for his own neck before he gives the bills back to their owners. I tell you what it is, Tom," he continued, "it is you yourself shall go to New York and bargain for the return of these papers. 'Twill be as good as another fortune to you."

They were mostly goldsmiths' bills of exchange issued in favor of some of the most prominent merchants in New York. Parson Jones, as he looked over the names, recognized almost all the gentlemen by reputation. Ah, here was this gentleman; he expected that name would be among them. What? Here is Mr. So-and-so. Well, if everything people say is true, that guy has robbed one of his best friends. "I wonder," he said, "why the jerk would have hidden these papers so carefully with the other valuables, since they can’t be of any use to him?" Then, answering his own question: "Most likely because these will give him leverage over the gentlemen they're drawn upon, so he can negotiate a good deal for himself before returning the bills to their owners. Listen, Tom," he continued, "you’re the one who should go to New York and negotiate for the return of these papers. It’ll be like getting another fortune for you."

The majority of the bills were drawn in favor of one Richard Chillingsworth, Esquire. "And he is," said Parson Jones, "one of the richest men in the province of New York. You shall go to him with the news of what we have found."

The majority of the bills were made out to one Richard Chillingsworth, Esquire. "And he is," said Parson Jones, "one of the richest men in the province of New York. You will go to him with the news of what we have discovered."

"When shall I go?" said Tom Chist.

"When should I go?" asked Tom Chist.

"You shall go upon the very first boat we can catch," said the parson. He had turned, still holding the bills in his hand, and was now fingering over the pile of money that yet lay tumbled out upon the coat. "I wonder, Tom," said he, "if you could spare me a score or so of these doubloons?"

"You should take the first boat we can get," said the parson. He turned around, still holding the bills, and was now sorting through the pile of money that was scattered across the coat. "I wonder, Tom," he said, "if you could lend me a few of these doubloons?"

"You shall have fifty score, if you choose," said Tom, bursting with gratitude and with generosity in his newly found treasure.

"You can have fifty, if you want," said Tom, overflowing with gratitude and generosity from his newfound treasure.

"You are as fine a lad as ever I saw, Tom," said the parson, "and I'll thank you to the last day of my life."

"You’re one of the best young men I’ve ever seen, Tom," said the parson, "and I'll be grateful to you until the day I die."

Tom scooped up a double handful of silver money. "Take it, sir," he said, "and you may have as much more as you want of it."[124]

Tom grabbed a double handful of silver coins. "Take it, sir," he said, "and you can have as much more as you want."[124]

"Pirates Used to Do That to Their Captains Now and Then" "Pirates Would Do That to Their Captains Every Now and Then"

Illustration from
SEA ROBBERS OF NEW YORK

by Thomas A. Janvier

Originally published in
Harper's Magazine, November, 1894

He poured it into the dish that the good man made of his hands, and the parson made a motion as though to empty it into his pocket. Then he stopped, as though a sudden doubt had occurred to him. "I don't know that 'tis fit for me to take this pirate money, after all," he said.

He poured it into the dish that the good man crafted by hand, and the parson started to reach for it to put it in his pocket. Then he paused, as if a sudden doubt had crossed his mind. "I’m not sure if it’s right for me to take this pirate money, after all," he said.

"But you are welcome to it," said Tom.

"But you’re welcome to it," said Tom.

Still the parson hesitated. "Nay," he burst out, "I'll not take it; 'tis blood money." And as he spoke he chucked the whole double handful into the now empty chest, then arose and dusted the sand from his breeches. Then, with a great deal of bustling energy, he helped to tie the bags again and put them all back into the chest.

Still, the parson paused. "No," he exclaimed, "I won't accept it; it's blood money." As he spoke, he tossed the entire double handful into the now empty chest, then stood up and brushed the sand off his pants. Then, with a lot of busy energy, he helped to tie the bags again and put them all back into the chest.

They reburied the chest in the place whence they had taken it, and then the parson folded the precious paper of directions, placed it carefully in his wallet, and his wallet in his pocket. "Tom," he said, for the twentieth time, "your fortune has been made this day."

They buried the chest again in the spot where they found it, and then the parson folded the valuable directions, put it carefully in his wallet, and his wallet in his pocket. "Tom," he said for the twentieth time, "your fortune has been made today."

And Tom Chist, as he rattled in his breeches pocket the half dozen doubloons he had kept out of his treasure, felt that what his friend had said was true.

And Tom Chist, as he jingled the half dozen doubloons he had saved from his treasure in his pants pocket, realized that what his friend had said was true.


As the two went back homeward across the level space of sand Tom Chist suddenly stopped stock-still and stood looking about him. "'Twas just here," he said, digging his heel down into the sand, "that they killed the poor black man."

As the two headed back home across the flat sandy area, Tom Chist suddenly stopped dead in his tracks and looked around. "It was right here," he said, banging his heel into the sand, "that they killed the poor black man."

"And here he lies buried for all time," said Parson Jones; and as he spoke he dug his cane down into the sand. Tom Chist shuddered. He would not have been surprised if the ferrule of the cane had struck something soft beneath that level surface. But it did not, nor was any sign of that tragedy ever seen again. For, whether the pirates had carried away what they had done and buried it elsewhere, or whether the storm in blowing the sand had completely leveled off and hidden all sign of that tragedy where it [125]was enacted, certain it is that it never came to sight again—at least so far as Tom Chist and the Rev. Hilary Jones ever knew.

"And here he lies buried forever," said Parson Jones, as he pushed his cane into the sand. Tom Chist shivered. He wouldn't have been shocked if the end of the cane had hit something soft beneath the surface. But it didn’t, and there was no sign of that tragedy ever seen again. Whether the pirates had taken what they did and buried it elsewhere, or whether the storm had completely leveled and concealed all evidence of that tragedy where it [125] happened, it's clear that it never appeared again—at least as far as Tom Chist and Rev. Hilary Jones ever knew.

VII

This is the story of the treasure box. All that remains now is to conclude the story of Tom Chist, and to tell of what came of him in the end.

This is the story of the treasure box. Now, all that’s left is to wrap up the story of Tom Chist and share what happened to him in the end.

He did not go back again to live with old Matt Abrahamson. Parson Jones had now taken charge of him and his fortunes, and Tom did not have to go back to the fisherman's hut.

He didn’t go back to live with old Matt Abrahamson. Parson Jones had now taken charge of him and his future, and Tom didn’t have to return to the fisherman's hut.

Old Abrahamson talked a great deal about it, and would come in his cups and harangue good Parson Jones, making a vast protestation of what he would do to Tom—if he ever caught him—for running away. But Tom on all these occasions kept carefully out of his way, and nothing came of the old man's threatenings.

Old Abrahamson talked a lot about it, and would come in drunk and lecture good Parson Jones, making a huge fuss about what he would do to Tom—if he ever caught him—for running away. But Tom always made sure to steer clear of him, and nothing ever came of the old man's threats.

Tom used to go over to see his foster mother now and then, but always when the old man was from home. And Molly Abrahamson used to warn him to keep out of her father's way. "He's in as vile a humor as ever I see, Tom," she said; "he sits sulking all day long, and 'tis my belief he'd kill ye if he caught ye."

Tom would visit his foster mother occasionally, but always when the old man was out. Molly Abrahamson would warn him to stay clear of her father. "He's in a terrible mood, Tom," she said; "he sulks all day, and I believe he’d hurt you if he found you."

Of course Tom said nothing, even to her, about the treasure, and he and the reverend gentleman kept the knowledge thereof to themselves. About three weeks later Parson Jones managed to get him shipped aboard of a vessel bound for New York town, and a few days later Tom Chist landed at that place. He had never been in such a town before, and he could not sufficiently wonder and marvel at the number of brick houses, at the multitude of people coming and going along the fine, hard, earthen sidewalk, at the shops and the stores where goods hung in the windows, and, most of all, the fortifications and the battery at the point, at the rows of threatening cannon, and at the scarlet-coated sentries pacing up and down the ramparts. All this was very wonderful, and so were the clustered boats riding at anchor in the harbor. It was[126] like a new world, so different was it from the sand hills and the sedgy levels of Henlopen.

Of course, Tom didn’t say anything to her about the treasure, and he and the reverend gentleman kept that secret to themselves. About three weeks later, Parson Jones arranged for him to get a spot on a ship heading to New York City, and a few days later, Tom Chist arrived there. He had never been in a city like this before, and he could hardly believe the number of brick buildings, the throngs of people bustling along the smooth, hard sidewalks, the shops and stores with goods displayed in the windows, and most impressively, the fortifications and the battery at the point, with rows of imposing cannons and the scarlet-coated guards marching along the ramparts. Everything was amazing, and so were the clusters of boats anchored in the harbor. It was[126] like a new world, so different from the sandy hills and marshy plains of Henlopen.

Tom Chist took up his lodgings at a coffee house near to the town hall, and thence he sent by the postboy a letter written by Parson Jones to Master Chillingsworth. In a little while the boy returned with a message, asking Tom to come up to Mr. Chillingsworth's house that afternoon at two o'clock.

Tom Chist checked into a coffee house near the town hall, and from there he sent a letter written by Parson Jones to Master Chillingsworth via the postboy. Soon after, the boy came back with a message, asking Tom to come to Mr. Chillingsworth's house that afternoon at two o'clock.

Tom went thither with a great deal of trepidation, and his heart fell away altogether when he found it a fine, grand brick house, three stories high, and with wrought-iron letters across the front.

Tom went there with a lot of anxiety, and his heart sank completely when he saw it was a beautiful, impressive brick house, three stories tall, with wrought-iron letters across the front.

The counting house was in the same building; but Tom, because of Mr. Jones's letter, was conducted directly into the parlor, where the great rich man was awaiting his coming. He was sitting in a leather-covered armchair, smoking a pipe of tobacco, and with a bottle of fine old Madeira close to his elbow.

The counting house was in the same building, but Tom, due to Mr. Jones's letter, was led straight into the parlor, where the wealthy man was waiting for him. He was sitting in a leather armchair, smoking a pipe, and had a bottle of fine old Madeira right next to him.

Tom had not had a chance to buy a new suit of clothes yet, and so he cut no very fine figure in the rough dress he had brought with him from Henlopen. Nor did Mr. Chillingsworth seem to think very highly of his appearance, for he sat looking sideways at Tom as he smoked.

Tom hadn't had a chance to buy a new suit yet, so he didn't make much of an impression in the rough clothes he had brought with him from Henlopen. Mr. Chillingsworth also didn't seem to think much of his appearance, as he sat there looking at Tom from the side while he smoked.

"Well, my lad," he said, "and what is this great thing you have to tell me that is so mightily wonderful? I got what's-his-name—Mr. Jones's—letter, and now I am ready to hear what you have to say."

"Well, kid," he said, "what's this amazing thing you have to tell me that's so extraordinary? I got that letter from Mr. Jones, and now I'm ready to hear what you have to say."

But if he thought but little of his visitor's appearance at first, he soon changed his sentiments toward him, for Tom had not spoken twenty words when Mr. Chillingsworth's whole aspect changed. He straightened himself up in his seat, laid aside his pipe, pushed away his glass of Madeira, and bade Tom take a chair.

But if he initially thought little of his visitor's appearance, he quickly changed his mind, because Tom hadn't spoken twenty words when Mr. Chillingsworth's whole demeanor shifted. He straightened in his seat, set aside his pipe, moved his glass of Madeira away, and invited Tom to take a seat.

He listened without a word as Tom Chist told of the buried treasure, of how he had seen the poor negro murdered, and of how he and Parson Jones had recovered the chest again. Only once did Mr. Chillingsworth interrupt the narrative. "And to think,"[127] he cried, "that the villain this very day walks about New York town as though he were an honest man, ruffling it with the best of us! But if we can only get hold of these log books you speak of. Go on; tell me more of this."

He listened quietly as Tom Chist talked about the buried treasure, how he had witnessed the poor black man being murdered, and how he and Parson Jones managed to recover the chest. Mr. Chillingsworth only interrupted once. "And to think,"[127] he exclaimed, "that the villain is walking around New York today like he’s an honest man, acting like one of us! But if we can just get a hold of those log books you mentioned. Keep going; tell me more about this."

When Tom Chist's narrative was ended, Mr. Chillingsworth's bearing was as different as daylight is from dark. He asked a thousand questions, all in the most polite and gracious tone imaginable, and not only urged a glass of his fine old Madeira upon Tom, but asked him to stay to supper. There was nobody to be there, he said, but his wife and daughter.

When Tom Chist finished telling his story, Mr. Chillingsworth's demeanor was as different as day is from night. He bombarded Tom with a thousand questions, all in the most polite and gracious tone you could imagine, and not only insisted that Tom have a glass of his fine old Madeira, but also invited him to stay for dinner. He mentioned that it would just be him, his wife, and daughter there.

Tom, all in a panic at the very thought of the two ladies, sturdily refused to stay even for the dish of tea Mr. Chillingsworth offered him.

Tom, completely panicked at the thought of the two ladies, firmly refused to stay even for the cup of tea Mr. Chillingsworth offered him.

He did not know that he was destined to stay there as long as he should live.

He didn’t realize he was meant to stay there for the rest of his life.

"And now," said Mr. Chillingsworth, "tell me about yourself."

"And now," said Mr. Chillingsworth, "tell me about yourself."

"I have nothing to tell, Your Honor," said Tom, "except that I was washed up out of the sea."

"I don't have anything to say, Your Honor," Tom said, "except that I was washed up from the sea."

"Washed up out of the sea!" exclaimed Mr. Chillingsworth. "Why, how was that? Come, begin at the beginning, and tell me all."

"Washed up from the sea!" Mr. Chillingsworth exclaimed. "How did that happen? Come on, start from the start and tell me everything."

Thereupon Tom Chist did as he was bidden, beginning at the very beginning and telling everything just as Molly Abrahamson had often told it to him. As he continued, Mr. Chillingsworth's interest changed into an appearance of stronger and stronger excitement. Suddenly he jumped up out of his chair and began to walk up and down the room.

Thereupon, Tom Chist did what he was told, starting from the very beginning and sharing everything just as Molly Abrahamson had often recounted to him. As he went on, Mr. Chillingsworth's interest shifted into a noticeable and growing excitement. Suddenly, he jumped up from his chair and started pacing around the room.

"Stop! stop!" he cried out at last, in the midst of something Tom was saying. "Stop! stop! Tell me; do you know the name of the vessel that was wrecked, and from which you were washed ashore?"

"Stop! Stop!" he shouted finally, interrupting Tom. "Stop! Stop! Tell me; do you know the name of the ship that wrecked and from which you were washed ashore?"

"I've heard it said," said Tom Chist, "'twas the Bristol Merchant."[128]

"I've heard it said," said Tom Chist, "it was the Bristol Merchant."[128]

"I knew it! I knew it!" exclaimed the great man, in a loud voice, flinging his hands up into the air. "I felt it was so the moment you began the story. But tell me this, was there nothing found with you with a mark or a name upon it?"

"I knew it! I knew it!" the great man shouted, throwing his hands up in the air. "I sensed it the moment you started the story. But tell me this, was there nothing with you that had a mark or a name on it?"

"There was a kerchief," said Tom, "marked with a T and a C."

"There was a handkerchief," Tom said, "with a T and a C on it."

"Theodosia Chillingsworth!" cried out the merchant. "I knew it! I knew it! Heavens! to think of anything so wonderful happening as this! Boy! boy! dost thou know who thou art? Thou art my own brother's son. His name was Oliver Chillingsworth, and he was my partner in business, and thou art his son." Then he ran out into the entryway, shouting and calling for his wife and daughter to come.

"Theodosia Chillingsworth!" shouted the merchant. "I knew it! I knew it! Wow! Can you believe something this incredible is happening! Boy! Boy! Do you know who you are? You’re my brother's son. His name was Oliver Chillingsworth, and he was my business partner, and you’re his son." Then he ran out into the hallway, yelling for his wife and daughter to come.


So Tom Chist—or Thomas Chillingsworth, as he now was to be called—did stay to supper, after all.

So Tom Chist—or Thomas Chillingsworth, as he was now going to be called—stayed for dinner, after all.


This is the story, and I hope you may like it. For Tom Chist became rich and great, as was to be supposed, and he married his pretty cousin Theodosia (who had been named for his own mother, drowned in the Bristol Merchant).

This is the story, and I hope you enjoy it. Tom Chist became rich and successful, as you would expect, and he married his beautiful cousin Theodosia (who was named after his own mother, who drowned in the Bristol Merchant).

He did not forget his friends, but had Parson Jones brought to New York to live.

He didn't forget his friends, but he had Parson Jones brought to New York to live.

As to Molly and Matt Abrahamson, they both enjoyed a pension of ten pounds a year for as long as they lived; for now that all was well with him, Tom bore no grudge against the old fisherman for all the drubbings he had suffered.

As for Molly and Matt Abrahamson, they both received a pension of ten pounds a year for as long as they lived; now that everything was good with him, Tom held no resentment towards the old fisherman for all the beatings he had taken.

The treasure box was brought on to New York, and if Tom Chist did not get all the money there was in it (as Parson Jones had opined he would) he got at least a good big lump of it.

The treasure box was brought to New York, and even if Tom Chist didn't get all the money that was in it (as Parson Jones had said he would), he definitely got a nice big chunk of it.

And it is my belief that those log books did more to get Captain Kidd arrested in Boston town and hanged in London than anything else that was brought up against him.

And I believe those log books did more to get Captain Kidd arrested in Boston and hanged in London than anything else that was used against him.

 


Chapter V

JACK BALLISTER'S FORTUNES

I

J

e, of these times, protected as we are by the laws and by the number of people about us, can hardly comprehend such a life as that of the American colonies in the early part of the eighteenth century, when it was possible for a pirate like Capt. Teach, known as Blackbeard, to exist, and for the governor and the secretary of the province in which he lived perhaps to share his plunder, and to shelter and to protect him against the law.

We, living in these times, shielded by laws and surrounded by people, can barely understand what life was like in the American colonies in the early eighteenth century. Back then, a pirate like Captain Teach, known as Blackbeard, could thrive, and the governor and the province's secretary might have even shared in his loot, offering him protection against the law.

At that time the American colonists were in general a rough, rugged people, knowing nothing of the finer things of life. They lived mostly in little settlements, separated by long distances from one another, so that they could neither make nor enforce laws to protect themselves. Each man or little group of men had to depend upon his or their own strength to keep what belonged to them, and to prevent fierce men or groups of men from seizing what did not belong to them.

At that time, American colonists were generally a tough, rugged people, unaware of the finer things in life. They mostly lived in small settlements, far apart from each other, making it difficult to create or enforce laws for their protection. Each person or small group had to rely on their own strength to defend what was theirs and to stop aggressive individuals or groups from taking what didn't belong to them.

It is the natural disposition of everyone to get all that he can. Little children, for instance, always try to take away from others[130] that which they want, and to keep it for their own. It is only by constant teaching that they learn that they must not do so; that they must not take by force what does not belong to them. So it is only by teaching and training that people learn to be honest and not to take what is not theirs. When this teaching is not sufficient to make a man learn to be honest, or when there is something in the man's nature that makes him not able to learn, then he only lacks the opportunity to seize upon the things he wants, just as he would do if he were a little child.

It's natural for everyone to want to get as much as they can. For example, little kids always try to grab what they want from others and keep it for themselves. They only learn not to do this through constant teaching—that they shouldn’t take by force what doesn’t belong to them. Similarly, people learn to be honest and not to take what isn’t theirs through teaching and training. If this teaching isn't enough to help a person learn to be honest, or if there's something in their nature that prevents them from learning, they will only miss out on the opportunity to grab what they want, just like a little child would.

In the colonies at that time, as was just said, men were too few and scattered to protect themselves against those who had made up their minds to take by force that which they wanted, and so it was that men lived an unrestrained and lawless life, such as we of these times of better government can hardly comprehend.

In the colonies back then, as mentioned earlier, there weren’t enough men, and they were too spread out to defend themselves against those who were determined to take what they wanted by force. Because of this, people lived a wild and lawless life that we in today's better-governed times can barely understand.

The usual means of commerce between province and province was by water in coasting vessels. These coasting vessels were so defenseless, and the different colonial governments were so ill able to protect them, that those who chose to rob them could do it almost without danger to themselves.

The typical way to trade between provinces was by water on coastal ships. These ships were so unprotected, and the various colonial governments were so incapable of safeguarding them, that anyone who decided to rob them could do so almost without any risk to themselves.

So it was that all the western world was, in those days, infested with armed bands of cruising freebooters or pirates, who used to stop merchant vessels and take from them what they chose.

So it was that the whole western world was, in those days, filled with armed groups of roaming pirates who would stop merchant ships and take whatever they wanted.

Each province in those days was ruled over by a royal governor appointed by the king. Each governor, at one time, was free to do almost as he pleased in his own province. He was accountable only to the king and his government, and England was so distant that he was really responsible almost to nobody but himself.

Each province back then was overseen by a royal governor chosen by the king. Each governor had a lot of freedom to manage their own province as they saw fit. They were answerable only to the king and his government, and since England was so far away, they were essentially accountable to almost no one but themselves.

The governors were naturally just as desirous to get rich quickly, just as desirous of getting all that they could for themselves, as was anybody else—only they had been taught and had been able to learn that it was not right to be an actual pirate or robber. They wanted to be rich easily and quickly, but the desire was not strong enough to lead them to dishonor themselves in their own opinion[131] and in the opinion of others by gratifying their selfishness. They would even have stopped the pirates from doing what they did if they could, but their provincial governments were too weak to prevent the freebooters from robbing merchant vessels, or to punish them when they came ashore. The provinces had no navies, and they really had no armies; neither were there enough people living within the community to enforce the laws against those stronger and fiercer men who were not honest.

The governors were just as eager to get rich quickly and take as much for themselves as anyone else—they just knew it wasn't right to be actual pirates or thieves. They wanted to become wealthy easily and fast, but their desire wasn't strong enough to make them dishonor themselves in their own eyes and in the eyes of others by indulging their selfishness. They would have stopped the pirates from doing what they did if they could, but their local governments were too weak to prevent the raiders from robbing merchant ships or to punish them when they came ashore. The provinces had no navies, and they didn’t really have any armies; there also weren't enough people in the community to enforce the laws against those stronger and more ruthless men who weren't honest.[131]

After the things the pirates seized from merchant vessels were once stolen they were altogether lost. Almost never did any owner apply for them, for it would be useless to do so. The stolen goods and merchandise lay in the storehouses of the pirates, seemingly without any owner excepting the pirates themselves.

After the stuff the pirates took from merchant ships was stolen, it was pretty much gone for good. Almost never did any owner try to claim it, because it would be pointless to do so. The stolen goods and merchandise sat in the pirates' hideouts, looking like they had no owner except for the pirates themselves.

The governors and the secretaries of the colonies would not dishonor themselves by pirating upon merchant vessels, but it did not seem so wicked after the goods were stolen—and so altogether lost—to take a part of that which seemed to have no owner.

The governors and the secretaries of the colonies wouldn’t shame themselves by robbing merchant ships, but it didn’t seem so terrible after the goods were stolen—and completely lost—to take a part of what appeared to have no owner.

A child is taught that it is a very wicked thing to take, for instance, by force, a lump of sugar from another child; but when a wicked child has seized the sugar from another and taken it around the corner, and that other child from whom he has seized it has gone home crying, it does not seem so wicked for the third child to take a bite of the sugar when it is offered to him, even if he thinks it has been taken from some one else.

A child learns that it's really wrong to take something, like a piece of candy, from another child by force. But when a bad child grabs the candy from someone else and runs away with it, and that other child goes home crying, it doesn’t seem so wrong for a third child to take a bite of the candy when it's offered to him, even if he knows it’s been taken from someone else.

It was just so, no doubt, that it did not seem so wicked to Governor Eden and Secretary Knight of North Carolina, or to Governor Fletcher of New York, or to other colonial governors, to take a part of the booty that the pirates, such as Blackbeard, had stolen. It did not even seem very wicked to compel such pirates to give up a part of what was not theirs, and which seemed to have no owner.

It was just the way it was, no doubt, that it didn’t seem so wrong to Governor Eden and Secretary Knight of North Carolina, or to Governor Fletcher of New York, or to other colonial governors, to take a share of the loot that pirates like Blackbeard had stolen. It didn’t even seem very wrong to force those pirates to give up a part of what wasn’t theirs and seemed to have no owner.

In Governor Eden's time, however, the colonies had begun to be more thickly peopled, and the laws had gradually become[132] stronger and stronger to protect men in the possession of what was theirs. Governor Eden was the last of the colonial governors who had dealings with the pirates, and Blackbeard was almost the last of the pirates who, with his banded men, was savage and powerful enough to come and go as he chose among the people whom he plundered.

In Governor Eden's time, the colonies had started to become more populated, and the laws had gradually become[132] stronger to protect people's property rights. Governor Eden was the last of the colonial governors to have interactions with the pirates, and Blackbeard was nearly the last of the pirates who, along with his crew, was ruthless and strong enough to move freely among the people he robbed.

"Jack Followed the Captain and the Young Lady up the Crooked Path to the House" "Jack followed the captain and the young lady up the winding path to the house."

Illustration from
Jack Ballister's Fortunes

by Howard Pyle

Originally published by
The Century Company, 1894

Virginia, at that time, was the greatest and the richest of all the American colonies, and upon the farther side of North Carolina was the province of South Carolina, also strong and rich. It was these two colonies that suffered the most from Blackbeard, and it began to be that the honest men that lived in them could endure no longer to be plundered.

Virginia, back then, was the biggest and wealthiest of all the American colonies, and just beyond North Carolina lay South Carolina, which was also strong and affluent. These two colonies suffered the most from Blackbeard, and it became clear that the honest people living there could no longer put up with being robbed.

The merchants and traders and others who suffered cried out loudly for protection, so loudly that the governors of these provinces could not help hearing them.

The merchants, traders, and others who were suffering cried out for protection so loudly that the governors of these provinces couldn't ignore them.

Governor Eden was petitioned to act against the pirates, but he would do nothing, for he felt very friendly toward Blackbeard—just as a child who has had a taste of the stolen sugar feels friendly toward the child who gives it to him.

Governor Eden was asked to take action against the pirates, but he refused to do anything because he felt very friendly toward Blackbeard—just like a child who has had a taste of stolen candy feels friendly toward the kid who shares it with him.

At last, when Blackbeard sailed up into the very heart of Virginia, and seized upon and carried away the daughter of that colony's foremost people, the governor of Virginia, finding that the governor of North Carolina would do nothing to punish the outrage, took the matter into his own hands and issued a proclamation offering a reward of one hundred pounds for Blackbeard, alive or dead, and different sums for the other pirates who were his followers.

At last, when Blackbeard sailed right into the heart of Virginia and kidnapped the daughter of the colony's most important people, the governor of Virginia, realizing that the governor of North Carolina wouldn't do anything to punish the crime, decided to take matters into his own hands. He issued a proclamation offering a reward of one hundred pounds for Blackbeard, alive or dead, and various amounts for the other pirates who were with him.

Governor Spottiswood had the right to issue the proclamation, but he had no right to commission Lieutenant Maynard, as he did, to take down an armed force into the neighboring province and to attack the pirates in the waters of the North Carolina sounds. It was all a part of the rude and lawless condition of the colonies at the time that such a thing could have been done.

Governor Spottiswood had the authority to issue the proclamation, but he had no authority to commission Lieutenant Maynard, as he did, to lead an armed force into the nearby province and attack the pirates in the waters of the North Carolina sounds. It was all part of the chaotic and lawless situation in the colonies at that time that something like this could happen.

The governor's proclamation against the pirates was issued [133]upon the eleventh day of November. It was read in the churches the Sunday following and was posted upon the doors of all the government custom offices in lower Virginia. Lieutenant Maynard, in the boats that Colonel Parker had already fitted out to go against the pirates, set sail upon the seventeenth of the month for Ocracoke. Five days later the battle was fought.

The governor's proclamation against the pirates was issued [133]on November 11th. It was read in churches the following Sunday and was posted on the doors of all government customs offices in lower Virginia. Lieutenant Maynard, in the boats that Colonel Parker had already prepared to go after the pirates, set sail on the 17th of the month for Ocracoke. Five days later, the battle took place.


Blackbeard's sloop was lying inside of Ocracoke Inlet among the shoals and sand bars when he first heard of Governor Spottiswood's proclamation.

Blackbeard's sloop was anchored inside Ocracoke Inlet among the shoals and sandbars when he first heard about Governor Spottiswood's proclamation.

There had been a storm, and a good many vessels had run into the inlet for shelter. Blackbeard knew nearly all of the captains of these vessels, and it was from them that he first heard of the proclamation.

There had been a storm, and many ships had gotten into the inlet for shelter. Blackbeard knew almost all the captains of these ships, and it was from them that he first heard about the proclamation.

He had gone aboard one of the vessels—a coaster from Boston. The wind was still blowing pretty hard from the southeast. There were maybe a dozen vessels lying within the inlet at that time, and the captain of one of them was paying the Boston skipper a visit when Blackbeard came aboard. The two captains had been talking together. They instantly ceased when the pirate came down into the cabin, but he had heard enough of their conversation to catch its drift. "Why d'ye stop?" he said. "I heard what you said. Well, what then? D'ye think I mind it at all? Spottiswood is going to send his bullies down here after me. That's what you were saying. Well, what then? You don't think I'm afraid of his bullies, do you?"

He had boarded one of the ships—a small cargo vessel from Boston. The wind was still blowing fairly strongly from the southeast. There were around a dozen vessels anchored in the inlet at that time, and the captain of one of them was visiting the Boston captain when Blackbeard came on board. The two captains had been chatting together. They immediately stopped when the pirate entered the cabin, but he had heard enough of their conversation to understand what was going on. "Why did you stop?" he said. "I heard what you were saying. So, what’s the big deal? Do you think I care at all? Spottiswood is going to send his thugs down here after me. That's what you were saying. So, what’s the big deal? You don't think I'm scared of his thugs, do you?"

"Why, no, Captain, I didn't say you was afraid," said the visiting captain.

"Of course not, Captain, I didn't say you were scared," said the visiting captain.

"And what right has he got to send down here against me in North Carolina, I should like to ask you?"

"And what right does he have to come down here against me in North Carolina, I'd like to ask you?"

"He's got none at all," said the Boston captain, soothingly. "Won't you take a taste of Hollands, Captain?"

"He's got nothing at all," said the Boston captain, gently. "How about a sip of Hollands, Captain?"

"He's no more right to come blustering down here into Governor[134] Eden's province than I have to come aboard of your schooner here, Tom Burley, and to carry off two or three kegs of this prime Hollands for my own drinking."

"He's no more entitled to storm down here into Governor[134] Eden's province than I am to come onto your boat here, Tom Burley, and take a couple of kegs of this top-notch Hollands for myself."

Captain Burley—the Boston man—laughed a loud, forced laugh. "Why, Captain," he said, "as for two or three kegs of Hollands, you won't find that aboard. But if you'd like to have a keg of it for your own drinking, I'll send it to you and be glad enough to do so for old acquaintance' sake."

Captain Burley—the Boston guy—let out a loud, forced laugh. "Well, Captain," he said, "when it comes to two or three kegs of Hollands, you won't find any here. But if you want a keg for yourself, I’ll be happy to send it to you, just because we go way back."

"But I tell you what 'tis, Captain," said the visiting skipper to Blackbeard, "they're determined and set against you this time. I tell you, Captain, Governor Spottiswood hath issued a hot proclamation against you, and 't hath been read out in all the churches. I myself saw it posted in Yorktown upon the customhouse door and read it there myself. The governor offers one hundred pounds for you, and fifty pounds for your officers, and twenty pounds each for your men."

"But let me tell you, Captain," said the visiting skipper to Blackbeard, "they're really set against you this time. Listen, Captain, Governor Spottiswood has put out a strong proclamation against you, and it's been announced in all the churches. I personally saw it posted on the customhouse door in Yorktown and read it there. The governor is offering one hundred pounds for you, fifty pounds for your officers, and twenty pounds each for your crew."

"Well, then," said Blackbeard, holding up his glass, "here, I wish 'em good luck, and when they get their hundred pounds for me they'll be in a poor way to spend it. As for the Hollands," said he, turning to Captain Burley, "I know what you've got aboard here and what you haven't. D'ye suppose ye can blind me? Very well, you send over two kegs, and I'll let you go without search." The two captains were very silent. "As for that Lieutenant Maynard you're all talking about," said Blackbeard, "why, I know him very well. He was the one who was so busy with the pirates down Madagascar way. I believe you'd all like to see him blow me out of the water, but he can't do it. There's nobody in His Majesty's service I'd rather meet than Lieutenant Maynard. I'd teach him pretty briskly that North Carolina isn't Madagascar."

"Well, then," said Blackbeard, raising his glass, "here's to wishing them good luck, and when they get their hundred pounds for me, they'll be in a tough spot to spend it. As for the Hollands," he said, looking at Captain Burley, "I know what you've got on board and what you don’t. Do you think you can fool me? Fine, you send over two kegs, and I'll let you go without searching." The two captains were very quiet. "As for that Lieutenant Maynard you're all talking about," Blackbeard continued, "I know him quite well. He was the one who was busy dealing with the pirates down near Madagascar. I think you'd all love to see him take me down, but he can't. There's no one in His Majesty's service I'd rather meet than Lieutenant Maynard. I'd show him pretty quickly that North Carolina isn't Madagascar."


On the evening of the twenty-second the two vessels under command of Lieutenant Maynard came into the mouth of Ocracoke Inlet and there dropped anchor. Meantime the weather had[135] cleared, and all the vessels but one had gone from the inlet. The one vessel that remained was a New Yorker. It had been there over a night and a day, and the captain and Blackbeard had become very good friends.

On the evening of the twenty-second, the two ships commanded by Lieutenant Maynard arrived at the entrance of Ocracoke Inlet and dropped anchor. Meanwhile, the weather had[135] cleared up, and all the ships except one had left the inlet. The one ship that stayed was from New York. It had been there for over a night and a day, and the captain and Blackbeard had become pretty good friends.

The same night that Maynard came into the inlet a wedding was held on the shore. A number of men and women came up the beach in oxcarts and sledges; others had come in boats from more distant points and across the water.

The same night Maynard arrived at the inlet, a wedding took place on the shore. Several men and women made their way up the beach in oxcarts and sledges; others had traveled by boat from farther away and across the water.

The captain of the New Yorker and Blackbeard went ashore together a little after dark. The New Yorker had been aboard of the pirate's sloop for all the latter part of the afternoon, and he and Blackbeard had been drinking together in the cabin. The New York man was now a little tipsy, and he laughed and talked foolishly as he and Blackbeard were rowed ashore. The pirate sat grim and silent.

The captain of the New Yorker and Blackbeard went ashore together shortly after dark. The New Yorker had spent most of the afternoon on the pirate's sloop, and he and Blackbeard had been drinking together in the cabin. The New Yorker was now a bit tipsy, laughing and talking nonsense as he and Blackbeard were rowed to shore. The pirate remained grim and silent.

It was nearly dark when they stepped ashore on the beach. The New York captain stumbled and fell headlong, rolling over and over, and the crew of the boat burst out laughing.

It was almost dark when they landed on the beach. The New York captain tripped and fell flat on his face, rolling over and over, and the crew of the boat erupted in laughter.

The people had already begun to dance in an open shed fronting upon the shore. There were fires of pine knots in front of the building, lighting up the interior with a red glare. A negro was playing a fiddle somewhere inside, and the shed was filled with a crowd of grotesque dancing figures—men and women. Now and then they called with loud voices as they danced, and the squeaking of the fiddle sounded incessantly through the noise of outcries and the stamp and shuffling of feet.

The people had already started dancing in a large shed facing the shore. There were pine knots burning in front of the building, illuminating the inside with a reddish glow. A Black man was playing a fiddle somewhere inside, and the shed was packed with a lively crowd of dancing figures—men and women. Every now and then, they shouted out loudly while they danced, and the squeaking of the fiddle could be heard continuously amid the noise of their shouts and the thudding and shuffling of feet.

Captain Teach and the New York captain stood looking on. The New York man had tilted himself against a post and stood there holding one arm around it, supporting himself. He waved the other hand foolishly in time to the music, now and then snapping his thumb and finger.

Captain Teach and the New York captain were watching. The New York guy had leaned against a post, using one arm to support himself. He waved his other hand awkwardly to the music, occasionally snapping his thumb and finger.

The young woman who had just been married approached the two. She had been dancing, and she was warm and red, her hair[136] blowzed about her head. "Hi, Captain, won't you dance with me?" she said to Blackbeard.

The young woman who had just gotten married walked up to the two. She had been dancing, and she was warm and flushed, her hair[136] blowing around her head. "Hey, Captain, will you dance with me?" she said to Blackbeard.

"He Led Jack up to a Man Who Sat upon a Barrel" "He took Jack to a man who was sitting on a barrel."

Illustration from
Jack Ballister's Fortunes

by Howard Pyle

Originally published by
The Century Company. 1894

Blackboard stared at her. "Who be you?" he said.

Blackboard stared at her. "Who are you?" he asked.

She burst out laughing. "You look as if you'd eat a body," she cried.

She burst out laughing. "You look like you'd eat a person," she exclaimed.

Blackbeard's face gradually relaxed. "Why, to be sure, you're a brazen one, for all the world," he said. "Well, I'll dance with you, that I will. I'll dance the heart out of you."

Blackbeard's face gradually softened. "Well, you're quite bold, I must say," he said. "Alright, I'll dance with you, I certainly will. I'll dance your heart out."

He pushed forward, thrusting aside with his elbow the newly made husband. The man, who saw that Blackbeard had been drinking, burst out laughing, and the other men and women who had been standing around drew away, so that in a little while the floor was pretty well cleared. One could see the negro now; he sat on a barrel at the end of the room. He grinned with his white teeth and, without stopping in his fiddling, scraped his bow harshly across the strings, and then instantly changed the tune to a lively jig. Blackbeard jumped up into the air and clapped his heels together, giving, as he did so, a sharp, short yell. Then he began instantly dancing grotesquely and violently. The woman danced opposite to him, this way and that, with her knuckles on her hips. Everybody burst out laughing at Blackbeard's grotesque antics. They laughed again and again, clapping their hands, and the negro scraped away on his fiddle like fury. The woman's hair came tumbling down her back. She tucked it back, laughing and panting, and the sweat ran down her face. She danced and danced. At last she burst out laughing and stopped, panting. Blackbeard again jumped up in the air and clapped his heels. Again he yelled, and as he did so, he struck his heels upon the floor and spun around. Once more everybody burst out laughing, clapping their hands, and the negro stopped fiddling.

He pushed forward, using his elbow to shove the recently married guy aside. The man, noticing that Blackbeard had been drinking, erupted with laughter, and the others standing around moved away, so before long, the floor was mostly clear. You could see the black man now; he was sitting on a barrel at the end of the room. He smiled with his white teeth and, without missing a beat in his fiddling, scraped his bow roughly across the strings, then quickly switched to a lively jig. Blackbeard jumped into the air and clashed his heels together, letting out a sharp, short yell. Then he immediately started dancing in a wild and exaggerated way. The woman danced facing him, shifting this way and that, with her fists on her hips. Everyone burst out laughing at Blackbeard's ridiculous antics. They laughed again and again, clapping their hands, while the black man played frantically on his fiddle. The woman's hair fell loose down her back. She tucked it back, laughing and catching her breath, with sweat streaming down her face. She kept dancing. Finally, she laughed out loud and stopped, panting. Blackbeard leaped into the air again and clapped his heels. He yelled once more, and as he did, he stomped his heels on the floor and spun around. Everyone erupted in laughter again, clapping their hands, and the black man stopped playing.

Near by was a shanty or cabin where they were selling spirits, and by and by Blackbeard went there with the New York captain, and presently they began drinking again. "Hi, Captain!" called [137]one of the men, "Maynard's out yonder in the inlet. Jack Bishop's just come across from t'other side. He says Mr. Maynard hailed him and asked for a pilot to fetch him in."

Nearby was a run-down shack where they were selling alcohol, and eventually, Blackbeard went there with the captain from New York, and soon they started drinking again. "Hey, Captain!" shouted [137] one of the men, "Maynard's out there in the inlet. Jack Bishop just came over from the other side. He says Mr. Maynard called out to him and asked for a pilot to bring him in."

"Well, here's luck to him, and he can't come in quick enough for me!" cried out Blackbeard in his hoarse, husky voice.

"Well, here’s to his luck, and I wish he would get here faster!" shouted Blackbeard in his rough, raspy voice.

"Well, Captain," called a voice, "will ye fight him to-morrow?"

"Well, Captain," called a voice, "are you going to fight him tomorrow?"

"Aye," shouted the pirate, "if he can get in to me, I'll try to give 'em what they seek, and all they want of it into the bargain. As for a pilot, I tell ye what 'tis—if any man hereabouts goes out there to pilot that villain in 'twill be the worst day's work he ever did in all of his life. 'Twon't be fit for him to live in these parts of America if I am living here at the same time." There was a burst of laughter.

"Aye," shouted the pirate, "if he can reach me, I'll try to give them what they want, and everything they’re after too. As for a pilot, let me tell you—if anyone here decides to guide that scoundrel in, it’ll be the worst mistake they ever make in their life. It won’t be safe for him to stay in these parts of America while I'm around." There was a burst of laughter.

"Give us a toast, Captain! Give us something to drink to! Aye, Captain, a toast! A toast!" a half dozen voices were calling out at the same time.

"Give us a toast, Captain! Give us something to drink to! Yeah, Captain, a toast! A toast!" half a dozen voices shouted at the same time.

"Well," cried out the pirate captain, "here's to a good, hot fight to-morrow, and the best dog on top! 'Twill be, Bang! bang!—this way!"

"Well," shouted the pirate captain, "here's to a good, hot fight tomorrow, and the best dog wins! It'll be, Bang! bang!—this way!"

He began pulling a pistol out of his pocket, but it stuck in the lining, and he struggled and tugged at it. The men ducked and scrambled away from before him, and then the next moment he had the pistol out of his pocket. He swung it around and around. There was perfect silence. Suddenly there was a flash and a stunning report, and instantly a crash and tinkle of broken glass. One of the men cried out, and began picking and jerking at the back of his neck. "He's broken that bottle all down my neck," he called out.

He started pulling a pistol out of his pocket, but it got stuck in the lining, and he struggled and tugged at it. The men ducked and scrambled away from him, and then, in the next moment, he finally got the pistol out of his pocket. He swung it around and around. There was complete silence. Suddenly, there was a flash and a deafening bang, and instantly, the crash and tinkle of broken glass followed. One of the men shouted and began picking and tugging at the back of his neck. "He smashed that bottle all down my neck," he yelled.

"That's the way 'twill be," said Blackbeard.

"That's how it will be," said Blackbeard.

"Lookee," said the owner of the place, "I won't serve out another drop if 'tis going to be like that. If there's any more trouble I'll blow out the lantern."[138]

"Hey," said the owner of the place, "I won't serve another drop if it's going to be like that. If there's any more trouble, I'll blow out the lantern." [138]

The sound of the squeaking and scraping of the fiddle and the shouts and the scuffling feet still came from the shed where the dancing was going on.

The noise of the squeaking and scraping of the fiddle, along with the shouting and shuffling feet, still came from the shed where the dancing was happening.

"Suppose you get your dose to-morrow, Captain," some one called out, "what then?"

"Imagine you get your dose tomorrow, Captain," someone called out, "what then?"

"Why, if I do," said Blackbeard, "I get it, and that's all there is of it."

"Why, if I do," said Blackbeard, "I get it, and that's all there is to it."

"Your wife 'll be a rich widdy then, won't she?" cried one of the men; and there was a burst of laughter.

"Your wife's going to be a rich widow then, right?" one of the men shouted, and everyone burst into laughter.

"Why," said the New York captain,—"why, has a—a bloody p-pirate like you a wife then—a—like any honest man?"

"Why," said the New York captain, "why does a bloody pirate like you have a wife, like any honest man?"

"She'll be no richer than she is now," said Blackbeard.

"She won't be any richer than she is now," said Blackbeard.

"She knows where you've hid your money, anyways. Don't she, Captain?" called out a voice.

"She knows where you've hidden your money, anyway. Doesn’t she, Captain?" called out a voice.

"The divil knows where I've hid my money," said Blackbeard, "and I know where I've hid it; and the longest liver of the twain will git it all. And that's all there is of it."

"The devil knows where I've hidden my money," said Blackbeard, "and I know where I've hidden it; and the one who lives the longest of the two will get it all. And that's all there is to it."

The gray of early day was beginning to show in the east when Blackbeard and the New York captain came down to the landing together. The New York captain swayed and toppled this way and that as he walked, now falling against Blackbeard, and now staggering away from him.

The gray of early morning was starting to light up the east when Blackbeard and the New York captain walked down to the landing together. The New York captain swayed and stumbled in various directions as he walked, sometimes leaning against Blackbeard and other times staggering away from him.

II

Early in the morning—perhaps eight o'clock—Lieutenant Maynard sent a boat from the schooner over to the settlement, which lay some four or five miles distant. A number of men stood lounging on the landing, watching the approach of the boat. The men rowed close up to the wharf, and there lay upon their oars, while the boatswain of the schooner, who was in command of the boat, stood up and asked if there was any man there who could pilot them over the shoals.

Early in the morning—around eight o'clock—Lieutenant Maynard sent a boat from the schooner over to the settlement, which was about four or five miles away. Several men were hanging around the landing, watching the boat come in. The rowers brought the boat right up to the wharf and paused with their oars in the water, while the boatswain of the schooner, who was in charge of the boat, stood up and asked if anyone there could guide them through the shallow areas.

Nobody answered, but all stared stupidly at him. After a[139] while one of the men at last took his pipe out of his mouth. "There ben't any pilot here, master," said he; "we ben't pilots."

Nobody answered, but they all stared blankly at him. After a[139] while, one of the men finally took his pipe out of his mouth. "There isn't any pilot here, sir," he said; "we aren't pilots."

"Why, what a story you do tell!" roared the boatswain. "D'ye suppose I've never been down here before, not to know that every man about here knows the passes of the shoals?"

"Wow, what a story you're telling!" shouted the boatswain. "Do you think I’ve never been down here before, that I don’t know every guy around here knows the routes through the shallow waters?"

The fellow still held his pipe in his hand. He looked at another one of the men. "Do you know the passes in over the shoals, Jem?" said he.

The guy still had his pipe in hand. He glanced at another man. "Do you know the routes through the shallow spots, Jem?" he asked.

The man to whom he spoke was a young fellow with long, shaggy, sunburnt hair hanging over his eyes in an unkempt mass. He shook his head, grunting, "Na—I don't know naught about t' shoals."

The guy he was talking to was a young man with long, messy, sunburned hair falling over his eyes in a disheveled clump. He shook his head and grunted, "No—I don't know anything about the shoals."

"'Tis Lieutenant Maynard of His Majesty's navy in command of them vessels out there," said the boatswain. "He'll give any man five pound to pilot him in." The men on the wharf looked at one another, but still no one spoke, and the boatswain stood looking at them. He saw that they did not choose to answer him. "Why," he said, "I believe you've not got right wits—that's what I believe is the matter with you. Pull me up to the landing, men, and I'll go ashore and see if I can find anybody that's willing to make five pound for such a little bit of piloting as that."

"That's Lieutenant Maynard of His Majesty's navy in charge of those ships out there," said the boatswain. "He'll pay any man five pounds to guide him in." The men on the wharf exchanged glances, but nobody spoke up, and the boatswain continued to look at them. He realized they didn't want to respond. "Well," he said, "I think you've lost your minds—that's what I think is going on with you. Row me to the dock, guys, and I'll get ashore and see if I can find someone eager to earn five pounds for such a quick bit of guiding."

After the boatswain had gone ashore the loungers still stood on the wharf, looking down into the boat, and began talking to one another for the men below to hear them. "They're coming in," said one, "to blow poor Blackbeard out of the water." "Aye," said another, "he's so peaceable, too, he is; he'll just lay still and let 'em blow and blow, he will." "There's a young fellow there," said another of the men; "he don't look fit to die yet, he don't. Why, I wouldn't be in his place for a thousand pound." "I do suppose Blackbeard's so afraid he don't know how to see," said the first speaker.[140]

After the boatswain went ashore, the onlookers still stood on the dock, looking down at the boat, and started talking among themselves so the men below could hear them. "They’re coming in," said one, "to take poor Blackbeard out." "Yeah," said another, "he’s such a peaceful guy, too; he’ll just lie there and let them shoot away, he will." "There’s a young guy down there," said another, "he doesn’t look ready to die yet, he doesn't. Honestly, I wouldn't trade places with him for a thousand pounds." "I guess Blackbeard is so scared he doesn’t even know how to react," said the first speaker.[140]

At last one of the men in the boat spoke up. "Maybe he don't know how to see," said he, "but maybe we'll blow some daylight into him afore we get through with him."

At last, one of the guys in the boat spoke up. "Maybe he doesn't know how to see," he said, "but maybe we'll shed some light on him before we're done with him."

Some more of the settlers had come out from the shore to the end of the wharf, and there was now quite a crowd gathering there, all looking at the men in the boat. "What do them Virginny 'baccy-eaters do down here in Caroliny, anyway?" said one of the newcomers. "They've got no call to be down here in North Caroliny waters."

Some more settlers had come out from the shore to the end of the wharf, and there was now quite a crowd gathering there, all looking at the men in the boat. "What are those Virginians doing down here in Carolina, anyway?" said one of the newcomers. "They have no reason to be in North Carolina waters."

"Maybe you can keep us away from coming, and maybe you can't," said a voice from the boat.

"Maybe you can stop us from coming, and maybe you can't," said a voice from the boat.

"Why," answered the man on the wharf, "we could keep you away easy enough, but you ben't worth the trouble, and that's the truth."

"Why," said the man on the dock, "we could easily keep you away, but you're not worth the effort, and that's the truth."

There was a heavy iron bolt lying near the edge of the landing. One of the men upon the wharf slyly thrust it out with the end of his foot. It hung for a moment and then fell into the boat below with a crash. "What d'ye mean by that?" roared the man in charge of the boat. "What d'ye mean, ye villains? D'ye mean to stave a hole in us?"

There was a heavy iron bolt lying near the edge of the landing. One of the men on the wharf secretly kicked it with his foot. It hung for a moment and then fell into the boat below with a crash. "What do you think you're doing?" shouted the man in charge of the boat. "What do you mean, you thugs? Are you trying to put a hole in us?"

"Why," said the man who had pushed it, "you saw 'twasn't done a purpose, didn't you?"

"Why," said the man who had pushed it, "you saw it wasn't done on purpose, right?"

"Well, you try it again, and somebody 'll get hurt," said the man in the boat, showing the butt end of his pistol.

"Well, you try it again, and someone’s going to get hurt," said the man in the boat, brandishing the butt of his pistol.

The men on the wharf began laughing. Just then the boatswain came down from the settlement again, and out along the landing. The threatened turbulence quieted as he approached, and the crowd moved sullenly aside to let him pass. He did not bring any pilot with him, and he jumped down into the stern of the boat, saying, briefly, "Push off." The crowd of loungers stood looking after them as they rowed away, and when the boat was some distance from the landing they burst out into a volley of derisive yells. "The villains!" said the boatswain, "they are all in league[141] together. They wouldn't even let me go up into the settlement to look for a pilot."

The guys on the wharf started laughing. Just then, the boatswain came back down from the settlement and walked along the landing. The rowdy vibe settled as he got closer, and the crowd moved grumpily aside to let him pass. He didn’t bring any pilot with him and jumped into the back of the boat, saying simply, "Push off." The group of idle onlookers watched as they rowed away, and when the boat got a good distance from the landing, they erupted into a bunch of mocking shouts. "Those guys are terrible!" said the boatswain, "They're all in cahoots together. They wouldn't even let me go up to the settlement to find a pilot."


The lieutenant and his sailing master stood watching the boat as it approached. "Couldn't you, then, get a pilot, Baldwin?" said Mr. Maynard, as the boatswain scrambled aboard.

The lieutenant and his sailing master stood watching the boat as it approached. "Couldn't you get a pilot, Baldwin?" Mr. Maynard asked as the boatswain climbed aboard.

"No, I couldn't, sir," said the man. "Either they're all banded together, or else they're all afraid of the villains. They wouldn't even let me go up into the settlement to find one."

"No, I couldn't, sir," said the man. "Either they're all in this together, or they're too scared of the bad guys. They wouldn't even let me go into the settlement to look for one."

"Well, then," said Mr. Maynard, "we'll make shift to work in as best we may by ourselves. 'Twill be high tide against one o'clock. We'll run in then with sail as far as we can, and then we'll send you ahead with the boat to sound for a pass, and we'll follow with the sweeps. You know the waters pretty well, you say."

"Alright," said Mr. Maynard, "we'll manage to work as best as we can on our own. The tide will be high around one o'clock. We'll sail in as far as we can, and then we'll send you ahead in the boat to check for a passage, and we'll follow with the oars. You mentioned you know the waters pretty well."

"They were saying ashore that the villain hath forty men aboard," said the boatswain.[2]

"They were saying on land that the villain has forty men on board," said the boatswain.[2]

[2] The pirate captain had really only twenty-five men aboard of his sloop at the time of the battle.

[2] The pirate captain actually only had twenty-five crew members on his sloop during the battle.

Lieutenant Maynard's force consisted of thirty-five men in the schooner and twenty-five men in the sloop. He carried neither cannons nor carronades, and neither of his vessels was very well fitted for the purpose for which they were designed. The schooner, which he himself commanded, offered almost no protection to the crew. The rail was not more than a foot high in the waist, and the men on the deck were almost entirely exposed. The rail of the sloop was perhaps a little higher, but it, too, was hardly better adapted for fighting. Indeed, the lieutenant depended more upon the moral force of official authority to overawe the pirates than upon any real force of arms or men. He never believed, until the very last moment, that the pirates would show any real fight. It is very possible that they might not have done so had they not thought that the lieutenant had actually no legal right supporting him in his attack upon them in North Carolina waters.

Lieutenant Maynard's crew included thirty-five men on the schooner and twenty-five men on the sloop. He had no cannons or carronades, and neither ship was really suited for their intended purpose. The schooner he commanded offered almost no protection for the crew. The rail was barely a foot high in the middle, leaving the men on deck mostly exposed. The sloop had a railing that was perhaps a bit higher, but it was still not well-designed for combat. In fact, the lieutenant relied more on the power of his official authority to intimidate the pirates than on any real firepower or manpower. He never truly believed, until the very last moment, that the pirates would put up a real fight. It's quite possible that they wouldn't have if they hadn't thought that the lieutenant was lacking any legal right to attack them in North Carolina waters.

It was about noon when anchor was hoisted, and, with the schooner leading, both vessels ran slowly in before a light wind that had begun to blow toward midday. In each vessel a man stood in the bows, sounding continually with lead and line. As they slowly opened up the harbor within the inlet, they could see the pirate sloop lying about three miles away. There was a boat just putting off from it to the shore.

It was around noon when the anchor was raised, and with the schooner in front, both ships moved slowly into the harbor with a light wind that had picked up by midday. On each vessel, a man stood at the front, continuously taking measurements with a lead weight and a line. As they gradually sailed into the harbor, they could spot the pirate sloop about three miles away. A boat was just leaving it to head to the shore.

"The Bullets Were Humming and Singing, Clipping Along the Top of the Water" "The bullets were buzzing and singing, skimming over the surface of the water."

Illustration from
JACK BALLISTER'S FORTUNES

by Howard Pyle

Originally published by
The Century Company, 1894

The lieutenant and his sailing master stood together on the roof of the cabin deckhouse. The sailing master held a glass to his eye. "She carries a long gun, sir," he said, "and four carronades. She'll be hard to beat, sir, I do suppose, armed as we are with only light arms for close fighting."

The lieutenant and his sailing master stood together on the roof of the cabin deckhouse. The sailing master held a glass to his eye. "She's got a long gun, sir," he said, "and four carronades. She'll be tough to take on, sir, I guess, considering we only have light arms for close combat."

The lieutenant laughed. "Why, Brookes," he said, "you seem to think forever of these men showing fight. You don't know them as I know them. They have a deal of bluster and make a deal of noise, but when you seize them and hold them with a strong hand, there's naught of fight left in them. 'Tis like enough there 'll not be so much as a musket fired to-day. I've had to do with 'em often enough before to know my gentlemen well by this time." Nor, as was said, was it until the very last that the lieutenant could be brought to believe that the pirates had any stomach for a fight.

The lieutenant laughed. "Why, Brookes," he said, "you seem to think these guys are always ready to fight. You don't know them like I do. They put on a show and make a lot of noise, but once you grab hold of them firmly, they’ve got no fight left. It’s likely that not a single musket will be fired today. I've dealt with them often enough to know my gentlemen well by now." And, as mentioned, it wasn’t until the very end that the lieutenant could be convinced that the pirates were actually up for a fight.

The two vessels had reached perhaps within a mile of the pirate sloop before they found the water too shallow to venture any farther with the sail. It was then that the boat was lowered as the lieutenant had planned, and the boatswain went ahead to sound, the two vessels, with their sails still hoisted but empty of wind, pulling in after with sweeps.

The two ships had gotten to within about a mile of the pirate sloop before they found the water too shallow to go any further with the sail. It was at that point that they lowered the boat as the lieutenant had intended, and the boatswain went ahead to check the depth, while the two vessels, with their sails still up but lacking wind, followed in with their oars.

The pirate had also hoisted sail, but lay as though waiting for the approach of the schooner and the sloop.

The pirate had also raised sail, but remained still as if waiting for the schooner and the sloop to come closer.

The boat in which the boatswain was sounding had run in a considerable distance ahead of the two vessels, which were gradually creeping up with the sweeps until they had reached to within less [143]than half a mile of the pirates—the boat with the boatswain maybe a quarter of a mile closer. Suddenly there was a puff of smoke from the pirate sloop, and then another and another, and the next moment there came the three reports of muskets up the wind.

The boat that the boatswain was in had moved quite a distance ahead of the two ships, which were slowly catching up with their oars until they got within less than half a mile of the pirates—the boat with the boatswain was probably about a quarter of a mile closer. Suddenly, there was a puff of smoke from the pirate ship, followed by another and another, and then the next moment, three gunshots rang out in the wind.

"By zounds!" said the lieutenant. "I do believe they're firing on the boat!" And then he saw the boat turn and begin pulling toward them.

"Wow!" said the lieutenant. "I really think they're shooting at the boat!" Then he saw the boat turn and start moving toward them.

The boat with the boatswain aboard came rowing rapidly. Again there were three or four puffs of smoke and three or four subsequent reports from the distant vessel. Then, in a little while, the boat was alongside, and the boatswain came scrambling aboard. "Never mind hoisting the boat," said the lieutenant; "we'll just take her in tow. Come aboard as quick as you can." Then, turning to the sailing master, "Well, Brookes, you'll have to do the best you can to get in over the shoals under half sail."

The boat with the bosun on board came rowing fast. Once more, there were a few puffs of smoke and a few loud bursts from the distant ship. After a little while, the boat reached us, and the bosun hopped on board. "Don't worry about hoisting the boat," the lieutenant said; "we'll just tow it. Get on here as quickly as possible." Then, turning to the sailing master, he added, "Alright, Brookes, you'll have to figure out how to get us over the shoals with just half sail."

"But, sir," said the master, "we'll be sure to run aground."

"But, sir," the captain said, "we're definitely going to run aground."

"Very well, sir," said the lieutenant, "you heard my orders. If we run aground we run aground, and that's all there is of it."

"Alright, sir," said the lieutenant, "you heard my orders. If we get stuck, we get stuck, and that's all there is to it."

"I sounded as far as maybe a little over a fathom," said the mate, "but the villains would let me go no nearer. I think I was in the channel, though. 'Tis more open inside, as I mind me of it. There's a kind of a hole there, and if we get in over the shoals just beyond where I was we'll be all right."

"I checked the depth and it was maybe just over a fathom," said the mate, "but the guys wouldn’t let me go any closer. I believe I was in the channel, though. It’s more open inside, from what I remember. There’s a sort of hole there, and if we can get past the shallow areas just beyond where I was, we’ll be fine."

"Very well, then, you take the wheel, Baldwin," said the lieutenant, "and do the best you can for us."

"Alright, then, you take the wheel, Baldwin," said the lieutenant, "and do your best for us."

Lieutenant Maynard stood looking out forward at the pirate vessel, which they were now steadily nearing under half sail. He could see that there were signs of bustle aboard and of men running around upon the deck. Then he walked aft and around the cabin. The sloop was some distance astern. It appeared to have run aground, and they were trying to push it off with the sweeps. The lieutenant looked down into the water over the stern, and saw that the schooner was already raising the mud in her wake.[144] Then he went forward along the deck. His men were crouching down along by the low rail, and there was a tense quietness of expectation about them. The lieutenant looked them over as he passed them. "Johnson," he said, "do you take the lead and line and go forward and sound a bit." Then to the others: "Now, my men, the moment we run her aboard, you get aboard of her as quick as you can, do you understand? Don't wait for the sloop or think about her, but just see that the grappling irons are fast, and then get aboard. If any man offers to resist you, shoot him down. Are you ready, Mr. Cringle?"

Lieutenant Maynard stood looking out toward the pirate ship, which they were steadily approaching under half sail. He noticed signs of activity on board and men moving around on the deck. Then he walked toward the back and around the cabin. The sloop was a bit behind them. It seemed to have run aground, and they were trying to push it off with the oars. The lieutenant glanced into the water over the stern and saw that the schooner was already stirring up mud in its wake.[144] He then moved forward along the deck. His men were crouched down by the low rail, and there was a tense anticipation in the air. The lieutenant looked them over as he passed. "Johnson," he said, "you take the lead and the line and go forward and sound a bit." Then to the others: "Now, my men, the moment we run her aboard, you get on her as quickly as you can, understand? Don’t wait for the sloop or think about it, just make sure the grappling irons are secured, and then get aboard. If anyone tries to resist you, shoot him down. Are you ready, Mr. Cringle?"

"Aye, aye, sir," said the gunner.

"Aye, aye, sir," replied the gunner.

"Very well, then, be ready, men; we'll be aboard 'em in a minute or two."

"Alright then, get ready, guys; we'll be on them in a minute or two."

"There's less than a fathom of water here, sir," sang out Johnson from the bows. As he spoke there was a sudden soft jar and jerk, then the schooner was still. They were aground. "Push her off to the lee there! Let go your sheets!" roared the boatswain from the wheel. "Push her off to the lee." He spun the wheel around as he spoke. A half a dozen men sprang up, seized the sweeps, and plunged them into the water. Others ran to help them, but the sweeps only sank into the mud without moving the schooner. The sails had fallen off and they were flapping and thumping and clapping in the wind. Others of the crew had scrambled to their feet and ran to help those at the sweeps. The lieutenant had walked quickly aft again. They were very close now to the pirate sloop, and suddenly some one hailed him from aboard of her. When he turned he saw that there was a man standing up on the rail of the pirate sloop, holding by the back stays. "Who are you?" he called, from the distance, "and whence come you? What do you seek here? What d'ye mean, coming down on us this way?"

"There's less than six feet of water here, sir," shouted Johnson from the front. As he spoke, there was a sudden gentle jolt, and then the schooner stopped moving. They were stuck. "Push her off to the leeward! Release the sheets!" yelled the boatswain from the helm. "Push her off to the leeward." He turned the wheel as he spoke. About six men jumped up, grabbed the oars, and plunged them into the water. Others came running to help, but the oars just sank into the mud without moving the schooner. The sails had fallen and were flapping and banging in the wind. More crew members had gotten to their feet and rushed to assist those at the oars. The lieutenant quickly walked back to the rear. They were very close now to the pirate sloop when someone called out to him from onboard. When he looked over, he saw a man standing on the rail of the pirate sloop, holding onto the back stays. "Who are you?" he called from a distance, "and where are you coming from? What do you want here? Why are you approaching us like this?"

The lieutenant heard somebody say, "That's Blackbeard his-self." And he looked with great interest at the distant figure.[145]

The lieutenant heard someone say, "That's Blackbeard himself." He looked with great interest at the figure in the distance.[145]

The pirate stood out boldly against the cloudy sky. Somebody seemed to speak to him from behind. He turned his head and then he turned round again. "We're only peaceful merchantmen!" he called out. "What authority have you got to come down upon us this way? If you'll come aboard I'll show you my papers and that we're only peaceful merchantmen."

The pirate stood out sharply against the cloudy sky. Someone seemed to be calling out to him from behind. He turned his head and then turned around again. "We're just peaceful merchants!" he shouted. "What right do you have to come at us like this? If you come aboard, I'll show you my papers and prove that we're just peaceful merchants."

"The villains!" said the lieutenant to the master, who stood beside him. "They're peaceful merchantmen, are they! They look like peaceful merchantmen, with four carronades and a long gun aboard!" Then he called out across the water, "I'll come aboard with my schooner as soon as I can push her off here."

"The villains!" said the lieutenant to the captain, who was standing next to him. "They're peaceful merchants, huh? They sure look like peaceful merchants, with four cannons and a long gun on board!" Then he shouted across the water, "I'll come aboard with my schooner as soon as I can get her moving from here."

"If you undertake to come aboard of me," called the pirate, "I'll shoot into you. You've got no authority to board me, and I won't have you do it. If you undertake it 'twill be at your own risk, for I'll neither ask quarter of you nor give none."

"If you try to come on board my ship," shouted the pirate, "I'll shoot you. You have no right to board me, and I won’t let you do it. If you attempt it, it’ll be at your own risk, because I won’t ask for mercy from you or show any."

"Very well," said the lieutenant, "if you choose to try that, you may do as you please; for I'm coming aboard of you as sure as heaven."

"Alright," said the lieutenant, "if you want to go that route, feel free; because I'm definitely coming on board with you."

"Push off the bow there!" called the boatswain at the wheel. "Look alive! Why don't you push off the bow?"

"Push off the front there!" called the boatswain at the wheel. "Move it! Why aren't you pushing off the front?"

"She's hard aground!" answered the gunner. "We can't budge her an inch."

"She's stuck!" replied the gunner. "We can't move her at all."

"If they was to fire into us now," said the sailing master, "they'd smash us to pieces."

"If they were to fire at us now," said the sailing master, "they'd tear us apart."

"They won't fire into us," said the lieutenant. "They won't dare to." He jumped down from the cabin deckhouse as he spoke, and went forward to urge the men in pushing off the boat. It was already beginning to move.

"They won't shoot at us," said the lieutenant. "They won't have the guts to." He jumped down from the cabin deckhouse as he spoke and went forward to encourage the men to push off the boat. It was already starting to move.

At that moment the sailing master suddenly called out, "Mr. Maynard! Mr. Maynard! they're going to give us a broadside!"

At that moment, the sailing master suddenly shouted, "Mr. Maynard! Mr. Maynard! They’re about to give us a broadside!"

Almost before the words were out of his mouth, before Lieutenant Maynard could turn, there came a loud and deafening crash, and then instantly another, and a third, and almost as instantly[146] a crackling and rending of broken wood. There were clean yellow splinters flying everywhere. A man fell violently against the lieutenant, nearly overturning him, but he caught at the stays and so saved himself. For one tense moment he stood holding his breath. Then all about him arose a sudden outcry of groans and shouts and oaths. The man who had fallen against him was lying face down upon the deck. His thighs were quivering, and a pool of blood was spreading and running out from under him. There were other men down, all about the deck. Some were rising; some were trying to rise; some only moved.

Almost before he finished speaking, before Lieutenant Maynard could turn around, there was a loud, deafening crash, followed almost immediately by another, then a third, and right after that, a crackling and tearing of broken wood. Clean yellow splinters flew everywhere. A man slammed into the lieutenant, nearly knocking him over, but he grabbed onto the rigging to steady himself. For a brief moment, he held his breath. Then chaos erupted all around him, filled with groans, shouts, and curses. The man who had collided with him lay face down on the deck. His legs were shaking, and a pool of blood was spreading out from beneath him. Other men were sprawled across the deck; some were getting up, some were trying to get up, and some were only moving slightly.

"The Combatants Cut and Slashed with Savage Fury" "The Fighters Cut and Slashed with Wild Intensity"

Illustration from
JACK BALLISTER'S FORTUNES

by Howard Pyle

Originally published by
The Century Company, 1894

There was a distant sound of yelling and cheering and shouting. It was from the pirate sloop. The pirates were rushing about upon her decks. They had pulled the cannon back, and, through the grunting sound of the groans about him, the lieutenant could distinctly hear the thud and punch of the rammers, and he knew they were going to shoot again.

There was a faint sound of yelling, cheering, and shouting. It was coming from the pirate sloop. The pirates were running around on her decks. They had pulled the cannon back, and, amidst the groans around him, the lieutenant could clearly hear the thud and punch of the rammers, and he knew they were about to fire again.

The low rail afforded almost no shelter against such a broadside, and there was nothing for it but to order all hands below for the time being.

The low rail offered almost no protection against such a powerful attack, and the only option was to send everyone below for now.

"Get below!" roared out the lieutenant. "All hands get below and lie snug for further orders!" In obedience the men ran scrambling below into the hold, and in a little while the decks were nearly clear except for the three dead men and some three or four wounded. The boatswain, crouching down close to the wheel, and the lieutenant himself were the only others upon deck. Everywhere there were smears and sprinkles of blood. "Where's Brookes?" the lieutenant called out.

"Get below!" shouted the lieutenant. "Everyone get below and lie low for further orders!" The men hurried below into the hold, and soon the decks were almost empty except for three dead men and about four wounded. The boatswain, crouching close to the wheel, and the lieutenant himself were the only ones remaining on deck. There were smears and splatters of blood everywhere. "Where's Brookes?" the lieutenant called out.

"He's hurt in the arm, sir, and he's gone below," said the boatswain.

"He's injured in the arm, sir, and he's gone downstairs," said the boatswain.

Thereupon the lieutenant himself walked over to the forecastle hatch, and, hailing the gunner, ordered him to get up another ladder, so that the men could be run up on deck if the pirates should undertake to come aboard. At that moment the boatswain at [147]the wheel called out that the villains were going to shoot again, and the lieutenant, turning, saw the gunner aboard of the pirate sloop in the act of touching the iron to the touchhole. He stooped down. There was another loud and deafening crash of cannon, one, two, three—four—the last two almost together—and almost instantly the boatswain called out, "'Tis the sloop, sir! look at the sloop!"

The lieutenant walked over to the forecastle hatch and called out to the gunner, ordering him to set up another ladder so the men could get on deck if the pirates tried to come aboard. At that moment, the boatswain at [147]the wheel shouted that the pirates were going to fire again, and the lieutenant turned to see the gunner on the pirate sloop getting ready to fire. He bent down. There was another loud and deafening cannon blast—one, two, three—four—the last two almost at the same time—and almost immediately, the boatswain shouted, "'Tis the sloop, sir! Look at the sloop!"

The sloop had got afloat again, and had been coming up to the aid of the schooner, when the pirates fired their second broadside now at her. When the lieutenant looked at her she was quivering with the impact of the shot, and the next moment she began falling off to the wind, and he could see the wounded men rising and falling and struggling upon her decks.

The sloop was back in the water and was heading to help the schooner when the pirates fired their second broadside at her. When the lieutenant looked at her, she was shaking from the impact of the shots, and the next moment she started drifting away from the wind, and he could see the injured men moving and struggling on her decks.

At the same moment the boatswain called out that the enemy was coming aboard, and even as he spoke the pirate sloop came drifting out from the cloud of smoke that enveloped her, looming up larger and larger as she came down upon them. The lieutenant still crouched down under the rail, looking out at them. Suddenly, a little distance away, she came about, broadside on, and then drifted. She was close aboard now. Something came flying through the air—another and another. They were bottles. One of them broke with a crash upon the deck. The others rolled over to the farther rail. In each of them a quick-match was smoking. Almost instantly there was a flash and a terrific report, and the air was full of the whiz and singing of broken particles of glass and iron. There was another report, and then the whole air seemed full of gunpowder smoke. "They're aboard of us!" shouted the boatswain, and even as he spoke the lieutenant roared out, "All hands to repel boarders!" A second later there came the heavy, thumping bump of the vessels coming together.

At that moment, the boatswain shouted that the enemy was boarding, and just as he spoke, the pirate sloop emerged from the cloud of smoke surrounding her, getting bigger as she approached. The lieutenant stayed crouched under the rail, watching them. Suddenly, a little ways off, she turned to face them, broadside on, and then drifted closer. She was right alongside now. Something flew through the air—then another and another. They were bottles. One shattered with a loud crash on the deck. The others rolled to the opposite rail. Each one had a quick-match smoking inside. Almost immediately, there was a flash and a deafening bang, filling the air with the sounds of breaking glass and metal. Another explosion followed, and the air became thick with gunpowder smoke. "They're on board!" shouted the boatswain, and as he said it, the lieutenant yelled, "All hands to repel boarders!" A moment later, the heavy thud of the ships colliding echoed around them.

Lieutenant Maynard, as he called out the order, ran forward through the smoke, snatching one of his pistols out of his pocket and the cutlass out of its sheath as he did so. Behind him the[148] men were coming, swarming up from below. There was a sudden stunning report of a pistol, and then another and another, almost together. There was a groan and the fall of a heavy body, and then a figure came jumping over the rail, with two or three more directly following. The lieutenant was in the midst of the gunpowder smoke, when suddenly Blackbeard was before him. The pirate captain had stripped himself naked to the waist. His shaggy black hair was falling over his eyes, and he looked like a demon fresh from the pit, with his frantic face. Almost with the blindness of instinct the lieutenant thrust out his pistol, firing it as he did so. The pirate staggered back: he was down—no; he was up again. He had a pistol in each hand; but there was a stream of blood running down his naked ribs. Suddenly, the mouth of a pistol was pointing straight at the lieutenant's head. He ducked instinctively, striking upward with his cutlass as he did so. There was a stunning, deafening report almost in his ear. He struck again blindly with his cutlass. He saw the flash of a sword and flung up his guard almost instinctively, meeting the crash of the descending blade. Somebody shot from behind him, and at the same moment he saw some one else strike the pirate. Blackbeard staggered again, and this time there was a great gash upon his neck. Then one of Maynard's own men tumbled headlong upon him. He fell with the man, but almost instantly he had scrambled to his feet again, and as he did so he saw that the pirate sloop had drifted a little away from them, and that their grappling irons had evidently parted. His hand was smarting as though struck with the lash of a whip. He looked around him; the pirate captain was nowhere to be seen—yes, there he was, lying by the rail. He raised himself upon his elbow, and the lieutenant saw that he was trying to point a pistol at him, with an arm that wavered and swayed blindly, the pistol nearly falling from his fingers. Suddenly his other elbow gave way and he fell down upon his face. He tried to raise himself—he fell down again. There was a report and a[149] cloud of smoke, and when it cleared away Blackbeard had staggered up again. He was a terrible figure—his head nodding down upon his breast. Somebody shot again, and then the swaying figure toppled and fell. It lay still for a moment—then rolled over—then lay still again.

Lieutenant Maynard shouted the order and charged forward through the smoke, pulling one of his pistols from his pocket and grabbing the cutlass from its sheath. Behind him, the men were climbing up from below in a rush. A loud crack of a pistol fired, followed closely by another and another. There was a groan, then the thud of a heavy body hitting the ground. Suddenly, a figure leaped over the rail, followed by two or three others. Maynard was engulfed in gunpowder smoke when Blackbeard appeared right in front of him. The pirate captain had stripped to the waist, his wild black hair falling over his face, looking like a demon fresh from hell. Almost instinctively, the lieutenant aimed his pistol and fired. The pirate staggered back, but then got back up, wielding a pistol in each hand, blood streaming down his bare ribs. In a flash, a pistol was aimed straight at Maynard's head. He ducked reflexively and swung his cutlass upward. There was a deafening shot right next to him as he struck again blindly with his cutlass. He saw a flash of a sword and quickly raised his guard, blocking the crashing blade. Someone shot from behind him, and at that moment, he noticed someone else hit the pirate. Blackbeard staggered again, this time with a deep cut on his neck. Then one of Maynard's men fell directly on him. They both hit the ground, but he quickly got back on his feet, realizing that the pirate sloop had drifted away and their grappling irons had come loose. His hand throbbed as if it had been whipped. He looked around, and the pirate captain was nowhere in sight—wait, there he was, lying by the rail. Blackbeard lifted himself on one elbow, trying to aim a pistol at Maynard, his arm shaking and nearly dropping the weapon. Suddenly, his other elbow gave out, and he collapsed face-first. He attempted to push himself up—he fell again. A shot rang out, followed by a cloud of smoke, and when it cleared, Blackbeard had staggered back to his feet. He was a frightening sight—his head drooping on his chest. Another shot fired, and then the swaying figure toppled and fell. It lay still for a moment, then rolled over, and remained still again.

There was a loud splash of men jumping overboard, and then, almost instantly, the cry of "Quarter! quarter!" The lieutenant ran to the edge of the vessel. It was as he had thought: the grappling irons of the pirate sloop had parted, and it had drifted away. The few pirates who had been left aboard of the schooner had jumped overboard and were now holding up their hands. "Quarter!" they cried. "Don't shoot!—quarter!" And the fight was over.

There was a loud splash as men jumped overboard, followed almost immediately by the cry of "Quarter! Quarter!" The lieutenant rushed to the edge of the ship. It was exactly as he had feared: the grappling hooks of the pirate sloop had come loose, and it had drifted away. The few pirates who had stayed on the schooner jumped into the water and were now raising their hands. "Quarter!" they shouted. "Don't shoot!—quarter!" And the fight was over.

The lieutenant looked down at his hand, and then he saw, for the first time, that there was a great cutlass gash across the back of it, and that his arm and shirt sleeve were wet with blood. He went aft, holding the wrist of his wounded hand. The boatswain was still at the wheel. "By zounds!" said the lieutenant, with a nervous, quavering laugh, "I didn't know there was such fight in the villains."

The lieutenant looked down at his hand and saw, for the first time, a deep cut across the back of it, along with his arm and shirt sleeve soaked in blood. He moved toward the back, holding his injured wrist. The boatswain was still at the wheel. "Wow!" said the lieutenant with a shaky laugh, "I didn’t realize those guys could fight like that."

His wounded and shattered sloop was again coming up toward him under sail, but the pirates had surrendered, and the fight was over.

His damaged and broken sloop was once again making its way toward him under sail, but the pirates had given up, and the battle was done.


Chapter VI

BLUESKIN, THE PIRATE

I

J

ape May and Cape Henlopen form, as it were, the upper and lower jaws of a gigantic mouth, which disgorges from its monstrous gullet the cloudy waters of the Delaware Bay into the heaving, sparkling blue-green of the Atlantic Ocean. From Cape Henlopen as the lower jaw there juts out a long, curving fang of high, smooth-rolling sand dunes, cutting sharp and clean against the still, blue sky above—silent, naked, utterly deserted, excepting for the squat, white-walled lighthouse standing upon the crest of the highest hill. Within this curving, sheltering hook of sand hills lie the smooth waters of Lewes Harbor, and, set a little back from the shore, the quaint old town, with its dingy wooden houses of clapboard and shingle, looks sleepily out through the masts of the shipping lying at anchor in the harbor, to the purple, clean-cut, level thread of the ocean horizon beyond.

Cape May and Cape Henlopen form, in a way, the upper and lower jaws of a giant mouth, which spills the cloudy waters of Delaware Bay into the vibrant, sparkling blue-green of the Atlantic Ocean. From Cape Henlopen as the lower jaw, a long, curving stretch of high, smooth-sand dunes juts out, sharply outlined against the clear, blue sky above—silent, exposed, completely deserted, except for the short, white-walled lighthouse perched on the crest of the highest hill. Within this curving, protective hook of sand hills lie the calm waters of Lewes Harbor, and a bit set back from the shore, the charming old town, with its weathered wooden houses made of clapboard and shingle, lazily gazes through the masts of the ships anchored in the harbor, towards the sharp, clean line of the ocean horizon beyond.

Lewes is a queer, odd, old-fashioned little town, smelling fragrant of salt marsh and sea breeze. It is rarely visited by strangers. The people who live there are the progeny of people who have lived there for many generations, and it is the very place to nurse, and preserve, and care for old legends and traditions of bygone times, until they grow from bits of gossip and news into local history of considerable size. As in the busier world men talk of last year's elections, here these old bits, and scraps, and odds and ends of history are retailed to the listener who cares to listen—traditions of the War of 1812, when Beresford's fleet lay off the[151] harbor threatening to bombard the town; tales of the Revolution and of Earl Howe's warships, tarrying for a while in the quiet harbor before they sailed up the river to shake old Philadelphia town with the thunders of their guns at Red Bank and Fort Mifflin.

Lewes is a quirky, charming little town that smells of salt marsh and sea breeze. It rarely gets visitors. The residents are descendants of families who have lived there for generations, and it's a place where old legends and traditions are cherished and kept alive until they evolve from bits of gossip into a significant local history. While people in busier places talk about last year's elections, here, stories and snippets of history are shared with anyone willing to listen—traditions from the War of 1812, when Beresford's fleet anchored off the[151] harbor, threatening to bomb the town; tales from the Revolution and of Earl Howe's warships, pausing for a moment in the tranquil harbor before sailing up the river to rattle Philadelphia with the booms of their guns at Red Bank and Fort Mifflin.

With these substantial and sober threads of real history, other and more lurid colors are interwoven into the web of local lore—legends of the dark doings of famous pirates, of their mysterious, sinister comings and goings, of treasures buried in the sand dunes and pine barrens back of the cape and along the Atlantic beach to the southward.

With these significant and serious threads of actual history, other, more exciting stories are woven into the fabric of local lore—legends of the dark activities of famous pirates, their mysterious and ominous arrivals and departures, treasures hidden in the sand dunes and pine forests behind the cape and along the Atlantic beach to the south.

Of such is the story of Blueskin, the pirate.

Of this kind is the story of Blueskin, the pirate.

II

It was in the fall and the early winter of the year 1750, and again in the summer of the year following, that the famous pirate, Blueskin, became especially identified with Lewes as a part of its traditional history.

It was in the fall and early winter of 1750, and again in the summer of the following year, that the well-known pirate, Blueskin, became particularly associated with Lewes as a part of its local history.

For some time—for three or four years—rumors and reports of Blueskin's doings in the West Indies and off the Carolinas had been brought in now and then by sea captains. There was no more cruel, bloody, desperate, devilish pirate than he in all those pirate-infested waters. All kinds of wild and bloody stories were current concerning him, but it never occurred to the good folk of Lewes that such stories were some time to be a part of their own history.

For several years—three or four—sea captains occasionally brought back rumors and reports about Blueskin’s activities in the West Indies and off the Carolinas. He was considered the most ruthless, bloody, desperate, and wicked pirate in all those pirate-ridden waters. There were all sorts of wild and gory tales about him, but it never crossed the minds of the good people of Lewes that these stories would one day become part of their own history.

But one day a schooner came drifting into Lewes harbor—shattered, wounded, her forecastle splintered, her foremast shot half away, and three great tattered holes in her mainsail. The mate with one of the crew came ashore in the boat for help and a doctor. He reported that the captain and the cook were dead and there were three wounded men aboard. The story he told to the gathering crowd brought a very peculiar thrill to those who heard it. They had fallen in with Blueskin, he said, off Fenwick's[152] Island (some twenty or thirty miles below the capes), and the pirates had come aboard of them; but, finding that the cargo of the schooner consisted only of cypress shingles and lumber, had soon quitted their prize. Perhaps Blueskin was disappointed at not finding a more valuable capture; perhaps the spirit of deviltry was hotter in him that morning than usual; anyhow, as the pirate craft bore away she fired three broadsides at short range into the helpless coaster. The captain had been killed at the first fire, the cook had died on the way up, three of the crew were wounded, and the vessel was leaking fast, betwixt wind and water.

One day, a schooner drifted into Lewes harbor—damaged, with a shattered forecastle, a foremast that was half blown away, and three huge torn holes in her mainsail. The mate, along with one of the crew, came ashore in a boat to get help and a doctor. He reported that the captain and the cook were dead, and there were three injured men on board. The story he shared with the gathered crowd created a thrilling sensation among them. He said they had encountered Blueskin off Fenwick's[152] Island (about twenty or thirty miles below the capes), and the pirates had boarded them; however, upon realizing that the schooner's cargo consisted only of cypress shingles and lumber, they quickly left their prize. Maybe Blueskin was let down by not finding more valuable loot; perhaps the urge for chaos was stronger in him that morning than usual; either way, as the pirate ship sailed away, it fired three broadsides at close range into the defenseless vessel. The captain was killed in the first volley, the cook died on the way up, three crew members were injured, and the ship was rapidly taking on water.

Such was the mate's story. It spread like wildfire, and in half an hour all the town was in a ferment. Fenwick's Island was very near home; Blueskin might come sailing into the harbor at any minute and then—! In an hour Sheriff Jones had called together most of the able-bodied men of the town, muskets and rifles were taken down from the chimney places, and every preparation was made to defend the place against the pirates, should they come into the harbor and attempt to land.

Such was

But Blueskin did not come that day, nor did he come the next or the next. But on the afternoon of the third the news went suddenly flying over the town that the pirates were inside the capes. As the report spread the people came running—men, women, and children—to the green before the tavern, where a little knot of old seamen were gathered together, looking fixedly out toward the offing, talking in low voices. Two vessels, one bark-rigged, the other and smaller a sloop, were slowly creeping up the bay, a couple of miles or so away and just inside the cape. There appeared nothing remarkable about the two crafts, but the little crowd that continued gathering upon the green stood looking out across the bay at them none the less anxiously for that. They were sailing close-hauled to the wind, the sloop following in the wake of her consort as the pilot fish follows in the wake of the shark.

But Blueskin didn’t show up that day, or the next, or the one after that. On the afternoon of the third day, news suddenly spread through the town that the pirates were just inside the capes. As the word got around, people came rushing—men, women, and children—to the green in front of the tavern, where a small group of old seamen had gathered, gazing intently toward the sea and speaking in hushed tones. Two ships, one bark-rigged and the other a smaller sloop, were slowly making their way up the bay, about a couple of miles off and just inside the cape. There was nothing particularly remarkable about the two boats, but the little crowd that kept forming on the green remained anxious as they stared out across the bay at them. They were sailing close to the wind, with the sloop following closely behind her companion like a pilot fish trailing a shark.

But the course they held did not lie toward the harbor, but[153] rather bore away toward the Jersey shore, and by and by it began to be apparent that Blueskin did not intend visiting the town. Nevertheless, those who stood looking did not draw a free breath until, after watching the two pirates for more than an hour and a half, they saw them—then about six miles away—suddenly put about and sail with a free wind out to sea again.

But the direction they were heading wasn’t toward the harbor, but[153] rather away toward the Jersey shore, and eventually it became clear that Blueskin didn't plan to visit the town. Still, those who were watching didn't breathe easy until, after observing the two pirates for over an hour and a half, they saw them—about six miles away—suddenly turn around and sail freely out to sea again.

"The bloody villains have gone!" said old Captain Wolfe, shutting his telescope with a click.

"The bloody villains are gone!" said old Captain Wolfe, snapping his telescope shut with a click.

But Lewes was not yet quit of Blueskin. Two days later a half-breed from Indian River bay came up, bringing the news that the pirates had sailed into the inlet—some fifteen miles below Lewes—and had careened the bark to clean her.

But Lewes wasn't done with Blueskin yet. Two days later, a mixed-race person from Indian River Bay arrived, bringing the news that the pirates had sailed into the inlet—about fifteen miles below Lewes—and had tilted the ship to clean it.

Perhaps Blueskin did not care to stir up the country people against him, for the half-breed reported that the pirates were doing no harm, and that what they took from the farmers of Indian River and Rehoboth they paid for with good hard money.

Perhaps Blueskin didn't want to incite the locals against him, since the half-breed claimed that the pirates weren't causing any trouble and that whatever they took from the farmers of Indian River and Rehoboth was paid for with good cash.

It was while the excitement over the pirates was at its highest fever heat that Levi West came home again.

It was during the peak of excitement about the pirates that Levi West came home again.

III

Even in the middle of the last century the grist mill, a couple of miles from Lewes, although it was at most but fifty or sixty years old, had all a look of weather-beaten age, for the cypress shingles, of which it was built, ripen in a few years of wind and weather to a silvery, hoary gray, and the white powdering of flour lent it a look as though the dust of ages had settled upon it, making the shadows within dim, soft, mysterious. A dozen willow trees shaded with dappling, shivering ripples of shadow the road before the mill door, and the mill itself, and the long, narrow, shingle-built, one-storied, hip-roofed dwelling house. At the time of the story the mill had descended in a direct line of succession to Hiram White, the grandson of old Ephraim White, who had built it, it was said, in 1701.[154]

Even in the middle of the last century, the grist mill a couple of miles from Lewes, though only fifty or sixty years old, had an appearance of weathered age. The cypress shingles it was made of quickly transformed into a silvery, gray tone after a few years of wind and weather, and the white dusting of flour gave it a look as if the dust of ages had settled on it, creating dim, soft, and mysterious shadows inside. A dozen willow trees cast dappled, shimmering shadows over the road in front of the mill door, the mill itself, and the long, narrow, shingle-sided, one-story, hip-roofed house next to it. At the time of the story, the mill had passed down directly to Hiram White, the grandson of old Ephraim White, who was said to have built it in 1701.[154]

SO THE TREASURE WAS DIVIDED so the treasure was split

Hiram White was only twenty-seven years old, but he was already in local repute as a "character." As a boy he was thought to be half-witted or "natural," and, as is the case with such unfortunates in small country towns where everybody knows everybody, he was made a common sport and jest for the keener, crueler wits of the neighborhood. Now that he was grown to the ripeness of manhood he was still looked upon as being—to use a quaint expression—"slack," or "not jest right." He was heavy, awkward, ungainly and loose-jointed, and enormously, prodigiously strong. He had a lumpish, thick-featured face, with lips heavy and loosely hanging, that gave him an air of stupidity, half droll, half pathetic. His little eyes were set far apart and flat with his face, his eyebrows were nearly white and his hair was of a sandy, colorless kind. He was singularly taciturn, lisping thickly when he did talk, and stuttering and hesitating in his speech, as though his words moved faster than his mind could follow. It was the custom for local wags to urge, or badger, or tempt him to talk, for the sake of the ready laugh that always followed the few thick, stammering words and the stupid drooping of the jaw at the end of each short speech. Perhaps Squire Hall was the only one in Lewes Hundred who mis-doubted that Hiram was half-witted. He had had dealings with him and was wont to say that whoever bought Hiram White for a fool made a fool's bargain. Certainly, whether he had common wits or no, Hiram had managed his mill to pretty good purpose and was fairly well off in the world as prosperity went in southern Delaware and in those days. No doubt, had it come to the pinch, he might have bought some of his tormentors out three times over.

Hiram White was only twenty-seven years old, but he was already known locally as a “character.” As a boy, people thought he was a bit slow or “simple,” and, as often happens in small towns where everyone knows each other, he became a target for the sharper, meaner minds in the neighborhood. Now that he had reached adulthood, he was still seen as— to use an old-fashioned term— “off” or “not quite right.” He was heavy, awkward, clumsy, and loose-jointed, yet incredibly, astonishingly strong. His face was thick-featured and lumpish, with heavy, drooping lips that gave him a look of stupidity that was both funny and sad. His small eyes were widely spaced and flat against his face, his eyebrows were almost white, and his hair was a sandy, colorless shade. He was notably quiet, speaking with a thick lisp, often stuttering and hesitating, as if his words raced ahead of his thoughts. Locals loved to push him to talk, as the awkward, stammering words and droopy jaw at the end of each short sentence often led to laughter. Perhaps Squire Hall was the only person in Lewes Hundred who genuinely believed Hiram might not be slow. He had interacted with him and liked to say that anyone who thought Hiram White was a fool was making a foolish deal. Regardless of whether he was truly slow-witted or not, Hiram had managed his mill quite well and was fairly well-off by the standards of southern Delaware at that time. It’s likely that, if he had wanted to, he could have bought out some of his tormentors multiple times over.

Hiram White had suffered quite a financial loss some six months before, through that very Blueskin who was now lurking in Indian River inlet. He had entered into a "venture" with Josiah Shippin, a Philadelphia merchant, to the tune of seven hundred pounds sterling. The money had been invested in a cargo of flour and corn meal which had been shipped to Jamaica by the [155]bark Nancy Lee. The Nancy Lee had been captured by the pirates off Currituck Sound, the crew set adrift in the longboat, and the bark herself and all her cargo burned to the water's edge.

Hiram White had faced a significant financial setback about six months earlier, caused by that same Blueskin who was now hiding in the Indian River inlet. He had entered into a "venture" with Josiah Shippin, a merchant from Philadelphia, for a total of seven hundred pounds sterling. The money had gone into a shipment of flour and cornmeal sent to Jamaica by the [155]bark Nancy Lee. The Nancy Lee was captured by pirates off Currituck Sound, her crew was thrown into the longboat, and both the bark and its entire cargo were burned to the waterline.

Five hundred of the seven hundred pounds invested in the unfortunate "venture" was money bequeathed by Hiram's father, seven years before, to Levi West.

Five hundred of the seven hundred pounds put into the unfortunate "venture" was money left by Hiram's father to Levi West seven years earlier.

Eleazer White had been twice married, the second time to the widow West. She had brought with her to her new home a good-looking, long-legged, black-eyed, black-haired ne'er-do-well of a son, a year or so younger than Hiram. He was a shrewd, quick-witted lad, idle, shiftless, willful, ill-trained perhaps, but as bright and keen as a pin. He was the very opposite to poor, dull Hiram. Eleazer White had never loved his son; he was ashamed of the poor, slack-witted oaf. Upon the other hand, he was very fond of Levi West, whom he always called "our Levi," and whom he treated in every way as though he were his own son. He tried to train the lad to work in the mill, and was patient beyond what the patience of most fathers would have been with his stepson's idleness and shiftlessness. "Never mind," he was used to say. "Levi 'll come all right. Levi's as bright as a button."

Eleazer White had been married twice, the second time to the widow West. She brought with her to her new home a good-looking, long-legged, black-eyed, black-haired son who was a year or so younger than Hiram. He was a clever, quick-witted kid—lazy, careless, and a bit willful, perhaps, but sharp and perceptive. He was the complete opposite of poor, dull Hiram. Eleazer White had never loved his son; he felt ashamed of the slow-witted oaf. On the other hand, he was very fond of Levi West, whom he always referred to as "our Levi," and treated in every way as if he were his own son. He tried to teach the kid to work in the mill and showed more patience than most fathers would have with his stepson's laziness and lack of ambition. "Never mind," he would often say. "Levi will be fine. Levi's as bright as a button."

It was one of the greatest blows of the old miller's life when Levi ran away to sea. In his last sickness the old man's mind constantly turned to his lost stepson. "Mebby he'll come back again," said he, "and if he does I want you to be good to him, Hiram. I've done my duty by you and have left you the house and mill, but I want you to promise that if Levi comes back again you'll give him a home and a shelter under this roof if he wants one." And Hiram had promised to do as his father asked.

It was one of the toughest moments of the old miller's life when Levi ran away to sea. During his final illness, the old man's thoughts repeatedly returned to his missing stepson. "Maybe he'll come back," he said, "and if he does, I want you to treat him well, Hiram. I've taken care of you and left you the house and the mill, but I want you to promise that if Levi comes back, you’ll give him a home and a place to stay under this roof if he wants it." And Hiram promised to do as his father asked.

After Eleazer died it was found that he had bequeathed five hundred pounds to his "beloved stepson, Levi West," and had left Squire Hall as trustee.

After Eleazer died, it was discovered that he had left five hundred pounds to his "beloved stepson, Levi West," and had appointed Squire Hall as the trustee.

Levi West had been gone nearly nine years and not a word[156] had been heard from him; there could be little or no doubt that he was dead.

Levi West had been gone for almost nine years, and not a single word[156] had come from him; there was little to no doubt that he was dead.

One day Hiram came into Squire Hall's office with a letter in his hand. It was the time of the old French war, and flour and corn meal were fetching fabulous prices in the British West Indies. The letter Hiram brought with him was from a Philadelphia merchant, Josiah Shippin, with whom he had had some dealings. Mr. Shippin proposed that Hiram should join him in sending a "venture" of flour and corn meal to Kingston, Jamaica. Hiram had slept upon the letter overnight and now he brought it to the old Squire. Squire Hall read the letter, shaking his head the while. "Too much risk, Hiram!" said he. "Mr Shippin wouldn't have asked you to go into this venture if he could have got anybody else to do so. My advice is that you let it alone. I reckon you've come to me for advice?" Hiram shook his head. "Ye haven't? What have ye come for, then?"

One day, Hiram walked into Squire Hall's office holding a letter. It was during the old French war, and flour and cornmeal were selling for outrageous prices in the British West Indies. The letter Hiram brought was from a Philadelphia merchant, Josiah Shippin, with whom he had done some business. Mr. Shippin suggested that Hiram team up with him to send a shipment of flour and cornmeal to Kingston, Jamaica. Hiram had thought about the letter overnight and now he brought it to the old Squire. Squire Hall read the letter, shaking his head the whole time. "Too much risk, Hiram!" he said. "Mr. Shippin wouldn’t have asked you to join this venture if he could have found anyone else to do it. My advice is to steer clear of it. I assume you came to me for advice?" Hiram shook his head. "You didn't? What did you come for, then?"

"Seven hundred pounds," said Hiram.

"Seven hundred bucks," said Hiram.

"Seven hundred pounds!" said Squire Hall. "I haven't got seven hundred pounds to lend you, Hiram."

"Seven hundred pounds!" said Squire Hall. "I don’t have seven hundred pounds to lend you, Hiram."

"Five hundred been left to Levi—I got hundred—raise hundred more on mortgage," said Hiram.

"Five hundred was left to Levi—I got a hundred— I'll raise a hundred more on a mortgage," said Hiram.

"Tut, tut, Hiram," said Squire Hall, "that'll never do in the world. Suppose Levi West should come back again, what then? I'm responsible for that money. If you wanted to borrow it now for any reasonable venture, you should have it and welcome, but for such a wildcat scheme—"

"Tut, tut, Hiram," Squire Hall said, "that won’t work at all. What if Levi West decides to come back? I’m accountable for that money. If you wanted to borrow it now for a reasonable project, you’d get it without any issue, but for such a crazy idea—"

"Levi never come back," said Hiram—"nine years gone—Levi's dead."

"Levi never came back," said Hiram—"it's been nine years—Levi's dead."

"Mebby he is," said Squire Hall, "but we don't know that."

"Might be he is," said Squire Hall, "but we don't know that."

"I'll give bond for security," said Hiram.

"I'll provide a guarantee for security," said Hiram.

Squire Hall thought for a while in silence. "Very well, Hiram," said he by and by, "if you'll do that. Your father left the money, and I don't see that it's right for me to stay his son from using it.[157] But if it is lost, Hiram, and if Levi should come back, it will go well to ruin ye."

Squire Hall thought for a moment in silence. "Alright, Hiram," he finally said, "if you'll do that. Your father left the money, and I don’t think it’s fair for me to stop his son from using it.[157] But if it gets lost, Hiram, and if Levi comes back, it will likely ruin you."

So Hiram White invested seven hundred pounds in the Jamaica venture and every farthing of it was burned by Blueskin, off Currituck Sound.

So Hiram White invested seven hundred pounds in the Jamaica venture, and every single penny of it was lost by Blueskin, off Currituck Sound.

IV

Sally Martin was said to be the prettiest girl in Lewes Hundred, and when the rumor began to leak out that Hiram White was courting her the whole community took it as a monstrous joke. It was the common thing to greet Hiram himself with, "Hey, Hiram; how's Sally?" Hiram never made answer to such salutation, but went his way as heavily, as impassively, as dully as ever.

Sally Martin was considered the prettiest girl in Lewes Hundred, and when the news started spreading that Hiram White was dating her, the entire community thought it was a huge joke. People would often greet Hiram with, "Hey, Hiram; how's Sally?" Hiram never responded to such greetings but continued on his way, just as heavy, emotionless, and dull as always.

The joke was true. Twice a week, rain or shine, Hiram White never failed to scrape his feet upon Billy Martin's doorstep. Twice a week, on Sundays and Thursdays, he never failed to take his customary seat by the kitchen fire. He rarely said anything by way of talk; he nodded to the farmer, to his wife, to Sally and, when he chanced to be at home, to her brother, but he ventured nothing further. There he would sit from half past seven until nine o'clock, stolid, heavy, impassive, his dull eyes following now one of the family and now another, but always coming back again to Sally. It sometimes happened that she had other company—some of the young men of the neighborhood. The presence of such seemed to make no difference to Hiram; he bore whatever broad jokes might be cracked upon him, whatever grins, whatever giggling might follow those jokes, with the same patient impassiveness. There he would sit, silent, unresponsive; then, at the first stroke of nine o'clock, he would rise, shoulder his ungainly person into his overcoat, twist his head into his three-cornered hat, and with a "Good night, Sally, I be going now," would take his departure, shutting the door carefully to behind him.[158]

The joke was true. Twice a week, rain or shine, Hiram White always scraped his feet on Billy Martin's doorstep. Every Sunday and Thursday, he would take his usual spot by the kitchen fire. He rarely talked; he nodded at the farmer, his wife, Sally, and occasionally her brother if he was home, but he never said much more. He would sit there from 7:30 until 9:00, solid, heavy, and expressionless, his dull eyes shifting from one family member to another, but always returning to Sally. Sometimes she had other company—some young men from the neighborhood. This didn't seem to bother Hiram; he took whatever jokes were aimed at him and the laughter that followed with the same patient indifference. He would remain silent and unresponsive; then, right at 9:00, he would rise, awkwardly put on his overcoat, adjust his three-cornered hat, and with a "Good night, Sally, I’m going now," he would leave, carefully shutting the door behind him.[158]

Never, perhaps, was there a girl in the world had such a lover and such a courtship as Sally Martin.

Never, maybe, was there a girl in the world who had such a lover and such a courtship as Sally Martin.

V

It was one Thursday evening in the latter part of November, about a week after Blueskin's appearance off the capes, and while the one subject of talk was of the pirates being in Indian River inlet. The air was still and wintry; a sudden cold snap had set in and skins of ice had formed over puddles in the road; the smoke from the chimneys rose straight in the quiet air and voices sounded loud, as they do in frosty weather.

It was a Thursday evening in late November, about a week after Blueskin showed up off the capes, and the main topic of conversation was the pirates being in Indian River inlet. The air was still and chilly; a sudden cold snap had hit, and sheets of ice had formed over puddles on the road. The smoke from the chimneys rose straight up into the calm air, and voices sounded loud, as they do in cold weather.

Hiram White sat by the dim light of a tallow dip, poring laboriously over some account books. It was not quite seven o'clock, and he never started for Billy Martin's before that hour. As he ran his finger slowly and hesitatingly down the column of figures, he heard the kitchen door beyond open and shut, the noise of footsteps crossing the floor and the scraping of a chair dragged forward to the hearth. Then came the sound of a basket of corncobs being emptied on the smoldering blaze and then the snapping and crackling of the reanimated fire. Hiram thought nothing of all this, excepting, in a dim sort of way, that it was Bob, the negro mill hand, or old black Dinah, the housekeeper, and so went on with his calculations.

Hiram White sat by the dim light of a candle, carefully studying some accounting books. It was just shy of seven o'clock, and he never left for Billy Martin's before that time. As he slowly and hesitantly traced his finger down the column of numbers, he heard the kitchen door open and close, footsteps crossing the floor, and the sound of a chair being pulled up to the hearth. Then he heard a basket of corncobs being dumped onto the smoldering fire, followed by the snapping and crackling as the flames came to life. Hiram didn’t think much of it, only vaguely realizing it was either Bob, the Black mill worker, or old Dinah, the housekeeper, so he continued with his calculations.

At last he closed the books with a snap and, smoothing down his hair, arose, took up the candle, and passed out of the room into the kitchen beyond.

At last, he shut the books with a snap, ran his fingers through his hair, stood up, grabbed the candle, and walked out of the room into the kitchen.

A man was sitting in front of the corncob fire that flamed and blazed in the great, gaping, sooty fireplace. A rough overcoat was flung over the chair behind him and his hands were spread out to the roaring warmth. At the sound of the lifted latch and of Hiram's entrance he turned his head, and when Hiram saw his face he stood suddenly still as though turned to stone. The face, marvelously altered and changed as it was, was the face of his[159] stepbrother, Levi West. He was not dead; he had come home again. For a time not a sound broke the dead, unbroken silence excepting the crackling of the blaze in the fireplace and the sharp ticking of the tall clock in the corner. The one face, dull and stolid, with the light of the candle shining upward over its lumpy features, looked fixedly, immovably, stonily at the other, sharp, shrewd, cunning—the red wavering light of the blaze shining upon the high cheek bones, cutting sharp on the nose and twinkling in the glassy turn of the black, ratlike eyes. Then suddenly that face cracked, broadened, spread to a grin. "I have come back again, Hi," said Levi, and at the sound of the words the speechless spell was broken.

A man was sitting in front of the corncob fire that blazed in the large, open, sooty fireplace. A worn overcoat was tossed over the chair behind him, and his hands were stretched out to enjoy the roaring warmth. When he heard the latch lift and Hiram enter, he turned his head, and as soon as Hiram saw his face, he froze, as if turned to stone. The face, remarkably changed and altered, was that of his[159] stepbrother, Levi West. He wasn't dead; he had come home again. For a time, the silence was unbroken except for the crackling of the fire and the sharp ticking of the tall clock in the corner. One face, dull and expressionless, with the candlelight flickering over its bumpy features, stared fixedly, motionlessly at the other face, sharp, clever, and cunning—the red flickering light of the fire highlighting the high cheekbones, sharply defining the nose, and gleaming in the glassy, ratlike eyes. Then suddenly, that face broke into a wide grin. "I’ve come back again, Hi," said Levi, and the moment he spoke, the spell of silence was shattered.

Hiram answered never a word, but he walked to the fireplace, set the candle down upon the dusty mantelshelf among the boxes and bottles, and, drawing forward a chair upon the other side of the hearth, sat down.

Hiram didn't say a word, but he went to the fireplace, placed the candle on the dusty mantel among the boxes and bottles, and pulled up a chair on the other side of the hearth to sit down.

His dull little eyes never moved from his stepbrother's face. There was no curiosity in his expression, no surprise, no wonder. The heavy under lip dropped a little farther open and there was more than usual of dull, expressionless stupidity upon the lumpish face; but that was all.

His lifeless little eyes stayed fixed on his stepbrother's face. There was no curiosity in his expression, no surprise, no wonder. His heavy lower lip hung a bit lower, and his expressionless dullness made his chubby face look even more vacant; but that was it.

As was said, the face upon which he looked was strangely, marvelously changed from what it had been when he had last seen it nine years before, and, though it was still the face of Levi West, it was a very different Levi West than the shiftless ne'er-do-well who had run away to sea in the Brazilian brig that long time ago. That Levi West had been a rough, careless, happy-go-lucky fellow; thoughtless and selfish, but with nothing essentially evil or sinister in his nature. The Levi West that now sat in a rush-bottom chair at the other side of the fireplace had that stamped upon his front that might be both evil and sinister. His swart complexion was tanned to an Indian copper. On one side of his face was a curious discoloration in the skin and a long, crooked, cruel scar that ran diagonally across forehead and temple and[160] cheek in a white, jagged seam. This discoloration was of a livid blue, about the tint of a tattoo mark. It made a patch the size of a man's hand, lying across the cheek and the side of the neck. Hiram could not keep his eyes from this mark and the white scar cutting across it.

As mentioned, the face he was looking at had changed in strange and remarkable ways since he last saw it nine years ago, and while it was still Levi West's face, it belonged to a very different Levi West than the aimless slacker who had run away to sea on the Brazilian brig so long ago. That Levi West had been a rough, carefree, happy-go-lucky guy; thoughtless and selfish, but with nothing essentially evil or sinister about him. The Levi West now sitting in a rush-bottom chair on the other side of the fireplace had something stamped on his features that could be both evil and sinister. His dark skin was tanned to a deep copper color. On one side of his face was a strange discoloration and a long, crooked, cruel scar that ran diagonally across his forehead, temple, and cheek in a white, jagged line. This discoloration was a livid blue, similar to a tattoo. It formed a patch the size of a man's hand, spread across his cheek and the side of his neck. Hiram couldn’t take his eyes off this mark and the white scar cutting across it.

There was an odd sort of incongruity in Levi's dress; a pair of heavy gold earrings and a dirty red handkerchief knotted loosely around his neck, beneath an open collar, displaying to its full length the lean, sinewy throat with its bony "Adam's apple," gave to his costume somewhat the smack of a sailor. He wore a coat that had once been of fine plum color—now stained and faded—too small for his lean length, and furbished with tarnished lace. Dirty cambric cuffs hung at his wrists and on his fingers were half a dozen and more rings, set with stones that shone, and glistened, and twinkled in the light of the fire. The hair at either temple was twisted into a Spanish curl, plastered flat to the cheek, and a plaited queue hung halfway down his back.

There was a strange mix in Levi's style; he had a pair of heavy gold earrings and a dirty red handkerchief loosely tied around his neck, underneath an open collar, showing off his lean, sinewy throat with its bony "Adam's apple," which gave his outfit a bit of a sailor vibe. He wore a coat that used to be a rich plum color—now stained and faded—too small for his lanky frame, decorated with tarnished lace. Dirty cambric cuffs drooped at his wrists, and his fingers sparkled with more than half a dozen rings, set with stones that shone, glimmered, and twinkled in the firelight. The hair at both temples was twisted into a Spanish curl, slicked flat against his cheeks, and a braided queue hung halfway down his back.

Hiram, speaking never a word, sat motionless, his dull little eyes traveling slowly up and down and around and around his stepbrother's person.

Hiram sat silently, completely still, his dull little eyes slowly scanning his stepbrother from top to bottom and back again.

Levi did not seem to notice his scrutiny, leaning forward, now with his palms spread out to the grateful warmth, now rubbing them slowly together. But at last he suddenly whirled his chair around, rasping on the floor, and faced his stepbrother. He thrust his hand into his capacious coat pocket and brought out a pipe which he proceeded to fill from a skin of tobacco. "Well, Hi," said he, "d'ye see I've come back home again?"

Levi didn’t seem to notice he was being watched. He leaned forward, spreading his palms to soak up the warm air, then rubbed his hands together slowly. But finally, he suddenly spun his chair around, scraping it across the floor, and faced his stepbrother. He reached into his big coat pocket and pulled out a pipe, which he started to fill from a pouch of tobacco. "Well, Hi," he said, "do you see I’ve come back home again?"

"Thought you was dead," said Hiram, dully.

"Thought you were dead," Hiram said flatly.

Levi laughed, then he drew a red-hot coal out of the fire, put it upon the bowl of the pipe and began puffing out clouds of pungent smoke. "Nay, nay," said he; "not dead—not dead by odds. But [puff] by the Eternal Holy, Hi, I played many a close game [puff] with old Davy Jones, for all that."[161]

Levi laughed, then pulled a red-hot coal from the fire, placed it on the bowl of his pipe, and started blowing out thick clouds of strong-smelling smoke. "No way, no way," he said; "not dead—not even close. But [puff] by the Eternal Holy, wow, I’ve had my fair share of close calls [puff] with old Davy Jones, for sure."[161]

Hiram's look turned inquiringly toward the jagged scar and Levi caught the slow glance. "You're lookin' at this," said he, running his finger down the crooked seam. "That looks bad, but it wasn't so close as this"—laying his hand for a moment upon the livid stain. "A cooly devil off Singapore gave me that cut when we fell foul of an opium junk in the China Sea four years ago last September. This," touching the disfiguring blue patch again, "was a closer miss, Hi. A Spanish captain fired a pistol at me down off Santa Catharina. He was so nigh that the powder went under the skin and it'll never come out again. —— his eyes—he had better have fired the pistol into his own head that morning. But never mind that. I reckon I'm changed, ain't I, Hi?"

Hiram glanced curiously at the jagged scar, and Levi noticed the lingering look. "You’re looking at this," he said, trailing his finger along the crooked seam. "That looks bad, but it wasn’t as close as this"—he paused, resting his hand momentarily on the dark stain. "A guy from Singapore gave me this cut when we collided with an opium boat in the China Sea four years ago last September. This," he said, touching the discolored blue patch again, "was a closer call, Hi. A Spanish captain shot at me near Santa Catharina. He was so close that the gunpowder got under my skin, and it’ll never come out. —His eyes—he would have been better off shooting himself in the head that morning. But, forget that. I guess I look different now, right, Hi?"

He took his pipe out of his mouth and looked inquiringly at Hiram, who nodded.

He took his pipe out of his mouth and looked curiously at Hiram, who nodded.

Levi laughed. "Devil doubt it," said he, "but whether I'm changed or no, I'll take my affidavy that you are the same old half-witted Hi that you used to be. I remember dad used to say that you hadn't no more than enough wits to keep you out of the rain. And, talking of dad, Hi, I hearn tell he's been dead now these nine years gone. D'ye know what I've come home for?"

Levi laughed. "No doubt about it," he said, "but whether I've changed or not, I'll swear you're still the same old clueless Hi you used to be. I remember Dad used to say you had barely enough sense to keep yourself dry in the rain. And speaking of Dad, Hi, I heard he’s been gone for nine years now. Do you know why I came home?"

Hiram shook his head.

Hiram shook his head.

"I've come for that five hundred pounds that dad left me when he died, for I hearn tell of that, too."

"I've come for the five hundred pounds that dad left me when he died, because I heard about that, too."

Hiram sat quite still for a second or two and then he said, "I put that money out to venture and lost it all."

Hiram sat still for a moment and then said, "I invested that money and lost it all."

Levi's face fell and he took his pipe out of his mouth, regarding Hiram sharply and keenly. "What d'ye mean?" said he presently.

Levi's expression changed, and he took his pipe out of his mouth, looking at Hiram sharply and intently. "What do you mean?" he asked after a moment.

"I thought you was dead—and I put—seven hundred pounds—into Nancy Lee—and Blueskin burned her—off Currituck."

"I thought you were dead—and I put—seven hundred pounds—into Nancy Lee—and Blueskin burned her—off Currituck."

"Burned her off Currituck!" repeated Levi. Then suddenly a light seemed to break upon his comprehension. "Burned by Blueskin!" he repeated, and thereupon flung himself back in his chair and burst into a short, boisterous fit of laughter. "Well, by[162] the Holy Eternal, Hi, if that isn't a piece of your tarnal luck. Burned by Blueskin, was it?" He paused for a moment, as though turning it over in his mind. Then he laughed again. "All the same," said he presently, "d'ye see, I can't suffer for Blueskin's doings. The money was willed to me, fair and true, and you have got to pay it, Hiram White, burn or sink, Blueskin or no Blueskin." Again he puffed for a moment or two in reflective silence. "All the same, Hi," said he, once more resuming the thread of talk, "I don't reckon to be too hard on you. You be only half-witted, anyway, and I sha'n't be too hard on you. I give you a month to raise that money, and while you're doing it I'll jest hang around here. I've been in trouble, Hi, d'ye see. I'm under a cloud and so I want to keep here, as quiet as may be. I'll tell ye how it came about: I had a set-to with a land pirate in Philadelphia, and somebody got hurt. That's the reason I'm here now, and don't you say anything about it. Do you understand?"

"Burned her off Currituck!" Levi said again. Then, suddenly, it seemed like he understood. "Burned by Blueskin!" he repeated and then threw himself back in his chair, laughing loudly for a moment. "Well, by[162] the Holy Eternal, Hi, if that isn’t just your terrible luck. Burned by Blueskin, huh?" He paused for a second, considering it. Then he laughed again. "Still," he said after a moment, "you see, I can’t be held responsible for what Blueskin does. The money was left to me, fair and square, and you have to pay up, Hiram White, whether it’s burning or sinking, Blueskin or no Blueskin." He sat in thoughtful silence for a bit. "But don’t worry, Hi," he continued, picking up the conversation again, "I’m not going to be too hard on you. You’re only half-bright anyway, and I won’t be too tough on you. I give you a month to get that money together, and while you’re working on it, I’ll just hang around here. I've been in some trouble, Hi, you know. I’m not in a good spot, and I want to stay here as quietly as I can. Here’s how it happened: I had a run-in with a land pirate in Philadelphia, and someone got hurt. That’s why I’m here now, and don’t mention it to anyone. Got it?"

Colonel Rhett and the Pirate Colonel Rhett and the Pirate

Illustration from
COLONIES AND NATION

by Woodrow Wilson

Originally published in
Harper's Magazine, May 1901

Hiram opened his lips as though it was his intent to answer, then seemed to think better of it and contented himself by nodding his head.

Hiram opened his mouth as if he was going to respond, then seemed to reconsider and settled for just nodding his head.

That Thursday night was the first for a six-month that Hiram White did not scrape his feet clean at Billy Martin's doorstep.

That Thursday night was the first in six months that Hiram White didn’t scrape his feet clean at Billy Martin’s doorstep.

VI

Within a week Levi West had pretty well established himself among his old friends and acquaintances, though upon a different footing from that of nine years before, for this was a very different Levi from that other. Nevertheless, he was none the less popular in the barroom of the tavern and at the country store, where he was always the center of a group of loungers. His nine years seemed to have been crowded full of the wildest of wild adventures and happenings, as well by land as by sea, and, given an appreciative audience, he would reel off his yarns by the hour, in a reckless, devil-may-care fashion that set agape even old sea dogs who had [163]sailed the western ocean since boyhood. Then he seemed always to have plenty of money, and he loved to spend it at the tavern taproom, with a lavishness that was at once the wonder and admiration of gossips.

Within a week, Levi West had pretty much established himself among his old friends and acquaintances, though this time it was on a different level than it had been nine years ago, because he was a very different Levi now. Still, he was just as popular in the tavern’s barroom and at the local store, where he was always the center of a group of hangers-on. His nine years seemed to have been packed with the wildest adventures and experiences, both on land and at sea, and given an appreciative audience, he could share his stories for hours with a reckless, carefree attitude that left even the old sea dogs, who had [163] sailed the western ocean since they were kids, in awe. Plus, he always seemed to have plenty of money, and he loved to spend it in the tavern taproom, with a generosity that both amazed and intrigued the local gossipmongers.

At that time, as was said, Blueskin was the one engrossing topic of talk, and it added not a little to Levi's prestige when it was found that he had actually often seen that bloody, devilish pirate with his own eyes. A great, heavy, burly fellow, Levi said he was, with a beard as black as a hat—a devil with his sword and pistol afloat, but not so black as he was painted when ashore. He told of many adventures in which Blueskin figured and was then always listened to with more than usual gaping interest.

At that time, as mentioned, Blueskin was the most talked-about subject, and it boosted Levi's reputation when people discovered that he had actually seen that bloody, devilish pirate in person. Levi described him as a huge, burly guy with a beard as black as a hat—a real devil with his sword and pistol on the water, but not as menacing as he was made out to be on land. He shared many stories about adventures involving Blueskin, and people listened with extra fascination.

As for Blueskin, the quiet way in which the pirates conducted themselves at Indian River almost made the Lewes folk forget what he could do when the occasion called. They almost ceased to remember that poor shattered schooner that had crawled with its ghastly dead and groaning wounded into the harbor a couple of weeks since. But if for a while they forgot who or what Blueskin was, it was not for long.

As for Blueskin, the way the pirates acted quietly at Indian River almost made the people of Lewes forget what he was capable of when the moment required it. They nearly stopped remembering the poor damaged schooner that had limped into the harbor a couple of weeks ago, filled with its horrific dead and moaning wounded. But even if they momentarily forgot who or what Blueskin was, it didn’t last long.

One day a bark from Bristol, bound for Cuba and laden with a valuable cargo of cloth stuffs and silks, put into Lewes harbor to take in water. The captain himself came ashore and was at the tavern for two or three hours. It happened that Levi was there and that the talk was of Blueskin. The English captain, a grizzled old sea dog, listened to Levi's yarns with not a little contempt. He had, he said, sailed in the China Sea and the Indian Ocean too long to be afraid of any hog-eating Yankee pirate such as this Blueskin. A junk full of coolies armed with stink-pots was something to speak of, but who ever heard of the likes of Blueskin falling afoul of anything more than a Spanish canoe or a Yankee coaster?

One day, a ship from Bristol heading to Cuba and carrying a valuable load of cloth and silks stopped in Lewes harbor to take on water. The captain came ashore and spent two or three hours at the tavern. Levi happened to be there, and they were discussing Blueskin. The English captain, an old sea dog with gray hair, listened to Levi's stories with a bit of disdain. He claimed he had sailed in the China Sea and the Indian Ocean long enough not to be scared of any hog-eating Yankee pirate like Blueskin. A junk full of coolies armed with stink bombs was worth talking about, but who ever heard of someone like Blueskin getting into trouble with anything larger than a Spanish canoe or a Yankee coaster?

Levi grinned. "All the same, my hearty," said he, "if I was you I'd give Blueskin a wide berth. I hear that he's cleaned the[164] vessel that was careened awhile ago, and mebby he'll give you a little trouble if you come too nigh him."

Levi smiled. "Still, my friend," he said, "if I were you, I'd stay clear of Blueskin. I hear he’s taken care of the [164] ship that was tilted recently, and he might cause you some trouble if you get too close to him."

To this the Englishman only answered that Blueskin might be——, and that the next afternoon, wind and weather permitting, he intended to heave anchor and run out to sea.

To this, the Englishman simply replied that Blueskin might be——, and that the next afternoon, if the wind and weather were favorable, he planned to raise the anchor and head out to sea.

Levi laughed again. "I wish I might be here to see what'll happen," said he, "but I'm going up the river to-night to see a gal and mebby won't be back again for three or four days."

Levi laughed again. "I wish I could be here to see what happens," he said, "but I'm heading up the river tonight to see a girl and maybe won't be back for three or four days."

The next afternoon the English bark set sail as the captain promised, and that night Lewes town was awake until almost morning, gazing at a broad red glare that lighted up the sky away toward the southeast. Two days afterward a negro oysterman came up from Indian River with news that the pirates were lying off the inlet, bringing ashore bales of goods from their larger vessel and piling the same upon the beach under tarpaulins. He said that it was known down at Indian River that Blueskin had fallen afoul of an English bark, had burned her and had murdered the captain and all but three of the crew, who had joined with the pirates.

The next afternoon, the English ship set sail as the captain promised, and that night, Lewes was awake until almost morning, watching a bright red glow lighting up the sky to the southeast. Two days later, a black oysterman came up from Indian River with news that the pirates were hanging out by the inlet, unloading bales of goods from their bigger ship and stacking them on the beach under tarps. He said that it was known down at Indian River that Blueskin had clashed with an English ship, had burned it, and had killed the captain and all but three of the crew, who had joined the pirates.

The excitement over this terrible happening had only begun to subside when another occurred to cap it. One afternoon a ship's boat, in which were five men and two women, came rowing into Lewes harbor. It was the longboat of the Charleston packet, bound for New York, and was commanded by the first mate. The packet had been attacked and captured by the pirates about ten leagues south by east of Cape Henlopen. The pirates had come aboard of them at night and no resistance had been offered. Perhaps it was that circumstance that saved the lives of all, for no murder or violence had been done. Nevertheless, officers, passengers and crew had been stripped of everything of value and set adrift in the boats and the ship herself had been burned. The longboat had become separated from the others during the night and had sighted Henlopen a little after sunrise.[165]

The excitement over this terrible event had just started to fade when another one happened to follow it. One afternoon, a ship's boat with five men and two women rowed into Lewes harbor. It was the longboat from the Charleston packet, headed for New York, and was led by the first mate. The packet had been attacked and taken by pirates about ten leagues south by east of Cape Henlopen. The pirates had boarded them at night, and no one fought back. Maybe that’s what saved their lives, since no murder or violence occurred. However, officers, passengers, and crew were stripped of all their valuables and set adrift in boats, while the ship itself was burned. The longboat had gotten separated from the others during the night and spotted Henlopen shortly after sunrise.[165]

It may be here said that Squire Hall made out a report of these two occurrences and sent it up to Philadelphia by the mate of the packet. But for some reason it was nearly four weeks before a sloop of war was sent around from New York. In the meanwhile, the pirates had disposed of the booty stored under the tarpaulins on the beach at Indian River inlet, shipping some of it away in two small sloops and sending the rest by wagons somewhere up the country.

It can be noted that Squire Hall prepared a report about these two events and sent it to Philadelphia with the mate of the packet. However, for some reason, it took almost four weeks before a war sloop was sent over from New York. In the meantime, the pirates had gotten rid of the loot hidden under the tarps on the beach at Indian River inlet, sending some of it away on two small sloops and transporting the rest by wagon to somewhere inland.

VII

Levi had told the English captain that he was going up-country to visit one of his lady friends. He was gone nearly two weeks. Then once more he appeared, as suddenly, as unexpectedly, as he had done when he first returned to Lewes. Hiram was sitting at supper when the door opened and Levi walked in, hanging up his hat behind the door as unconcernedly as though he had only been gone an hour. He was in an ugly, lowering humor and sat himself down at the table without uttering a word, resting his chin upon his clenched fist and glowering fixedly at the corn cake while Dinah fetched him a plate and knife and fork.

Levi had told the English captain that he was heading upcountry to visit a female friend. He was gone for almost two weeks. Then suddenly, just as unexpectedly as when he first returned to Lewes, he appeared again. Hiram was having dinner when the door opened and Levi walked in, casually hanging up his hat behind the door as if he had only been gone for an hour. He was in a bad mood and sat down at the table without saying a word, resting his chin on his clenched fist and staring intently at the corn cake while Dinah brought him a plate, knife, and fork.

His coming seemed to have taken away all of Hiram's appetite. He pushed away his plate and sat staring at his stepbrother, who presently fell to at the bacon and eggs like a famished wolf. Not a word was said until Levi had ended his meal and filled his pipe. "Look'ee, Hiram," said he, as he stooped over the fire and raked out a hot coal. "Look'ee, Hiram! I've been to Philadelphia, d'ye see, a-settlin' up that trouble I told you about when I first come home. D'ye understand? D'ye remember? D'ye get it through your skull?" He looked around over his shoulder, waiting as though for an answer. But getting none, he continued: "I expect two gentlemen here from Philadelphia to-night. They're friends of mine and are coming to talk over the business and ye needn't stay at home, Hi. You can go out[166] somewhere, d'ye understand?" And then he added with a grin, "Ye can go to see Sally."

His arrival seemed to drain all of Hiram's appetite. He pushed his plate away and sat staring at his stepbrother, who was now devouring the bacon and eggs like a hungry wolf. Not a word was spoken until Levi finished his meal and lit his pipe. "Listen, Hiram," he said as he leaned over the fire to pull out a hot coal. "Listen, Hiram! I've been to Philadelphia, you see, to settle that issue I mentioned when I first got back. Do you understand? Do you remember? Are you getting it through your head?" He glanced back over his shoulder, waiting for a response. But receiving none, he continued: "I'm expecting two guys from Philadelphia tonight. They're my friends and they're coming to discuss the business, and you don't have to stay home, Hi. You can go out[166] somewhere, you get it?" Then he added with a grin, "You can go see Sally."

Hiram pushed back his chair and arose. He leaned with his back against the side of the fireplace. "I'll stay at home," said he presently.

Hiram pushed his chair back and stood up. He leaned against the side of the fireplace. "I’ll stay home," he said after a moment.

"But I don't want you to stay at home, Hi," said Levi. "We'll have to talk business and I want you to go!"

"But I don't want you to stay home, Hi," Levi said. "We need to discuss business, and I want you to be there!"

"I'll stay at home," said Hiram again.

"I'll stay home," Hiram said again.

Levi's brow grew as black as thunder. He ground his teeth together and for a moment or two it seemed as though an explosion was coming. But he swallowed his passion with a gulp. "You're a——pig-headed, half-witted fool," said he. Hiram never so much as moved his eyes. "As for you," said Levi, whirling round upon Dinah, who was clearing the table, and glowering balefully upon the old negress, "you put them things down and git out of here. Don't you come nigh this kitchen again till I tell ye to. If I catch you pryin' around may I be ——, eyes and liver, if I don't cut your heart out."

Levi's brow darkened with anger. He clenched his teeth, and for a moment, it felt like he might explode. But he swallowed his rage with a deep breath. "You're a stubborn, dim-witted fool," he said. Hiram didn't even blink. "And you," Levi said, turning sharply to Dinah, who was clearing the table, glaring fiercely at the old woman, "put those things down and get out of here. Don't come near this kitchen again until I say so. If I catch you snooping around, may I be damned, if I don't take your heart out."


In about half an hour Levi's friends came; the first a little, thin, wizened man with a very foreign look. He was dressed in a rusty black suit and wore gray yarn stockings and shoes with brass buckles. The other was also plainly a foreigner. He was dressed in sailor fashion, with petticoat breeches of duck, a heavy pea-jacket, and thick boots, reaching to the knees. He wore a red sash tied around his waist, and once, as he pushed back his coat, Hiram saw the glitter of a pistol butt. He was a powerful, thickset man, low-browed and bull-necked, his cheek, and chin, and throat closely covered with a stubble of blue-black beard. He wore a red kerchief tied around his head and over it a cocked hat, edged with tarnished gilt braid.

In about half an hour, Levi's friends arrived; the first was a small, thin, scrappy-looking man with a distinctly foreign appearance. He was wearing a worn black suit, gray wool stockings, and shoes with brass buckles. The other man was obviously a foreigner as well. He was dressed in a sailor's outfit, with knee-length breeches made of duck fabric, a heavy pea coat, and thick knee-high boots. A red sash was tied around his waist, and when he pushed back his coat, Hiram noticed the gleam of a pistol butt. He was a strong, stocky man, with a low brow and thick neck, his cheeks, chin, and neck covered in a stubble of blue-black beard. He had a red bandana tied around his head and wore a cocked hat edged with tarnished gold braid.

Levi himself opened the door to them. He exchanged a few words outside with his visitors, in a foreign language of which[167] Hiram understood nothing. Neither of the two strangers spoke a word to Hiram: the little man shot him a sharp look out of the corners of his eyes and the burly ruffian scowled blackly at him, but beyond that neither vouchsafed him any regard.

Levi himself opened the door for them. He said a few words outside with his visitors in a foreign language that Hiram didn’t understand at all. Neither of the two strangers spoke to Hiram: the little man gave him a sharp glance out of the corner of his eye, and the bulky thug frowned at him, but other than that, neither acknowledged him.

Levi drew to the shutters, shot the bolt in the outer door, and tilted a chair against the latch of the one that led from the kitchen into the adjoining room. Then the three worthies seated themselves at the table which Dinah had half cleared of the supper china, and were presently deeply engrossed over a packet of papers which the big, burly man had brought with him in the pocket of his pea-jacket. The confabulation was conducted throughout in the same foreign language which Levi had used when first speaking to them—a language quite unintelligible to Hiram's ears. Now and then the murmur of talk would rise loud and harsh over some disputed point; now and then it would sink away to whispers.

Levi closed the shutters, locked the outer door, and propped a chair against the latch of the door that led from the kitchen to the next room. Then, the three men sat down at the table that Dinah had partially cleared of the dinner dishes and soon became engrossed in a stack of papers that the big, burly man had brought in his pea coat pocket. The conversation was carried on entirely in the same foreign language that Levi had used when he first spoke to them—a language completely incomprehensible to Hiram. Occasionally, the sound of their discussion would rise loudly and harshly over some disagreement; at other times, it would fade into whispers.

Twice the tall clock in the corner whirred and sharply struck the hour, but throughout the whole long consultation Hiram stood silent, motionless as a stock, his eyes fixed almost unwinkingly upon the three heads grouped close together around the dim, flickering light of the candle and the papers scattered upon the table.

Twice the tall clock in the corner whirred and chimed the hour, but during the entire long consultation, Hiram stood silent, as still as a statue, his eyes almost unblinking as he focused intently on the three heads huddled close together around the dim, flickering light of the candle and the papers spread across the table.

Suddenly the talk came to an end, the three heads separated and the three chairs were pushed back, grating harshly. Levi rose, went to the closet and brought thence a bottle of Hiram's apple brandy, as coolly as though it belonged to himself. He set three tumblers and a crock of water upon the table and each helped himself liberally.

Suddenly, the conversation stopped, the three people pulled away, and the chairs scraped back with a loud noise. Levi stood up, walked over to the closet, and casually grabbed a bottle of Hiram's apple brandy as if it belonged to him. He put three glasses and a pitcher of water on the table, and everyone poured themselves a generous drink.

As the two visitors departed down the road, Levi stood for a while at the open door, looking after the dusky figures until they were swallowed in the darkness. Then he turned, came in, shut the door, shuddered, took a final dose of the apple brandy and went to bed, without, since his first suppressed explosion, having said a single word to Hiram.[168]

As the two visitors left down the road, Levi lingered at the open door, watching the shadowy figures until they disappeared into the darkness. Then he turned, stepped inside, closed the door, shivered, took one last sip of the apple brandy, and went to bed, not having said a single word to Hiram since his initial outburst.[168]

Hiram, left alone, stood for a while, silent, motionless as ever, then he looked slowly about him, gave a shake of the shoulders as though to arouse himself, and taking the candle, left the room, shutting the door noiselessly behind him.

Hiram, alone now, stood in silence for a moment, as still as ever. Then he slowly looked around, shrugged his shoulders as if to wake himself up, and took the candle before leaving the room, closing the door quietly behind him.

VIII

This time of Levi West's unwelcome visitation was indeed a time of bitter trouble and tribulation to poor Hiram White. Money was of very different value in those days than it is now, and five hundred pounds was in its way a good round lump—in Sussex County it was almost a fortune. It was a desperate struggle for Hiram to raise the amount of his father's bequest to his stepbrother. Squire Hall, as may have been gathered, had a very warm and friendly feeling for Hiram, believing in him when all others disbelieved; nevertheless, in the matter of money the old man was as hard and as cold as adamant. He would, he said, do all he could to help Hiram, but that five hundred pounds must and should be raised—Hiram must release his security bond. He would loan him, he said, three hundred pounds, taking a mortgage upon the mill. He would have lent him four hundred but that there was already a first mortgage of one hundred pounds upon it, and he would not dare to put more than three hundred more atop of that.

Levi West’s unwanted visit was definitely a time of pain and struggle for poor Hiram White. Money meant something very different back then compared to now, and five hundred pounds was quite a significant amount—in Sussex County, it was nearly a fortune. Hiram was desperately trying to come up with the sum of his father’s inheritance for his stepbrother. Squire Hall, as you might have guessed, had a strong bond with Hiram, believing in him when no one else did; still, when it came to money, the old man was as tough and unyielding as stone. He said he would do everything he could to help Hiram, but that five hundred pounds absolutely had to be raised—Hiram needed to release his security bond. He offered to loan him three hundred pounds, taking a mortgage on the mill. He would have lent him four hundred, but there was already a first mortgage of one hundred pounds on it, and he didn’t want to risk putting more than three hundred on top of that.

Hiram had a considerable quantity of wheat which he had bought upon speculation and which was then lying idle in a Philadelphia storehouse. This he had sold at public sale and at a very great sacrifice; he realized barely one hundred pounds upon it. The financial horizon looked very black to him; nevertheless, Levi's five hundred pounds was raised, and paid into Squire Hall's hands, and Squire Hall released Hiram's bond.

Hiram had a large amount of wheat that he had bought on speculation, and it was just sitting unused in a Philadelphia warehouse. He sold it at public auction for a significant loss, only making about one hundred pounds from it. His financial outlook looked quite bleak; however, Levi's five hundred pounds was gathered and handed over to Squire Hall, who then released Hiram's bond.

The business was finally closed on one cold, gray afternoon in the early part of December. As Hiram tore his bond across and then tore it across again and again, Squire Hall pushed back[169] the papers upon his desk and cocked his feet upon its slanting top. "Hiram," said he, abruptly, "Hiram, do you know that Levi West is forever hanging around Billy Martin's house, after that pretty daughter of his?"

The business finally shut down on a cold, gray afternoon in early December. As Hiram ripped his bond apart and tore it again and again, Squire Hall pushed the papers back on his desk and propped his feet up on its slanted surface. "Hiram," he said suddenly, "Hiram, do you know that Levi West is always hanging around Billy Martin's place, after that pretty daughter of his?"

So long a space of silence followed the speech that the Squire began to think that Hiram might not have heard him. But Hiram had heard. "No," said he, "I didn't know it."

So much silence followed the speech that the Squire started to think Hiram might not have heard him. But Hiram had heard. "No," he said, "I didn’t know that."

"Well, he is," said Squire Hall. "It's the talk of the whole neighborhood. The talk's pretty bad, too. D'ye know that they say that she was away from home three days last week, nobody knew where? The fellow's turned her head with his sailor's yarns and his traveler's lies."

"Well, he is," said Squire Hall. "It's the talk of the whole neighborhood. And it's not good talk, either. Did you hear they say she was gone for three days last week, and no one knew where she was? That guy's filled her head with his sailor stories and travel lies."

Hiram said not a word, but he sat looking at the other in stolid silence. "That stepbrother of yours," continued the old Squire presently, "is a rascal—he is a rascal, Hiram, and I mis-doubt he's something worse. I hear he's been seen in some queer places and with queer company of late."

Hiram didn't say anything, but he sat there looking at the other man in silence. "That stepbrother of yours," the old Squire continued after a moment, "is trouble—he's trouble, Hiram, and I suspect he's up to something worse. I've heard he's been spotted in some strange places and with some odd company recently."

He stopped again, and still Hiram said nothing. "And look'ee, Hiram," the old man resumed, suddenly, "I do hear that you be courtin' the girl, too; is that so?"

He stopped again, and Hiram still didn’t say anything. "And look, Hiram," the old man said suddenly, "I hear you’re seeing that girl too; is that true?"

"Yes," said Hiram, "I'm courtin' her, too."

"Yeah," Hiram said, "I'm dating her, too."

"Tut! tut!" said the Squire, "that's a pity, Hiram. I'm afraid your cakes are dough."

"Tut! Tut!" said the Squire, "that's too bad, Hiram. I'm afraid your cakes are still raw."

After he had left the Squire's office, Hiram stood for a while in the street, bareheaded, his hat in his hand, staring unwinkingly down at the ground at his feet, with stupidly drooping lips and lackluster eyes. Presently he raised his hand and began slowly smoothing down the sandy shock of hair upon his forehead. At last he aroused himself with a shake, looked dully up and down the street, and then, putting on his hat, turned and walked slowly and heavily away.

After leaving the Squire's office, Hiram stood in the street for a moment, bareheaded, holding his hat in his hand, staring blankly at the ground at his feet, with droopy lips and dull eyes. Eventually, he raised his hand and started slowly smoothing down the sandy mess of hair on his forehead. Finally, he shook himself awake, glanced listlessly up and down the street, and then, putting on his hat, turned and walked away slowly and heavily.

The early dusk of the cloudy winter evening was settling fast, for the sky was leaden and threatening. At the outskirts of[170] the town Hiram stopped again and again stood for a while in brooding thought. Then, finally, he turned slowly, not the way that led homeward, but taking the road that led between the bare and withered fields and crooked fences toward Billy Martin's.

The early dusk of the cloudy winter evening was settling in quickly, as the sky was gray and ominous. At the edge of[170] the town, Hiram paused repeatedly, lost in deep thought. Then, finally, he turned slowly, not towards home, but down the road that wound between the bare, dry fields and crooked fences toward Billy Martin's place.

It would be hard to say just what it was that led Hiram to seek Billy Martin's house at that time of day—whether it was fate or ill fortune. He could not have chosen a more opportune time to confirm his own undoing. What he saw was the very worst that his heart feared.

It’s tough to pinpoint what drove Hiram to head to Billy Martin’s place at that hour—whether it was destiny or bad luck. He couldn’t have picked a worse time to confront his own downfall. What he discovered was exactly what his heart dreaded the most.

Along the road, at a little distance from the house, was a mock-orange hedge, now bare, naked, leafless. As Hiram drew near he heard footsteps approaching and low voices. He drew back into the fence corner and there stood, half sheltered by the stark network of twigs. Two figures passed slowly along the gray of the roadway in the gloaming. One was his stepbrother, the other was Sally Martin. Levi's arm was around her, he was whispering into her ear, and her head rested upon his shoulder.

Along the road, not far from the house, there was a mock-orange hedge, now bare and leafless. As Hiram got closer, he heard footsteps and quiet voices. He stepped back into the corner of the fence, half-hidden by the bare twigs. Two figures walked slowly along the gray road in the dim light. One was his stepbrother, and the other was Sally Martin. Levi had his arm around her, whispering in her ear, with her head resting on his shoulder.

Hiram stood as still, as breathless, as cold as ice. They stopped upon the side of the road just beyond where he stood. Hiram's eyes never left them. There for some time they talked together in low voices, their words now and then reaching the ears of that silent, breathless listener.

Hiram stood completely still, breathless, and as cold as ice. They stopped on the side of the road just past where he was standing. Hiram's eyes stayed fixed on them. For a while, they spoke in quiet voices, occasionally letting their words reach the ears of that silent, breathless listener.

Suddenly there came the clattering of an opening door, and then Betty Martin's voice broke the silence, harshly, shrilly: "Sal!—Sal!—Sally Martin! You, Sally Martin! Come in yere. Where be ye?"

Suddenly, there was the sound of a door opening, and then Betty Martin's voice pierced the silence, loud and sharp: "Sal!—Sal!—Sally Martin! You, Sally Martin! Come in here. Where are you?"

The girl flung her arms around Levi's neck and their lips met in one quick kiss. The next moment she was gone, flying swiftly, silently, down the road past where Hiram stood, stooping as she ran. Levi stood looking after her until she was gone; then he turned and walked away whistling.

The girl threw her arms around Levi's neck and they shared a quick kiss. In the next moment, she was gone, racing quietly down the road past where Hiram stood, bent over as she ran. Levi kept watching her until she disappeared; then he turned and walked away whistling.

His whistling died shrilly into silence in the wintry distance,[171] and then at last Hiram came stumbling out from the hedge. His face had never looked before as it looked then.

His whistling faded sharply into silence in the wintry distance,[171] and then finally Hiram stumbled out from the hedge. His face had never looked like that before.

IX

Hiram was standing in front of the fire with his hands clasped behind his back. He had not touched the supper on the table. Levi was eating with an appetite. Suddenly he looked over his plate at his stepbrother.

Hiram was standing in front of the fire with his hands clasped behind his back. He hadn’t touched the dinner on the table. Levi was eating heartily. Suddenly, he glanced over his plate at his stepbrother.

"How about that five hundred pounds, Hiram?" said he. "I gave ye a month to raise it and the month ain't quite up yet, but I'm goin' to leave this here place day after to-morrow—by next day at the furd'st—and I want the money that's mine."

"How about that five hundred pounds, Hiram?" he said. "I gave you a month to come up with it, and the month isn't quite over yet, but I'm leaving this place the day after tomorrow—at the latest, the next day—and I want my money."

"I paid it to Squire Hall to-day and he has it fer ye," said Hiram, dully.

"I gave it to Squire Hall today, and he has it for you," said Hiram, flatly.

Levi laid down his knife and fork with a clatter. "Squire Hall!" said he, "what's Squire Hall got to do with it? Squire Hall didn't have the use of that money. It was you had it and you have got to pay it back to me, and if you don't do it, by G——, I'll have the law on you, sure as you're born."

Levi dropped his knife and fork with a loud bang. "Squire Hall!" he said, "what does Squire Hall have to do with this? Squire Hall didn't benefit from that money. You had it, and you need to pay it back to me. If you don’t do it, I swear I’ll take legal action against you, just like you were born."

"Squire Hall's trustee—I ain't your trustee," said Hiram, in the same dull voice.

"Squire Hall's trustee—I’m not your trustee," Hiram said in the same flat tone.

"I don't know nothing about trustees," said Levi, "or anything about lawyer business, either. What I want to know is, are you going to pay me my money or no?"

"I don't know anything about trustees," said Levi, "or anything about legal stuff, either. What I want to know is, are you going to pay me my money or not?"

"No," said Hiram, "I ain't—Squire Hall 'll pay ye; you go to him."

"No," Hiram said, "I'm not—Squire Hall will pay you; you should go to him."

Levi West's face grew purple red. He pushed back, his chair grating harshly. "You—bloody land pirate!" he said, grinding his teeth together. "I see through your tricks. You're up to cheating me out of my money. You know very well that Squire Hall is down on me, hard and bitter—writin' his —— reports to Philadelphia and doing all he can to stir up everybody agin me and to bring[172] the bluejackets down on me. I see through your tricks as clear as glass, but ye sha'n't trick me. I'll have my money if there's law in the land—ye bloody, unnatural thief ye, who'd go agin your dead father's will!"

Levi West's face turned bright red. He pushed his chair back, making a loud screeching sound. "You—damn land pirate!" he exclaimed between clenched teeth. "I see right through your schemes. You're trying to cheat me out of my money. You know that Squire Hall is completely against me—writing his damn reports to Philadelphia and doing everything he can to turn everyone against me and bring[172] the bluejackets down on me. I see your tricks clearly, but you won't fool me. I'll get my money if there's any justice around—you're a filthy, unnatural thief who would go against your dead father's wishes!"

Then—if the roof had fallen in upon him, Levi West could not have been more amazed—Hiram suddenly strode forward, and, leaning half across the table with his fists clenched, fairly glared into Levi's eyes. His face, dull, stupid, wooden, was now fairly convulsed with passion. The great veins stood out upon his temples like knotted whipcords, and when he spoke his voice was more a breathless snarl than the voice of a Christian man.

Then—if the roof had collapsed on him, Levi West could not have been more shocked—Hiram suddenly stepped forward, and, leaning over the table with his fists clenched, stared intensely into Levi's eyes. His face, once dull and expressionless, was now twisted with emotion. The thick veins bulged on his temples like knotted ropes, and when he spoke, his voice was more of a breathless snarl than that of a decent man.

"Ye'll have the law, will ye?" said he. "Ye'll—have the law, will ye? You're afeared to go to law—Levi West—you try th' law—and see how ye like it. Who 're you to call me thief—ye bloody, murderin' villain ye! You're the thief—Levi West—you come here and stole my daddy from me—ye did. You make me ruin—myself to pay what oughter to been mine—then—ye—ye steal the gal I was courtin', to boot." He stopped and his lips writhed for words to say. "I know ye," said he, grinding his teeth. "I know ye! And only for what my daddy made me promise I'd a-had you up to the magistrate's before this."

"You want to take it to the law, huh?" he said. "You want to take it to the law? You're too scared to go to court—Levi West—you try it and see how it goes for you. Who do you think you are, calling me a thief—you bloody, murdering scoundrel! You're the real thief—Levi West—you came here and took my dad away from me—you did. You made me ruin myself to pay for what should have been mine—then—you—stole the girl I was dating, too." He paused, his lips twisting as he searched for words. "I know you," he said, clenching his teeth. "I know you! And if it weren't for what my dad made me promise, I'd have already had you brought before the magistrate."

Then, pointing with quivering finger: "There's the door—you see it! Go out that there door and don't never come into it again—if ye do—or if ye ever come where I can lay eyes on ye again—by th' Holy Holy I'll hale ye up to the Squire's office and tell all I know and all I've seen. Oh, I'll give ye your belly-fill of law if—ye want th' law! Git out of the house, I say!"

Then, pointing with a trembling finger: "There’s the door—you see it? Go out that door and never come back—if you do—or if you ever come where I can see you again—by the Holy Holy, I’ll drag you to the Squire’s office and tell everything I know and everything I’ve seen. Oh, I’ll give you a whole lot of legal trouble if—you want the law! Get out of the house, I say!"

As Hiram spoke Levi seemed to shrink together. His face changed from its copper color to a dull, waxy yellow. When the other ended he answered never a word. But he pushed back his chair, rose, put on his hat and, with a furtive, sidelong look, left[173] the house, without stopping to finish the supper which he had begun. He never entered Hiram White's door again.

As Hiram spoke, Levi seemed to withdraw. His face went from a copper tone to a dull, waxy yellow. When Hiram finished, Levi didn’t say a word. Instead, he pushed back his chair, stood up, put on his hat, and with a sneaky, sideways glance, left[173] the house without finishing the dinner he had started. He never stepped inside Hiram White's door again.

X

Hiram had driven out the evil spirit from his home, but the mischief that it had brewed was done and could not be undone. The next day it was known that Sally Martin had run away from home, and that she had run away with Levi West. Old Billy Martin had been in town in the morning with his rifle, hunting for Levi and threatening if he caught him to have his life for leading his daughter astray.

Hiram had kicked the evil spirit out of his house, but the trouble it caused was done and couldn’t be reversed. The next day, it was reported that Sally Martin had run away from home, and she had gone off with Levi West. Old Billy Martin had been in town that morning with his rifle, looking for Levi and threatening to kill him if he caught him for leading his daughter astray.

And, as the evil spirit had left Hiram's house, so had another and a greater evil spirit quitted its harborage. It was heard from Indian River in a few days more that Blueskin had quitted the inlet and had sailed away to the southeast; and it was reported, by those who seemed to know, that he had finally quitted those parts.

And, just as the evil spirit had left Hiram's house, another and even greater evil spirit had also departed. A few days later, there were reports from Indian River that Blueskin had left the inlet and had sailed away to the southeast; and it was said by those who seemed to know that he had finally left those areas.

It was well for himself that Blueskin left when he did, for not three days after he sailed away the Scorpion sloop-of-war dropped anchor in Lewes harbor. The New York agent of the unfortunate packet and a government commissioner had also come aboard the Scorpion.

It was good for him that Blueskin left when he did, because just three days after he set sail, the Scorpion sloop-of-war anchored in Lewes harbor. The New York agent of the unfortunate packet and a government commissioner had also boarded the Scorpion.

Without loss of time, the officer in command instituted a keen and searching examination that brought to light some singularly curious facts. It was found that a very friendly understanding must have existed for some time between the pirates and the people of Indian River, for, in the houses throughout that section, many things—some of considerable value—that had been taken by the pirates from the packet, were discovered and seized by the commissioner. Valuables of a suspicious nature had found their way even into the houses of Lewes itself.

Without wasting any time, the officer in charge conducted a thorough investigation that revealed some really interesting facts. It turned out that there must have been a very close relationship between the pirates and the people of Indian River for some time, as many items—some quite valuable—that had been stolen by the pirates from the packet were found and confiscated by the commissioner in the homes throughout that area. Suspicious valuables had even made their way into the houses in Lewes itself.

The whole neighborhood seemed to have become more or less tainted by the presence of the pirates.[174]

The entire neighborhood felt somewhat affected by the presence of the pirates.[174]

The Pirate's Christmas The Pirate's Christmas

First published in
Harper's Weekly, Christmas, 1893

Even poor Hiram White did not escape the suspicions of having had dealings with them. Of course the examiners were not slow in discovering that Levi West had been deeply concerned with Blueskin's doings.

Even poor Hiram White didn't escape the suspicion of having been involved with them. Of course, the examiners quickly found out that Levi West was heavily involved with Blueskin's activities.

Old Dinah and black Bob were examined, and not only did the story of Levi's two visitors come to light, but also the fact that Hiram was present and with them while they were in the house disposing of the captured goods to their agent.

Old Dinah and black Bob were questioned, and not only did the story of Levi's two visitors come out, but it was also revealed that Hiram was there with them while they were in the house getting rid of the stolen goods to their agent.

Of all that he had endured, nothing seemed to cut poor Hiram so deeply and keenly as these unjust suspicions. They seemed to bring the last bitter pang, hardest of all to bear.

Of everything he had gone through, nothing seemed to hurt poor Hiram as much as these unfair suspicions. They felt like the final, most painful blow, hardest to handle.

Levi had taken from him his father's love; he had driven him, if not to ruin, at least perilously close to it. He had run away with the girl he loved, and now, through him, even Hiram's good name was gone.

Levi had taken his father's love from him; he had pushed him, if not to destruction, at least dangerously close to it. He had eloped with the girl he loved, and now, because of him, even Hiram's good reputation was lost.

Neither did the suspicions against him remain passive; they became active.

Neither did the suspicions against him stay passive; they became active.

Goldsmiths' bills, to the amount of several thousand pounds, had been taken in the packet and Hiram was examined with an almost inquisitorial closeness and strictness as to whether he had or had not knowledge of their whereabouts.

Goldsmiths' bills totaling several thousand pounds had been taken in the package, and Hiram was questioned with almost an interrogative intensity and strictness about whether he knew where they were or not.

Under his accumulated misfortunes, he grew not only more dull, more taciturn, than ever, but gloomy, moody, brooding as well. For hours he would sit staring straight before him into the fire, without moving so much as a hair.

Under the weight of his many misfortunes, he became not only more dull and quiet than ever, but also gloomy, moody, and brooding. For hours he would sit, staring blankly into the fire, without moving a muscle.

One night—it was a bitterly cold night in February, with three inches of dry and gritty snow upon the ground—while Hiram sat thus brooding, there came, of a sudden, a soft tap upon the door.

One night—it was an extremely cold night in February, with three inches of dry and gritty snow on the ground—while Hiram sat there deep in thought, suddenly, there was a soft knock at the door.

Low and hesitating as it was, Hiram started violently at the sound. He sat for a while, looking from right to left. Then suddenly pushing back his chair, he arose, strode to the door, and flung it wide open.

Low and hesitant as it was, Hiram jumped at the sound. He sat for a moment, glancing from side to side. Then, suddenly pushing back his chair, he stood up, walked to the door, and swung it wide open.

It was Sally Martin.[175]

It was Sally Martin.

Hiram stood for a while staring blankly at her. It was she who first spoke. "Won't you let me come in, Hi?" said she. "I'm nigh starved with the cold and I'm fit to die, I'm so hungry. For God's sake, let me come in."

Hiram stood there for a moment, staring blankly at her. She was the one who spoke first. "Will you let me come in, Hi?" she said. "I'm freezing and I'm about to pass out from hunger. Please, let me in."

"Yes," said Hiram, "I'll let you come in, but why don't you go home?"

"Sure," Hiram said, "I'll let you come in, but why don't you just head home?"

The poor girl was shivering and chattering with the cold; now she began crying, wiping her eyes with the corner of a blanket in which her head and shoulders were wrapped. "I have been home, Hiram," she said, "but dad, he shut the door in my face. He cursed me just awful, Hi—I wish I was dead!"

The poor girl was shivering and chattering from the cold; now she started crying, wiping her eyes with the corner of a blanket that wrapped around her head and shoulders. "I went home, Hiram," she said, "but Dad shut the door in my face. He cursed me really bad, Hi—I wish I was dead!"

"You better come in," said Hiram. "It's no good standing out there in the cold." He stood aside and the girl entered, swiftly, gratefully.

"You should come in," said Hiram. "It's not good to be out there in the cold." He moved aside, and the girl came in quickly and with appreciation.

At Hiram's bidding black Dinah presently set some food before Sally and she fell to eating ravenously, almost ferociously. Meantime, while she ate, Hiram stood with his back to the fire, looking at her face—that face once so round and rosy, now thin, pinched, haggard.

At Hiram's request, Black Dinah quickly placed some food in front of Sally, and she started eating eagerly, almost like a wild animal. Meanwhile, as she ate, Hiram stood with his back to the fire, gazing at her face—that face that was once so round and rosy, now thin, tight, and worn.

"Are you sick, Sally?" said he presently.

"Are you feeling sick, Sally?" he asked after a moment.

"No," said she, "but I've had pretty hard times since I left home, Hi." The tears sprang to her eyes at the recollection of her troubles, but she only wiped them hastily away with the back of her hand, without stopping in her eating.

"No," she said, "but I've had a really tough time since I left home, Hi." Tears filled her eyes as she remembered her struggles, but she quickly wiped them away with the back of her hand, continuing to eat without pausing.

A long pause of dead silence followed. Dinah sat crouched together on a cricket at the other side of the hearth, listening with interest. Hiram did not seem to see her. "Did you go off with Levi?" said he at last, speaking abruptly. The girl looked up furtively under her brows. "You needn't be afeared to tell," he added.

A long pause of complete silence followed. Dinah sat crouched on a cricket on the other side of the hearth, listening intently. Hiram didn’t seem to notice her. "Did you leave with Levi?" he finally asked, speaking suddenly. The girl glanced up shyly from under her brows. "You don't have to be afraid to say," he added.

"Yes," said she at last, "I did go off with him, Hi."

"Yeah," she finally said, "I did leave with him, Hi."

"Where've you been?"

"Where have you been?"

At the question, she suddenly laid down her knife and fork.[176] "Don't you ask me that, Hi," said she, agitatedly, "I can't tell you that. You don't know Levi, Hiram; I darsn't tell you anything he don't want me to. If I told you where I been he'd hunt me out, no matter where I was, and kill me. If you only knew what I know about him, Hiram, you wouldn't ask anything about him."

At the question, she suddenly put down her knife and fork.[176] "Don't ask me that, Hi," she said, visibly upset. "I can't tell you that. You don't know Levi, Hiram; I can't share anything he doesn't want me to. If I told you where I've been, he'd track me down, no matter where I was, and kill me. If you only knew what I know about him, Hiram, you wouldn’t ask anything about him."

Hiram stood looking broodingly at her for a long time; then at last he again spoke. "I thought a sight of you onc't, Sally," said he.

Hiram stood there, staring at her with a somber expression for a long time; then finally he spoke again. "I saw you once, Sally," he said.

Sally did not answer immediately, but, after a while, she suddenly looked up. "Hiram," said she, "if I tell ye something will you promise on your oath not to breathe a word to any living soul?" Hiram nodded. "Then I'll tell you, but if Levi finds I've told he'll murder me as sure as you're standin' there. Come nigher—I've got to whisper it." He leaned forward close to her where she sat. She looked swiftly from right to left; then raising her lips she breathed into his ear: "I'm an honest woman, Hi. I was married to Levi West before I run away."

Sally didn't respond right away, but after a moment, she suddenly looked up. "Hiram," she said, "if I tell you something, will you promise on your word not to share it with anyone?" Hiram nodded. "Then I'll tell you, but if Levi finds out I've said anything, he'll definitely kill me. Come closer—I need to whisper it." He leaned in close to her where she sat. She quickly glanced around, then leaned in and whispered in his ear: "I'm an honest woman, Hi. I was married to Levi West before I ran away."

XI

The winter had passed, spring had passed, and summer had come. Whatever Hiram had felt, he had made no sign of suffering. Nevertheless, his lumpy face had begun to look flabby, his cheeks hollow, and his loose-jointed body shrunk more awkwardly together into its clothes. He was often awake at night, sometimes walking up and down his room until far into the small hours.

The winter had passed, spring had passed, and summer had arrived. Whatever Hiram felt, he showed no signs of distress. However, his uneven face had started to look soft, his cheeks were sunken, and his loose body seemed to awkwardly shrink into his clothes. He often lay awake at night, sometimes pacing his room until the early hours.

It was through such a wakeful spell as this that he entered into the greatest, the most terrible, happening of his life.

It was during a time like this that he experienced the greatest, most horrifying event of his life.

It was a sulphurously hot night in July. The air was like the breath of a furnace, and it was a hard matter to sleep with even the easiest mind and under the most favorable circumstances. The full moon shone in through the open window, laying a white square of light upon the floor, and Hiram, as he paced up and down, up and down, walked directly through it, his gaunt figure starting[177] out at every turn into sudden brightness as he entered the straight line of misty light.

It was a scorching hot night in July. The air felt like the breath of an oven, making it really hard to sleep comfortably even under the best conditions. The full moon streamed in through the open window, casting a white square of light on the floor, and Hiram, as he walked back and forth, stepped right through it, his thin figure suddenly becoming bright whenever he crossed into that beam of hazy light.[177]

The clock in the kitchen whirred and rang out the hour of twelve, and Hiram stopped in his walk to count the strokes.

The clock in the kitchen whirred and chimed twelve, and Hiram paused in his walk to count the strikes.

The last vibration died away into silence, and still he stood motionless, now listening with a new and sudden intentness, for, even as the clock rang the last stroke, he heard soft, heavy footsteps, moving slowly and cautiously along the pathway before the house and directly below the open window. A few seconds more and he heard the creaking of rusty hinges. The mysterious visitor had entered the mill. Hiram crept softly to the window and looked out. The moon shone full on the dusty, shingled face of the old mill, not thirty steps away, and he saw that the door was standing wide open. A second or two of stillness followed, and then, as he still stood looking intently, he saw the figure of a man suddenly appear, sharp and vivid, from the gaping blackness of the open doorway. Hiram could see his face as clear as day. It was Levi West, and he carried an empty meal bag over his arm.

The last vibration faded into silence, and he remained standing still, now listening with a new and intense focus. Just as the clock chimed its last stroke, he heard soft, heavy footsteps slowly and cautiously moving along the path in front of the house and directly beneath the open window. A few moments later, he heard the creaking of rusty hinges. The mysterious visitor had entered the mill. Hiram quietly moved to the window and looked outside. The moon cast a bright light on the dusty, shingled face of the old mill, about thirty steps away, and he noticed that the door was wide open. A moment of silence followed, and then, as he continued to gaze intently, he saw the figure of a man suddenly emerge, sharp and vivid, from the dark gaping doorway. Hiram could see his face clearly. It was Levi West, and he had an empty meal bag slung over his arm.

Levi West stood looking from right to left for a second or two, and then he took off his hat and wiped his brow with the back of his hand. Then he softly closed the door behind him and left the mill as he had come, and with the same cautious step. Hiram looked down upon him as he passed close to the house and almost directly beneath. He could have touched him with his hand.

Levi West stood looking from side to side for a moment, then he took off his hat and wiped his forehead with the back of his hand. He gently closed the door behind him and left the mill as he had arrived, walking with the same careful pace. Hiram looked down at him as he walked close to the house, almost directly underneath. He could have reached out and touched him.

Fifty or sixty yards from the house Levi stopped and a second figure arose from the black shadow in the angle of the worm fence and joined him. They stood for a while talking together, Levi pointing now and then toward the mill. Then the two turned, and, climbing over the fence, cut across an open field and through the tall, shaggy grass toward the southeast.

Fifty or sixty yards from the house, Levi stopped, and another figure emerged from the dark shadow by the corner of the fence to join him. They talked for a bit, with Levi occasionally pointing toward the mill. Then the two turned, climbed over the fence, and crossed an open field through the tall, shaggy grass heading southeast.

Hiram straightened himself and drew a deep breath, and the[178] moon, shining full upon his face, showed it twisted, convulsed, as it had been when he had fronted his stepbrother seven months before in the kitchen. Great beads of sweat stood on his brow and he wiped them away with his sleeve. Then, coatless, hatless as he was, he swung himself out of the window, dropped upon the grass, and, without an instant of hesitation, strode off down the road in the direction that Levi West had taken.

Hiram straightened up and took a deep breath, and the[178] moon, shining brightly on his face, revealed how twisted and pained it was, just like when he had confronted his stepbrother seven months earlier in the kitchen. Large beads of sweat gathered on his forehead, and he wiped them away with his sleeve. Then, without a coat or hat, he climbed out of the window, landed on the grass, and without a moment's hesitation, walked down the road in the direction Levi West had gone.

As he climbed the fence where the two men had climbed it he could see them in the pallid light, far away across the level, scrubby meadow land, walking toward a narrow strip of pine woods.

As he climbed over the fence where the two men had crossed, he could see them in the pale light, far across the flat, scrubby meadow, heading toward a narrow stretch of pine trees.

A little later they entered the sharp-cut shadows beneath the trees and were swallowed in the darkness.

A little later, they stepped into the sharply defined shadows under the trees and were engulfed by the darkness.

With fixed eyes and close-shut lips, as doggedly, as inexorably as though he were a Nemesis hunting his enemy down, Hiram followed their footsteps across the stretch of moonlit open. Then, by and by, he also was in the shadow of the pines. Here, not a sound broke the midnight hush. His feet made no noise upon the resinous softness of the ground below. In that dead, pulseless silence he could distinctly hear the distant voices of Levi and his companion, sounding loud and resonant in the hollow of the woods. Beyond the woods was a cornfield, and presently he heard the rattling of the harsh leaves as the two plunged into the tasseled jungle. Here, as in the woods, he followed them, step by step, guided by the noise of their progress through the canes.

With fixed eyes and tightly shut lips, as stubbornly and relentlessly as if he were a Nemesis tracking his enemy, Hiram followed their footsteps across the stretch of moonlit ground. Soon, he too was in the shadow of the pines. Here, not a sound interrupted the midnight stillness. His feet made no noise on the soft, resinous ground below. In that deathly silence, he could clearly hear the distant voices of Levi and his companion, echoing loudly in the hollow of the woods. Beyond the woods was a cornfield, and soon he heard the rustling of the dry leaves as the two plunged into the dense greenery. Here, just like in the woods, he followed them step by step, guided by the sound of their movement through the stalks.

Beyond the cornfield ran a road that, skirting to the south of Lewes, led across a wooden bridge to the wide salt marshes that stretched between the town and the distant sand hills. Coming out upon this road Hiram found that he had gained upon those he followed, and that they now were not fifty paces away, and he could see that Levi's companion carried over his shoulder what looked like a bundle of tools.

Beyond the cornfield, there was a road that curved to the south of Lewes, leading across a wooden bridge to the vast salt marshes that spread out between the town and the far-off sand hills. As Hiram stepped onto this road, he realized he had caught up with the people he was following, who were now less than fifty paces ahead. He noticed that Levi's companion was carrying what looked like a bundle of tools over his shoulder.

He waited for a little while to let them gain their distance[179] and for the second time wiped his forehead with his shirt sleeve; then, without ever once letting his eyes leave them, he climbed the fence to the roadway.

He waited a moment to let them get farther away[179] and, for the second time, wiped his forehead with his shirt sleeve; then, keeping his eyes on them the whole time, he climbed over the fence to the road.

For a couple of miles or more he followed the two along the white, level highway, past silent, sleeping houses, past barns, sheds, and haystacks, looming big in the moonlight, past fields, and woods, and clearings, past the dark and silent skirts of the town, and so, at last, out upon the wide, misty salt marshes, which seemed to stretch away interminably through the pallid light, yet were bounded in the far distance by the long, white line of sand hills.

For a couple of miles or more, he followed the two along the flat, white highway, past quiet, sleeping houses, barns, sheds, and haystacks, which loomed large in the moonlight, past fields, woods, and clearings, past the dark and silent edges of the town, and finally out onto the wide, misty salt marshes that seemed to stretch endlessly through the pale light, yet were marked in the far distance by the long, white line of sand dunes.

Across the level salt marshes he followed them, through the rank sedge and past the glassy pools in which his own inverted image stalked beneath as he stalked above; on and on, until at last they had reached a belt of scrub pines, gnarled and gray, that fringed the foot of the white sand hills.

Across the flat salt marshes, he followed them through the thick reeds and past the smooth pools that reflected his own image below as he moved above; on and on, until they finally reached a line of twisted, gray scrub pines that lined the base of the white sand hills.

Here Hiram kept within the black network of shadow. The two whom he followed walked more in the open, with their shadows, as black as ink, walking along in the sand beside them, and now, in the dead, breathless stillness, might be heard, dull and heavy, the distant thumping, pounding roar of the Atlantic surf, beating on the beach at the other side of the sand hills, half a mile away.

Here Hiram stayed hidden in the dark shadows. The two people he was following walked more out in the open, their shadows, as dark as ink, following along in the sand beside them. In the quiet, lifeless stillness, the distant, heavy sound of the Atlantic surf could be heard, pounding against the beach on the other side of the sand dunes, half a mile away.

At last the two rounded the southern end of the white bluff, and when Hiram, following, rounded it also, they were no longer to be seen.

At last, the two rounded the southern end of the white bluff, and when Hiram followed and rounded it as well, they could no longer be seen.

Before him the sand hill rose, smooth and steep, cutting in a sharp ridge against the sky. Up this steep hill trailed the footsteps of those he followed, disappearing over the crest. Beyond the ridge lay a round, bowl-like hollow, perhaps fifty feet across and eighteen or twenty feet deep, scooped out by the eddying of the winds into an almost perfect circle. Hiram, slowly, cautiously, stealthily, following their trailing line of footmarks, mounted to the top of the hillock and peered down into the bowl beneath. The two men were sitting upon the sand, not far from the tall, skeleton-[180]like shaft of a dead pine tree that rose, stark and gray, from the sand in which it may once have been buried, centuries ago.

Ahead of him, the sand hill rose, smooth and steep, creating a sharp ridge against the sky. Up this steep hill trailed the footprints of those he was following, fading over the crest. Beyond the ridge lay a round, bowl-shaped hollow, about fifty feet across and eighteen or twenty feet deep, formed by the swirling winds into an almost perfect circle. Hiram, slowly, carefully, and quietly, following their line of footprints, climbed to the top of the hill and looked down into the bowl below. The two men were sitting on the sand, not far from the tall, skeleton-like trunk of a dead pine tree that stood, stark and gray, from the sand where it may have been buried centuries ago.

XII

Levi had taken off his coat and waistcoat and was fanning himself with his hat. He was sitting upon the bag he had brought from the mill and which he had spread out upon the sand. His companion sat facing him. The moon shone full upon him and Hiram knew him instantly—he was the same burly, foreign-looking ruffian who had come with the little man to the mill that night to see Levi. He also had his hat off and was wiping his forehead and face with a red handkerchief. Beside him lay the bundle of tools he had brought—a couple of shovels, a piece of rope, and a long, sharp iron rod.

Levi had taken off his coat and vest and was fanning himself with his hat. He was sitting on the bag he had brought from the mill, which he had spread out on the sand. His friend sat facing him. The moon shone brightly on him, and Hiram recognized him immediately—he was the same heavyset, foreign-looking thug who had come with the little guy to the mill that night to see Levi. He also had his hat off and was wiping his forehead and face with a red handkerchief. Next to him lay the bundle of tools he had brought—a couple of shovels, a piece of rope, and a long, sharp iron rod.

The two men were talking together, but Hiram could not understand what they said, for they spoke in the same foreign language that they had before used. But he could see his stepbrother point with his finger, now to the dead tree and now to the steep, white face of the opposite side of the bowl-like hollow.

The two men were talking, but Hiram couldn’t understand what they were saying since they were using the same foreign language as before. However, he could see his stepbrother pointing with his finger, first at the dead tree and then at the steep, white face of the opposite side of the bowl-shaped hollow.

At last, having apparently rested themselves, the conference, if conference it was, came to an end, and Levi led the way, the other following, to the dead pine tree. Here he stopped and began searching, as though for some mark; then, having found that which he looked for, he drew a tapeline and a large brass pocket compass from his pocket. He gave one end of the tape line to his companion, holding the other with his thumb pressed upon a particular part of the tree. Taking his bearings by the compass, he gave now and then some orders to the other, who moved a little to the left or the right as he bade. At last he gave a word of command, and, thereupon, his companion drew a wooden peg from his pocket and thrust it into the sand. From this peg as a base they again measured, taking bearings by the compass, and again drove a peg. For a third time they repeated[181] their measurements and then, at last, seemed to have reached the point which they aimed for.

Finally, after what seemed like a break, the meeting—if it could be called that—came to a close, and Levi led the way to the dead pine tree, with the others following. He paused and began looking for some marking on the tree; once he found what he was searching for, he took out a tape measure and a large brass pocket compass. He handed one end of the tape to his companion while pressing the other end against a specific spot on the tree. Using the compass to find his direction, he occasionally instructed the other person to move a bit to the left or right as needed. Eventually, he gave a clear command, prompting his companion to take a wooden peg from his pocket and push it into the sand. They used this peg as a starting point to measure again, checking their direction with the compass, and then drove another peg into the ground. They repeated this process one more time and finally seemed to have found the spot they were looking for.

Here Levi marked a cross with his heel upon the sand.

Here Levi marked a cross with his heel in the sand.

His companion brought him the pointed iron rod which lay beside the shovels, and then stood watching as Levi thrust it deep into the sand, again and again, as though sounding for some object below. It was some while before he found that for which he was seeking, but at last the rod struck with a jar upon some hard object below. After making sure of success by one or two additional taps with the rod, Levi left it remaining where it stood, brushing the sand from his hands. "Now fetch the shovels, Pedro," said he, speaking for the first time in English.

His companion handed him the pointed iron rod that was next to the shovels, and then stood by as Levi pushed it deep into the sand repeatedly, as if searching for something below. It took him a while to find what he was looking for, but eventually the rod hit something hard beneath. After confirming his find with one or two more taps, Levi left the rod where it was, brushing the sand off his hands. "Now grab the shovels, Pedro," he said, speaking in English for the first time.

The two men were busy for a long while, shoveling away the sand. The object for which they were seeking lay buried some six feet deep, and the work was heavy and laborious, the shifting sand sliding back, again and again, into the hole. But at last the blade of one of the shovels struck upon some hard substance and Levi stooped and brushed away the sand with the palm of his hand.

The two men worked for a long time, shoveling away the sand. What they were looking for was buried about six feet deep, and the job was tough and exhausting, with the shifting sand sliding back into the hole over and over again. But eventually, the blade of one of the shovels hit something hard, and Levi bent down to clear the sand with his hand.

Levi's companion climbed out of the hole which they had dug and tossed the rope which he had brought with the shovels down to the other. Levi made it fast to some object below and then himself mounted to the level of the sand above. Pulling together, the two drew up from the hole a heavy iron-bound box, nearly three feet long and a foot wide and deep.

Levi's friend climbed out of the hole they had dug and threw down the rope he had brought along with the shovels to Levi. Levi secured it to something below and then climbed up to the level of the sand above. Together, they pulled up a heavy iron-bound box from the hole, which was almost three feet long and a foot wide and deep.

Levi's companion stooped and began untying the rope which had been lashed to a ring in the lid.

Levi's friend bent down and started to untie the rope that was secured to a ring in the lid.

What next happened happened suddenly, swiftly, terribly. Levi drew back a single step, and shot one quick, keen look to right and to left. He passed his hand rapidly behind his back, and the next moment Hiram saw the moonlight gleam upon the long, sharp, keen blade of a knife. Levi raised his arm. Then, just as the other arose from bending over the chest, he struck, and struck[182] again, two swift, powerful blows. Hiram saw the blade drive, clean and sharp, into the back, and heard the hilt strike with a dull thud against the ribs—once, twice. The burly, black-bearded wretch gave a shrill, terrible cry and fell staggering back. Then, in an instant, with another cry, he was up and clutched Levi with a clutch of despair by the throat and by the arm. Then followed a struggle, short, terrible, silent. Not a sound was heard but the deep, panting breath and the scuffling of feet in the sand, upon which there now poured and dabbled a dark-purple stream. But it was a one-sided struggle and lasted only for a second or two. Levi wrenched his arm loose from the wounded man's grasp, tearing his shirt sleeve from the wrist to the shoulder as he did so. Again and again the cruel knife was lifted, and again and again it fell, now no longer bright, but stained with red.

What happened next was sudden, swift, and terrible. Levi took a step back and scanned the area quickly. He moved his hand behind his back, and the next moment, Hiram saw the moonlight glint off the long, sharp blade of a knife. Levi raised his arm. Just as the other man got up from leaning over the chest, Levi struck, delivering two quick, powerful blows. Hiram watched as the blade sank cleanly into the man's back, hearing the hilt thud dully against his ribs—once, twice. The burly, black-bearded man let out a piercing, awful cry and staggered back. Then, in an instant, he lunged forward again, grabbing Levi by the throat and arm in a desperate grip. There was a brief, terrifying struggle, completely silent except for the deep, panting breaths and the scuffling of feet in the sand, which now began to run with a dark-purple stream. But it was a one-sided fight that lasted only a second or two. Levi freed his arm from the wounded man’s grip, ripping the shirt sleeve from wrist to shoulder in the process. Again and again, the cruel knife was raised, and again and again it struck, now no longer shining but coated in red.

"He Lay Silent and Still, with His Face Half Buried in the Sand" "He lay silent and still, with his face half buried in the sand."

Illustration from
BLUESKIN, THE PIRATE

by Howard Pyle

Originally published in
The Northwestern Miller, December, 1890

Then, suddenly, all was over. Levi's companion dropped to the sand without a sound, like a bundle of rags. For a moment he lay limp and inert; then one shuddering spasm passed over him and he lay silent and still, with his face half buried in the sand.

Then, suddenly, it was all over. Levi's companion collapsed onto the sand without a sound, like a pile of rags. For a moment, he lay limp and motionless; then a shuddering spasm went through him, and he lay quiet and still, with his face half buried in the sand.

Levi, with the knife still gripped tight in his hand, stood leaning over his victim, looking down upon his body. His shirt and hand, and even his naked arm, were stained and blotched with blood. The moon lit up his face and it was the face of a devil from hell.

Levi, still gripping the knife tightly in his hand, leaned over his victim, looking down at the body. His shirt and hand, and even his bare arm, were stained and splattered with blood. The moon illuminated his face, which looked like a devil from hell.

At last he gave himself a shake, stooped and wiped his knife and hand and arm upon the loose petticoat breeches of the dead man. He thrust his knife back into its sheath, drew a key from his pocket and unlocked the chest. In the moonlight Hiram could see that it was filled mostly with paper and leather bags, full, apparently of money.

At last, he shook himself off, bent down, and wiped his knife, hand, and arm on the loose petticoat breeches of the dead man. He slid his knife back into its sheath, pulled a key from his pocket, and unlocked the chest. In the moonlight, Hiram could see that it was mostly filled with paper and leather bags, which seemed to be full of money.

All through this awful struggle and its awful ending Hiram lay, dumb and motionless, upon the crest of the sand hill, looking with a horrid fascination upon the death struggle in the pit below. Now Hiram arose. The sand slid whispering down from the crest [183]as he did so, but Levi was too intent in turning over the contents of the chest to notice the slight sound.

All through this terrible struggle and its terrible ending, Hiram lay silent and still on top of the sand hill, watching with a disturbing fascination the fight for life in the pit below. Now Hiram got up. The sand slid softly down from the top [183] as he did, but Levi was too focused on examining the contents of the chest to notice the faint noise.

Hiram's face was ghastly pale and drawn. For one moment he opened his lips as though to speak, but no word came. So, white, silent, he stood for a few seconds, rather like a statue than a living man, then, suddenly, his eyes fell upon the bag, which Levi had brought with him, no doubt, to carry back the treasure for which he and his companion were in search, and which still lay spread out on the sand where it had been flung. Then, as though a thought had suddenly flashed upon him, his whole expression changed, his lips closed tightly together as though fearing an involuntary sound might escape, and the haggard look dissolved from his face.

Hiram's face was ghostly pale and drawn. For a moment, he opened his mouth as if to speak, but no words came out. Silent and white, he stood still for a few seconds, more like a statue than a living person, then suddenly, his eyes landed on the bag that Levi had brought with him, presumably to carry back the treasure that he and his companion were searching for, which still lay spread out on the sand where it had been tossed. Then, as if a thought had suddenly hit him, his entire expression shifted, his lips pressed tightly together as if he feared an involuntary sound might escape, and the haggard look vanished from his face.

Cautiously, slowly, he stepped over the edge of the sand hill and down the slanting face. His coming was as silent as death, for his feet made no noise as he sank ankle-deep in the yielding surface. So, stealthily, step by step, he descended, reached the bag, lifted it silently. Levi, still bending over the chest and searching through the papers within, was not four feet away. Hiram raised the bag in his hands. He must have made some slight rustle as he did so, for suddenly Levi half turned his head. But he was one instant too late. In a flash the bag was over his head—shoulders—arms—body.

Cautiously, slowly, he stepped over the edge of the sand hill and down the sloping surface. His approach was as quiet as death, as his feet made no sound while sinking ankle-deep into the soft ground. Stealthily, step by step, he descended, reached the bag, and lifted it quietly. Levi, still bent over the chest and searching through the papers inside, was not four feet away. Hiram raised the bag in his hands. He must have made some faint noise as he did so, because suddenly Levi turned his head slightly. But he was just a moment too late. In an instant, the bag was over his head—shoulders—arms—body.

Then came another struggle, as fierce, as silent, as desperate as that other—and as short. Wiry, tough, and strong as he was, with a lean, sinewy, nervous vigor, fighting desperately for his life as he was, Levi had no chance against the ponderous strength of his stepbrother. In any case, the struggle could not have lasted long; as it was, Levi stumbled backward over the body of his dead mate and fell, with Hiram upon him. Maybe he was stunned by the fall; maybe he felt the hopelessness of resistance, for he lay quite still while Hiram, kneeling upon him, drew the rope from the ring of the chest and, without uttering a word, bound it tightly around[184] both the bag and the captive within, knotting it again and again and drawing it tight. Only once was a word spoken. "If you'll lemme go," said a muffled voice from the bag, "I'll give you five thousand pounds—it's in that there box." Hiram answered never a word, but continued knotting the rope and drawing it tight.

Then came another struggle, just as fierce, just as quiet, and just as desperate as the previous one—and just as brief. Even though Levi was wiry, tough, and strong with a lean, sinewy, nervous energy, fighting desperately for his life, he had no chance against the heavy strength of his stepbrother. In any case, the struggle couldn’t have lasted long; as it happened, Levi stumbled backward over the body of his dead friend and fell, with Hiram on top of him. Maybe he was stunned from the fall; maybe he felt the hopelessness of fighting back, because he lay completely still while Hiram, kneeling on him, took the rope from the ring of the chest and, without saying a word, bound it tightly around[184] both the bag and the captive inside, knotting it repeatedly and pulling it tight. Only once did a word get spoken. "If you let me go," said a muffled voice from the bag, "I'll give you five thousand pounds—it's in that box." Hiram didn't respond at all but kept knotting the rope and pulling it tight.

XIII

The Scorpion sloop-of-war lay in Lewes harbor all that winter and spring, probably upon the slim chance of a return of the pirates. It was about eight o'clock in the morning and Lieutenant Maynard was sitting in Squire Hall's office, fanning himself with his hat and talking in a desultory fashion. Suddenly the dim and distant noise of a great crowd was heard from without, coming nearer and nearer. The Squire and his visitor hurried to the door. The crowd was coming down the street shouting, jostling, struggling, some on the footway, some in the roadway. Heads were at the doors and windows, looking down upon them. Nearer they came, and nearer; then at last they could see that the press surrounded and accompanied one man. It was Hiram White, hatless, coatless, the sweat running down his face in streams, but stolid and silent as ever. Over his shoulder he carried a bag, tied round and round with a rope. It was not until the crowd and the man it surrounded had come quite near that the Squire and the lieutenant saw that a pair of legs in gray-yarn stockings hung from the bag. It was a man he was carrying.

The Scorpion sloop-of-war stayed in Lewes harbor all winter and spring, probably hoping the pirates would return. It was around eight in the morning and Lieutenant Maynard was in Squire Hall's office, fanning himself with his hat and chatting casually. Suddenly, the distant sound of a large crowd could be heard, getting closer. The Squire and his guest rushed to the door. The crowd was coming down the street, shouting, pushing, and struggling—some on the sidewalk, some in the street. People leaned out of doors and windows to see what was happening. They got closer and closer, and then finally it became clear that the crowd was surrounding one man. It was Hiram White, hatless and coatless, sweat streaming down his face, but still as stoic as ever. He carried a bag over his shoulder, tightly bound with a rope. It wasn't until the crowd and the man they surrounded got really close that the Squire and the lieutenant noticed a pair of legs in gray-yarn stockings hanging out of the bag. He was carrying a man.

Hiram had lugged his burden five miles that morning without help and with scarcely a rest on the way.

Hiram had carried his load for five miles that morning on his own and barely took a break along the way.

He came directly toward the Squire's office and, still surrounded and hustled by the crowd, up the steep steps to the office within. He flung his burden heavily upon the floor without a word and wiped his streaming forehead.

He walked straight to the Squire's office and, still jostled by the crowd, climbed the steep steps to the office inside. He dropped his load heavily on the floor without saying anything and wiped the sweat from his forehead.

The Squire stood with his knuckles on his desk, staring first at Hiram and then at the strange burden he had brought. A sudden[185] hush fell upon all, though the voices of those without sounded as loud and turbulent as ever. "What is it, Hiram?" said Squire Hall at last.

The Squire stood with his fists on his desk, looking first at Hiram and then at the odd load he had brought. A sudden[185] silence enveloped everyone, even though the noises outside were as loud and chaotic as ever. "What is it, Hiram?" Squire Hall finally asked.

Then for the first time Hiram spoke, panting thickly. "It's a bloody murderer," said he, pointing a quivering finger at the motionless figure.

Then for the first time Hiram spoke, breathing heavily. "It's a bloody murderer," he said, pointing a shaking finger at the still figure.

"Here, some of you!" called out the Squire. "Come! Untie this man! Who is he?" A dozen willing fingers quickly unknotted the rope and the bag was slipped from the head and body.

"Hey, some of you!" called the Squire. "Come on! Untie this guy! Who is he?" A dozen eager hands quickly untied the rope, and the bag was pulled off his head and body.

Hair and face and eyebrows and clothes were powdered with meal, but, in spite of all and through all the innocent whiteness, dark spots and blotches and smears of blood showed upon head and arm and shirt. Levi raised himself upon his elbow and looked scowlingly around at the amazed, wonderstruck faces surrounding him.

Hair, face, eyebrows, and clothes were dusted with flour, but despite all that innocent white, dark spots, stains, and smears of blood were visible on his head, arms, and shirt. Levi propped himself up on his elbow and glared at the amazed, awestruck faces around him.

"Why, it's Levi West!" croaked the Squire, at last finding his voice.

"Why, it's Levi West!" croaked the Squire, finally finding his voice.

Then, suddenly, Lieutenant Maynard pushed forward, before the others crowded around the figure on the floor, and, clutching Levi by the hair, dragged his head backward so as to better see his face. "Levi West!" said he in a loud voice. "Is this the Levi West you've been telling me of? Look at that scar and the mark on his cheek! This is Blueskin himself."

Then, out of nowhere, Lieutenant Maynard pushed ahead, before the others surrounded the figure on the floor, and, gripping Levi by the hair, pulled his head back to get a clearer look at his face. "Levi West!" he said loudly. "Is this the Levi West you've been telling me about? Look at that scar and the mark on his cheek! This is Blueskin himself."

XIV

In the chest which Blueskin had dug up out of the sand were found not only the goldsmiths' bills taken from the packet, but also many other valuables belonging to the officers and the passengers of the unfortunate ship.

In the chest that Blueskin had dug up from the sand, they found not only the goldsmiths' bills taken from the packet but also many other valuables belonging to the officers and the passengers of the unfortunate ship.

The New York agents offered Hiram a handsome reward for his efforts in recovering the lost bills, but Hiram declined it, positively and finally. "All I want," said he, in his usual dull, stolid fashion, "is to have folks know I'm honest." Nevertheless,[186] though he did not accept what the agents of the packet offered, fate took the matter into its own hands and rewarded him not unsubstantially. Blueskin was taken to England in the Scorpion. But he never came to trial. While in Newgate he hanged himself to the cell window with his own stockings. The news of his end was brought to Lewes in the early autumn and Squire Hall took immediate measures to have the five hundred pounds of his father's legacy duly transferred to Hiram.

The New York agents offered Hiram a generous reward for his efforts in recovering the lost bills, but Hiram firmly and finally turned it down. "All I want," he said in his typical dull, unemotional way, "is for people to know I'm honest." However,[186] even though he didn’t accept what the agents of the packet offered, fate intervened and rewarded him significantly. Blueskin was taken to England on the Scorpion. But he never faced trial. While in Newgate, he hanged himself from the cell window using his own stockings. The news of his death reached Lewes in early autumn, and Squire Hall quickly took steps to have the five hundred pounds from his father's inheritance properly transferred to Hiram.

In November Hiram married the pirate's widow.

In November, Hiram married the pirate's widow.

"There Cap'n Goldsack goes, creeping, creeping, creeping, Looking for his treasure down below!" "There goes Cap'n Goldsack, sneaking, sneaking, sneaking, looking for his treasure down below!"

Illustration from
CAP'N GOLDSACK

by William Sharp

Originally published in
Harper's Magazine, July, 1902

Chapter VII

CAPTAIN SCARFIELD

PREFACE

The author of this narrative cannot recall that, in any history of the famous pirates, he has ever read a detailed and sufficient account of the life and death of Capt. John Scarfield. Doubtless some data concerning his death and the destruction of his schooner might be gathered from the report of Lieutenant Mainwaring, now filed in the archives of the Navy Department, but beyond such bald and bloodless narrative the author knows of nothing, unless it be the little chap-book history published by Isaiah Thomas in Newburyport about the year 1821-22, entitled, "A True History of the Life and Death of Captain Jack Scarfield." This lack of particularity in the history of one so notable in his profession it is the design of the present narrative in a measure to supply, and, if the author has seen fit to cast it in the form of a fictional story, it is only that it may make more easy reading for those who see fit to follow the tale from this to its conclusion.

The author of this story doesn't remember reading a detailed and sufficient account of the life and death of Capt. John Scarfield in any history of famous pirates. Sure, some information about his death and the sinking of his schooner might be found in the report by Lieutenant Mainwaring, now stored in the Navy Department's archives, but apart from that dry and lifeless narrative, the author knows of nothing else, unless it’s the little booklet published by Isaiah Thomas in Newburyport around 1821-22, titled, "A True History of the Life and Death of Captain Jack Scarfield." This absence of detail in the history of someone so remarkable in his field is something this narrative aims to address, and if the author chose to present it as a fictional story, it’s just to make it easier for those who decide to follow the tale to its conclusion.

CAPTAIN SCARFIELD

I

E

leazer Cooper, or Captain Cooper, as was his better-known title in Philadelphia, was a prominent member of the Society of Friends. He was an overseer of the meeting and an occasional speaker upon particular occasions. When at home from one of his many voyages he never failed to occupy his seat in the meeting both on First Day and Fifth Day, and he was regarded by his fellow townsmen as a model of business integrity and of domestic responsibility.

Leazer Cooper, or Captain Cooper, as he was better known in Philadelphia, was a prominent member of the Quaker community. He served as an overseer of the meeting and occasionally spoke at special events. Whenever he returned home from one of his many voyages, he always made it a point to attend the meeting on both Sunday and Wednesday, and his fellow townspeople saw him as a role model for business integrity and family responsibility.

More incidental to this history, however, it is to be narrated that Captain Cooper was one of those trading skippers who carried their own merchandise in their own vessels which they sailed themselves, and on whose decks they did their own bartering. His vessel was a swift, large schooner, the Eliza Cooper, of Philadelphia, named for his wife. His cruising grounds were the West India Islands, and his merchandise was flour and corn meal ground at the Brandywine Mills at Wilmington, Delaware.

More incidentally to this history, it should be mentioned that Captain Cooper was one of those trading captains who transported their own goods in their own ships, which they sailed themselves, and on whose decks they conducted their own trading. His ship was a fast, large schooner, the Eliza Cooper, of Philadelphia, named after his wife. His cruising areas were the West Indies, and his goods were flour and cornmeal ground at the Brandywine Mills in Wilmington, Delaware.

During the War of 1812 he had earned, as was very well known, an extraordinary fortune in this trading; for flour and corn meal sold at fabulous prices in the French, Spanish, Dutch, and Danish islands, cut off, as they were, from the rest of the world by the British blockade.

During the War of 1812, he made a well-known fortune in trading; flour and cornmeal sold for incredible prices in the French, Spanish, Dutch, and Danish islands, which were isolated from the rest of the world due to the British blockade.

The running of this blockade was one of the most hazardous maritime ventures possible, but Captain Cooper had met with such unvaried success, and had sold his merchandise at such incredible[189] profit that, at the end of the war, he found himself to have become one of the wealthiest merchants of his native city.

The operation of this blockade was one of the riskiest maritime undertakings imaginable, but Captain Cooper had experienced such consistent success and sold his goods at such unbelievable[189] profit that, by the end of the war, he discovered he had become one of the wealthiest merchants in his hometown.

It was known at one time that his balance in the Mechanics' Bank was greater than that of any other individual depositor upon the books, and it was told of him that he had once deposited in the bank a chest of foreign silver coin, the exchanged value of which, when translated into American currency, was upward of forty-two thousand dollars—a prodigious sum of money in those days.

It was once known that his balance at the Mechanics' Bank was higher than that of any other individual depositor, and people said he had once deposited a chest of foreign silver coins, the value of which, when converted to American money, was over forty-two thousand dollars—a huge amount of money back then.

In person, Captain Cooper was tall and angular of frame. His face was thin and severe, wearing continually an unsmiling, mask-like expression of continent and unruffled sobriety. His manner was dry and taciturn, and his conduct and life were measured to the most absolute accord with the teachings of his religious belief.

In person, Captain Cooper was tall and angular. His face was thin and stern, always showing a serious, mask-like expression of self-control and unwavering seriousness. He was dry and quiet, and his behavior and life were in complete alignment with the principles of his faith.

He lived in an old-fashioned house on Front Street below Spruce—as pleasant, cheerful a house as ever a trading captain could return to. At the back of the house a lawn sloped steeply down toward the river. To the south stood the wharf and storehouses; to the north an orchard and kitchen garden bloomed with abundant verdure. Two large chestnut trees sheltered the porch and the little space of lawn, and when you sat under them in the shade you looked down the slope between two rows of box bushes directly across the shining river to the Jersey shore.

He lived in a charming old house on Front Street just below Spruce—just as pleasant and cheerful as any trading captain could hope to come back to. At the back of the house, a lawn sloped steeply down toward the river. To the south were the wharf and storage buildings; to the north, an orchard and kitchen garden flourished with lush greenery. Two large chestnut trees shaded the porch and the small lawn area, and when you sat beneath them in the shade, you looked down the slope between two rows of box bushes straight across the shimmering river to the New Jersey shore.

At the time of our story—that is, about the year 1820—this property had increased very greatly in value, but it was the old home of the Coopers, as Eleazer Cooper was entirely rich enough to indulge his fancy in such matters. Accordingly, as he chose to live in the same house where his father and his grandfather had dwelt before him, he peremptorily, if quietly, refused all offers looking toward the purchase of the lot of ground—though it was now worth five or six times its former value.

At the time of our story—around the year 1820—this property had significantly increased in value, but it was the traditional home of the Coopers, as Eleazer Cooper was more than wealthy enough to indulge his preferences in such matters. Therefore, since he wanted to live in the same house where his father and grandfather had lived before him, he firmly, yet calmly, rejected all offers to buy the piece of land—even though it was now worth five or six times what it had been.

As was said, it was a cheerful, pleasant home, impressing you when you entered it with the feeling of spotless and all-pervading cleanliness—a cleanliness that greeted you in the shining brass door-[190]knocker; that entertained you in the sitting room with its stiff, leather-covered furniture, the brass-headed tacks whereof sparkled like so many stars—a cleanliness that bade you farewell in the spotless stretch of sand-sprinkled hallway, the wooden floor of which was worn into knobs around the nail heads by the countless scourings and scrubbings to which it had been subjected and which left behind them an all-pervading faint, fragrant odor of soap and warm water.

As mentioned, it was a cheerful, pleasant home that immediately made you feel the sense of immaculate cleanliness as soon as you walked in—an cleanliness that welcomed you with the shiny brass door knocker; that kept you entertained in the living room with its stiff, leather-covered furniture, the brass tacks sparkling like little stars—an cleanliness that said goodbye in the spotless, sand-dusted hallway, the wooden floor of which was worn down around the nail heads from countless cleanings, leaving behind a faint, pleasant scent of soap and warm water.

"He Had Found the Captain Agreeable and Companionable" "He Found the Captain Pleasant and Easy to Get Along With"

Illustration from
SEA ROBBERS OF NEW YORK

by Thomas A. Janvier

Originally published in
Harper's Magazine, November, 1894

Eleazer Cooper and his wife were childless, but one inmate made the great, silent, shady house bright with life. Lucinda Fairbanks, a niece of Captain Cooper's by his only sister, was a handsome, sprightly girl of eighteen or twenty, and a great favorite in the Quaker society of the city.

Eleazer Cooper and his wife didn't have any kids, but one resident brought warmth and energy to their large, quiet house. Lucinda Fairbanks, Captain Cooper's niece through his only sister, was a beautiful, lively girl around eighteen or twenty, and she was very popular in the city's Quaker community.

It remains only to introduce the final and, perhaps, the most important actor of the narrative—Lieut. James Mainwaring. During the past twelve months or so he had been a frequent visitor at the Cooper house. At this time he was a broad-shouldered, red-cheeked, stalwart fellow of twenty-six or twenty-eight. He was a great social favorite, and possessed the added romantic interest of having been aboard the Constitution when she fought the Guerriere, and of having, with his own hands, touched the match that fired the first gun of that great battle.

It’s time to introduce the final and probably the most important character in the story—Lieut. James Mainwaring. Over the past year or so, he had often visited the Cooper house. At this point, he was a broad-shouldered, red-cheeked, strong guy around twenty-six or twenty-eight. He was a popular figure socially and had an added element of romance since he was aboard the Constitution when it fought the Guerriere, and he personally lit the match that fired the first shot in that epic battle.

Mainwaring's mother and Eliza Cooper had always been intimate friends, and the coming and going of the young man during his leave of absence were looked upon in the house as quite a matter of course. Half a dozen times a week he would drop in to execute some little commission for the ladies, or, if Captain Cooper was at home, to smoke a pipe of tobacco with him, to sip a dram of his famous old Jamaica rum, or to play a rubber of checkers of an evening. It is not likely that either of the older people was the least aware of the real cause of his visits; still less did they suspect that any passages of sentiment had passed between the young people.

Mainwaring's mother and Eliza Cooper had always been close friends, and the young man's frequent visits during his time off were seen as completely normal in the house. He would drop by several times a week to run little errands for the ladies, or, if Captain Cooper was around, to enjoy a pipe of tobacco with him, share a drink of his well-known old Jamaica rum, or play a few games of checkers in the evening. It's unlikely that either of the older folks had any idea about the real reason for his visits; even less did they suspect that any romantic feelings had developed between the young people.

The truth was that Mainwaring and the young lady were very deeply in love. It was a love that they were obliged to keep a profound secret, for not only had Eleazer Cooper held the strictest sort of testimony against the late war—a testimony so rigorous as to render it altogether unlikely that one of so military a profession as Mainwaring practiced could hope for his consent to a suit for marriage, but Lucinda could not have married one not a member of the Society of Friends without losing her own birthright membership therein. She herself might not attach much weight to such a loss of membership in the Society, but her fear of, and her respect for, her uncle led her to walk very closely in her path of duty in this respect. Accordingly she and Mainwaring met as they could—clandestinely—and the stolen moments were very sweet. With equal secrecy Lucinda had, at the request of her lover, sat for a miniature portrait to Mrs. Gregory, which miniature, set in a gold medallion, Mainwaring, with a mild, sentimental pleasure, wore hung around his neck and beneath his shirt frill next his heart.

The truth was that Mainwaring and the young woman were very much in love. It was a love they had to keep a deep secret, as Eleazer Cooper had a strict stance against the recent war—a stance so rigid that it made it unlikely for someone with Mainwaring's military profession to expect his approval for marriage. Additionally, Lucinda couldn’t marry someone outside the Society of Friends without losing her own membership. While she might not have valued that loss greatly, her fear of and respect for her uncle made her stick closely to her duties in this regard. So, she and Mainwaring met whenever they could—in secret—and those stolen moments were very sweet. In equal secrecy, Lucinda had, at her lover’s request, posed for a miniature portrait by Mrs. Gregory, which Mainwaring wore in a gold medallion around his neck, resting just beneath his shirt frill, close to his heart, with a gentle, sentimental pleasure.

In the month of April of the year 1820 Mainwaring received orders to report at Washington. During the preceding autumn the West India pirates, and notably Capt. Jack Scarfield, had been more than usually active, and the loss of the packet Marblehead (which, sailing from Charleston, South Carolina, was never heard of more) was attributed to them. Two other coasting vessels off the coast of Georgia had been looted and burned by Scarfield, and the government had at last aroused itself to the necessity of active measures for repressing these pests of the West India waters.

In April 1820, Mainwaring got orders to report to Washington. The previous autumn, the West India pirates, especially Captain Jack Scarfield, had been unusually active, and the loss of the packet Marblehead (which had sailed from Charleston, South Carolina, and was never heard from again) was blamed on them. Two other coastal vessels off the Georgia coast were looted and burned by Scarfield, and the government had finally recognized the need for active measures to deal with these threats in the West India waters.

Mainwaring received orders to take command of the Yankee, a swift, light-draught, heavily armed brig of war, and to cruise about the Bahama Islands and to capture and destroy all the pirates' vessels he could there discover.

Mainwaring was given orders to take charge of the Yankee, a fast, shallow-draft, heavily armed warship, and to patrol the Bahama Islands to capture and destroy any pirate ships he could find.

On his way from Washington to New York, where the Yankee was then waiting orders, Mainwaring stopped in Philadelphia to[192] bid good-by to his many friends in that city. He called at the old Cooper house. It was on a Sunday afternoon. The spring was early and the weather extremely pleasant that day, being filled with a warmth almost as of summer. The apple trees were already in full bloom and filled all the air with their fragrance. Everywhere there seemed to be the pervading hum of bees, and the drowsy, tepid sunshine was very delightful.

On his way from Washington to New York, where the Yankee was waiting for orders, Mainwaring stopped in Philadelphia to[192] say goodbye to his many friends in the city. He visited the old Cooper house. It was a Sunday afternoon. Spring had arrived early, and the weather was incredibly pleasant that day, feeling almost like summer. The apple trees were already in full bloom, filling the air with their sweet scent. Everywhere, there was the constant buzz of bees, and the warm, lazy sunshine was truly enjoyable.

At that time Eleazer was just home from an unusually successful voyage to Antigua. Mainwaring found the family sitting under one of the still leafless chestnut trees, Captain Cooper smoking his long clay pipe and lazily perusing a copy of the National Gazette. Eleazer listened with a great deal of interest to what Mainwaring had to say of his proposed cruise. He himself knew a great deal about the pirates, and, singularly unbending from his normal, stiff taciturnity, he began telling of what he knew, particularly of Captain Scarfield—in whom he appeared to take an extraordinary interest.

At that time, Eleazer had just returned home from a surprisingly successful trip to Antigua. Mainwaring found the family sitting under one of the still-bare chestnut trees, Captain Cooper smoking his long clay pipe and casually reading a copy of the National Gazette. Eleazer listened intently to what Mainwaring had to say about his planned cruise. He knew a lot about the pirates and, unusually breaking from his typical, stiff silence, he started sharing what he knew, especially about Captain Scarfield—who seemed to intrigue him quite a bit.

Vastly to Mainwaring's surprise, the old Quaker assumed the position of a defendant of the pirates, protesting that the wickedness of the accused was enormously exaggerated. He declared that he knew some of the freebooters very well and that at the most they were poor, misdirected wretches who had, by easy gradation, slid into their present evil ways, from having been tempted by the government authorities to enter into privateering in the days of the late war. He conceded that Captain Scarfield had done many cruel and wicked deeds, but he averred that he had also performed many kind and benevolent actions. The world made no note of these latter, but took care only to condemn the evil that had been done. He acknowledged that it was true that the pirate had allowed his crew to cast lots for the wife and the daughter of the skipper of the Northern Rose, but there were none of his accusers who told how, at the risk of his own life and the lives of all his crew, he had given succor to the schooner Halifax, found adrift with all hands down[193] with yellow fever. There was no defender of his actions to tell how he and his crew of pirates had sailed the pest-stricken vessel almost into the rescuing waters of Kingston harbor. Eleazer confessed that he could not deny that when Scarfield had tied the skipper of the Baltimore Belle naked to the foremast of his own brig he had permitted his crew of cutthroats (who were drunk at the time) to throw bottles at the helpless captive, who died that night of the wounds he had received. For this he was doubtless very justly condemned, but who was there to praise him when he had, at the risk of his life and in the face of the authorities, carried a cargo of provisions which he himself had purchased at Tampa Bay to the Island of Bella Vista after the great hurricane of 1818? In this notable adventure he had barely escaped, after a two days' chase, the British frigate Ceres, whose captain, had a capture been effected, would instantly have hung the unfortunate man to the yardarm in spite of the beneficent mission he was in the act of conducting.

To Mainwaring's surprise, the old Quaker took on the role of defending the pirates, arguing that the wrongdoing of the accused was greatly exaggerated. He said he knew some of the pirates very well and insisted that, at most, they were just poor, misguided souls who had gradually fallen into their current bad habits after being lured by the government to engage in privateering during the last war. He admitted that Captain Scarfield had committed many cruel and wicked acts, but he also claimed that Scarfield had done many kind and generous things. The world ignored these positive deeds, focusing only on condemning the wrongdoing. He acknowledged that it was true Scarfield had let his crew draw lots for the wife and daughter of the captain of the Northern Rose, but none of his accusers mentioned how he had risked his own life and that of his crew to aid the schooner Halifax, which was adrift with its entire crew incapacitated by yellow fever. There was no one to defend him and share how he and his pirate crew had navigated the disease-ridden vessel almost to the safety of Kingston harbor. Eleazer admitted that he couldn't deny that when Scarfield had tied the captain of the Baltimore Belle naked to the foremast of his own brig, he had allowed his drunken crew to throw bottles at the helpless man, who died that night from his injuries. For this, he was certainly deserving of condemnation, but who spoke up for him when he had, at great personal risk and in defiance of the authorities, delivered a cargo of supplies he bought in Tampa Bay to Bella Vista after the devastating hurricane of 1818? During this significant endeavor, he narrowly escaped the British frigate Ceres, whose captain would have hanged him on the spot had he been captured, despite the humanitarian mission he was undertaking.

In all this Eleazer had the air of conducting the case for the defendant. As he talked he became more and more animated and voluble. The light went out in his tobacco pipe, and a hectic spot appeared in either thin and sallow cheek. Mainwaring sat wondering to hear the severely peaceful Quaker preacher defending so notoriously bloody and cruel a cutthroat pirate as Capt. Jack Scarfield. The warm and innocent surroundings, the old brick house looking down upon them, the odor of apple blossoms and the hum of bees seemed to make it all the more incongruous. And still the elderly Quaker skipper talked on and on with hardly an interruption, till the warm sun slanted to the west and the day began to decline.

In all this, Eleazer seemed to be representing the defendant. As he spoke, he became increasingly animated and articulate. The flame in his tobacco pipe went out, and flushed spots appeared on each of his thin, pale cheeks. Mainwaring sat in disbelief, listening to the strictly peaceful Quaker preacher defend such a notoriously violent and ruthless pirate as Capt. Jack Scarfield. The warm and innocent surroundings, the old brick house overlooking them, the scent of apple blossoms, and the buzz of bees made it feel even more out of place. Yet the elderly Quaker continued to talk without hardly any interruptions, until the warm sun tilted toward the west and the day started to wind down.

That evening Mainwaring stayed to tea and when he parted from Lucinda Fairbanks it was after nightfall, with a clear, round moon shining in the milky sky and a radiance pallid and unreal enveloping the old house, the blooming apple trees, the sloping[194] lawn and the shining river beyond. He implored his sweetheart to let him tell her uncle and aunt of their acknowledged love and to ask the old man's consent to it, but she would not permit him to do so. They were so happy as they were. Who knew but what her uncle might forbid their fondness? Would he not wait a little longer? Maybe it would all come right after a while. She was so fond, so tender, so tearful at the nearness of their parting that he had not the heart to insist. At the same time it was with a feeling almost of despair that he realized that he must now be gone—maybe for the space of two years—without in all that time possessing the right to call her his before the world.

That evening, Mainwaring stayed for tea, and when he said goodbye to Lucinda Fairbanks, it was after dark, with a clear, round moon shining in the milky sky and a faint, surreal glow enveloping the old house, the blooming apple trees, the sloping[194] lawn, and the sparkling river beyond. He begged his girlfriend to let him tell her uncle and aunt about their love and to ask for the old man's blessing, but she wouldn’t allow it. They were so happy as they were. Who knew if her uncle might disapprove of their affection? Could he wait just a little longer? Maybe everything would work out eventually. She was so affectionate, so emotional, so tearful at the thought of their parting that he couldn’t bring himself to push the issue. At the same time, he felt almost hopeless as he realized he had to leave now—maybe for two years—without having the right to publicly call her his.

When he bade farewell to the older people it was with a choking feeling of bitter disappointment. He yet felt the pressure of her cheek against his shoulder, the touch of soft and velvet lips to his own. But what were such clandestine endearments compared to what might, perchance, be his—the right of calling her his own when he was far away and upon the distant sea? And, besides, he felt like a coward who had shirked his duty.

When he said goodbye to the older people, he felt a tight, bitter disappointment. He still felt her cheek pressed against his shoulder and the touch of her soft, velvet lips on his. But what did those secret moments mean compared to what could possibly be his—the chance to call her his own while he was far away at sea? Plus, he felt like a coward for avoiding his responsibility.

But he was very much in love. The next morning appeared in a drizzle of rain that followed the beautiful warmth of the day before. He had the coach all to himself, and in the damp and leathery solitude he drew out the little oval picture from beneath his shirt frill and looked long and fixedly with a fond and foolish joy at the innocent face, the blue eyes, the red, smiling lips depicted upon the satinlike, ivory surface.

But he was very much in love. The next morning arrived with a light drizzle that followed the beautiful warmth of the day before. He had the coach all to himself, and in the damp and leathery solitude, he took out the little oval picture from under his shirt frill and looked long and intently with a fond, silly joy at the innocent face, the blue eyes, and the red, smiling lips captured on the satin-like, ivory surface.

II

For the better part of five months Mainwaring cruised about in the waters surrounding the Bahama Islands. In that time he ran to earth and dispersed a dozen nests of pirates. He destroyed no less than fifteen piratical crafts of all sizes, from a large half-[195]decked whaleboat to a three-hundred-ton barkentine. The name of the Yankee became a terror to every sea wolf in the western tropics, and the waters of the Bahama Islands became swept almost clean of the bloody wretches who had so lately infested it.

For about five months, Mainwaring sailed around the waters near the Bahama Islands. During that time, he tracked down and scattered a dozen pirate nests. He destroyed at least fifteen pirate ships of all sizes, from a large half-decked whaleboat to a three-hundred-ton barkentine. The name of the Yankee became a nightmare for every sea wolf in the western tropics, and the waters of the Bahama Islands were almost entirely cleared of the bloody scoundrels who had recently occupied them.

But the one freebooter of all others whom he sought—Capt. Jack Scarfield—seemed to evade him like a shadow, to slip through his fingers like magic. Twice he came almost within touch of the famous marauder, both times in the ominous wrecks that the pirate captain had left behind him. The first of these was the water-logged remains of a burned and still smoking wreck that he found adrift in the great Bahama channel. It was the Water Witch, of Salem, but he did not learn her tragic story until, two weeks later, he discovered a part of her crew at Port Maria, on the north coast of Jamaica. It was, indeed, a dreadful story to which he listened. The castaways said that they of all the vessel's crew had been spared so that they might tell the commander of the Yankee, should they meet him, that he might keep what he found, with Captain Scarfield's compliments, who served it up to him hot cooked.

But the one pirate he was really after—Capt. Jack Scarfield—seemed to dodge him like a shadow, slipping through his fingers like magic. Twice he came close to catching the famous marauder, both times at the ominous wrecks left behind by the pirate captain. The first was the waterlogged remains of a burned and still smoking wreck he found drifting in the vast Bahama channel. It was the Water Witch from Salem, but he didn't learn her tragic story until two weeks later when he encountered part of her crew at Port Maria on the north coast of Jamaica. It was truly a dreadful tale he listened to. The survivors said they were the only ones from the crew who had been spared so they could tell the captain of the Yankee, if they encountered him, that he could keep whatever he found, courtesy of Captain Scarfield, who had served it up to him hot and ready.

Three weeks later he rescued what remained of the crew of the shattered, bloody hulk of the Baltimore Belle, eight of whose crew, headed by the captain, had been tied hand and foot and heaved overboard. Again, there was a message from Captain Scarfield to the commander of the Yankee that he might season what he found to suit his own taste.

Three weeks later, he rescued what was left of the crew from the wrecked, bloody remains of the Baltimore Belle. Eight crew members, led by the captain, had been tied up and thrown overboard. Once more, there was a message from Captain Scarfield to the commander of the Yankee, telling him he could prepare whatever he found to his liking.

Mainwaring was of a sanguine disposition, with fiery temper. He swore, with the utmost vehemence, that either he or John Scarfield would have to leave the earth.

Mainwaring had a cheerful personality but a hot temper. He insisted, with great intensity, that either he or John Scarfield would have to leave this world.

He had little suspicion of how soon was to befall the ominous realization of his angry prophecy.

He had little idea of how soon the dark realization of his angry prediction would come true.

At that time one of the chief rendezvous of the pirates was the little island of San José, one of the southernmost of the Bahama group. Here, in the days before the coming of the Yankee, they were wont[196] to put in to careen and clean their vessels and to take in a fresh supply of provisions, gunpowder, and rum, preparatory to renewing their attacks upon the peaceful commerce circulating up and down outside the islands, or through the wide stretches of the Bahama channel.

At that time, one of the main hangouts for pirates was the small island of San José, one of the southernmost islands in the Bahamas. Here, before the arrival of the Yankee, they used[196] to stop to careen and clean their ships, and to stock up on fresh supplies of food, gunpowder, and rum, getting ready to launch their attacks on the peaceful trade flowing in and out of the islands or through the vast expanse of the Bahama Channel.

THE BUCCANEER WAS A PICTURESQUE FELLOW the buccaneer was quite a colorful character

Mainwaring had made several descents upon this nest of freebooters. He had already made two notable captures, and it was here he hoped eventually to capture Captain Scarfield himself.

Mainwaring had made several attempts to take down this group of pirates. He had already made two significant captures, and it was here that he hoped to eventually catch Captain Scarfield himself.

A brief description of this one-time notorious rendezvous of freebooters might not be out of place. It consisted of a little settlement of those wattled and mud-smeared houses such as you find through the West Indies. There were only three houses of a more pretentious sort, built of wood. One of these was a storehouse, another was a rum shop, and a third a house in which dwelt a mulatto woman, who was reputed to be a sort of left-handed wife of Captain Scarfield's. The population was almost entirely black and brown. One or two Jews and a half dozen Yankee traders, of hardly dubious honesty, comprised the entire white population. The rest consisted of a mongrel accumulation of negroes and mulattoes and half-caste Spaniards, and of a multitude of black or yellow women and children. The settlement stood in a bight of the beach forming a small harbor and affording a fair anchorage for small vessels, excepting it were against the beating of a southeasterly gale. The houses, or cabins, were surrounded by clusters of coco palms and growths of bananas, and a long curve of white beach, sheltered from the large Atlantic breakers that burst and exploded upon an outer bar, was drawn like a necklace around the semicircle of emerald-green water.

A short description of this once-infamous meeting place for pirates might be appropriate. It was a small settlement of those woven and mud-covered houses you find throughout the West Indies. There were only three larger houses made of wood. One served as a storehouse, another was a rum shop, and the third was the home of a mixed-race woman who was believed to be Captain Scarfield's unofficial wife. The population was mostly black and brown. A couple of Jews and about half a dozen Yankee traders, of questionable honesty, made up the entire white population. The rest were a mix of black people, mulattoes, and mixed-race Spaniards, along with many black and yellow women and children. The settlement was located in a cove along the beach, creating a small harbor with decent anchorage for small boats, except during a strong southeasterly storm. The houses, or cabins, were surrounded by clusters of coconut palms and banana plants, and a long stretch of white beach, protected from the powerful Atlantic waves crashing on an outer reef, nestled like a necklace around the semicircle of emerald-green water.

Such was the famous pirates' settlement of San José—a paradise of nature and a hell of human depravity and wickedness—and it was to this spot that Mainwaring paid another visit a few days after rescuing the crew of the Baltimore Belle from her shattered and sinking wreck.

Such was the famous pirates' settlement of San José—a natural paradise and a place of human depravity and wickedness—and it was to this spot that Mainwaring returned a few days after rescuing the crew of the Baltimore Belle from her broken and sinking wreck.

As the little bay with its fringe of palms and its cluster of wattle huts opened up to view, Mainwaring discovered a vessel lying at anchor in the little harbor. It was a large and well-rigged schooner of two hundred and fifty or three hundred tons burden. As the Yankee rounded to under the stern of the stranger and dropped anchor in such a position as to bring her broadside battery to bear should the occasion require, Mainwaring set his glass to his eye to read the name he could distinguish beneath the overhang of her stern. It is impossible to describe his infinite surprise when, the white lettering starting out in the circle of the glass, he read, The Eliza Cooper, of Philadelphia.

As the small bay, lined with palm trees and a cluster of wattle huts, came into view, Mainwaring spotted a ship anchored in the harbor. It was a large, well-rigged schooner, weighing about two hundred fifty to three hundred tons. When the Yankee turned and anchored behind the stranger, positioning itself to potentially fire its broadside if necessary, Mainwaring lifted his binoculars to see the name partially obscured under the overhang of the stern. He could hardly believe his astonishment when, through the lens, he read the white lettering: The Eliza Cooper, of Philadelphia.

He could not believe the evidence of his senses. Certainly this sink of iniquity was the last place in the world he would have expected to have fallen in with Eleazer Cooper.

He couldn't believe what he was seeing. This place of wrongdoing was definitely the last spot in the world he would have thought he'd run into Eleazer Cooper.

He ordered out the gig and had himself immediately rowed over to the schooner. Whatever lingering doubts he might have entertained as to the identity of the vessel were quickly dispelled when he beheld Captain Cooper himself standing at the gangway to meet him. The impassive face of the friend showed neither surprise nor confusion at what must have been to him a most unexpected encounter.

He called for the small boat and quickly had himself rowed over to the schooner. Any doubts he might have had about the identity of the vessel vanished when he saw Captain Cooper himself standing at the gangway to greet him. The stern expression on his friend's face showed no surprise or confusion at what must have been a very unexpected meeting for him.

But when he stepped upon the deck of the Eliza Cooper and looked about him, Mainwaring could hardly believe the evidence of his senses at the transformation that he beheld. Upon the main deck were eight twelve-pound carronade neatly covered with tarpaulin; in the bow a Long Tom, also snugly stowed away and covered, directed a veiled and muzzled snout out over the bowsprit.

But when he stepped onto the deck of the Eliza Cooper and looked around, Mainwaring could hardly believe what he saw at the transformation before him. On the main deck were eight twelve-pound carronades neatly covered with tarpaulin; in the bow, a Long Tom, also securely stored and covered, pointed its concealed and muzzled snout out over the bowsprit.

It was entirely impossible for Mainwaring to conceal his astonishment at so unexpected a sight, and whether or not his own thoughts lent color to his imagination, it seemed to him that Eleazer Cooper concealed under the immobility of his countenance no small degree of confusion.[198]

It was completely impossible for Mainwaring to hide his shock at such an unexpected sight, and whether his own thoughts intensified his imagination or not, it appeared to him that Eleazer Cooper was hiding a considerable amount of confusion beneath the stillness of his face.[198]

After Captain Cooper had led the way into the cabin and he and the younger man were seated over a pipe of tobacco and the invariable bottle of fine old Jamaica rum, Mainwaring made no attempt to refrain from questioning him as to the reason for this singular and ominous transformation.

After Captain Cooper led the way into the cabin, and he and the younger man were sitting down with a pipe of tobacco and the usual bottle of fine old Jamaica rum, Mainwaring didn’t hold back from asking him about the reason for this strange and concerning change.

"I am a man of peace, James Mainwaring," Eleazer replied, "but there are men of blood in these waters, and an appearance of great strength is of use to protect the innocent from the wicked. If I remained in appearance the peaceful trader I really am, how long does thee suppose I could remain unassailed in this place?"

"I’m a man of peace, James Mainwaring," Eleazer replied, "but there are violent men in these waters, and looking strong helps protect the innocent from the evil. If I acted like the peaceful trader I truly am, how long do you think I could stay safe in this place?"

It occurred to Mainwaring that the powerful armament he had beheld was rather extreme to be used merely as a preventive. He smoked for a while in silence and then he suddenly asked the other point-blank whether, if it came to blows with such a one as Captain Scarfield, would he make a fight of it?

It struck Mainwaring that the heavy weaponry he had seen was a bit much to be used just as a deterrent. He sat quietly smoking for a while, then abruptly asked the other person straight out whether, if it came down to a fight with someone like Captain Scarfield, he would stand and fight.

The Quaker trading captain regarded him for a while in silence. His look, it seemed to Mainwaring, appeared to be dubitative as to how far he dared to be frank. "Friend James," he said at last, "I may as well acknowledge that my officers and crew are somewhat worldly. Of a truth they do not hold the same testimony as I. I am inclined to think that if it came to the point of a broil with those men of iniquity, my individual voice cast for peace would not be sufficient to keep my crew from meeting violence with violence. As for myself, thee knows who I am and what is my testimony in these matters."

The Quaker trading captain stared at him silently for a moment. Mainwaring felt that his expression seemed uncertain about how honest he could be. "Friend James," he finally said, "I should admit that my officers and crew are a bit worldly. Honestly, they don’t share the same beliefs as I do. I think that if it came down to a conflict with those corrupt men, my personal call for peace wouldn’t be enough to stop my crew from responding to aggression with aggression. As for me, you know who I am and what I believe about these issues."

Mainwaring made no comment as to the extremely questionable manner in which the Quaker proposed to beat the devil about the stump. Presently he asked his second question:

Mainwaring didn’t say anything about the highly questionable way the Quaker planned to deal with the devil. Eventually, he asked his second question:

"And might I inquire," he said, "what you are doing here and why you find it necessary to come at all into such a wicked, dangerous place as this?"

"And can I ask," he said, "what you're doing here and why you feel it's necessary to come into such a wicked, dangerous place like this?"

"Indeed, I knew thee would ask that question of me," said the[199] Friend, "and I will be entirely frank with thee. These men of blood are, after all, but human beings, and as human beings they need food. I have at present upon this vessel upward of two hundred and fifty barrels of flour which will bring a higher price here than anywhere else in the West Indies. To be entirely frank with thee, I will tell thee that I was engaged in making a bargain for the sale of the greater part of my merchandise when the news of thy approach drove away my best customer."

"Honestly, I knew you would ask me that," said the[199] Friend, "and I’ll be completely honest with you. These bloodthirsty men are, after all, just human beings, and like everyone else, they need food. Right now, I have over two hundred and fifty barrels of flour on this ship that will fetch a better price here than anywhere else in the West Indies. To be completely upfront with you, I was in the middle of making a deal to sell most of my goods when the news of your arrival scared off my best customer."

Mainwaring sat for a while in smoking silence. What the other had told him explained many things he had not before understood. It explained why Captain Cooper got almost as much for his flour and corn meal now that peace had been declared as he had obtained when the war and the blockade were in full swing. It explained why he had been so strong a defender of Captain Scarfield and the pirates that afternoon in the garden. Meantime, what was to be done? Eleazer confessed openly that he dealt with the pirates. What now was his—Mainwaring's—duty in the case? Was the cargo of the Eliza Cooper contraband and subject to confiscation? And then another question framed itself in his mind: Who was this customer whom his approach had driven away?

Mainwaring sat in silence, smoking for a while. What the other person had told him cleared up a lot of things he hadn’t understood before. It explained why Captain Cooper was getting nearly as much for his flour and cornmeal now that peace had been declared as he had during the war and the blockade. It also explained why he had strongly defended Captain Scarfield and the pirates that afternoon in the garden. Meanwhile, what was he supposed to do? Eleazer openly admitted that he was dealing with the pirates. What was Mainwaring's duty in this situation? Was the cargo of the Eliza Cooper illegal and subject to being seized? And then another question popped into his mind: Who was this customer that his approach had scared off?

As though he had formulated the inquiry into speech the other began directly to speak of it. "I know," he said, "that in a moment thee will ask me who was this customer of whom I have just now spoken. I have no desire to conceal his name from thee. It was the man who is known as Captain Jack or Captain John Scarfield."

As if he had just come up with the question, the other person started to talk about it right away. "I know," he said, "that any moment now you're going to ask me who this customer is that I just mentioned. I have no intention of keeping his name from you. It was the man known as Captain Jack or Captain John Scarfield."

Mainwaring fairly started from his seat. "The devil you say!" he cried. "And how long has it been," he asked, "since he left you?"

Mainwaring jumped up from his seat. "No way!" he exclaimed. "And how long has it been," he asked, "since he left you?"

The Quaker skipper carefully refilled his pipe, which he had by now smoked out. "I would judge," he said, "that it is a matter of four or five hours since news was brought overland by means of swift runners of thy approach. Immediately the man of wickedness[200] disappeared." Here Eleazer set the bowl of his pipe to the candle flame and began puffing out voluminous clouds of smoke. "I would have thee understand, James Mainwaring," he resumed, "that I am no friend of this wicked and sinful man. His safety is nothing to me. It is only a question of buying upon his part and of selling upon mine. If it is any satisfaction to thee I will heartily promise to bring thee news if I hear anything of the man of Belial. I may furthermore say that I think it is likely thee will have news more or less directly of him within the space of a day. If this should happen, however, thee will have to do thy own fighting without help from me, for I am no man of combat nor of blood and will take no hand in it either way."

The Quaker captain carefully refilled his pipe, which he had completely smoked out. "I would say," he said, "that it’s been about four or five hours since news came overland through swift runners about your arrival. Right after, the evil man[200] vanished." Here, Eleazer held the bowl of his pipe to the candle flame and began puffing out large clouds of smoke. "I want you to understand, James Mainwaring," he continued, "that I am not a friend of this wicked and sinful man. His safety means nothing to me. It’s just a matter of his buying and my selling. If it brings you any comfort, I promise to inform you if I hear anything about the man of Belial. I can also say that I think you’ll have some news about him within a day. However, if that happens, you’ll need to do your own fighting without any help from me, because I am not a fighter nor a bloodshedder, and I won’t get involved either way."

THEN THE REAL FIGHT BEGAN then the real battle started

It struck Mainwaring that the words contained some meaning that did not appear upon the surface. This significance struck him as so ambiguous that when he went aboard the Yankee he confided as much of his suspicions as he saw fit to his second in command, Lieutenant Underwood. As night descended he had a double watch set and had everything prepared to repel any attack or surprise that might be attempted.

It occurred to Mainwaring that the words held a deeper meaning that wasn’t obvious at first glance. This significance seemed so unclear that when he got on the Yankee, he shared as much of his suspicions as he deemed appropriate with his second-in-command, Lieutenant Underwood. As night fell, he assigned a double watch and made all the necessary preparations to defend against any potential attack or surprise.

III

Nighttime in the tropics descends with a surprising rapidity. At one moment the earth is shining with the brightness of the twilight; the next, as it were, all things are suddenly swallowed into a gulf of darkness. The particular night of which this story treats was not entirely clear; the time of year was about the approach of the rainy season, and the tepid, tropical clouds added obscurity to the darkness of the sky, so that the night fell with even more startling quickness than usual. The blackness was very dense. Now and then a group of drifting stars swam out of a rift in the vapors, but the night was curiously silent and of a velvety darkness.

Night in the tropics falls unexpectedly fast. One moment, the earth is glowing with the light of twilight; the next, everything seems to vanish into a sea of darkness. The particular night this story focuses on wasn’t completely clear; it was around the start of the rainy season, and the warm, tropical clouds added to the murkiness of the sky, making the night fall even more suddenly than usual. The darkness was thick. Occasionally, a cluster of stars would peek through a break in the clouds, but the night was strangely quiet and enveloped in a deep, velvety blackness.

As the obscurity had deepened, Mainwaring had ordered [201]lanthorns to be lighted and slung to the shrouds and to the stays, and the faint yellow of their illumination lighted the level white of the snug little war vessel, gleaming here and there in a starlike spark upon the brass trimmings and causing the rows of cannons to assume curiously gigantic proportions.

As the darkness settled in, Mainwaring had ordered [201]lanterns to be lit and hung from the rigging and the stays. The soft yellow glow illuminated the sleek white of the cozy little warship, glistening here and there like tiny stars on the brass fittings and making the rows of cannons look strangely massive.

For some reason Mainwaring was possessed by a strange, uneasy feeling. He walked restlessly up and down the deck for a time, and then, still full of anxieties for he knew not what, went into his cabin to finish writing up his log for the day. He unstrapped his cutlass and laid it upon the table, lighted his pipe at the lanthorn and was about preparing to lay aside his coat when word was brought to him that the captain of the trading schooner was come alongside and had some private information to communicate to him.

For some reason, Mainwaring felt a strange, uneasy sensation. He paced up and down the deck for a while, still filled with anxieties he couldn't quite place, and then went into his cabin to finish writing his log for the day. He unbuckled his cutlass and set it on the table, lit his pipe at the lantern, and was about to take off his coat when he was informed that the captain of the trading schooner had arrived and had some private information to share with him.

Mainwaring surmised in an instant that the trader's visit related somehow to news of Captain Scarfield, and as immediately, in the relief of something positive to face, all of his feeling of restlessness vanished like a shadow of mist. He gave orders that Captain Cooper should be immediately shown into the cabin, and in a few moments the tall, angular form of the Quaker skipper appeared in the narrow, lanthorn-lighted space.

Mainwaring quickly guessed that the trader's visit had something to do with news about Captain Scarfield, and as soon as he thought that, all of his restlessness faded away like a wisp of fog in the sunlight. He ordered that Captain Cooper be brought into the cabin right away, and a few moments later, the tall, lean figure of the Quaker captain stepped into the narrow, lantern-lit space.

Mainwaring at once saw that his visitor was strangely agitated and disturbed. He had taken off his hat, and shining beads of perspiration had gathered and stood clustered upon his forehead. He did not reply to Mainwaring's greeting; he did not, indeed, seem to hear it; but he came directly forward to the table and stood leaning with one hand upon the open log book in which the lieutenant had just been writing. Mainwaring had reseated himself at the head of the table, and the tall figure of the skipper stood looking down at him as from a considerable height.

Mainwaring immediately noticed that his visitor was strangely agitated and upset. He had taken off his hat, and shiny beads of sweat had gathered on his forehead. He didn’t respond to Mainwaring's greeting; in fact, he didn’t seem to hear it. Instead, he walked right up to the table and leaned one hand on the open logbook where the lieutenant had just been writing. Mainwaring had settled back into his seat at the head of the table, and the tall figure of the skipper loomed over him as if from a great height.

"James Mainwaring," he said, "I promised thee to report if I had news of the pirate. Is thee ready now to hear my news?"

"James Mainwaring," he said, "I promised to let you know if I had any news about the pirate. Are you ready to hear what I have to say?"

There was something so strange in his agitation that it began[202] to infect Mainwaring with a feeling somewhat akin to that which appeared to disturb his visitor. "I know not what you mean, sir!" he cried, "by asking if I care to hear your news. At this moment I would rather have news of that scoundrel than to have anything I know of in the world."

There was something so odd about his agitation that it started[202] to infect Mainwaring with a feeling similar to what seemed to trouble his visitor. "I don’t know what you mean, sir!" he exclaimed, "by asking if I want to hear your news. Right now, I would rather hear news about that scoundrel than anything else I know in the world."

"Thou would? Thou would?" cried the other, with mounting agitation. "Is thee in such haste to meet him as all that? Very well; very well, then. Suppose I could bring thee face to face with him—what then? Hey? Hey? Face to face with him, James Mainwaring!"

"Would you? Would you?" cried the other, with growing agitation. "Are you really in that much of a hurry to meet him? Alright, alright then. Suppose I could bring you face to face with him—what then? Huh? Huh? Face to face with him, James Mainwaring!"

The thought instantly flashed into Mainwaring's mind that the pirate had returned to the island; that perhaps at that moment he was somewhere near at hand.

The thought quickly crossed Mainwaring's mind that the pirate had come back to the island; that maybe right then he was nearby.

"I do not understand you, sir," he cried. "Do you mean to tell me that you know where the villain is? If so, lose no time in informing me, for every instant of delay may mean his chance of again escaping."

"I don't understand you, sir," he exclaimed. "Are you saying that you know where the villain is? If that's the case, don't waste any time telling me, because every moment of delay could give him a chance to escape again."

"No danger of that!" the other declared, vehemently. "No danger of that! I'll tell thee where he is and I'll bring thee to him quick enough!" And as he spoke he thumped his fist against the open log book. In the vehemence of his growing excitement his eyes appeared to shine green in the lanthorn light, and the sweat that had stood in beads upon his forehead was now running in streams down his face. One drop hung like a jewel to the tip of his beaklike nose. He came a step nearer to Mainwaring and bent forward toward him, and there was something so strange and ominous in his bearing that the lieutenant instinctively drew back a little where he sat.

"No way that's happening!" the other shouted, passionately. "No way that's happening! I'll tell you where he is and I'll get you to him fast!" As he said this, he slammed his fist against the open logbook. In the intensity of his rising excitement, his eyes seemed to shine green in the lantern light, and the sweat that had beads on his forehead was now streaming down his face. A drop hung like a jewel at the tip of his beak-like nose. He stepped closer to Mainwaring and leaned toward him, and there was something so unusual and foreboding in his demeanor that the lieutenant instinctively leaned back a little where he sat.

"Captain Scarfield sent something to you," said Eleazer, almost in a raucous voice, "something that you will be surprised to see." And the lapse in his speech from the Quaker "thee" to the plural "you" struck Mainwaring as singularly strange.

"Captain Scarfield sent you something," Eleazer said, almost in a loud voice, "something that's going to surprise you." The shift in his speech from the Quaker "thee" to the plural "you" struck Mainwaring as unusually odd.

As he was speaking Eleazer was fumbling in a pocket of his[203] long-tailed drab coat, and presently he brought something forth that gleamed in the lanthorn light.

As he was talking, Eleazer was digging around in a pocket of his[203] long, drab coat, and soon he pulled out something that sparkled in the lantern light.

The next moment Mainwaring saw leveled directly in his face the round and hollow nozzle of a pistol.

The next moment, Mainwaring saw the round and hollow barrel of a pistol aimed straight at his face.

There was an instant of dead silence and then, "I am the man you seek!" said Eleazer Cooper, in a tense and breathless voice.

There was a moment of complete silence and then, "I'm the guy you're looking for!" said Eleazer Cooper, in a tight and breathless voice.

The whole thing had happened so instantaneously and unexpectedly that for the moment Mainwaring sat like one petrified. Had a thunderbolt fallen from the silent sky and burst at his feet he could not have been more stunned. He was like one held in the meshes of a horrid nightmare, and he gazed as through a mist of impossibility into the lineaments of the well-known, sober face now transformed as from within into the aspect of a devil. That face, now ashy white, was distorted into a diabolical grin. The teeth glistened in the lamplight. The brows, twisted into a tense and convulsed frown, were drawn down into black shadows, through which the eyes burned a baleful green like the eyes of a wild animal driven to bay. Again he spoke in the same breathless voice. "I am John Scarfield! Look at me, then, if you want to see a pirate!" Again there was a little time of silence, through which Mainwaring heard his watch ticking loudly from where it hung against the bulkhead. Then once more the other began speaking. "You would chase me out of the West Indies, would you? G—— —— you! What are you come to now? You are caught in your own trap, and you'll squeal loud enough before you get out of it. Speak a word or make a movement and I'll blow your brains out against the partition behind you! Listen to what I say or you are a dead man. Sing out an order instantly for my mate and my bos'n to come here to the cabin, and be quick about it, for my finger's on the trigger, and it's only a pull to shut your mouth forever."

The whole thing had happened so quickly and unexpectedly that for a moment, Mainwaring sat frozen. If a lightning bolt had struck at his feet, he couldn’t have been more shocked. He felt trapped in a dreadful nightmare, staring through a fog of disbelief at the familiar, serious face that had now transformed into something devilish. That face, now pale and ashy, was twisted into a sinister grin. The teeth shone in the lamplight. The brows were contorted into a tense, angry scowl, casting dark shadows, while the eyes glowed a menacing green, like those of a wild animal cornered. He spoke again, his voice breathless. "I am John Scarfield! Look at me if you want to see a pirate!" There was a moment of silence during which Mainwaring could hear his watch ticking loudly from where it hung on the wall. Then the other person started speaking again. "You would drive me out of the West Indies, would you? Damn you! What have you gotten yourself into now? You're caught in your own trap, and you'll scream loud enough before you manage to escape. Say a word or make a move, and I’ll blow your brains out against that wall behind you! Listen to what I say, or you're a dead man. Call for my mate and my bosun to come here to the cabin, and do it fast, because my finger’s on the trigger, and it only takes a pull to silence you forever."

It was astonishing to Mainwaring, in afterward thinking about it all, how quickly his mind began to recover its steadiness after that first astonishing shock. Even as the other was speaking[204] he discovered that his brain was becoming clarified to a wonderful lucidity; his thoughts were becoming rearranged, and with a marvelous activity and an alertness he had never before experienced. He knew that if he moved to escape or uttered any outcry he would be instantly a dead man, for the circle of the pistol barrel was directed full against his forehead and with the steadiness of a rock. If he could but for an instant divert that fixed and deadly attention he might still have a chance for life. With the thought an inspiration burst into his mind and he instantly put it into execution; thought, inspiration, and action, as in a flash, were one. He must make the other turn aside his deadly gaze, and instantly he roared out in a voice that stunned his own ears: "Strike, bos'n! Strike, quick!"

It was astonishing to Mainwaring, when he thought back on it all, how quickly his mind started to regain its steadiness after that initial shock. Even while the other person was speaking[204], he found that his brain was becoming increasingly clear; his thoughts were reorganizing, and he felt a quickness and alertness he had never experienced before. He understood that if he tried to escape or made any noise, he would be dead in an instant, as the pistol was aimed directly at his forehead with unshakeable steadiness. If he could just for a moment shift that intense and lethal focus, he might still have a chance to survive. With that thought, a burst of inspiration hit him, and he acted on it immediately; thought, inspiration, and action merged in a flash. He had to make the other person look away from his lethal gaze, so he shouted in a voice that surprised even him: "Strike, bos'n! Strike, quick!"

Taken by surprise, and thinking, doubtless, that another enemy stood behind him, the pirate swung around like a flash with his pistol leveled against the blank boarding. Equally upon the instant he saw the trick that had been played upon him and in a second flash had turned again. The turn and return had occupied but a moment of time, but that moment, thanks to the readiness of his own invention, had undoubtedly saved Mainwaring's life. As the other turned away his gaze for that brief instant Mainwaring leaped forward and upon him. There was a flashing flame of fire as the pistol was discharged and a deafening detonation that seemed to split his brain. For a moment, with reeling senses, he supposed himself to have been shot, the next he knew he had escaped. With the energy of despair he swung his enemy around and drove him with prodigious violence against the corner of the table. The pirate emitted a grunting cry and then they fell together, Mainwaring upon the top, and the pistol clattered with them to the floor in their fall. Even as he fell, Mainwaring roared in a voice of thunder, "All hands repel boarders!" And then again, "All hands repel boarders!"

Caught off guard and likely thinking another enemy was behind him, the pirate spun around quickly, his pistol pointed at the empty boarding. At that moment, he realized the trick that had been played on him, and instantly he turned back again. This move took only a moment, but that moment, thanks to his quick thinking, had definitely saved Mainwaring's life. As the pirate briefly looked away, Mainwaring lunged at him. There was a bright flash as the pistol fired and a deafening bang that felt like it split his head. For a second, with his senses spinning, he thought he had been shot, but then he realized he had escaped. Fueled by a desperate energy, he spun his enemy around and slammed him violently against the corner of the table. The pirate let out a grunt, and they both fell, with Mainwaring landing on top, causing the pistol to clatter to the floor with them. As they fell, Mainwaring shouted in a booming voice, "All hands repel boarders!" Then again, "All hands repel boarders!"

Whether hurt by the table edge or not, the fallen pirate struggled[205] as though possessed of forty devils, and in a moment or two Mainwaring saw the shine of a long, keen knife that he had drawn from somewhere about his person. The lieutenant caught him by the wrist, but the other's muscles were as though made of steel. They both fought in despairing silence, the one to carry out his frustrated purposes to kill, the other to save his life. Again and again Mainwaring felt that the knife had been thrust against him, piercing once his arm, once his shoulder, and again his neck. He felt the warm blood streaming down his arm and body and looked about him in despair. The pistol lay near upon the deck of the cabin. Still holding the other by the wrist as he could, Mainwaring snatched up the empty weapon and struck once and again at the bald, narrow forehead beneath him. A third blow he delivered with all the force he could command, and then with a violent and convulsive throe the straining muscles beneath him relaxed and grew limp and the fight was won.

Whether he was hurt by the edge of the table or not, the fallen pirate struggled[205] like he was possessed by forty devils, and in a moment, Mainwaring noticed the glint of a long, sharp knife that he had pulled from somewhere on his body. The lieutenant grabbed his wrist, but the other’s muscles felt like steel. They fought in desperate silence, one to fulfill his intent to kill, the other to save his life. Over and over, Mainwaring felt the knife press against him, cutting into his arm, his shoulder, and again his neck. He felt warm blood streaming down his arm and body and looked around in despair. The pistol lay close on the cabin deck. Still holding the other by the wrist as best he could, Mainwaring grabbed the empty weapon and struck once and then again at the bald, narrow forehead beneath him. He delivered a third blow with all the strength he could muster, and then with a violent and convulsive jerk, the straining muscles beneath him relaxed and went limp, signaling the fight was won.

Through all the struggle he had been aware of the shouts of voices, of trampling of feet and discharge of firearms, and the thought came to him, even through his own danger, that the Yankee was being assaulted by the pirates. As he felt the struggling form beneath him loosen and dissolve into quietude, he leaped up, and snatching his cutlass, which still lay upon the table, rushed out upon the deck, leaving the stricken form lying twitching upon the floor behind him.

Throughout all the chaos, he could hear the shouts of voices, the sound of feet trampling, and the firing of guns. The thought crossed his mind, even in the face of his own danger, that the Yankee was under attack by the pirates. As he felt the struggling body beneath him relax and become still, he jumped up, grabbed his cutlass, which was still on the table, and rushed out onto the deck, leaving the wounded form twitching on the floor behind him.

It was a fortunate thing that he had set double watches and prepared himself for some attack from the pirates, otherwise the Yankee would certainly have been lost. As it was, the surprise was so overwhelming that the pirates, who had been concealed in the large whaleboat that had come alongside, were not only able to gain a foothold upon the deck, but for a time it seemed as though they would drive the crew of the brig below the hatches.

It was lucky that he had arranged for double watches and got ready for a possible attack from the pirates; otherwise, the Yankee would definitely have been lost. As it turned out, the surprise was so intense that the pirates, who had been hiding in the big whaleboat that had come alongside, not only managed to get a foothold on the deck, but for a while it looked like they would push the crew of the brig below deck.

But as Mainwaring, streaming with blood, rushed out upon the deck, the pirates became immediately aware that their own[206] captain must have been overpowered, and in an instant their desperate energy began to evaporate. One or two jumped overboard; one, who seemed to be the mate, fell dead from a pistol shot, and then, in the turn of a hand, there was a rush of a retreat and a vision of leaping forms in the dusky light of the lanthorns and a sound of splashing in the water below.

But as Mainwaring, covered in blood, burst out onto the deck, the pirates quickly realized that their own[206] captain must have been defeated, and in an instant, their frantic energy started to fade away. A couple of them jumped overboard; one, who looked like the first mate, dropped dead from a gunshot, and then, in the blink of an eye, there was a chaotic retreat and a blur of bodies moving in the dim light of the lanterns and the sound of splashing in the water below.

"He Struck Once and Again at the Bald, Narrow Forehead Beneath Him" "He Hit Again and Again on the Bald, Narrow Forehead Below Him"

Illustration from
CAPTAIN SCARFIELD

by Howard Pyle

Originally published in
The Northwestern Miller, December 18, 1897

The crew of the Yankee continued firing at the phosphorescent wakes of the swimming bodies, but whether with effect it was impossible at the time to tell.

The crew of the Yankee kept shooting at the glowing trails left by the swimming bodies, but it was impossible to tell at that moment whether they were hitting anything.

IV

The pirate captain did not die immediately. He lingered for three or four days, now and then unconscious, now and then semi-conscious, but always deliriously wandering. All the while he thus lay dying, the mulatto woman, with whom he lived in this part of his extraordinary dual existence, nursed and cared for him with such rude attentions as the surroundings afforded. In the wanderings of his mind the same duality of life followed him. Now and then he would appear the calm, sober, self-contained, well-ordered member of a peaceful society that his friends in his far-away home knew him to be; at other times the nether part of his nature would leap up into life like a wild beast, furious and gnashing. At the one time he talked evenly and clearly of peaceful things; at the other time he blasphemed and hooted with fury.

The pirate captain didn’t die right away. He held on for three or four days, sometimes unconscious, sometimes semi-conscious, but always moving in and out of delirium. While he lay dying, the mulatto woman, with whom he shared this strange double life, took care of him with the rough attentions that the situation allowed. In the chaos of his thoughts, the same duality persisted. Occasionally, he’d seem like the calm, composed, orderly member of a peaceful society that his friends back in his distant home knew him to be; at other times, the wilder side of his nature would erupt like a furious beast, raging and gnashing. At one moment, he’d speak steadily and clearly about peaceful topics; at another, he’d curse and roar with anger.

Several times Mainwaring, though racked by his own wounds, sat beside the dying man through the silent watches of the tropical nights. Oftentimes upon these occasions as he looked at the thin, lean face babbling and talking so aimlessly, he wondered what it all meant. Could it have been madness—madness in which the separate entities of good and bad each had, in its turn, a perfect and distinct existence? He chose to think that this was the case. Who, within his inner consciousness, does not feel that same ferine, savage man struggling against the stern, adamantine bonds of [207]morality and decorum? Were those bonds burst asunder, as it was with this man, might not the wild beast rush forth, as it had rushed forth in him, to rend and to tear? Such were the questions that Mainwaring asked himself. And how had it all come about? By what easy gradations had the respectable Quaker skipper descended from the decorum of his home life, step by step, into such a gulf of iniquity? Many such thoughts passed through Mainwaring's mind, and he pondered them through the still reaches of the tropical nights while he sat watching the pirate captain struggle out of the world he had so long burdened. At last the poor wretch died, and the earth was well quit of one of its torments.

Several times Mainwaring, despite his own injuries, sat beside the dying man through the quiet hours of the tropical nights. Often during these moments, as he looked at the thin, gaunt face mumbling and talking aimlessly, he wondered what it all meant. Could it have been madness—where the separate pieces of good and evil each had a clear and distinct existence? He preferred to believe that this was true. Who, deep down inside, doesn't sense that same wild, primal instinct fighting against the unyielding chains of morality and decorum? If those chains were broken, as they were for this man, might the beast within not surge forth, as it had in him, to tear and destroy? These were the questions Mainwaring asked himself. And how had it all come to this? Through what small steps had the respectable Quaker captain fallen from the decorum of his home life into such a pit of wickedness? Many of these thoughts ran through Mainwaring's mind, and he reflected on them through the quiet stretches of the tropical nights while he sat watching the pirate captain as he struggled to leave the world that had burdened him for so long. Eventually, the poor soul died, and the earth was finally free from one of its torments.

A systematic search was made through the island for the scattered crew, but none was captured. Either there were some secret hiding places upon the island (which was not very likely) or else they had escaped in boats hidden somewhere among the tropical foliage. At any rate they were gone.

A thorough search was conducted across the island for the missing crew, but no one was found. Either there were some secret hiding spots on the island (which seemed unlikely) or they had managed to escape in boats concealed somewhere among the tropical greenery. In any case, they were gone.

Nor, search as he would, could Mainwaring find a trace of any of the pirate treasure. After the pirate's death and under close questioning, the weeping mulatto woman so far broke down as to confess in broken English that Captain Scarfield had taken a quantity of silver money aboard his vessel, but either she was mistaken or else the pirates had taken it thence again and had hidden it somewhere else.

Nor, no matter how hard he looked, could Mainwaring find any sign of the pirate treasure. After the pirate died and while being closely questioned, the crying mulatto woman eventually broke down and admitted in shaky English that Captain Scarfield had taken a stash of silver coins onto his ship, but either she was wrong or the pirates had taken it back and hidden it somewhere else.

Nor would the treasure ever have been found but for a most fortuitous accident.

Nor would the treasure ever have been found if it weren't for a very lucky accident.

Mainwaring had given orders that the Eliza Cooper was to be burned, and a party was detailed to carry the order into execution. At this the cook of the Yankee came petitioning for some of the Wilmington and Brandywine flour to make some plum duff upon the morrow, and Mainwaring granted his request in so far that he ordered one of the men to knock open one of the barrels of flour and to supply the cook's demands.

Mainwaring had ordered that the Eliza Cooper was to be burned, and a group was assigned to carry out the order. At this point, the cook of the Yankee came asking for some of the Wilmington and Brandywine flour to make plum duff the next day, and Mainwaring agreed to his request by telling one of the men to break open a barrel of flour and provide for the cook's needs.

The crew detailed to execute this modest order in connection[208] with the destruction of the pirate vessel had not been gone a quarter of an hour when word came back that the hidden treasure had been found.

The crew assigned to carry out this simple task related[208] to the destruction of the pirate ship had only been gone for about fifteen minutes when news returned that the hidden treasure had been discovered.

Mainwaring hurried aboard the Eliza Cooper, and there in the midst of the open flour barrel he beheld a great quantity of silver coin buried in and partly covered by the white meal. A systematic search was now made. One by one the flour barrels were heaved up from below and burst open on the deck and their contents searched, and if nothing but the meal was found it was swept overboard. The breeze was whitened with clouds of flour, and the white meal covered the surface of the ocean for yards around.

Mainwaring rushed onto the Eliza Cooper, and there, in the middle of the open flour barrel, he saw a large amount of silver coins buried in and partially covered by the white flour. They began a thorough search. One by one, the flour barrels were brought up from below, opened on the deck, and their contents examined. If only flour was found, it was swept overboard. The breeze was filled with clouds of flour, and the white powder covered the surface of the ocean for yards around.

In all, upward of one hundred and fifty thousand dollars was found concealed beneath the innocent flour and meal. It was no wonder the pirate captain was so successful, when he could upon an instant's notice transform himself from a wolf of the ocean to a peaceful Quaker trader selling flour to the hungry towns and settlements among the scattered islands of the West Indies, and so carrying his bloody treasure safely into his quiet Northern home.

In total, over one hundred and fifty thousand dollars was discovered hidden beneath the seemingly harmless flour and meal. It’s no surprise the pirate captain was so successful; he could instantly switch from a fierce ocean predator to a peaceful Quaker trader selling flour to the hungry towns and settlements scattered across the islands of the West Indies, safely transporting his bloody treasure to his quiet Northern home.

In concluding this part of the narrative it may be added that a wide strip of canvas painted black was discovered in the hold of the Eliza Cooper. Upon it, in great white letters, was painted the name, "The Bloodhound." Undoubtedly this was used upon occasions to cover the real and peaceful title of the trading schooner, just as its captain had, in reverse, covered his sanguine and cruel life by a thin sheet of morality and respectability.

In wrapping up this part of the story, it should be noted that a large piece of black canvas was found in the hold of the Eliza Cooper. On it, in bold white letters, was the name "The Bloodhound." This was clearly used at times to hide the true and peaceful identity of the trading schooner, just like its captain had, in a twisted way, concealed his brutal and ruthless life under a thin layer of morality and respectability.

This is the true story of the death of Capt. Jack Scarfield.

This is the true story of the death of Capt. Jack Scarfield.

The Newburyport chap-book, of which I have already spoken, speaks only of how the pirate disguised himself upon the ocean as a Quaker trader.

The Newburyport chapbook I mentioned earlier talks only about how the pirate disguised himself at sea as a Quaker trader.

Nor is it likely that anyone ever identified Eleazer Cooper with the pirate, for only Mainwaring of all the crew of the Yankee was exactly aware of the true identity of Captain Scarfield. All that[209] was ever known to the world was that Eleazer Cooper had been killed in a fight with the pirates.

Nor is it likely that anyone ever linked Eleazer Cooper to the pirate, since only Mainwaring among all the crew of the Yankee really knew the true identity of Captain Scarfield. All that[209] was ever known to the world was that Eleazer Cooper had died in a battle with the pirates.

In a little less than a year Mainwaring was married to Lucinda Fairbanks. As to Eleazer Cooper's fortune, which eventually came into the possession of Mainwaring through his wife, it was many times a subject of speculation to the lieutenant how it had been earned. There were times when he felt well assured that a part of it at least was the fruit of piracy, but it was entirely impossible to guess how much more was the result of legitimate trading.

In just under a year, Mainwaring married Lucinda Fairbanks. As for Eleazer Cooper's fortune, which Mainwaring eventually inherited through his wife, the lieutenant often speculated about how it was made. Sometimes he was pretty convinced that at least a portion of it came from piracy, but it was completely impossible to determine how much more had come from legitimate trade.

For a little time it seemed to Mainwaring that he should give it all up, but this was at once so impracticable and so quixotic that he presently abandoned it, and in time his qualms and misdoubts faded away and he settled himself down to enjoy that which had come to him through his marriage.

For a short while, Mainwaring thought about giving it all up, but that idea was both unrealistic and overly idealistic, so he quickly let it go. Eventually, his doubts and worries faded, and he began to enjoy what had come to him through his marriage.

In time the Mainwarings removed to New York, and ultimately the fortune that the pirate Scarfield had left behind him was used in part to found the great shipping house of Mainwaring & Bigot, whose famous transatlantic packet ships were in their time the admiration of the whole world.

In time, the Mainwarings moved to New York, and eventually, the fortune that the pirate Scarfield had left behind was partly used to establish the renowned shipping company Mainwaring & Bigot, whose famous transatlantic packet ships were the pride of the entire world in their era.


Chapter VIII

THE RUBY OF KISHMOOOR

Prologue

A

 very famous pirate of his day was Capt. Robertson Keitt.

A very famous pirate of his time was Captain Robertson Keitt.

Before embarking upon his later career of infamy, he was, in the beginning, very well known as a reputable merchant in the island of Jamaica. Thence entering, first of all, upon the business of the African trade, he presently, by regular degrees, became a pirate, and finally ended his career as one of the most renowned freebooters of history.

Before starting his later infamous career, he was initially well-known as a respected merchant in Jamaica. From there, he began his involvement in the African trade, and gradually became a pirate, ultimately finishing his career as one of the most famous freebooters in history.

The remarkable adventure through which he at once reached the pinnacle of success, and became in his profession the most famous figure of his day, was the capture of the Rajah of Kishmoor's great ship, The Sun of the East. In this vessel was the Rajah's favorite Queen, who, together with her attendants, was set upon a pilgrimage to Mecca. The court of this great Oriental potentate was, as may be readily supposed, fairly aglitter with gold and jewels, so that, what with such personal adornments that the Queen and her attendants had fetched with them, besides an ample treasury for the expenses of the expedition, an incredible prize of[211] gold and jewels rewarded the freebooters for their successful adventure.

The amazing adventure that led him to the peak of success and made him the most well-known figure in his field was the capture of the Rajah of Kishmoor's grand ship, The Sun of the East. Onboard was the Rajah's beloved Queen, who, along with her attendants, was on a pilgrimage to Mecca. The court of this powerful Eastern ruler was, as you might imagine, sparkling with gold and jewels. With the personal adornments the Queen and her attendants brought along, plus a substantial treasury for the trip's expenses, the freebooters were rewarded with an incredible haul of [211] gold and jewels for their successful venture.

Among the precious stones taken in this great purchase was the splendid ruby of Kishmoor. This, as may be known to the reader, was one of the world's greatest gems, and was unique alike both for its prodigious size and the splendor of its color. This precious jewel the Rajah of Kishmoor had, upon a certain occasion, bestowed upon his Queen, and at the time of her capture she wore it as the centerpiece of a sort of coronet which encircled her forehead and brow.

Among the precious stones acquired in this significant purchase was the magnificent ruby of Kishmoor. This, as you may know, was one of the world's greatest gems, unique for both its incredible size and the richness of its color. The Rajah of Kishmoor had given this valuable jewel to his Queen on a special occasion, and at the time of her capture, she was wearing it as the centerpiece of a coronet that surrounded her forehead and brow.

The seizure by the pirate of so considerable a person as that of the Queen of Kishmoor, and of the enormous treasure that he found aboard her ship, would alone have been sufficient to have established his fame. But the capture of so extraordinary a prize as that of the ruby—which was, in itself, worth the value of an entire Oriental kingdom—exalted him at once to the very highest pinnacle of renown.

The pirate’s capture of such an important figure as the Queen of Kishmoor, along with the huge treasure he discovered on her ship, would have been enough to make him famous. But taking such an extraordinary prize as the ruby—which was worth the equivalent of an entire Eastern kingdom—boosted his reputation to the highest level of fame.

Having achieved the capture of this incredible prize, our captain scuttled the great ship and left her to sink with all on board. Three Lascars of the crew alone escaped to bear the news of this tremendous disaster to an astounded world.

Having successfully captured this amazing prize, our captain sank the great ship and left it to go down with everyone on board. Only three Lascars from the crew managed to escape to bring the news of this huge disaster to a shocked world.

As may readily be supposed, it was now no longer possible for Captain Keitt to hope to live in such comparative obscurity as he had before enjoyed. His was now too remarkable a figure in the eyes of the world. Several expeditions from various parts were immediately fitted out against him, and it presently became no longer compatible with his safety to remain thus clearly outlined before the eyes of the world. Accordingly, he immediately set about seeking such security as he might now hope to find, which he did the more readily since he had now, and at one cast, so entirely fulfilled his most sanguine expectations of good fortune and of fame.

As you might expect, it was no longer possible for Captain Keitt to live in the same relative obscurity that he had enjoyed before. He had become too well-known in the eyes of the world. Several expeditions from different places were quickly organized against him, and it soon became unsafe for him to remain so visible. Therefore, he immediately began looking for the kind of security he could now hope to find, especially since he had, in one fell swoop, completely fulfilled his most optimistic expectations of success and recognition.

Thereafter, accordingly, the adventures of our captain became[212] of a more apocryphal sort. It was known that he reached the West Indies in safety, for he was once seen at Port Royal and twice at Spanish Town, in the island of Jamaica. Thereafter, however, he disappeared; nor was it until several years later that the world heard anything concerning him.

Thereafter, the adventures of our captain became[212] more legendary. It was known that he safely arrived in the West Indies, as he was spotted once in Port Royal and twice in Spanish Town, on the island of Jamaica. After that, though, he vanished; it wasn't until several years later that the world learned anything about him.

CAPTAIN KEITT Captain Keitt

One day a certain Nicholas Duckworthy, who had once been gunner aboard the pirate captain's own ship, The Good Fortune, was arrested in the town of Bristol in the very act of attempting to sell to a merchant of that place several valuable gems from a quantity which he carried with him tied up in a red bandanna handkerchief.

One day, a man named Nicholas Duckworthy, who had once been a gunner on the pirate captain's own ship, The Good Fortune, was caught in Bristol while trying to sell several valuable gems to a local merchant. He had the gems wrapped in a red bandanna handkerchief.

In the confession of which Duckworthy afterward delivered himself he declared that Captain Keitt, after his great adventure, having sailed from Africa in safety, and so reached the shores of the New World, had wrecked The Good Fortune on a coral reef off the Windward Islands; that he then immediately deserted the ship, and together with Duckworthy himself, the sailing master (who was a Portuguese), the captain of a brig, The Bloody Hand (a consort of Keitt's), and a villainous rascal named Hunt (who, occupying no precise position among the pirates, was at once the instigator of and the partaker in the greatest part of Captain Keitt's wickednesses), made his way to the nearest port of safety. These five worthies at last fetched the island of Jamaica, bringing with them all of the jewels and some of the gold that had been captured from The Sun of the East.

In the confession that Duckworthy later gave, he stated that Captain Keitt, after his big adventure, had safely sailed from Africa and reached the shores of the New World, only to wreck The Good Fortune on a coral reef off the Windward Islands. He then immediately abandoned the ship and, along with Duckworthy himself, the sailing master (who was Portuguese), the captain of a brig called The Bloody Hand (a companion of Keitt's), and a shady guy named Hunt (who had no specific role among the pirates but was both the instigator and participant in most of Captain Keitt's misdeeds), made his way to the nearest safe port. These five individuals eventually reached the island of Jamaica, bringing with them all the jewels and some of the gold they'd captured from The Sun of the East.

But, upon coming to a division of their booty, it was presently discovered that the Rajah's ruby had mysteriously disappeared from the collection of jewels to be divided. The other pirates immediately suspected their captain of having secretly purloined it, and, indeed, so certain were they of his turpitude that they immediately set about taking means to force a confession from him.

But when it came time to divide up their loot, they quickly realized that the Rajah's ruby had mysteriously gone missing from the collection of jewels set to be shared. The other pirates immediately suspected their captain of secretly stealing it, and they were so convinced of his guilt that they quickly started trying to find a way to force him to confess.

In this, however, they were so far unsuccessful that the captain, refusing to yield to their importunities, had suffered himself to die [213]under their hands, and had so carried the secret of the hiding place of the great ruby—if he possessed such a secret—along with him.

In this, however, they were so unsuccessful that the captain, refusing to give in to their pleas, let himself die [213] under their watch, taking with him the secret of where the great ruby was hidden—if he even had such a secret.

Duckworthy concluded his confession by declaring that in his opinion he himself, the Portuguese sailing master, the captain of The Bloody Hand, and Hunt were the only ones of Captain Keitt's crew who were now alive; for that The Good Fortune must have broken up in a storm, which immediately followed their desertion of her; in which event the entire crew must inevitably have perished.

Duckworthy ended his confession by stating that, in his opinion, he, the Portuguese sailing master, the captain of The Bloody Hand, and Hunt were the only survivors of Captain Keitt's crew; because The Good Fortune must have been wrecked in a storm that hit right after they deserted it, and in that case, the whole crew would have definitely died.

It may be added that Duckworthy himself was shortly hanged, so that, if his surmise was true, there were now only three left alive of all that wicked crew that had successfully carried to its completion the greatest adventure which any pirate in the world had ever, perhaps, embarked upon.

It might be noted that Duckworthy himself was soon hanged, so if his guess was right, there were now only three survivors left of that entire wicked group that had managed to complete the greatest adventure any pirate in the world had ever embarked on.

I

Jonathan Rugg

You may never know what romantic aspirations may lie hidden beneath the most sedate and sober demeanor.

You might never realize what romantic dreams are hidden beneath the calm and serious exterior.

To have observed Jonathan Rugg, who was a tall, lean, loose-jointed young Quaker of a somewhat forbidding aspect, with straight, dark hair and a bony, overhanging forehead set into a frown, a pair of small, deep-set eyes, and a square jaw, no one would for a moment have suspected that he concealed beneath so serious an exterior any appetite for romantic adventure.

To see Jonathan Rugg, a tall, lean, loose-jointed young Quaker with a somewhat intimidating look, straight dark hair, and a bony forehead that always seemed to frown, along with small, deep-set eyes and a square jaw, no one would have imagined that he hid any desire for romantic adventure beneath such a serious exterior.

Nevertheless, finding himself suddenly transported, as it were, from the quiet of so sober a town as that of Philadelphia to the tropical enchantment of Kingston, in the island of Jamaica, the night brilliant with a full moon that swung in an opal sky, the warm and luminous darkness replete with the mysteries of a tropical night, and burdened with the odors of a land breeze, he suddenly discovered himself to be overtaken with so vehement a desire for some unwonted excitement that, had the opportunity[214] presented itself, he felt himself ready to embrace any adventure with the utmost eagerness, no matter whither it would have conducted him.

Nevertheless, finding himself suddenly transported, so to speak, from the quiet of a serious town like Philadelphia to the tropical charm of Kingston in Jamaica, with a brilliant full moon hanging in an opalescent sky, the warm and radiant darkness filled with the mysteries of a tropical night and heavy with the scents of a land breeze, he suddenly realized he was overwhelmed by an intense desire for some unusual excitement that, had the chance[214] arisen, he would have eagerly embraced any adventure, no matter where it led him.

At home (where he was a clerk in the countinghouse of a leading merchant, by name Jeremiah Doolittle), should such idle fancies have come to him, he would have looked upon himself as little better than a fool, but now that he found himself for the first time in a foreign country, surrounded by such strange and unusual sights and sounds, all conducive to extravagant imaginations, the wish for some extraordinary and altogether unusual experience took possession of him with a singular vehemence to which he had heretofore been altogether a stranger.

At home (where he worked as a clerk in a prominent merchant's office, named Jeremiah Doolittle), if such silly thoughts had crossed his mind, he would have considered himself no better than a fool. But now, for the first time in a foreign country, surrounded by unfamiliar sights and sounds that sparked wild imaginations, the desire for some extraordinary and completely unique experience took hold of him with a intensity he had never known before.

In the street where he stood, which was of a shining whiteness and which reflected the effulgence of the moonlight with an incredible distinction, he observed, stretching before him, long lines of white garden walls, overtopped by a prodigious luxuriance of tropical foliage.

In the street where he stood, which was a brilliant white and reflected the bright moonlight with remarkable clarity, he noticed long stretches of white garden walls ahead of him, topped by an impressive abundance of tropical plants.

In these gardens, and set close to the street, stood several pretentious villas and mansions, the slatted blinds and curtains of the windows of which were raised to admit of the freer entrance of the cool and balmy air of the night. From within there issued forth bright lights, together with the exhilarating sound of merry voices laughing and talking, or perhaps a song accompanied by the tinkling music of a spinet or of a guitar. An occasional group of figures, clad in light and summerlike garments, and adorned with gay and startling colors, passed him through the moonlight; so that what with the brightness and warmth of the night, together with all these unusual sights and sounds, it appeared to Jonathan Rugg that he was rather the inhabitant of some extraordinary land of enchantment and unreality than a dweller upon that sober and solid world in which he had heretofore passed his entire existence.

In these gardens, close to the street, stood several flashy villas and mansions, their slatted blinds and curtains pulled up to let in the cool, refreshing night air. Bright lights shone from inside, along with the cheerful sounds of laughter and conversation, or maybe a song accompanied by the sparkling notes of a spinet or guitar. Occasionally, groups of people dressed in light, summery clothes with vibrant, bold colors strolled by in the moonlight. With the brightness and warmth of the night, along with all these unusual sights and sounds, Jonathan Rugg felt more like he was in some magical place than in the ordinary world where he had spent his whole life.

Before continuing this narrative the reader may here be informed that our hero had come into this enchanted world as the[215] supercargo of the ship Susanna Hayes, of Philadelphia; that he had for several years proved himself so honest and industrious a servant to the merchant house of the worthy Jeremiah Doolittle that that benevolent man had given to his well-deserving clerk this opportunity at once of gratifying an inclination for foreign travel and of filling a position of trust that should redound to his individual profit. The Susanna Hayes had entered Kingston harbor that afternoon, and this was Jonathan's first night spent in those tropical latitudes, whither his fancy and his imagination had so often carried him while he stood over the desk filing the accounts of invoices from foreign parts.

Before continuing this story, the reader should know that our hero had arrived in this enchanted world as the[215] supercargo of the ship Susanna Hayes from Philadelphia. For several years, he had proven himself to be an honest and hard-working employee for the merchant house of the esteemed Jeremiah Doolittle, who had generously given his deserving clerk this chance to fulfill his desire for foreign travel while also taking on a position of trust that would benefit him personally. The Susanna Hayes had entered Kingston harbor that afternoon, and this was Jonathan's first night in those tropical regions, where his dreams and imagination had often taken him while he was busy at the desk organizing invoices from overseas.

It might be finally added that, had he at all conceived how soon and to what a degree his sudden inclination for adventure was to be gratified, his romantic aspirations might have been somewhat dashed at the prospect that lay before him.

It might be worth noting that if he had realized how quickly and to what extent his sudden desire for adventure would be fulfilled, his romantic hopes might have been somewhat crushed by the reality ahead of him.

II

The Mysterious Lady with the Silver Veil

At that moment our hero suddenly became conscious of the fact that a small wicket in a wooden gate near which he stood had been opened, and that the eyes of an otherwise concealed countenance were observing him with the utmost closeness of scrutiny.

At that moment, our hero suddenly realized that a small gate in the wooden fence nearby had been opened, and that the eyes of a hidden face were watching him with intense scrutiny.

He had hardly time to become aware of this observation of his person when the gate itself was opened, and there appeared before him, in the moonlight, the bent and crooked figure of an aged negress. She was clad in a calamanco raiment, and was further adorned with a variety of gaudily colored trimmings, vastly suggestive of the tropical world of which she was an inhabitant. Her woolly head was enveloped, after the fashion of her people, in the folds of a gigantic and flaming red turban constructed of an entire pocket handkerchief. Her face was pock-pitted to an incredible degree, so that what with this deformity, emphasized by[216] the pouting of her prodigious and shapeless lips, and the rolling of a pair of eyes as yellow as saffron, Jonathan Rugg thought that he had never beheld a figure at once so extraordinary and so repulsive.

He barely had time to notice this observation of his appearance when the gate swung open, revealing, in the moonlight, the hunched and twisted figure of an elderly Black woman. She was dressed in a colorful fabric and sported a variety of brightly colored decorations that strongly hinted at the tropical region she hailed from. Her curly hair was wrapped, in the style of her culture, in the folds of a large, bright red turban made from an entire handkerchief. Her face was covered in deep pockmarks, and combined with her exaggerated, shapeless lips and the rolling of her eyes, which were as yellow as saffron, Jonathan Rugg thought he had never seen a figure so both remarkable and unsettling.

It occurred to our hero that here, maybe, was to overtake him such an adventure as that which he had just a moment before been desiring so ardently. Nor was he mistaken; for the negress, first looking this way and then that, with an extremely wary and cunning expression, and apparently having satisfied herself that the street, for the moment, was pretty empty of passers, beckoned to him to draw nearer. When he had approached close enough to her she caught him by the sleeve, and, instantly drawing him into the garden beyond, shut and bolted the gate with a quickness and a silence suggestive of the most extravagant secrecy.

It occurred to our hero that maybe he was about to experience the kind of adventure he had just been longing for. And he wasn’t wrong; the woman, first glancing around cautiously with a clever look, seemed to ensure that the street was mostly empty of people before signaling for him to come closer. When he got near enough, she grabbed his sleeve and quickly pulled him into the garden, shutting and locking the gate with a speed and silence that hinted at the utmost secrecy.

At the same moment a huge negro suddenly appeared from the shadow of the gatepost, and so placed himself between Jonathan and the gate that any attempt to escape would inevitably have entailed a conflict, upon our hero's part, with the sable and giant guardian.

At that moment, a huge Black man suddenly stepped out from the shadow of the gatepost and positioned himself between Jonathan and the gate, making any attempt to escape result in a confrontation with the large, dark-skinned guardian.

Says the negress, looking very intently at our hero, "Be you afeared, Buckra?"

Says the woman, looking very intently at our hero, "Are you afraid, Buckra?"

"Why, no," quoth Jonathan; "for to tell thee the truth, friend, though I am a man of peace, being of that religious order known as the Society of Friends, I am not so weak in person nor so timid in disposition as to warrant me in being afraid of anyone. Indeed, were I of a mind to escape, I might, without boasting, declare my belief that I should be able to push my way past even a better man than thy large friend who stands so threateningly in front of yonder gate."

"Not at all," Jonathan said. "To be honest, my friend, even though I’m a peaceful person and part of the Society of Friends, I’m not so weak or timid that I would be afraid of anyone. In fact, if I wanted to escape, I believe I could confidently say that I could get past someone even stronger than your big friend standing there menacingly in front of that gate."

At these words the negress broke into so prodigious a grin that, in the moonlight, it appeared as though the whole lower part of her face had been transformed into shining teeth. "You be a brave Buckra," said she, in her gibbering English. "You come wid[217] Melina, and Melina take you to pretty lady, who want you to eat supper wid her."

At these words, the Black woman smiled so widely that, in the moonlight, it looked like the entire lower half of her face had turned into bright teeth. "You’re a brave white man," she said in her broken English. "You come with[217] Melina, and Melina will take you to a pretty lady who wants you to have dinner with her."

Thereupon, and allowing our hero no opportunity to decline this extraordinary invitation, even had he been of a mind to do so, she took him by the hand and led him toward the large and imposing house which commanded the garden. "Indeed," says Jonathan to himself, as he followed his sable guide—himself followed in turn by the gigantic negro—"indeed, I am like to have my fill of adventure, if anything is to be judged from such a beginning as this."

Thereupon, without giving our hero a chance to decline this incredible invitation, even if he wanted to, she took his hand and led him toward the large, impressive house overlooking the garden. "Wow," Jonathan thought to himself as he followed his dark-skinned guide—who was also followed by the huge man—"it looks like I'm in for quite an adventure if this is how it all begins."

Nor did the interior sumptuousness of the mansion at all belie the imposing character of its exterior, for, entering by way of an illuminated veranda, and so coming into a brilliantly lighted hallway beyond, Jonathan beheld himself to be surrounded by such a wealth of exquisite and well-appointed tastefulness as it had never before been his good fortune to behold.

The luxurious interior of the mansion matched its impressive exterior perfectly. As Jonathan stepped through the beautifully lit porch and entered the brightly lit hallway, he found himself surrounded by an incredible level of exquisite and stylish decor that he had never seen before.

Candles of clarified wax sparkled like stars in chandeliers of crystal. These in turn, catching the illumination, glittered in prismatic fragments with all the varied colors of the rainbow, so that a mellow yet brilliant radiance filled the entire apartment. Polished mirrors of a spotless clearness, framed in golden frames and built into the walls, reflected the waxed floors, the rich Oriental carpets, and the sumptuous paintings that hung against the ivory-tinted paneling, so that in appearance the beauties of the apartment were continued in bewildering vistas upon every side toward which the beholder directed his gaze.

Candles made of clear wax sparkled like stars in crystal chandeliers. These, in turn, caught the light and shimmered in prismatic pieces with all the colors of the rainbow, filling the whole apartment with a warm yet bright glow. Polished mirrors with spotless clarity, framed in gold and set into the walls, reflected the shiny floors, the luxurious Oriental rugs, and the gorgeous paintings that hung against the ivory-colored panels, creating the illusion that the apartment's beauty extended in mesmerizing views in every direction that one looked.

Bidding our hero to be seated, which he did with no small degree of embarrassment and constraint, and upon the extreme edge of the gilt and satin-covered chair, the negress who had been his conductor left him for the time being to his own contemplation.

Bidding our hero to take a seat, which he did with a fair amount of embarrassment and discomfort, perched on the very edge of the gold and satin-covered chair, the Black woman who had guided him left him for the moment to his own thoughts.

Almost before he had an opportunity to compose himself into anything more than a part of his ordinary sedateness of demeanor, the silken curtains at the doorway at the other end of the apartment were suddenly divided, and Jonathan beheld before him a female[218] figure displaying the most exquisite contour of mold and of proportion. She was clad entirely in white, and was enveloped from head to foot in the folds of a veil of delicate silver gauze, which, though hiding her countenance from recognition, nevertheless permitted sufficient of her beauties to be discerned to suggest the extreme elegance and loveliness of her lineaments. Advancing toward our hero, and extending to him a tapering hand as white as alabaster, the fingers encircled with a multitude of jeweled rings, she addressed him thus:

Almost before he could gather himself into anything more than his usual calm demeanor, the silk curtains at the doorway on the other side of the room suddenly parted, and Jonathan saw a woman before him with the most exquisite shape and proportions. She was dressed completely in white and wrapped from head to toe in delicate silver gauze, which, while concealing her face from view, still revealed enough of her beauty to hint at the extreme elegance and loveliness of her features. As she approached our hero, extending a slender hand as white as alabaster, adorned with numerous jeweled rings, she spoke to him:

"Sir," she said, speaking in accents of the most silvery and musical cadence, "you are no doubt vastly surprised to find yourself thus unexpectedly, and almost as by violence, introduced into the house of one who is such an entire stranger to you as myself. But though I am unknown to you, I must inform you that I am better acquainted with my visitor, for my agents have been observing you ever since you landed this afternoon at the dock, and they have followed you ever since, until a little while ago, when you stopped immediately opposite my garden gate. These agents have observed you with a closeness of scrutiny of which you are doubtless entirely unaware. They have even informed me that, owing doubtless to your extreme interest in your new surroundings, you have not as yet supped. Knowing this, and that you must now be enjoying a very hearty appetite, I have to ask you if you will do me the extreme favor of sitting at table with me at a repast which you will doubtless be surprised to learn has been hastily prepared entirely in your honor."

"Sir," she said, her voice soft and melodic, "you must be quite surprised to find yourself unexpectedly brought into the home of someone as unfamiliar as I am. But even though you don’t know me, I should let you know that I’m well aware of who you are, as my agents have been watching you since you arrived at the dock this afternoon. They’ve followed you ever since, right up to the moment when you stopped directly in front of my garden gate. These agents have observed you closely, likely without you even realizing it. They’ve informed me that, probably due to your keen interest in your new surroundings, you haven’t had dinner yet. Knowing this and that you must be quite hungry, I would like to ask if you would do me the great honor of joining me for a meal that I’ve had hurriedly prepared just for you."

So saying, and giving Jonathan no time for reply, she offered him her hand, and with the most polite insistence conducted him into an exquisitely appointed dining room adjoining.

So saying, and not giving Jonathan a chance to respond, she held out her hand and, with the utmost politeness, led him into an elegantly decorated dining room next door.

Here stood a table covered with a snow-white cloth, and embellished with silver and crystal ornaments of every description. Having seated herself and having indicated to Jonathan to take the chair opposite to her, the two were presently served with a[219] repast such as our hero had not thought could have existed out of the pages of certain extraordinary Oriental tales which one time had fallen to his lot to read.

Here was a table covered with a bright white cloth, adorned with silver and crystal decorations of all kinds. After she took her seat and signaled for Jonathan to sit across from her, they were soon served a[219] meal that our hero never imagined could exist outside of some extraordinary Oriental stories he had once read.

This supper (which in itself might successfully have tempted the taste of a Sybarite) was further enhanced by several wines and cordials which, filling the room with the aroma of the sunlit grapes from which they had been expressed, stimulated the appetite, which without them needed no such spur. The lady, who ate but sparingly herself, possessed herself with patience until Jonathan's hunger had been appeased. When, however, she beheld that he weakened in his attacks upon the dessert of sweets with which the banquet was concluded, she addressed him upon the business which was evidently entirely occupying her mind.

This dinner (which could have easily tempted even the most extravagant person) was made even better by several wines and liqueurs that filled the room with the scent of sun-ripened grapes. They whetted the appetite, which didn’t really need any encouragement. The lady, who ate only a little herself, remained patient until Jonathan was satisfied. However, when she noticed that he was losing steam in his efforts to tackle the sweets that rounded off the feast, she brought up the topic that was clearly on her mind.

"Sir," said she, "you are doubtless aware that everyone, whether man or woman, is possessed of an enemy. In my own case I must inform you that I have no less than three who, to compass their ends, would gladly sacrifice my life itself to their purposes. At no time am I safe from their machinations, nor have I anyone," cried she, exhibiting a great emotion, "to whom I may turn in my need. It was this that led me to hope to find in you a friend in my perils, for, having observed through my agents that you are not only honest in disposition and strong in person, but that you are possessed of a considerable degree of energy and determination, I am most desirous of imposing upon your good nature a trust of which you cannot for a moment suspect the magnitude. Tell me, are you willing to assist a poor, defenseless female in her hour of trial?"

"Sir," she said, "you surely know that everyone, man or woman, has an enemy. In my case, I must tell you that I have no less than three who would gladly sacrifice my life to achieve their goals. I am never safe from their schemes, nor do I have anyone," she exclaimed with great emotion, "to whom I can turn in my time of need. It was this that made me hope to find a friend in you during my troubles, for, having learned through my agents that you are not only honest and strong but also possess a good deal of energy and determination, I really want to place a trust in you that you cannot begin to imagine the scale of. Tell me, are you willing to help a vulnerable woman in her moment of crisis?"

"Indeed, friend," quoth Jonathan, with more vivacity than he usually exhibited, with a lenity to which he had heretofore in his lifetime been a stranger—being warmed into such a spirit, doubtless, by the generous wines of which he had partaken—"indeed, friend, if I could but see thy face it would doubtless make my decision in such a matter the more favorable, since I am inclined to think,[220] from the little I can behold of it, that thy appearance must be extremely comely to the eye."

"You're right, my friend," Jonathan said, with more energy than usual and a friendliness he had seldom shown before—likely warmed up by the nice wines he had enjoyed—"You're right, my friend, if I could just see your face, it would surely make my decision easier, since I suspect, from what little I can see of it, that your appearance must be really pleasant to look at."

"Sir," said the lady, exhibiting some amusement at this unexpected sally, "I am, you must know, as God made me. Sometime, perhaps, I may be very glad to satisfy your curiosity, and exhibit to you my poor countenance such as it is. But now"—and here she reverted to her more serious mood—"I must again put it to you: are you willing to help an unprotected woman in a period of very great danger to herself? Should you decline the assistance which I solicit, my slaves shall conduct you to the gate through which you entered, and suffer you to depart in peace. Should you, upon the other hand, accept the trust, you are to receive no reward therefor, except the gratitude of one who thus appeals to you in her helplessness."

"Sir," the lady said, clearly amused by this unexpected comment, "I am, just so you know, as I was made. Maybe, at some point, I'll be happy to satisfy your curiosity and show you my plain face as it is. But right now"—her tone turned serious—"I must ask you again: are you willing to help an unprotected woman who is in great danger? If you refuse the help I'm asking for, my servants will take you to the gate you came through and let you leave peacefully. But if you choose to accept this responsibility, the only reward you'll receive is the gratitude of someone who is reaching out to you in her vulnerability."

For a few moments Jonathan fell silent, for here, indeed, was he entering into an adventure which infinitely surpassed any anticipation that he could have formed. He was, besides, of a cautious nature, and was entirely disinclined to embark in any affair so obscure and tangled as that in which he now found himself becoming involved.

For a few moments, Jonathan was quiet, because he was truly stepping into an adventure that far exceeded anything he had expected. He was also a careful person and was not at all eager to get involved in anything as unclear and complicated as what he was now facing.

"Friend," said he, at last, "I may tell thee that thy story has so far moved me as to give me every inclination to help thee in thy difficulties, but I must also inform thee that I am a man of caution, having never before entered into any business of this sort. Therefore, before giving any promise that may bind my future actions, I must, in common wisdom, demand to know what are the conditions that thou hast in mind to impose upon me."

"Friend," he said at last, "I should let you know that your story has really touched me and made me want to help you with your troubles. However, I also need to tell you that I’m someone who is careful and has never been involved in anything like this before. So before I make any promises that might tie me down in the future, I have to, out of common sense, ask what conditions you have in mind for me."

"Indeed, sir," cried the lady, with great vivacity and with more cheerful accents—as though her mind had been relieved of a burden of fear that her companion might at once have declined even a consideration of her request—"indeed, sir, you will find that the trust which I would impose upon you is in appearance no such great matter as my words may have led you to suppose.[221]

"Of course, sir," the lady said eagerly, her tone more cheerful—as if she had just been freed from the worry that her companion might refuse to even consider her request—"of course, sir, you'll see that the trust I want to place in you isn't as significant as my words might suggest.[221]

"You must know that I am possessed of a little trinket which, in the hands of anyone who, like yourself, is a stranger in these parts, would possess no significance, but which while in my keeping is fraught with infinite menace to me."

"You should know that I have a little trinket that, in the hands of someone like you who is a stranger here, wouldn’t mean much. However, while it’s in my possession, it carries a lot of danger for me."

Hereupon, and having so spoken, she clapped her hands, and an attendant immediately entered, disclosing the person of the same negress who had first introduced Jonathan into the strange adventure in which he now found himself involved. This creature, who appeared still more deformed and repulsive in the brilliantly lighted room than she had in the moonlight, carried in her hands a white napkin, which she handed to her mistress. This being opened, disclosed a small ivory ball of about the bigness of a lime. Nodding to the negress to withdraw, the lady handed him the ivory ball, and Jonathan took it with no small degree of curiosity and examined it carefully. It appeared to be of an exceeding antiquity, and of so deep a yellow as to be almost brown in color. It was covered over with strange figures and characters of an Oriental sort, which appeared to our hero to be of Chinese workmanship.

She clapped her hands, and an attendant immediately entered, revealing the same negress who had first introduced Jonathan to the strange adventure he was now caught up in. This woman looked even more deformed and repulsive in the brightly lit room than she had in the moonlight. She carried a white napkin, which she handed to her mistress. When opened, it revealed a small ivory ball about the size of a lime. Nodding for the negress to leave, the lady handed Jonathan the ivory ball, which he took with curiosity and examined closely. It seemed very old and had a deep yellow color that was almost brown. It was covered with strange figures and characters of an Oriental style, which Jonathan thought looked like Chinese craftsmanship.

"I must tell you, sir," said the lady, after she had permitted her guest to examine this for a while in silence, "that though this appears to you to be of little worth, it is yet of extreme value. After all, however, it is nothing but a curiosity that anyone who is interested in such matters might possess. What I have to ask you is this: will you be willing to take this into your charge, to guard it with the utmost care and fidelity—yes, even as the apple of your eye—during your continuance in these parts, and to return it to me in safety the day before your departure? By so doing you will render me a service which you may neither understand nor comprehend, but which shall make me your debtor for my entire life."

"I need to tell you, sir," the lady said after letting her guest silently study it for a while, "that even though this may seem insignificant to you, it holds great value. Ultimately, it's just a curiosity that anyone interested in such things might have. What I want to ask is this: will you take responsibility for it, guarding it with the utmost care—yes, even as if it were the apple of your eye—while you're here, and return it to me safely the day before you leave? By doing so, you'll be doing me a service that you might not fully grasp, but it will make me your lifelong debtor."

By this time Jonathan had pretty well composed his mind for a reply.

By this time, Jonathan had mostly decided on how to respond.

"Friend," said he, "such a matter as this is entirely out of my knowledge of business, which is, indeed, that of a clerk in the[222] mercantile profession. Nevertheless, I have every inclination to help thee, though I trust thou mayest have magnified the dangers that beset thee. This appears to me to be a little trifle for such an ado; nevertheless, I will do as thou dost request. I will keep it in safety and will return it to thee upon this day a week hence, by which time I hope to have discharged my cargo and be ready to continue my voyage to Demerara."

"Friend," he said, "this kind of thing is totally beyond my business expertise, which is really just that of a clerk in the[222] merchant industry. Still, I really want to help you, though I hope you haven't made the situation seem worse than it is. This seems like a minor issue for all the fuss; however, I’ll do what you ask. I’ll keep it safe and return it to you a week from today, by which time I hope to have finished unloading my cargo and be ready to set off for Demerara."

At these words the lady, who had been watching him all the time with a most unaccountable eagerness, burst forth into words of such heartfelt gratitude as to entirely overwhelm our hero. When her transports had been somewhat assuaged she permitted him to depart, and the negress conducted him back through the garden, whence she presently showed him through the gate whither he had entered and out into the street.

At these words, the lady, who had been watching him all along with a strange eagerness, expressed such heartfelt gratitude that it completely overwhelmed our hero. Once her excitement calmed down a bit, she let him leave, and the Black woman guided him back through the garden, where she soon showed him the gate he had entered and led him out into the street.

III

The Terrific Encounter with the One-Eyed Little Gentleman in Black

Finding himself once more in the open street, Jonathan Rugg stood for a while in the moonlight, endeavoring to compose his mind into somewhat of that sobriety that was habitual with him; for, indeed, he was not a little excited by the unexpected incidents that had just befallen him. From this effort at composure he was aroused by observing that a little gentleman clad all in black had stopped at a little distance away and was looking very intently at him. In the brightness of the moonlight our hero could see that the little gentleman possessed but a single eye, and that he carried a gold-headed cane in his hand. He had hardly time to observe these particulars, when the other approached him with every appearance of politeness and cordiality.

Finding himself back on the open street, Jonathan Rugg paused for a moment in the moonlight, trying to gather his thoughts and regain the calm he usually had; after all, he was quite shaken by the unexpected events that had just happened. His attempt to steady himself was interrupted when he noticed a little man dressed completely in black standing a short distance away, looking intently at him. In the bright moonlight, our hero could see that this little man had only one eye and was holding a gold-headed cane. He barely had time to take in these details when the man approached him, exuding politeness and warmth.

"Sir," said he, "surely I am not mistaken in recognizing in you the supercargo of the ship Susanna Hayes, which arrived this afternoon at this port?"[223]

"Sir," he said, "I must be right in recognizing you as the supercargo of the ship Susanna Hayes, which arrived this afternoon at this port?"[223]

"Indeed," said Jonathan, "thou art right, friend. That is my occupation, and that is whence I came."

"You're right, my friend," said Jonathan. "That's my job, and that's where I came from."

"To be sure!" said the little gentleman. "To be sure! To be sure! The Susanna Hayes, with a cargo of Indian-corn meal, and from my dear good friend Jeremiah Doolittle, of Philadelphia. I know your good master very well—very well indeed. And have you never heard him speak of his friend Mr. Abner Greenway, of Kingston, Jamaica?"

"Of course!" said the little man. "Of course! Of course! The Susanna Hayes, carrying a load of cornmeal, and sent by my dear good friend Jeremiah Doolittle from Philadelphia. I know your master quite well—very well, in fact. And have you never heard him mention his friend Mr. Abner Greenway from Kingston, Jamaica?"

"Why, no," replied Jonathan, "I have no such recollection of the name—nor do I know that any such name hath ever appeared upon our books."

"Why, no," Jonathan replied, "I don't recall that name at all—nor do I believe it has ever shown up in our records."

"To be sure! To be sure!" repeated the little gentleman, briskly, and with exceeding good nature. "Indeed, my name is not likely to have ever appeared upon your employer's books, for I am not a business correspondent, but one who, in times past, was his extremely intimate friend. There is much I would like to ask about him, and, indeed, I was in hopes that you would have been the bearer of a letter from him. But I have lodgings at a little distance from here, so that if it is not requesting too much of you maybe you will accompany me thither, so that we may talk at our leisure. I would gladly accompany you to your ship instead of urging you to come to my apartments, but I must tell you I am possessed of a devil of a fever, so that my physician hath forbidden me to be out of nights."

"Absolutely! Absolutely!" the little gentleman said cheerfully and with great kindness. "In fact, my name probably hasn’t shown up in your employer's records since I’m not a business associate, but rather someone who was once a very close friend of his. There’s a lot I’d like to ask about him, and I was actually hoping you might be carrying a letter from him. However, I have a place not too far from here, so if it’s not too much trouble, would you mind coming with me there so we can chat more comfortably? I would happily go with you to your ship instead of asking you to come to my place, but I should mention that I'm dealing with a nasty fever, so my doctor has advised me not to be out at night."

"Indeed," said Jonathan, who, you may have observed, was of a very easy disposition—"indeed, I shall be very glad to accompany thee to thy lodgings. There is nothing I would like better than to serve any friend of good Jeremiah Doolittle's."

"Definitely," said Jonathan, who you may have noticed was quite easygoing—"definitely, I'd be really happy to join you to your place. There's nothing I'd like more than to help out any friend of good Jeremiah Doolittle's."

And thereupon, and with great amity, the two walked off together, the little one-eyed gentleman in black linking his arm confidingly into that of Jonathan's, and tapping the pavement continually with his cane as he trotted on at a great pace. He was very well acquainted with the town (of which he was a citizen),[224] and so interesting was his discourse that they had gone a considerable distance before Jonathan observed they were entering into a quarter darker and less frequented than that which they had quitted. Tall brick houses stood upon either side, between which stretched a narrow, crooked roadway, with a kennel running down the center.

And with a friendly vibe, the two walked off together, the little one-eyed man in black linking his arm trustingly with Jonathan's and tapping the sidewalk continuously with his cane as he quickly trotted along. He knew the town well (since he was a resident),[224] and his conversation was so engaging that they had traveled quite a distance before Jonathan noticed they were entering a darker, less crowded area than the one they had just left. Tall brick buildings lined both sides, with a narrow, winding road in the middle, featuring a gutter running down the center.

How the Buccaneers Kept Christmas How the Buccaneers Celebrated Christmas

Originally published in
Harper's Weekly, December 16, 1899

In front of one of these houses—a tall and gloomy structure—our hero's conductor stopped and, opening the door with a key, beckoned for him to enter. Jonathan having complied, his new-found friend led the way up a flight of steps, against which Jonathan's feet beat noisily in the darkness, and at length, having ascended two stairways and having reached a landing, he opened a door at the end of the passage and ushered Jonathan into an apartment, unlighted, except for the moonshine, which, coming in through a partly open shutter, lay in a brilliant patch of light upon the floor.

In front of one of these houses—a tall and gloomy structure—our hero's guide stopped and, using a key to unlock the door, signaled for him to come inside. Once Jonathan stepped in, his new friend led the way up a set of stairs, making loud noises as Jonathan's feet hit the steps in the darkness. After going up two flights and reaching a landing, he opened a door at the end of the hallway and brought Jonathan into an unlit room, except for the moonlight streaming in through a slightly open shutter, casting a bright patch of light on the floor.

His conductor having struck a light with a flint and steel, our hero by the illumination of a single candle presently discovered himself to be in a bedchamber furnished with no small degree of comfort, and even elegance, and having every appearance of a bachelor's chamber.

His conductor lit a flame with flint and steel, and with the light of a single candle, our hero quickly realized he was in a bedroom that was quite comfortable and even elegant, looking very much like a bachelor’s space.

"You will pardon me," said his new acquaintance, "if I shut these shutters and the window, for that devilish fever of which I spoke is of such a sort that I must keep the night air even out from my room, or else I shall be shaking the bones out of my joints and chattering the teeth out of my head by to-morrow morning."

"You'll forgive me," said his new acquaintance, "if I close these shutters and the window, because that nasty fever I mentioned is such that I have to keep the night air out of my room, or else by tomorrow morning, I'll be shaking so much my bones will feel like they're falling apart and my teeth will be chattering uncontrollably."

So saying he was as good as his word, and not only drew the shutters to, but shot the heavy iron bolt into its place. Having accomplished this he bade our hero to be seated, and placing before him some exceedingly superior rum, together with some equally excellent tobacco, they presently fell into the friendliest discourse imaginable. In the course of their talk, which after a while became exceedingly confidential, Jonathan confided to his new friend the [225]circumstances of the adventure into which he had been led by the beautiful stranger, and to all that he said concerning his adventure his interlocutor listened with the closest and most scrupulously riveted attention.

So saying, he kept his promise and not only closed the shutters but also secured the heavy iron bolt in place. Once he had done this, he invited our hero to sit down and offered him some really good rum, along with some equally great tobacco. They soon got into the friendliest conversation imaginable. During their chat, which eventually became quite personal, Jonathan shared with his new friend the details of the adventure he had experienced with the beautiful stranger, and his companion listened with intense and focused attention to everything he said about his experience.

"Upon my word," said he, when Jonathan had concluded, "I hope that you may not have been made the victim of some foolish hoax. Let me see what it is she has confided to you."

"Honestly," he said when Jonathan finished, "I hope you haven't fallen for some silly prank. Let me see what she has shared with you."

"That I will," replied Jonathan. And thereupon he thrust his hand into his breeches' pocket and brought forth the ivory ball.

"Sure will," replied Jonathan. He then reached into his pants pocket and pulled out the ivory ball.

No sooner did the one eye of the little gentleman in black light upon the object than a most singular and extraordinary convulsion appeared to seize upon him. Had a bullet penetrated his heart he could not have started more violently, nor have sat more rigidly and breathlessly staring.

No sooner did the one eye of the little gentleman in black land on the object than a really strange and intense shock seemed to take hold of him. If a bullet had hit his heart, he couldn't have jumped more violently, nor sat more stiffly and breathlessly staring.

Mastering his emotion with the utmost difficulty as Jonathan replaced the ball in his pocket, he drew a deep and profound breath and wiped the palm of his hand across his forehead as though arousing himself from a dream.

Struggling to control his emotions as Jonathan put the ball back in his pocket, he took a deep breath and wiped his hand across his forehead, as if waking up from a dream.

"And you," he said, of a sudden, "are, I understand it, a Quaker. Do you, then, never carry a weapon, even in such a place as this, where at any moment in the dark a Spanish knife may be stuck betwixt your ribs?"

"And you," he said suddenly, "are, as I understand it, a Quaker. So, you never carry a weapon, even in a place like this, where at any moment in the dark a Spanish knife could be stuck between your ribs?"

"Why, no," said Jonathan, somewhat surprised that so foreign a topic should have been so suddenly introduced into the discourse. "I am a man of peace and not of blood. The people of the Society of Friends never carry weapons, either of offense or defense."

"Why, no," Jonathan said, a bit surprised that such a foreign topic had been brought up so suddenly. "I’m a peaceful person, not one for violence. The members of the Society of Friends never carry weapons, whether for offense or defense."

As Jonathan concluded his reply the little gentleman suddenly arose from his chair and moved briskly around to the other side of the room. Our hero, watching him with some surprise, beheld him clap to the door and with a single movement shoot the bolt and turn the key therein. The next instant he turned to Jonathan a visage transformed as suddenly as though he had dropped a mask from his face. The gossiping and polite little old bachelor[226] was there no longer, but in his stead a man with a countenance convulsed with some furious and nameless passion.

As Jonathan finished his reply, the little gentleman suddenly got up from his chair and quickly walked over to the other side of the room. Our hero, watching him with surprise, saw him close the door and, in one swift motion, shoot the bolt and turn the key. In an instant, he turned to Jonathan with a face transformed as if he had just dropped a mask. The gossipy and polite little old bachelor[226] was gone, replaced by a man with a face twisted by some intense and unknown anger.

"That ball!" he cried, in a hoarse and raucous voice. "That ivory ball! Give it to me upon the instant!"

"That ball!" he shouted, in a rough and raspy voice. "That ivory ball! Hand it over to me right now!"

As he spoke he whipped out from his bosom a long, keen Spanish knife that in its every appearance spoke without equivocation of the most murderous possibilities.

As he talked, he pulled out a long, sharp Spanish knife from his chest that clearly hinted at the most deadly possibilities.

The malignant passions that distorted every lineament of the countenance of the little old gentleman in black filled our hero with such astonishment that he knew not whether he were asleep or awake; but when he beheld the other advancing with the naked and shining knife in his hand his reason returned to him like a flash. Leaping to his feet, he lost no time in putting the table between himself and his sudden enemy.

The malicious emotions that twisted every feature of the little old man in black shocked our hero so much that he couldn't tell if he was dreaming or awake; but when he saw the other man coming toward him with a bare, gleaming knife in his hand, his clarity came back in an instant. Jumping to his feet, he quickly placed the table between himself and his unexpected foe.

"Indeed, friend," he cried, in a voice penetrated with terror—"indeed, friend, thou hadst best keep thy distance from me, for though I am a man of peace and a shunner of bloodshed, I promise thee that I will not stand still to be murdered without outcry or without endeavoring to defend my life!"

"Definitely, friend," he shouted, his voice filled with fear—"definitely, friend, you should keep your distance from me, because even though I'm a peaceful person and avoid violence, I assure you that I won't just stand by and be killed without making noise or trying to defend my life!"

"Cry as loud as you please!" exclaimed the other. "No one is near this place to hear you! Cry until you are hoarse; no one in this neighborhood will stop to ask what is the matter with you. I tell you I am determined to possess myself of that ivory ball, and have it I shall, even though I am obliged to cut out your heart to get it!" As he spoke he grinned with so extraordinary and devilish a distortion of his countenance, and with such an appearance of every intention of carrying out his threat as to send the goose flesh creeping like icy fingers up and down our hero's spine with the most incredible rapidity and acuteness.

“Cry as loud as you want!” the other shouted. “No one is close by to hear you! Cry until your voice is gone; nobody in this neighborhood will bother to find out what’s wrong with you. I’m telling you, I’m determined to get that ivory ball, and I will get it, even if it means cutting out your heart to do so!” As he spoke, he grinned with such a twisted and sinister expression and showed every sign that he intended to follow through on his threat, making our hero feel a chill run up and down his spine like icy fingers, quicker and sharper than he could imagine.

Nevertheless, mastering his fears, Jonathan contrived to speak up with a pretty good appearance of spirit. "Indeed, friend," he said, "thou appearest to forget that I am a man of twice thy bulk and half thy years, and that though thou hast a knife I am[227] determined to defend myself to the last extremity. I am not going to give thee that which thou demandest of me, and for thy sake I advise thee to open the door and let me go free as I entered, or else harm may befall thee."

Nevertheless, overcoming his fears, Jonathan managed to speak up with a pretty good show of confidence. "Listen, friend," he said, "you seem to forget that I’m a man of twice your size and half your age, and that even though you have a knife, I am[227] determined to defend myself to the end. I’m not going to give you what you’re asking for, and for your own sake, I suggest you open the door and let me go free like I came in, or else you might get hurt."

"Fool!" cried the other, hardly giving him time to end. "Do you, then, think that I have time to chatter with you while two villains are lying in wait for me, perhaps at the very door? Blame your own self for your death!" And, gnashing his teeth with an indescribable menace, and resting his hand upon the table, he vaulted with incredible agility clean across it and upon our hero, who, entirely unprepared for such an extraordinary attack, was flung back against the wall, with an arm as strong as steel clutching his throat and a knife flashing in his very eyes with dreadful portent of instant death.

"Fool!" the other shouted, hardly letting him finish. "Do you really think I have time to chat with you while two villains are lurking around, maybe even right at the door? It's your own fault you’re about to die!" With a fierce grit of his teeth and a threat that was impossible to ignore, he slammed his hand on the table and leaped across it with astonishing speed. Our hero, completely unready for such a sudden attack, was thrown back against the wall, with a grip like steel around his throat and a knife glinting ominously in his eyes, signaling imminent death.

With an instinct to preserve his life, he caught his assailant by the wrist, and, bending it away from himself, set every fiber of his body in a superhuman effort to guard and protect himself. The other, though so much older and smaller, seemed to be composed entirely of fibers of steel, and, in his murderous endeavors, put forth a strength so extraordinary that for a moment our hero felt his heart melt within him with terror for his life. The spittle appeared to dry up within his mouth, and his hair to creep and rise upon his head. With a vehement cry of despair and anguish, he put forth one stupendous effort for defense, and, clapping his heel behind the other's leg, and throwing his whole weight forward, he fairly tripped his antagonist backward as he stood. Together they fell upon the floor, locked in the most desperate embrace, and overturning a chair with a prodigious clatter in their descent—our hero upon the top and the little gentleman in black beneath him.

With an instinct to save his life, he grabbed his attacker by the wrist and, bending it away from himself, focused every part of his body in a tremendous effort to defend himself. The other man, though older and smaller, seemed to be made entirely of steel, and in his violent attempts, displayed a strength so incredible that for a moment our hero felt his heart sink with fear for his life. His mouth went dry, and his hair seemed to stand on end. With a desperate shout of anguish, he made one massive effort to fight back, and by placing his heel behind the other man's leg and throwing his entire weight forward, he managed to trip his opponent backward as he stood. They both fell to the floor, locked in a fierce embrace, knocking over a chair with a loud crash in their fall—our hero on top and the little man in black beneath him.

As they struck the floor the little man in black emitted a most piercing and terrible scream, and instantly relaxing his efforts of attack, fell to beating the floor with the back of his hands and[228] drubbing with his heels upon the rug in which he had become entangled.

As they hit the floor, the little man in black let out a sharp and terrifying scream. Immediately stopping his attack, he started pounding the floor with the backs of his hands and kicking his heels against the rug he had gotten tangled in.[228]

Our hero leaped to his feet, and with dilating eyes and expanding brain and swimming sight stared down upon the other like one turned to a stone.

Our hero jumped up, his eyes wide, mind racing, and vision blurry as he stared down at the other person like he was turned to stone.

He beheld instantly what had occurred, and that he had, without so intending, killed a fellow man. The knife, turned away from his own person, had in their fall been plunged into the bosom of the other, and he now lay quivering in the last throes of death. As Jonathan gazed he beheld a thin red stream trickle out from the parted and grinning lips; he beheld the eyes turn inward; he beheld the eyelids contract; he beheld the figure stretch itself; he beheld it become still in death.

He immediately realized what had happened, and that he had, without meaning to, killed another man. The knife, aimed away from himself, had instead been driven into the chest of the other during their fall, and now he lay convulsing in his final moments. As Jonathan watched, he saw a thin stream of red trickle from the parted, grinning lips; he watched the eyes roll back; he saw the eyelids close; he watched the body stiffen; he saw it become still in death.

IV

The Momentous Adventure with the Stranger with the Silver Earrings

So our hero stood stunned and bedazed, gazing down upon his victim, like a man turned into a stone. His brain appeared to him to expand like a bubble, the blood surged and hummed in his ears with every gigantic beat of his heart, his vision swam, and his trembling hands were bedewed with a cold and repugnant sweat. The dead figure upon the floor at his feet gazed at him with a wide, glassy stare, and in the confusion of his mind it appeared to Jonathan that he was, indeed, a murderer.

So our hero stood there, stunned and dazed, looking down at his victim, like a man turned to stone. His mind felt like it was expanding like a bubble, the blood rushed and throbbed in his ears with every pounding beat of his heart, his vision blurred, and his shaking hands were covered in a cold and disgusting sweat. The lifeless body on the floor at his feet stared up at him with a wide, glassy look, and in the chaos of his thoughts, it seemed to Jonathan that he really was a murderer.

What monstrous thing was this that had befallen him who, but a moment before, had been so entirely innocent of the guilt of blood? What was he now to do in such an extremity as this, with his victim lying dead at his feet, a poniard in his heart? Who would believe him to be guiltless of crime with such a dreadful evidence as this presented against him? How was he, a stranger in a foreign land, to totally defend himself against an accusation of mistaken justice? At these thoughts a developed terror gripped[229] at his vitals and a sweat as cold as ice bedewed his entire body. No, he must tarry for no explanation or defense! He must immediately fly from this terrible place, or else, should he be discovered, his doom would certainly be sealed!

What monstrous thing had happened to him, who just a moment before had been completely innocent of any guilt? What was he supposed to do now, with his victim lying dead at his feet, a dagger in his heart? Who would believe he was innocent with such horrifying evidence against him? How was he, a stranger in a foreign land, supposed to defend himself against an accusation of wrongful justice? This thought filled him with a deep terror, gripping his insides, and a cold sweat drenched his entire body. No, he couldn't wait for an explanation or a defense! He had to flee from this terrible place immediately, or if he was discovered, his fate would surely be sealed!

At that moment, and in the very extremity of his apprehensions, there fell of a sudden a knock upon the door, sounding so loud and so startling upon the silence of the room that every shattered nerve in our hero's frame tingled and thrilled in answer to it. He stood petrified, scarcely so much as daring to breathe; and then, observing that his mouth was agape, he moistened his dry and parching lips, and drew his jaws together with a snap.

At that moment, right at the peak of his fears, there was a sudden knock on the door, so loud and jarring in the quiet of the room that every shattered nerve in our hero's body tingled in response. He stood frozen, hardly daring to breathe; then, noticing that his mouth was hanging open, he wet his dry, parched lips and snapped his jaw shut.

Again there fell the same loud, insistent knock upon the panel, followed by the imperative words, "Open within!"

Again, there came the same loud, persistent knock on the door, followed by the urgent command, "Open up!"

The wretched Jonathan flung about him a glance at once of terror and of despair, but there was for him no possible escape. He was shut tight in the room with his dead victim, like a rat in a trap. Nothing remained for him but to obey the summons from without. Indeed, in the very extremity of his distraction, he possessed reason enough to perceive that the longer he delayed opening the door the less innocent he might hope to appear in the eyes of whoever stood without.

The miserable Jonathan glanced around in fear and despair, but there was no way out for him. He was trapped in the room with his dead victim, like a rat in a cage. All he could do was answer the call from outside. In fact, in his overwhelming panic, he was still rational enough to realize that the longer he waited to open the door, the less innocent he would seem to whoever was out there.

With the uncertain and spasmodic movements of an ill-constructed automaton, he crossed the room, and stepping very carefully over the prostrate body upon the floor, and with a hesitating reluctance that he could in no degree master, he unlocked, unbolted, and opened the door.

With the shaky and erratic movements of a poorly built robot, he crossed the room, carefully stepping over the body lying on the floor, and with a hesitation he couldn't control, he unlocked, unbolted, and opened the door.

The figure that outlined itself in the light of the candle, against the blackness of the passageway without, was of such a singular and foreign aspect as to fit extremely well into the extraordinary tragedy of which Jonathan was at once the victim and the cause.

The figure that appeared in the candlelight, against the darkness of the hallway outside, looked so unusual and out of place that it suited perfectly the extraordinary tragedy that Jonathan was both a victim and a cause of.

It was that of a lean, tall man with a thin, yellow countenance, embellished with a long, black mustache, and having a pair of forbidding, deeply set, and extremely restless black eyes. A crimson[230] handkerchief beneath a lace cocked hat was tied tightly around the head, and a pair of silver earrings, which caught the light of the candle, gleamed and twinkled against the inky darkness of the passageway beyond.

It was a tall, lean man with a pale yellow face, adorned with a long black mustache, and he had a pair of intense, deep-set black eyes that seemed very restless. A red[230] handkerchief was tied snugly around his head under a lace cocked hat, and a pair of silver earrings sparkled and flickered in the candlelight against the dark passageway beyond.

This extraordinary being, without favoring our hero with any word of apology for his intrusion, immediately thrust himself forward into the room, and stretching his long, lean, birdlike neck so as to direct his gaze over the intervening table, fixed a gaping and concentrated stare upon the figure lying still and motionless in the center of the room.

This unusual person, offering no words of apology to our hero for barging in, quickly stepped into the room. He elongated his thin, birdlike neck to peer over the table and focused an intense, wide-eyed stare at the figure lying still and motionless in the middle of the room.

"Vat you do dare," said he, with a guttural and foreign accent, and thereupon, without waiting for a reply, came forward and knelt down beside the dead man. After thrusting his hand into the silent and shrunken bosom, he presently looked up and fixed his penetrating eyes upon our hero's countenance, who, benumbed and bedazed with his despair, still stood like one enchained in the bonds of a nightmare. "He vas dead!" said the stranger, and Jonathan nodded his head in reply.

"Whatever you do, don’t," he said, with a thick foreign accent, and then, without waiting for a response, stepped forward and knelt beside the dead man. After reaching into the still and lifeless chest, he looked up and locked his intense gaze onto our hero's face, who, numb and dazed by his grief, stood frozen like someone trapped in a nightmare. "He is dead!" said the stranger, and Jonathan nodded in agreement.

"Vy you keel ze man?" inquired his interlocutor.

"Why did you kill the man?" his conversation partner asked.

"Indeed," cried Jonathan, finding a voice at last, but one so hoarse that he could hardly recognize it for his own, "I know not what to make of the affair! But, indeed, I do assure thee, friend, that I am entirely innocent of what thou seest."

"Honestly," Jonathan shouted, finally finding his voice, though it was so rough he could barely recognize it as his own, "I don’t know what to make of this! But really, I promise you, my friend, that I am completely innocent of what you see."

The stranger still kept his piercing gaze fixed upon our hero's countenance, and Jonathan, feeling that something further was demanded of him, continued: "I am, indeed, a victim of a most extravagant and extraordinary adventure. This evening, coming an entire stranger to this country, I was introduced into the house of a beautiful female, who bestowed upon me a charge that appeared to me to be at once insignificant and absurd. Behold this little ivory ball," said he, drawing the globe from his pocket, and displaying it between his thumb and finger. "It is this that appears to have brought all this disaster upon me; for, coming from the[231] house of the young woman, the man whom thou now beholdest lying dead upon the floor induced me to come to this place. Having inveigled me hither, he demanded of me to give him at once this insignificant trifle. Upon my refusing to do so, he assaulted me with every appearance of a mad and furious inclination to deprive me of my life!"

The stranger kept his intense gaze locked on our hero's face, and Jonathan, sensing that more was expected of him, continued: "I am indeed a victim of a truly wild and extraordinary adventure. This evening, as a complete outsider to this country, I was welcomed into the home of a beautiful woman, who gave me a task that seemed both trivial and ridiculous. Look at this little ivory ball," he said, pulling the globe from his pocket and holding it up between his thumb and finger. "It’s this that seems to have brought all this chaos upon me; for, after leaving the house of the young woman, the man you now see lying dead on the floor lured me here. Once I arrived, he demanded that I immediately hand over this trivial object. When I refused, he attacked me with all the fury of a madman, seemingly intent on ending my life!"

At the sight of the ivory ball the stranger quickly arose from his kneeling posture and fixed upon our hero a gaze the most extraordinary that he had ever encountered. His eyes dilated like those of a cat, the breath expelled itself from his bosom in so deep and profound an expiration that it appeared as though it might never return again. Nor was it until Jonathan had replaced the ball in his pocket that he appeared to awaken from the trance that the sight of the object had sent him into. But no sooner had the cause of this strange demeanor disappeared into our hero's breeches' pocket than he arose as with an electric shock. In an instant he became transformed as by the touch of magic. A sudden and baleful light flamed into his eyes, his face grew as red as blood, and he clapped his hand to his pocket with a sudden and violent motion. "Ze ball!" he cried, in a hoarse and strident voice. "Ze ball! Give me ze ball!" And upon the next instant our hero beheld the round and shining nozzle of a pistol pointed directly against his forehead.

At the sight of the ivory ball, the stranger quickly got up from his kneeling position and fixed an extraordinary gaze on our hero—one he had never seen before. His eyes widened like a cat’s, and he let out a breath so deep and profound that it seemed it might never come back. It wasn't until Jonathan put the ball back in his pocket that the stranger seemed to snap out of the trance the object had put him in. But as soon as the cause of his bizarre behavior disappeared into our hero's pocket, he shot up as if zapped by electricity. In an instant, he transformed as if by magic. A sudden, ominous light flared in his eyes, his face turned as red as blood, and he slapped his hand against his pocket with a sudden, violent motion. "The ball!" he shouted, in a harsh and loud voice. "The ball! Give me the ball!" And in the next moment, our hero saw the shiny barrel of a pistol pointed directly at his forehead.

For a moment he stood as though transfixed; then in the mortal peril that faced him, he uttered a roar that sounded in his own ears like the outcry of a wild beast, and thereupon flung himself bodily upon the other with the violence and the fury of a madman.

For a moment, he stood frozen in place; then, faced with the life-threatening danger, he let out a roar that echoed in his ears like a wild animal's cry, and then he launched himself at the other person with the force and rage of a madman.

The stranger drew the trigger, and the powder flashed in the pan. He dropped the weapon, clattering, and in an instant tried to draw another from his other pocket. Before he could direct his aim, however, our hero had caught him by both wrists, and, bending his hand backward, prevented the chance of any shot from taking immediate effect upon his person. Then followed a struggle of extraordinary ferocity and frenzy—the stranger endeavoring to free[232] his hand, and Jonathan striving with all the energy of despair to prevent him from effecting his murderous purpose.

The stranger pulled the trigger, and the gunpowder ignited in the pan. He dropped the weapon with a loud clatter and immediately tried to pull another gun from his other pocket. But before he could aim it, our hero grabbed him by both wrists and forced his hand backward, stopping him from firing at once. What followed was an intense and wild struggle—the stranger trying to break free[232] and Jonathan doing everything he could, fueled by desperation, to stop him from carrying out his deadly intent.

In the struggle our hero became thrust against the edge of the table. He felt as though his back were breaking, and became conscious that in such a situation he could hope to defend himself only a few moments longer. The stranger's face was pressed close to his own. His hot breath, strong with the odor of garlic, fanned our hero's cheek, while his lips, distended into a ferocious and ferine grin, displayed his sharp teeth shining in the candlelight.

In the fight, our hero was pushed up against the edge of the table. He felt like his back might break and realized that he could only defend himself for a little bit longer. The stranger's face was right up against his. His hot breath, heavy with the smell of garlic, brushed against our hero's cheek, while his lips, twisted into a wild and vicious grin, revealed his sharp teeth glinting in the candlelight.

"Give me ze ball!" he said, in a harsh and furious whisper.

"Give me the ball!" he said in a harsh, angry whisper.

At the moment there rang in Jonathan's ears the sudden and[233] astounding detonation of a pistol shot, and for a moment he wondered whether he had received a mortal wound without being aware of it. Then suddenly he beheld an extraordinary and dreadful transformation take place in the countenance thrust so close to his own; the eyes winked several times with incredible rapidity, and then rolled upward and inward; the jaws gaped into a dreadful and cavernous yawn; the pistol fell with a clatter to the floor, and the next moment the muscles, so rigid but an instant before, relaxed into a limp and listless flaccidity. The joints collapsed, and the entire man fell into an indistinguishable heap upon and across the dead figure stretched out upon the floor, while at the same time a pungent and blinding cloud of gunpowder smoke filled the apartment. For a few moments the hands twitched convulsively; the neck stretched itself to an abominable length; the long, lean legs slowly and gradually relaxed, and every fiber of the body gradually collapsed into the lassitude of death. A spot of blood appeared and grew upon the collar at the throat, and in the same degree the color ebbed from the face, leaving it of a dull and leaden pallor.

At that moment, Jonathan heard the sudden and[233] shocking blast of a gunshot, and for a brief second, he wondered if he had been mortally wounded without realizing it. Then, he saw an unbelievable and horrifying change occur in the face so close to his own; the eyes blinked rapidly several times before rolling upward and inward; the mouth opened wide in a terrifying yawn. The pistol clattered to the floor, and in the next moment, the muscles that had been so tense relaxed into a lifeless, floppy state. The joints gave way, and the entire body crumpled into a heap on top of the lifeless figure sprawled on the floor, as a pungent and blinding cloud of gunpowder smoke filled the room. For a few moments, the hands twitched spasmodically; the neck stretched grotesquely; the long, thin legs slowly relaxed, and every fiber of the body gradually fell into the weakness of death. A spot of blood appeared and spread on the collar at the throat, while the color drained from the face, leaving it a dull, leaden shade.

All these terrible and formidable changes of aspect our hero stood watching with a motionless and riveted attention, and as though they were to him matters of the utmost consequence and importance; and only when the last flicker of life had departed from his second victim did he lift his gaze from this terrible scene of dissolution to stare about him, this way and that, his eyes blinded, and his breath stifled by the thick cloud of sulphurous smoke that obscured the objects about him in a pungent cloud.

All these dreadful and overwhelming changes happening around him kept our hero frozen in intense focus, as if they were incredibly important to him. Only when the last bit of life faded from his second victim did he finally look away from this horrifying scene of decay to glance around him, his vision obscured and his breathing constricted by the thick cloud of sulfurous smoke that surrounded everything in a sharp haze.

V

The Unexpected Encounter with the Sea Captain with the Broken Nose

If our hero had been distracted and bedazed by the first catastrophe that had befallen, this second and even more dreadful and violent occurrence appeared to take away from him, for the[234] moment, every power of thought and of sensation. All that perturbation of emotion that had before convulsed him he discovered to have disappeared, and in its stead a benumbed and blinded intelligence alone remained to him. As he stood in the presence of this second death, of which he had been as innocent and as unwilling an instrument as he had of the first, he could observe no signs either of remorse or of horror within him. He picked up his hat, which had fallen upon the floor in the first encounter, and, brushing away the dust with the cuff of his coat sleeve with extraordinary care, adjusted the beaver upon his head with the utmost nicety. Then turning, still stupefied as with the fumes of some powerful drug, he prepared to quit the scene of tragic terrors that had thus unexpectedly accumulated upon him.

If our hero had been distracted and dazed by the first disaster that had struck, this second and even more dreadful and violent event seemed to take away from him, for the[234] moment, every ability to think and feel. All the emotional upheaval that had previously wracked him he found to have vanished, leaving him with only a numb and clouded mind. As he faced this second death, which he had been as innocent and unwilling a part of as he had with the first, he felt no signs of remorse or horror within himself. He picked up his hat, which had fallen to the floor during the first incident, and, carefully brushing off the dust with his coat sleeve, adjusted it on his head with the utmost precision. Then, still in a daze as if from some strong drug, he prepared to leave the scene of tragic horrors that had unexpectedly piled up around him.

But ere he could put his design into execution his ears were startled by the sound of loud and hurried footsteps which, coming from below, ascended the stairs with a prodigious clatter and bustle of speed. At the landing these footsteps paused for a while, and then approached, more cautious and deliberate, toward the room where the double tragedy had been enacted, and where our hero yet stood silent and inert.

But before he could act on his plan, he was startled by the sound of loud and hurried footsteps coming from below, climbing the stairs with a tremendous clatter and hurry. At the landing, the footsteps stopped for a moment, then approached more cautiously and deliberately toward the room where the double tragedy had taken place, and where our hero still stood silent and motionless.

All this while Jonathan made no endeavor to escape, but stood passive and submissive to what might occur. He felt himself the victim of circumstances over which he himself had no control. Gazing at the partly opened door, he waited for whatever adventure might next befall him. Once again the footsteps paused, this time at the very threshold, and then the door was slowly pushed open from without.

All this time, Jonathan didn't try to escape; he just stood there, accepting whatever might happen. He felt like a victim of circumstances beyond his control. Watching the partly open door, he waited for whatever adventure might come next. Once more, the footsteps stopped, this time right at the threshold, and then the door was slowly pushed open from the outside.

As our hero gazed at the aperture there presently became disclosed to his view the strong and robust figure of one who was evidently of a seafaring habit. From the gold braid upon his hat, the seals dangling from the ribbon at his fob, and a certain particularity of custom, he was evidently one of no small consideration in his profession. He was of a strong and powerful build, with a[235] head set close to his shoulders, and upon a round, short bull neck. He wore a black cravat, loosely tied into a knot, and a red waistcoat elaborately trimmed with gold braid; a leather belt with a brass buckle and hanger, and huge sea boots completed a costume singularly suggestive of his occupation in life. His face was round and broad, like that of a cat, and a complexion stained, by constant exposure to the sun and wind, to a color of newly polished mahogany. But a countenance which otherwise might have been humorous, in this case was rendered singularly repulsive by the fact that his nose had been broken so flat to his face that all that remained to distinguish that feature were two circular orifices where the nostrils should have been. His eyes were by no means so sinister as the rest of his visage, being of a light-gray color and exceedingly vivacious—even good-natured in the merry restlessness of their glance—albeit they were well-nigh hidden beneath a black bush of overhanging eyebrows. When he spoke, his voice was so deep and resonant that it was as though it issued from a barrel rather than from the breast of a human being.

As our hero looked through the opening, he soon spotted the strong, sturdy figure of someone clearly used to the sea. The gold braid on his hat, the seals hanging from the ribbon at his fob, and his distinct manner suggested he was quite important in his field. He had a powerful build, with a head set close to broad shoulders and a short, thick neck. He wore a loosely tied black cravat, a red waistcoat richly trimmed with gold braid, a leather belt with a brass buckle and hanger, and massive sea boots that all hinted at his line of work. His face was round and broad, somewhat feline in appearance, and his complexion, weathered by sun and wind, was the color of shiny mahogany. What might have been a humorous expression was instead quite unpleasant, as his nose was broken so flat against his face that all that remained were two round holes where his nostrils should have been. His eyes were not as menacing as the rest of his features, being a lively light gray and full of life—even friendly in their playful glances—though they were nearly obscured by thick black eyebrows. When he spoke, his voice was so deep and resonant that it sounded more like it came from a barrel than from a human being.

"How now, my hearty!" cried he, in stentorian tones, so loud that they seemed to stun the tensely drawn drums of our hero's ears. "How now, my hearty! What's to do here? Who is shooting pistols at this hour of the night?" Then, catching sight of the figures lying in a huddle upon the floor, his great, thick lips parted into a gape of wonder and his gray eyes rolled in his head like two balls, so that what with his flat face and the round holes of his nostrils he presented an appearance which, under other circumstances, would have been at once ludicrous and grotesque.

"Hey there, my friend!" he shouted in a booming voice, so loud that it seemed to overwhelm our hero's sensitive ears. "Hey there! What's going on here? Who's firing guns at this hour of the night?" Then, noticing the figures huddled on the floor, his thick lips fell open in surprise and his gray eyes swirled in his head like two marbles, creating an expression that, in different circumstances, would have been both funny and bizarre.

"By the blood!" cried he, "to be sure it is murder that has happened here."

"By the blood!" he exclaimed, "it’s definitely murder that’s happened here."

"Not murder!" cried Jonathan, in a shrill and panting voice. "Not murder! It was all an accident, and I am as innocent as a baby."

"Not murder!" Jonathan yelled, his voice sharp and breathless. "Not murder! It was all an accident, and I'm as innocent as a baby."

The newcomer looked at him and then at the two figures upon[236] the floor, and then back at him again with eyes at once quizzical and cunning. Then his face broke into a grin that might hardly be called of drollery. "Accident!" quoth he. "By the blood! d'ye see 'tis a strange accident, indeed, that lays two men by the heels and lets the third go without a scratch!" Delivering himself thus, he came forward into the room, and, taking the last victim of Jonathan's adventure by the arm, with as little compunction as he would have handled a sack of grain he dragged the limp and helpless figure from where it lay to the floor beside the first victim. Then, lifting the lighted candle, he bent over the two prostrate bodies, holding the illumination close to the lineaments first of one and then of the other. He looked at them very carefully for a long while, with the closest and most intent scrutiny, and in perfect silence. "They are both as dead," says he, "as Davy Jones, and, whoever you be, I protest that you have done your business the most completest that I ever saw in all of my life."

The newcomer looked at him, then at the two figures on[236] the floor, and back at him again with a mix of curiosity and slyness. Then his face broke into a grin that could barely be called funny. "An accident!" he said. "By the blood! Do you see it’s a strange accident indeed that knocks two men down and leaves the third without a scratch!" Saying this, he stepped into the room and, grabbing the last victim of Jonathan's adventure by the arm, pulled the limp and helpless figure from where it lay to the floor next to the first victim, as casually as if he were moving a sack of grain. Then, lifting the lit candle, he leaned over the two fallen bodies, holding the light close to one face and then the other. He examined them closely for a long time, scrutinizing them intently in complete silence. "They are both as dead," he said, "as Davy Jones, and whoever you are, I swear that you’ve done your job more completely than I’ve ever seen in my life."

The Burning Ship The Burning Ship

Originally published in
Collier's Weekly, 1898

"Indeed," cried Jonathan, in the same shrill and panting voice, "it was themselves who did it. First one of them attacked me and then the other, and I did but try to keep them from murdering me. This one fell on his knife, and that one shot himself in his efforts to destroy me."

"Yeah," yelled Jonathan, in a sharp and breathless voice, "it was them who did it. First, one of them came at me, and then the other one did too, and I just tried to stop them from killing me. This one stabbed himself, and that one shot himself while trying to take me out."

"That," says the seaman, "you may very well tell to a dry-lander, and maybe he will believe you; but you cannot so easily pull the wool over the eyes of Captain Benny Willitts. And what, if I may be so bold as for to ask you, was the reason for their attacking so harmless a man as you proclaim yourself to be?"

"That," says the sailor, "you might easily say to someone who lives on land, and maybe they'll believe you; but you can't trick Captain Benny Willitts that easily. And what, if I may be so bold to ask, was the reason for them attacking such a harmless person as you claim to be?"

"That I know not," cried Jonathan; "but I am entirely willing to tell thee all the circumstances. Thou must know that I am a member of the Society of Friends. This day I landed here in Kingston, and met a young woman of very comely appearance, who intrusted me with this little ivory ball, which she requested me to keep for her a few days. The sight of this ball—in which I can detect nothing that could be likely to arouse any feelings of [237]violence—appears to have driven these two men entirely mad, so that they instantly made the most ferocious and murderous assault upon me. See! wouldst thou have believed that so small a thing as this would have caused so much trouble?" And as he spoke he held up to the gaze of the other the cause of the double tragedy that had befallen. But no sooner had Captain Willitts's eyes lighted upon the ball than the most singular change passed over his countenance. The color appeared to grow dull and yellow in his ruddy cheeks, his fat lips dropped apart, and his eyes stared with a fixed and glassy glare. He arose to his feet and, still with the expression of astonishment and wonder upon his face, gazed first at our hero and then at the ivory ball in his hands, as though he were deprived both of reason and of speech. At last, as our hero slipped the trifle back in his pocket again, the mariner slowly recovered himself, though with a prodigious effort, and drew a deep and profound breath as to the very bottom of his lungs. He wiped, with the corner of his black-silk cravat, his brow, upon which the sweat appeared to have gathered. "Well, messmate," says he, at last, with a sudden change of voice, "you have, indeed, had a most wonderful adventure." Then with another deep breath: "Well, by the blood! I may tell you plainly that I am no poor hand at the reading of faces. Well, I think you to be honest, and I am inclined to believe every word you tell me. By the blood! I am prodigiously sorry for you, and am inclined to help you out of your scrape.

"That, I don't know," Jonathan exclaimed; "but I'm more than happy to share the whole story with you. You should know I'm a member of the Society of Friends. Today, I landed here in Kingston and met a young woman who was very attractive. She gave me this small ivory ball and asked me to hold onto it for a few days. The sight of this ball—which I can't see causing any feelings of violence—seems to have driven these two men completely insane, making them instantly attack me in the most brutal and murderous way. Can you believe that such a small object could cause so much trouble?" As he spoke, he held up the item that had led to the double tragedy. But as soon as Captain Willitts saw the ball, a strange change came over his face. His rosy cheeks turned dull and yellow, his full lips parted, and his eyes stared with a fixed, glassy look. He stood up, and with a mixture of shock and disbelief, he looked first at our hero and then at the ivory ball in his hands, as if he had lost both his reason and his voice. Finally, as our hero put the object back in his pocket, the sailor slowly got himself together with great effort and took a deep breath, filling his lungs completely. He wiped the sweat from his brow with the corner of his black silk cravat. "Well, shipmate," he said finally, with a sudden shift in his tone, "you've certainly had an incredible adventure." Then, taking another deep breath: "Well, by heavens! I can honestly say I'm good at reading faces. I think you're honest, and I'm inclined to believe everything you tell me. By heavens! I really feel for you, and I'm willing to help you out of your predicament."

"The first thing to do," he continued, "is to get rid of these two dead men, and that is an affair I believe we shall have no trouble in handling. One of them we will wrap up in the carpet here, and t'other we can roll into yonder bed curtain. You shall carry the one and I the other, and, the harbor being at no great distance, we can easily bring them thither and tumble them overboard, and no one will be the wiser of what has happened. For your own safety, as you may easily see, you can hardly go away[238] and leave these objects here to be found by the first comer, and to rise up in evidence against you."

"The first thing we need to do," he continued, "is get rid of these two dead bodies, and I don’t think we’ll have any trouble handling that. We can wrap one of them up in this carpet and roll the other one into that bed curtain over there. You can carry one, and I’ll take the other. Since the harbor isn’t too far away, we can easily take them there and toss them overboard, and no one will know what happened. For your own safety, as you can see, you can’t just leave these bodies here for someone to find, which could end up being evidence against you."

This reasoning, in our hero's present bewildered state, appeared to him to be so extremely just that he raised not the least objection to it. Accordingly, each of the two silent, voiceless victims of the evening's occurrences was wrapped into a bundle that from without appeared to be neither portentous nor terrible in appearance.

This reasoning, given our hero's current confused state, seemed so perfectly reasonable to him that he had no objections at all. So, each of the two silent, voiceless victims of the evening's events was bundled up in a way that looked neither threatening nor frightening from the outside.

Thereupon, Jonathan shouldering the rug containing the little gentleman in black, and the sea captain doing the like for the other, they presently made their way down the stairs through the darkness, and so out into the street. Here the sea captain became the conductor of the expedition, and leading the way down several alleys and along certain by-streets—now and then stopping to rest, for the burdens were both heavy and clumsy to carry—they both came out at last to the harbor front, without anyone having questioned them or having appeared to suspect them of anything wrong. At the waterside was an open wharf extending a pretty good distance out into the harbor. Thither the captain led the way and Jonathan followed. So they made their way out along the wharf or pier, stumbling now and then over loose boards, until they came at last to where the water was of a sufficient depth for their purpose. Here the captain, bending his shoulders, shot his burden out into the dark, mysterious waters, and Jonathan, following his example, did the same. Each body sank with a sullen and leaden splash into the element, where, the casings which swathed them becoming loosened, the rug and the curtain rose to the surface and drifted slowly away with the tide.

Then, Jonathan, carrying the rug with the little gentleman in black, and the sea captain doing the same with the other, made their way down the stairs through the darkness and out into the street. Here, the sea captain took the lead, guiding them through several alleys and by-streets—stopping occasionally to rest, as their loads were both heavy and awkward to carry. Finally, they emerged at the harbor front, without anyone questioning them or seeming to suspect anything was amiss. At the waterfront was an open wharf that extended quite a distance into the harbor. The captain led the way, with Jonathan following. They walked along the wharf or pier, stumbling now and then over loose boards, until they reached a spot where the water was deep enough for their purpose. Here, the captain, bending his shoulders, tossed his burden into the dark, mysterious waters, and Jonathan, following suit, did the same. Each body sank with a dull, heavy splash, and as the wrappings surrounding them loosened, the rug and the curtain floated to the surface and drifted slowly away with the tide.

As Jonathan stood gazing dully at the disappearance of these last evidences of his two inadvertent murders, he was suddenly and vehemently aroused by feeling a pair of arms of enormous strength flung about him from behind. In their embrace his elbows were instantly pinned tight to his side, and he stood for a moment helpless and astounded, while the voice of the sea captain,[239] rumbling in his very ear, exclaimed, "Ye bloody, murthering Quaker, I'll have that ivory ball, or I'll have your life!"

As Jonathan stood there, staring blankly at the fading signs of his two accidental murders, he was suddenly jolted to attention by a pair of incredibly strong arms wrapping around him from behind. His elbows were immediately pinned tightly to his sides, leaving him momentarily helpless and shocked, while the voice of the sea captain,[239] booming in his ear, shouted, "You bloody, murdering Quaker, I want that ivory ball, or I'll take your life!"

These words produced the same effect upon Jonathan as though a douche of cold water had suddenly been flung over him. He began instantly to struggle to free himself, and that with a frantic and vehement violence begotten at once of terror and despair. So prodigious were his efforts that more than once he had nearly torn himself free, but still the powerful arms of his captor held him as in a vise of iron. Meantime, our hero's assailant[240] made frequent though ineffectual attempts to thrust a hand into the breeches' pocket where the ivory ball was hidden, swearing the while under his breath with a terrifying and monstrous string of oaths. At last, finding himself foiled in every such attempt, and losing all patience at the struggles of his victim, he endeavored to lift Jonathan off of his feet, as though to dash him bodily upon the ground. In this he would doubtless have succeeded had he not caught his heel in the crack of a loose board of the wharf. Instantly they both fell, violently prostrate, the captain beneath and Jonathan above him, though still encircled in his iron embrace. Our hero felt the back of his head strike violently upon the flat face of the other, and he heard the captain's skull sound with a terrific crack like that of a breaking egg upon some post or billet of wood, against which he must have struck. In their frantic struggles they had approached extremely near the edge of the wharf, so that the next instant, with an enormous and thunderous splash, Jonathan found himself plunged into the waters of the harbor, and the arms of his assailant loosened from about his body.

These words hit Jonathan like a splash of cold water. He immediately started to fight to escape, filled with a wild and desperate energy born from fear and hopelessness. He struggled so hard that he almost broke free several times, but his captor's strong arms held him like a vise. Meanwhile, the attacker[240] kept trying, with little success, to reach into Jonathan's pocket where the ivory ball was hidden, cursing under his breath with a terrifying stream of profanities. Eventually, frustrated with Jonathan's struggles and failing in every attempt, he tried to lift Jonathan off his feet, as if he intended to slam him down onto the ground. He likely would have succeeded if he hadn’t caught his heel on a loose board of the wharf. They both fell to the ground hard, the captain underneath and Jonathan on top, still trapped in his grip. Jonathan felt the back of his head hit the captain's face, and he heard the captain's skull crack like an egg hitting a post or piece of wood. In their wild struggle, they had moved dangerously close to the edge of the wharf, and in the next moment, with a massive splash, Jonathan found himself submerged in the harbor waters, free from his captor's grasp.

Dead Men Tell No Tales Dead Men Tell No Tales

Originally published in
Collier's Weekly, December 17, 1899

The shock of the water brought him instantly to his senses, and, being a fairly good swimmer, he had not the least difficulty in reaching and clutching the crosspiece of a wooden ladder that, coated with slimy sea moss, led from the water level to the wharf above.

The cold water jolted him back to reality, and since he was a decent swimmer, he had no trouble at all grabbing onto the rungs of a wooden ladder covered in slippery sea moss that went from the water to the wharf above.

After reaching the safety of the dry land once more, Jonathan gazed about him as though to discern whence the next attack might be delivered upon him. But he stood entirely alone upon the dock—not another living soul was in sight. The surface of the water exhibited some commotion, as though disturbed by something struggling beneath; but the sea captain, who had doubtless been stunned by the tremendous crack upon his head, never arose again out of the element that had engulfed him.

After finally making it back to dry land, Jonathan looked around as if trying to figure out where the next attack might come from. But he was completely alone on the dock—there wasn’t a single person in sight. The water's surface was rippling, as if something was struggling underneath; but the sea captain, who must have been knocked out by the heavy blow to his head, never came back up from the water that had swallowed him.


The moonlight shone with a peaceful and resplendent illumination, and, excepting certain remote noises from the distant town, [241]not a sound broke the silence and the peacefulness of the balmy, tropical night. The limpid water, illuminated by the resplendent moonlight, lapped against the wharf. All the world was calm, serene, and enveloped in a profound and entire repose.

The moonlight glowed with a calm and radiant light, and, aside from some distant sounds from the town, [241]not a single sound disturbed the silence and tranquility of the warm, tropical night. The clear water, lit up by the bright moonlight, gently lapped against the wharf. The whole world felt calm, peaceful, and wrapped in deep and complete relaxation.

Jonathan looked up at the round and brilliant globe of light floating in the sky above his head, and wondered whether it were, indeed, possible that all that had befallen him was a reality and not some tremendous hallucination. Then suddenly arousing himself to a renewed realization of that which had occurred, he turned and ran like one possessed, up along the wharf, and so into the moonlit town once more.

Jonathan looked up at the round, bright globe of light floating in the sky above him and wondered if everything that had happened to him was real and not just some crazy hallucination. Suddenly, shaking off his thoughts and fully realizing what had happened, he turned and ran like he was on fire, up the wharf and back into the moonlit town.

VI

The Conclusion of the Adventure with the Lady with the Silver Veil

Nor did he check his precipitous flight until suddenly, being led perhaps by some strange influence of which he was not at all the master, he discovered himself to be standing before the garden gate where not more than an hour before he had first entered upon the series of monstrous adventures that had led to such tremendous conclusions.

Nor did he slow down his rapid escape until suddenly, maybe guided by some bizarre force that he had no control over, he found himself standing in front of the garden gate where, just an hour earlier, he had begun the series of monstrous adventures that had led to such incredible conclusions.

People were still passing and repassing, and one of these groups—a party of young ladies and gentlemen—paused upon the opposite side of the street to observe, with no small curiosity and amusement, his dripping and bedraggled aspect. But only one thought and one intention possessed our hero—to relieve himself as quickly as possible of that trust which he had taken up so thoughtlessly, and with such monstrous results to himself and to his victims. He ran to the gate of the garden and began beating and kicking upon it with a vehemence that he could neither master nor control. He was aware that the entire neighborhood was becoming aroused, for he beheld lights moving and loud voices of inquiry; yet he gave not the least thought to the disturbance he was creating, but[242] continued without intermission his uproarious pounding upon the gate.

People were still walking back and forth, and one of these groups—a bunch of young men and women—stopped across the street to watch, with a mix of curiosity and amusement, his wet and disheveled appearance. But our hero was consumed by a single thought and purpose—to get rid of the responsibility he had taken on so carelessly, which had resulted in terrible consequences for both himself and others. He ran to the garden gate and started banging on it with a force he couldn’t contain. He noticed that the whole neighborhood was waking up, as he saw lights moving and heard loud voices asking what was going on; yet, he paid no attention to the chaos he was causing, but[242] kept pounding on the gate non-stop.

At length, in answer to the sound of his vehement blows, the little wicket was opened and a pair of eyes appeared thereat. The next instant the gate was cast ajar very hastily, and the pock-pitted negress appeared. She caught him by the sleeve of his coat and drew him quickly into the garden. "Buckra, Buckra!" she cried. "What you doing? You wake de whole town!" Then, observing his dripping garments: "You been in de water. You catch de fever and shake till you die."

At last, in response to his loud knocking, the small gate swung open, revealing a pair of eyes. In the next moment, the gate was flung wide open, and a pockmarked Black woman stepped out. She grabbed him by the sleeve of his coat and quickly pulled him into the garden. "White man, white man!" she exclaimed. "What are you doing? You’re waking up the whole town!" Then, noticing his soaked clothes: "You’ve been in the water. You’ll catch a fever and tremble until you die."

"Thy mistress!" cried Jonathan, almost sobbing in the excess of his emotion; "take me to her upon the instant, or I cannot answer for my not going entirely mad!"

"Your mistress!" cried Jonathan, nearly in tears from his overwhelming emotions. "Take me to her right now, or I can't promise I won't go completely crazy!"

When our hero was again introduced to the lady he found her clad in a loose and elegant negligee, infinitely becoming to her graceful figure, and still covered with the veil of silver gauze that had before enveloped her.

When our hero was reintroduced to the lady, he found her wearing a loose and elegant robe that perfectly complemented her graceful figure, still covered with the silver gauze veil that had previously draped her.

"Friend," he cried, vehemently, approaching her and holding out toward her the little ivory ball, "take again this which thou gavest me! It has brought death to three men, and I know not what terrible fate may befall me if I keep it longer in my possession."

"Friend," he exclaimed passionately, walking up to her and holding out the small ivory ball, "take back what you gave me! It has caused the deaths of three men, and I don’t know what awful fate might come to me if I keep it any longer."

"What is it you say?" cried she, in a piercing voice. "Did you say it hath caused the death of three men? Quick! Tell me what has happened, for I feel somehow a presage that you bring me news of safety and release from all my dangers."

"What are you saying?" she shouted, her voice sharp. "Did you say it has caused the death of three men? Hurry! Tell me what happened, because I somehow feel that you’re bringing me news of safety and freedom from all my troubles."

"I know not what thou meanest!" cried Jonathan, still panting with agitation. "But this I do know: that when I went away from thee I departed an innocent man, and now I come back to thee burdened with the weight of three lives, which, though innocent, I have been instrumental in taking."

"I don’t understand what you mean!" Jonathan shouted, still breathing heavily from his tension. "But I do know this: when I left you, I was an innocent man, and now I return to you carrying the weight of three lives, which, although innocent, I helped to end."

"Explain!" exclaimed the lady, tapping the floor with her foot. "Explain! explain! explain!"

"Explain!" the lady shouted, tapping her foot on the floor. "Explain! explain! explain!"

"That I will," cried Jonathan, "and as soon as I am able![243] When I left thee and went out into the street I was accosted by a little gentleman clad in black."

"Absolutely," shouted Jonathan, "and I'll do it as soon as I can![243] When I left you and stepped out onto the street, I was approached by a small man dressed in black."

"Indeed!" cried the lady. "And had he but one eye, and did he carry a gold-headed cane?"

"Really!" exclaimed the lady. "Did he have only one eye and carry a gold-headed cane?"

"Exactly," said Jonathan; "and he claimed acquaintance with friend Jeremiah Doolittle."

"Exactly," said Jonathan; "and he said he knew my friend Jeremiah Doolittle."

"He never knew him!" cried the lady, vehemently; "and I must tell you that he was a villain named Hunt, who at one time was the intimate consort of the pirate Keitt. He it was who plunged a deadly knife into his captain's bosom, and so murdered him in this very house. He himself, or his agents, must have been watching my gate when you went forth."

"He never knew him!" the lady shouted passionately. "And I have to tell you that he was a villain named Hunt, who was once close with the pirate Keitt. He was the one who stabbed his captain in the chest, killing him right in this house. He or his people must have been watching my gate when you left."

"I know not how that may be," said Jonathan, "but he took me to his apartment, and there, obtaining a knowledge of the trust thou didst burden me with, he demanded it of me, and upon my refusing to deliver it to him he presently fell to attacking me with a dagger. In my efforts to protect my life I inadvertently caused him to plunge the knife into his own bosom and to kill himself."

"I don't know how that could be," said Jonathan, "but he took me to his apartment, and there, learning about the trust you had placed upon me, he demanded it from me. When I refused to give it to him, he immediately attacked me with a dagger. In my attempts to defend myself, I accidentally caused him to stab himself in the chest and kill himself."

"And what then?" cried the lady, who appeared well-nigh distracted with her emotions.

"And what then?" the lady exclaimed, clearly overwhelmed with her emotions.

"Then," said Jonathan, "there came a strange man—a foreigner—who upon his part assaulted me with a pistol, with every intention of murdering me and thus obtaining possession of that same little trifle."

"Then," Jonathan said, "a strange man—someone from another country—attacked me with a gun, clearly intending to kill me and take that little thing for himself."

"And did he," exclaimed the lady, "have long, black mustachios, and did he have silver earrings in his ears?"

"And did he," the lady exclaimed, "have long, black mustaches, and did he have silver earrings in his ears?"

"Yes," said Jonathan, "he did."

"Yes," Jonathan said, "he did."

"That," cried the lady, "could have been none other than Captain Keitt's Portuguese sailing master, who must have been spying upon Hunt! Tell me what happened next!"

"That," exclaimed the lady, "had to be Captain Keitt's Portuguese sailing master, who must have been watching Hunt! Tell me what happened next!"

"He would have taken my life," said Jonathan, "but in the struggle that followed he shot himself accidentally with his own pistol, and died at my very feet. I do not know what would[244] have happened to me if a sea captain had not come and proffered his assistance."

"He would have killed me," Jonathan said, "but during the struggle that followed, he accidentally shot himself with his own gun and died right at my feet. I have no idea what would[244] have happened to me if a sea captain hadn't come and offered his help."

"I AM THE DAUGHTER OF THAT UNFORTUNATE CAPTAIN KEITT" "I am the daughter of that unfortunate Captain Keitt."

"A sea captain!" she exclaimed; "and had he a flat face and a broken nose?"

"A sea captain!" she exclaimed. "Did he have a flat face and a broken nose?"

"Indeed he had," replied Jonathan.

"Yes, he did," replied Jonathan.

"That," said the lady, "must have been Captain Keitt's pirate partner—Captain Willitts, of The Bloody Hand. He was doubtless spying upon the Portuguese."

"That," said the lady, "must have been Captain Keitt's pirate partner—Captain Willitts, of The Bloody Hand. He was probably spying on the Portuguese."

"He induced me," said Jonathan, "to carry the two bodies down to the wharf. Having inveigled me there—where, I suppose, he thought no one could interfere—he assaulted me, and endeavored to take the ivory ball away from me. In my efforts to escape we both fell into the water, and he, striking his head upon the edge of the wharf, was first stunned and then drowned."

"He convinced me," Jonathan said, "to take the two bodies down to the wharf. Once he had lured me there—where I guess he thought no one could interrupt us—he attacked me and tried to take the ivory ball from me. In my attempt to get away, we both fell into the water, and he hit his head on the edge of the wharf, getting stunned first and then drowning."

"Thank God!" cried the lady, with a transport of fervor, and clasping her jeweled hands together. "At last I am free of those who have heretofore persecuted me and threatened my very life itself! You have asked to behold my face; I will now show it to you! Heretofore I have been obliged to keep it concealed lest, recognizing me, my enemies should have slain me." As she spoke she drew aside her veil, and disclosed to the vision of our hero a countenance of the most extraordinary and striking beauty. Her luminous eyes were like those of a Jawa, and set beneath exquisitely arched and penciled brows. Her forehead was like lustrous ivory and her lips like rose leaves. Her hair, which was as soft as the finest silk, was fastened up in masses of ravishing abundance. "I am," said she, "the daughter of that unfortunate Captain Keitt, who, though weak and a pirate, was not so wicked, I would have you know, as he has been painted. He would, doubtless, have been an honest man had he not been led astray by the villain Hunt, who so nearly compassed your destruction. He returned to this island before his death, and made me the sole heir of all that great fortune which he had gathered—perhaps not by the most honest means—[245]in the waters of the Indian Ocean. But the greatest treasure of all that fortune bequeathed to me was a single jewel which you yourself have just now defended with a courage and a fidelity that I cannot sufficiently extol. It is that priceless gem known as the Ruby of Kishmoor. I will show it to you."

"Thank God!" the lady exclaimed passionately, clasping her jeweled hands together. "At last, I'm free from those who have tormented me and threatened my very life! You've asked to see my face; I will show it to you now! Until now, I had to keep it hidden, fearing that if my enemies recognized me, they would kill me." As she spoke, she pulled back her veil, revealing to our hero a face of extraordinary and striking beauty. Her bright eyes resembled those of a Jawa, set beneath beautifully arched and finely shaped brows. Her forehead gleamed like polished ivory, and her lips were like rose petals. Her hair, as soft as the finest silk, was styled in luxuriously abundant masses. "I am," she said, "the daughter of that unfortunate Captain Keitt, who, though weak and a pirate, was not as wicked as he has been made out to be. He would undoubtedly have been an honest man if he hadn't been led astray by the villain Hunt, who nearly caused your downfall. He returned to this island before he died and made me the sole heir of the great fortune he amassed—perhaps not through the most honest means—[245]in the waters of the Indian Ocean. But the greatest treasure he left me was a single jewel that you just defended with courage and loyalty that I can't praise enough. It's the priceless gem known as the Ruby of Kishmoor. I will show it to you."

Hereupon she took the little ivory ball in her hand, and, with a turn of her beautiful wrists, unscrewed a lid so nicely and cunningly adjusted that no eye could have detected where it was joined to the parent globe. Within was a fleece of raw silk containing an object which she presently displayed before the astonished gaze of our hero. It was a red stone of about the bigness of a plover's egg, and which glowed and flamed with such an exquisite and ruddy brilliancy as to dazzle even Jonathan's inexperienced eyes. Indeed, he did not need to be informed of the priceless value of the treasure, which he beheld in the rosy palm extended toward him. How long he gazed at this extraordinary jewel he knew not, but he was aroused from his contemplation by the sound of the lady's voice addressing him. "The three villains," said she, "who have this day met their deserts in a violent and bloody death, had by an accident obtained knowledge that this jewel was in my possession. Since then my life has hung upon a thread, and every step that I have taken has been watched by these enemies, the most cruel and relentless that it was ever the lot of any unfortunate to possess. From the mortal dangers of their machinations you have saved me, exhibiting a courage and a determination that cannot be sufficiently applauded. In this you have earned my deepest admiration and regard. I would rather," she cried, "intrust my life and my happiness to you than into the keeping of any man whom I have ever known! I cannot hope to reward you in such a way as to recompense you for the perils into which my necessities have thrust you; but yet"—and here she hesitated, as though seeking for words in which to express herself—"but yet if you are willing to accept of this jewel, and all of the[246] fortune that belongs to me, together with the person of poor Evaline Keitt herself, not only the stone and the wealth, but the woman also, are yours to dispose of as you see fit!"

She took the little ivory ball in her hand and, with a twist of her beautiful wrists, unscrewed a lid that was so cleverly hidden that no one could tell where it joined the main globe. Inside was a soft bundle of raw silk containing an object that she soon revealed to the astonished gaze of our hero. It was a red stone about the size of a plover's egg, glowing and shining with such exquisite and fiery brilliance that it dazzled even Jonathan's inexperienced eyes. He didn't need anyone to tell him how priceless the treasure was, which he saw in the rosy palm extended toward him. He lost track of how long he stared at this extraordinary jewel until the lady's voice broke his reverie. "The three villains," she said, "who met their fate in a violent and bloody death today, accidentally learned that I had this jewel. Since then, my life has been hanging by a thread, and every move I made was monitored by these merciless enemies, the most cruel anyone could ever encounter. You have saved me from the deadly plots they hatched, showing a bravery and determination deserving of great praise. Because of this, you have my deepest admiration and appreciation. I would rather trust my life and happiness to you than to any man I have ever known! I can't hope to reward you fully for the dangers my situation has put you in; but still"—and here she paused, as if searching for the right words—"if you are willing to accept this jewel, along with all the fortune that belongs to me and the person of poor Evaline Keitt herself, not just the stone and the wealth, but the woman too, are yours to do with as you choose!"

Our hero was so struck aback at this unexpected turn that he knew not upon the instant what reply to make. "Friend," said he, at last, "I thank thee extremely for thy offer, and, though I would not be ungracious, it is yet borne in upon me to testify to thee that as to the stone itself and the fortune—of which thou speakest, and of which I very well know the history—I have no inclination to receive either the one or the other, both the fruits of theft, rapine, and murder. The jewel I have myself beheld three times stained, as it were, with the blood of my fellow man, so that it now has so little value in my sight that I would not give a peppercorn to possess it. Indeed, there is no inducement in the world that could persuade me to accept it, or even to take it again into my hand. As to the rest of thy generous offer, I have only to say that I am, four months hence, to be married to a very comely young woman of Kensington, in Pennsylvania, by name Martha Dobbs, and therefore I am not at all at liberty to consider my inclinations in any other direction."

Our hero was so taken aback by this unexpected turn that he didn't know what to say right away. "Friend," he finally said, "I really appreciate your offer, and while I don't want to be rude, I feel it's important to let you know that regarding the stone and the fortune you mentioned—of which I know the history—I have no desire to accept either, both being products of theft, violence, and murder. I've seen the jewel three times, each time stained with the blood of my fellow man, so it has so little value to me that I wouldn't want it even if you offered it for free. Honestly, there's nothing in the world that could convince me to take it or even hold it again. As for the rest of your generous offer, I should mention that in four months, I am set to marry a lovely young woman named Martha Dobbs from Kensington, Pennsylvania, so I’m not free to consider any other possibilities."

Having so delivered himself, Jonathan bowed with such ease as his stiff and awkward joints might command, and thereupon withdrew from the presence of the charmer, who, with cheeks suffused with blushes and with eyes averted, made no endeavor to detain him.

Having said that, Jonathan bowed as gracefully as his stiff and awkward joints would allow, and then he left the presence of the charmer, who, with flushed cheeks and downcast eyes, made no effort to stop him.

So ended the only adventure of moment that ever happened him in all his life. For thereafter he contented himself with such excitement as his mercantile profession and his extremely peaceful existence might afford.

So ended the only significant adventure he ever had in his life. After that, he settled for the kind of excitement that his business and very quiet life could offer.

Epilogue

In conclusion it may be said that when the worthy Jonathan Rugg was married to Martha Dobbs, upon the following June, some[247] mysterious friend presented to the bride a rope of pearls of such considerable value that when they were realized into money our hero was enabled to enter into partnership with his former patron the worthy Jeremiah Doolittle, and that, having made such a beginning, he by and by arose to become, in his day, one of the leading merchants of his native town of Philadelphia.

In conclusion, it can be said that when the honorable Jonathan Rugg married Martha Dobbs in the following June, a mysterious friend gifted the bride a pearl necklace of such great value that when it was sold for cash, our hero was able to partner with his former mentor, the esteemed Jeremiah Doolittle. With this strong start, he eventually rose to become one of the leading merchants in his hometown of Philadelphia.

 

The End


Books by

HOWARD PYLE

  • HOWARD PYLE'S BOOK OF PIRATES
  • MEN OF IRON
  • A MODERN ALADDIN
  • PEPPER AND SALT
  • THE RUBY OF KISHMOOR
  • STOLEN TREASURE
  • THE WONDER CLOCK

HARPER & BROTHERS PUBLISHERS

Founded 1817





        
        
    
Download ePUB

If you like this ebook, consider a donation!